Attached files

file filename
EX-32 - EXHIBIT 32 - Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolisex32section1350certificati.htm
EX-31.3 - EXHIBIT 31.3 - Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolisex313.htm
EX-31.2 - EXHIBIT 31.2 - Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolisex312.htm
EX-31.1 - EXHIBIT 31.1 - Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolisex311.htm
EX-24 - EXHIBIT 24 - Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolisex24powerofattorneydecembe.htm
EX-12.0 - EXHIBIT 12.0 - Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolisex12.htm
EX-10.10 - EXHIBIT 10.10 - Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolisex1010.htm
EX-10.7 - EXHIBIT 10.7 - Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolisex107.htm


UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
  FORM 10-K
 
 (Mark One)
x
ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2017
Or
 
o
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the transition period from              to            
Commission file number 000-51404
  FEDERAL HOME LOAN BANK OF INDIANAPOLIS
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
  
 
Federally Chartered Corporation
 
35-6001443
(State or other jurisdiction of incorporation)
 
(IRS employer identification number)
 
 
 8250 Woodfield Crossing Blvd. Indianapolis, IN
 
46240
(Address of principal executive offices)
 
(Zip code)
Registrant's telephone number, including area code:
(317) 465-0200
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
Not Applicable
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:
Class B capital stock, par value $100 per share
(Title of class)
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.
o  Yes    x  No
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.
o  Yes    x  No
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.    x  Yes    o  No
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§ 232.405) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).   x  Yes     o No
Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K (§ 229.405) is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant's knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.   x  
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of "large accelerated filer," "accelerated filer" and "smaller reporting company" in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):
o Large accelerated filer
 
o  Accelerated filer
x  Non-accelerated filer (Do not check if a smaller reporting company)
 
o Smaller reporting company
 
 
o Emerging growth company
If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act. o
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act). o  Yes    x  No
Registrant's Class B stock is not publicly traded and is only issued to members of the registrant. Such stock is issued and redeemed at par value, $100 per share, subject to certain regulatory and statutory limits. At June 30, 2017, the aggregate par value of the Class B stock held by members and former members of the registrant was approximately $1.9 billion. At February 28, 2018, 20,395,278 shares of Class B stock were outstanding.

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE: None.



Table of Contents
 
Page
 
 
Number
 
Glossary of Terms
 
Special Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements
ITEM 1.
BUSINESS
 
Operating Segments
7 
 
Funding Sources
 
Community Investment and Affordable Housing Programs
 
Use of Derivatives
 
Supervision and Regulation
 
Membership
 
Competition
 
Employees
 
Available Information
ITEM 1A.
RISK FACTORS
ITEM 1B.
UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS
None
ITEM 2.
PROPERTIES
ITEM 3.
LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
ITEM 4.
MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES
N/A
ITEM 5.
MARKET FOR REGISTRANT'S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES
ITEM 6.
SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA
ITEM 7.
MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
 
Executive Summary
 
Results of Operations and Changes in Financial Condition
 
Operating Segments
 
Analysis of Financial Condition
 
Liquidity and Capital Resources
 
Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements
 
Contractual Obligations
 
Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates
 
Recent Accounting and Regulatory Developments
 
Risk Management
 ITEM 7A.
QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK
 ITEM 8.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA
 ITEM 9.
CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE
None
 ITEM 9A.
CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
 ITEM 9B.
OTHER INFORMATION
None
 ITEM 10.
DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
 ITEM 11.
EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION
 ITEM 12.
SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS
 ITEM 13.
CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE
 ITEM 14.
PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING FEES AND SERVICES
 ITEM 15.
EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES
 ITEM 16.
FORM 10-K SUMMARY
None
 





GLOSSARY OF TERMS

ABS: Asset-Backed Securities
Advance: Secured loan to members, former members or Housing Associates
AFS: Available-for-Sale
AHP: Affordable Housing Program
AMA: Acquired Member Assets
AOCI: Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)
Bank Act: Federal Home Loan Bank Act of 1932, as amended
bps: basis points
CBSA: Core Based Statistical Areas, refer collectively to metropolitan and micropolitan statistical areas as defined by the United States Office of Management and Budget
CDFI: Community Development Financial Institution
CE: Credit Enhancement
CFI: Community Financial Institution, an FDIC-insured depository institution with average total assets below an annually adjusted limit by the Director based on the Consumer Price Index
CFPB: Consumer Financial Protection Bureau
CFTC: United States Commodity Futures Trading Commission
Clearinghouse: A United States Commodity Futures Trading Commission-registered derivatives clearing organization
CME: CME Clearing
CMO: Collateralized Mortgage Obligation
CO bond: Consolidated Obligation bond
DB plan: Pentegra Defined Benefit Pension Plan for Financial Institutions
DC plan: Pentegra Defined Contribution Retirement Savings Plan for Financial Institutions
DDCP: Directors' Deferred Compensation Plan
Director: Director of the Federal Housing Finance Agency
Dodd-Frank Act: Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act, as amended
Exchange Act: Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended
Fannie Mae: Federal National Mortgage Association
FASB: Financial Accounting Standards Board
FDIC: Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation
FHA: Federal Housing Administration
FHLBank: A Federal Home Loan Bank
FHLBanks: The 11 Federal Home Loan Banks or a subset thereof
FHLBank System: The 11 Federal Home Loan Banks and the Office of Finance
FICO®: Fair Isaac Corporation, the creators of the FICO credit score
Final Membership Rule: Final Rule on FHLBank Membership issued by the Federal Housing Finance Agency effective February 19, 2016
Finance Agency: Federal Housing Finance Agency, successor to Finance Board
Finance Board: Federal Housing Finance Board, predecessor to Finance Agency
FLA: First Loss Account
FOMC: Federal Open Market Committee
Form 8-K: Current Report on Form 8-K as filed with the SEC under the Exchange Act
Form 10-K: Annual Report on Form 10-K as filed with the SEC under the Exchange Act
Form 10-Q: Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q as filed with the SEC under the Exchange Act
FRB: Federal Reserve Board
Freddie Mac: Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
GAAP: Generally Accepted Accounting Principles in the United States of America
Ginnie Mae: Government National Mortgage Association
GLB Act: Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act of 1999, as amended
GSE: United States Government-Sponsored Enterprise
HERA: Housing and Economic Recovery Act of 2008, as amended
Housing Associate: Approved lender under Title II of the National Housing Act of 1934 that is either a government agency or is chartered under federal or state law with rights and powers similar to those of a corporation
HTM: Held-to-Maturity
HUD: United States Department of Housing and Urban Development
JCE Agreement: Joint Capital Enhancement Agreement, as amended, among the 11 FHLBanks
LCH: LCH.Clearnet LLC
LIBOR: London Interbank Offered Rate



LRA: Lender Risk Account
LTV: Loan-to-Value
MAP-21: Moving Ahead for Progress in the 21st Century Act, enacted on July 6, 2012
MBS: Mortgage-Backed Securities
MCC: Master Commitment Contract
MDC: Mandatory Delivery Commitment
Moody's: Moody's Investor Services
MPF: Mortgage Partnership Finance®
MPP: Mortgage Purchase Program, including Original and Advantage unless indicated otherwise
MRCS: Mandatorily Redeemable Capital Stock
MVE: Market Value of Equity
NRSRO: Nationally Recognized Statistical Rating Organization
OCC: Office of the Comptroller of the Currency
OCI: Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)
OIS: Overnight-Indexed Swap
ORERC: Other Real Estate-Related Collateral
OTTI: Other-Than-Temporary Impairment or -Temporarily Impaired (as the context indicates)
PFI: Participating Financial Institution
PMI: Primary Mortgage Insurance
REMIC: Real Estate Mortgage Investment Conduit
REO: Real Estate Owned
RMBS: Residential Mortgage-Backed Securities
S&P: Standard & Poor's Rating Service
Safety and Soundness Act: Federal Housing Enterprises Financial Safety and Soundness Act of 1992, as amended
SEC: Securities and Exchange Commission
Securities Act: Securities Act of 1933, as amended
SERP: Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolis 2005 Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan and/or a similar frozen plan
SETP: Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolis 2016 Supplemental Executive Thrift Plan, as amended
SMI: Supplemental Mortgage Insurance
TBA: To Be Announced, which represents a forward contract for the purchase or sale of MBS at a future agreed-upon date for an established price
TDR: Troubled Debt Restructuring
TVA: Tennessee Valley Authority
UPB: Unpaid Principal Balance
VaR: Value at Risk
VIE: Variable Interest Entity
WAIR: Weighted-Average Interest Rate





Special Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements
 
Statements in this Form 10-K, including statements describing our objectives, projections, estimates or predictions, may be considered to be "forward-looking statements." These statements may use forward-looking terminology, such as "anticipates," "believes," "could," "estimates," "may," "should," "expects," "will," or their negatives or other variations on these terms. We caution that, by their nature, forward-looking statements involve risk or uncertainty and that actual results either could differ materially from those expressed or implied in these forward-looking statements or could affect the extent to which a particular objective, projection, estimate, or prediction is realized. These forward-looking statements involve risks and uncertainties including, but not limited to, the following:

economic and market conditions, including the timing and volume of market activity, inflation or deflation, changes in the value of global currencies, and changes in the financial condition of market participants;
volatility of market prices, interest rates, and indices or other factors, resulting from the effects of, and changes in, various monetary or fiscal policies and regulations, including those determined by the FRB and the FDIC, or a decline in liquidity in the financial markets, that could affect the value of investments (including OTTI of private-label RMBS), or collateral we hold as security for the obligations of our members and counterparties;
demand for our advances and purchases of mortgage loans resulting from:
changes in our members' deposit flows and credit demands;
federal or state regulatory developments impacting suitability or eligibility of membership classes;
membership changes, including, but not limited to, mergers, acquisitions and consolidations of charters;
changes in the general level of housing activity in the United States and particularly our district states of Michigan and Indiana, the level of refinancing activity and consumer product preferences; and
competitive forces, including, without limitation, other sources of funding available to our members;
changes in mortgage asset prepayment patterns, delinquency rates and housing values or improper or inadequate mortgage originations and mortgage servicing;
ability to introduce and successfully manage new products and services, including new types of collateral securing advances;
political events, including administrative, legislative, regulatory, or other developments, and judicial rulings that affect us, our status as a secured creditor, our members (or certain classes of members), prospective members, counterparties, GSE's generally, one or more of the FHLBanks and/or investors in the consolidated obligations of the FHLBanks;
ability to access the capital markets and raise capital market funding on acceptable terms;
changes in our credit ratings or the credit ratings of the other FHLBanks and the FHLBank System;
changes in the level of government guarantees provided to other United States and international financial institutions;
dealer commitment to supporting the issuance of our consolidated obligations;
ability of one or more of the FHLBanks to repay its portion of the consolidated obligations, or otherwise meet its financial obligations;
ability to attract and retain skilled personnel;
ability to develop, implement and support technology and information systems sufficient to manage our business effectively;
nonperformance of counterparties to uncleared and cleared derivative transactions;
changes in terms of derivative agreements and similar agreements;
loss arising from natural disasters, acts of war or acts of terrorism;
changes in or differing interpretations of accounting guidance; and
other risk factors identified in our filings with the SEC. 

Although we undertake no obligation to revise or update any forward-looking statements, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise, additional disclosures may be made through reports filed with the SEC in the future, including our Forms 10-K, 10-Q and 8-K. This Form 10-K, including the Business section and Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations, should be read in conjunction with our financial statements and notes, which are included in Item 8.



ITEM 1. BUSINESS

As used in this Form 10-K, unless the context otherwise requires, the terms "we," "us," "our," and the "Bank" refer to the Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolis or its management. We use acronyms and terms throughout this Item that are defined herein or in the Glossary of Terms.

Unless otherwise stated, dollar amounts disclosed in Item 1 are rounded to the nearest million; therefore, dollar amounts of less than one million may not be reflected or, due to rounding, may not appear to agree to the amounts presented in thousands in the Financial Statements and related Notes to Financial Statements. Amounts used to calculate dollar and percentage changes are based on numbers in the thousands. Accordingly, calculations based upon the disclosed amounts (millions) may not produce the same results.

Background Information

The Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolis is a regional wholesale bank that serves its member financial institutions in Michigan and Indiana. We are one of 11 regional FHLBanks across the United States, which, along with the Office of Finance, compose the FHLBank System established in 1932. Each FHLBank is a federal instrumentality of the United States of America that is privately capitalized and funded, receives no Congressional appropriations and operates as an independent entity with its own board of directors, management, and employees.

Our mission is to provide reliable and readily available liquidity to our member institutions in support of housing finance and community investment. Our advance and mortgage purchase programs provide funding to assist members with asset/liability management, interest-rate risk management, mortgage pipelines, and other liquidity needs. In addition to funding, we provide various correspondent services, such as securities safekeeping and wire transfers. We also help to meet the economic and housing needs of communities and families through grants and low-cost advances that help support affordable housing and economic development initiatives.

We are wholly owned by our member institutions. All federally- insured depository institutions (including commercial banks, savings associations and credit unions), CDFIs certified by the CDFI Fund of the United States Treasury, certain non-federally insured credit unions and non-captive insurance companies are eligible to become members of our Bank if they have a principal place of business, or are domiciled, in our district states of Michigan or Indiana. Applicants for membership must meet certain requirements that demonstrate that they are engaged in residential housing finance. All member institutions are required to purchase a minimum amount of our Class B capital stock as a condition of membership. Only members may own our capital stock, except for stock held by former members or their legal successors during their stock redemption period. Our capital stock is not publicly-traded; it is purchased by members from us and redeemed or repurchased by us at the stated par value. With written approval from us, a member may transfer any of its excess capital stock in our Bank to another member at par value.

As a financial cooperative, our members are also our primary customers. We are generally limited to making advances to and purchasing mortgage loans from members; however, by regulation, we are also permitted to make advances to and purchase loans from Housing Associates, but they may not purchase our stock and have no voting rights. We do not lend directly to, or purchase mortgage loans directly from, the general public.
 
The principal source of our funding is the proceeds from the sale to the public of FHLBank debt instruments, known as consolidated obligations, which consist of CO bonds and discount notes. The Office of Finance was established as a joint office of the FHLBanks to facilitate the issuance and servicing of consolidated obligations. The United States government does not guarantee, directly or indirectly, our consolidated obligations, which are the joint and several obligations of all FHLBanks.




Each FHLBank was organized under the authority of the Bank Act as a GSE, i.e., an entity that combines elements of private capital, public sponsorship, and public policy. The public sponsorship and public policy attributes of the FHLBanks include:

an exemption from federal, state, and local taxation, except employment and real estate taxes;
an exemption from registration under the Securities Act (although the FHLBanks are required by federal law to register a class of their equity securities under the Exchange Act);
the requirement that at least 40% of our directors be non-member "independent" directors; that two of these "independent" directors have more than four years of experience representing consumer or community interests in banking services, credit needs, housing, or consumer financial protections; and that the remaining "independent" directors have demonstrated knowledge or experience in auditing or accounting, derivatives, financial management, organizational management, project development or risk management practices, or other expertise established by Finance Agency regulations;
the United States Treasury's authority to purchase up to $4.0 billion of FHLBank consolidated obligations; and
the required allocation of 10% of annual net earnings before interest expense on MRCS to fund the AHP.

As an FHLBank, we seek to maintain a balance between our public policy mission and our goal of providing adequate returns on our members' capital.

The Finance Agency has been the federal regulator of the FHLBanks, Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac since July 2008. The Finance Agency's stated mission is to ensure that the housing GSEs operate in a safe and sound manner so that they serve as a reliable source of liquidity and funding for housing finance and community investment. The Finance Agency's operating expenses with respect to the FHLBanks are funded by assessments on the FHLBanks. No tax dollars are used to support the operations of the Finance Agency relating to the FHLBanks.

Operating Segments

We manage our operations by grouping products and services within two operating segments. The segments identify the principal ways we provide services to our members. These segments reflect our two primary mission asset activities and the manner in which they are managed from the perspective of development, resource allocation, product delivery, pricing, credit risk and operational administration.

These operating segments are (i) traditional, which consists of credit products, investments, and correspondent services and deposits; and (ii) mortgage loans, which consist substantially of mortgage loans purchased from our members through our MPP. The revenues, profit or loss, and total assets for each segment are disclosed in Notes to Financial Statements - Note 18 - Segment Information.

Traditional.

Credit Products. We offer our members a wide variety of credit products, including advances, letters of credit, and lines of credit. We approve member credit requests based on our assessment of the member's creditworthiness and financial condition, as well as its collateral position. All credit products must be fully collateralized by a member's pledge of eligible assets.

Our primary credit product is advances. Members utilize advances for a wide variety of purposes including, but not limited to:

funding for single-family mortgages and multi-family mortgages held in portfolio, including both conforming and non-conforming mortgages (as determined in accordance with secondary market criteria);
temporary funding during the origination, packaging, and sale of mortgages into the secondary market;
funding for commercial real estate loans and, especially with respect to CFIs, funding for small business, small farm, and small agri-business portfolio loans;
acquiring or holding MBS;
short-term liquidity;
asset/liability and interest-rate risk management;
a cost-effective alternative to holding short-term investments to meet contingent liquidity needs;
a competitively priced alternative source of funds, especially with respect to smaller members with less diverse funding sources; and
low-cost funding to help support affordable housing and economic development initiatives.




We offer standby letters of credit, typically for up to 10 years in term, which are rated Aaa by Moody's and AA+ by S&P. Letters of credit are performance contracts that guarantee the performance of a member to a third party and are subject to the same collateralization and borrowing limits that are applicable to advances. Letters of credit may be offered to assist members in facilitating residential housing finance, community lending, asset/liability management, or liquidity. We also offer a standby letter of credit product to collateralize public deposits.

We also offer lines of credit which allow members to fund short-term cash needs without submitting a new application for each funding request.

Advances. We offer a wide array of fixed-rate and adjustable-rate advances, on which interest is generally due monthly. The maturities of advances currently offered typically range from 1 day to 10 years, although the maximum maturity may be longer in some instances. Our primary advance products include:

Fixed-rate Bullet Advances, which have fixed rates throughout the term of the advances. These advances are typically referred to as "bullet" advances because no principal payment is due until maturity. Prepayments prior to maturity may be subject to prepayment fees. These advances can include a feature that allows for delayed settlement.
Putable Advances, which are fixed-rate advances that give us an option to terminate the advance prior to maturity. We would normally exercise the option to terminate the advance when interest rates increase. Upon our exercise of the option, the member must repay the putable advance or convert it to a floating-rate instrument under the terms established at the time of the original issuance.
Fixed-rate Amortizing Advances, which are fixed-rate advances that require principal payments either monthly, annually, or based on a specified amortization schedule and may have a balloon payment of remaining principal at maturity.
Adjustable-rate Advances, which are sometimes called "floaters," reprice periodically based on a variety of indices, including LIBOR. LIBOR floaters are the most common type of adjustable-rate advance we extend to our members. Prepayment terms are agreed to before the advance is extended. Most frequently, no prepayment fees are required if a member prepays an adjustable rate advance on a reset date, after a pre-determined lock-out period, with the required notification. No principal payment is due prior to maturity.
Variable-rate Advances, which reprice daily. These advances may be extended on terms from one day to six months and may be prepaid on any given business day during that term without fee or penalty. No principal payment is due until maturity.
Callable Advances, which are fixed-rate advances that give the member an option to prepay the advance before maturity on call dates with no prepayment fee, which members normally would exercise when interest rates decrease.

We also offer customized advances to meet the particular needs of our members. Our entire menu of advance products is generally available to each creditworthy member, regardless of the member's asset size. Finance Agency regulations require us to price our credit products consistently and without discrimination to any member applying for advances. We are also prohibited from pricing our advances below our marginal cost of matching term and maturity funds in the marketplace, including embedded options, and the administrative cost associated with extending such advances to members. Therefore, advances are typically priced at standard spreads above our cost of funds. Our board-approved credit policy allows us to offer lower rates on certain types of advances transactions. Determinations of such rates are based on factors such as volume, maturity, product type, funding availability and costs, and competitive factors in regard to other sources of funds.

Advances Concentration. Credit risk can be magnified if a lender's portfolio is concentrated in a few borrowers. At December 31, 2017, our top five borrowers accounted for 45% of total advances outstanding, at par. Because of this concentration in advances, we perform frequent credit and collateral reviews on our largest borrowers. In addition, we regularly analyze the implications to our financial management and profitability if we were to lose the business of one or more of these customers.




The following tables present the par value of advances outstanding to our largest borrowers ($ amounts in millions). At our discretion, and provided the borrower meets our contractual requirements, advances to borrowers that are no longer members may remain outstanding until maturity, subject to certain regulatory requirements.
December 31, 2017
 
Advances Outstanding
 
% of Total
Flagstar Bank, FSB
 
$
5,665

 
17
%
Lincoln National Life Insurance Company
 
2,900

 
8
%
Jackson National Life Insurance Company
 
2,621

 
8
%
Chemical Bank
 
2,337

 
7
%
American United Life Insurance Company
 
1,671

 
5
%
Subtotal - largest borrowers
 
15,194

 
45
%
Next five largest borrowers
 
6,802

 
19
%
Others
 
12,173

 
36
%
Total advances, par value
 
$
34,169

 
100
%
 
 
 
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
Advances Outstanding
 
% of Total
Lincoln National Life Insurance Company
 
$
3,350

 
12
%
Flagstar Bank, FSB
 
2,980

 
11
%
Jackson National Life Insurance Company
 
2,376

 
8
%
Tuebor Captive Insurance Company LLC
 
1,660

 
6
%
IAS Services LLC
 
1,650

 
6
%
Subtotal - largest borrowers
 
12,016

 
43
%
Next five largest borrowers
 
5,601

 
20
%
Others
 
10,515

 
37
%
Total advances, par value
 
$
28,132

 
100
%

For the years ended December 31, 2017, 2016, and 2015, we did not have gross interest income on advances, excluding the effects of interest-rate swaps, from any one customer that exceeded 10% of our total interest income.

See Item 7. Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Analysis of Financial Condition - Total Assets - Advances for additional information on advances.

Collateral. All credit products extended to a member must be fully collateralized by the member's pledge of eligible assets. Each borrowing member and its affiliates that hold pledged collateral are required to grant us a security interest in such collateral. All such security interests held by us are afforded a priority by the Competitive Equality Banking Act of 1987 over the claims of any party, including any receiver, conservator, trustee, or similar party having rights as a lien creditor, except for claims held by bona fide purchasers for value or by parties that are secured by prior perfected security interests, provided that such claims would otherwise be entitled to priority under applicable law. Moreover, with respect to federally-insured depository institution members, our claims are given certain preferences pursuant to the receivership provisions of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act.

With respect to insurance company members, however, Congress provided in the McCarran-Ferguson Act of 1945 that state law generally governs the regulation of insurance and shall not be preempted by federal law unless the federal law expressly regulates the business of insurance. Thus, if a court were to determine that the priority status afforded the FHLBanks under Section 10(e) of the Bank Act conflicts with state insurance law applicable to our insurance company members, the court might then determine that the priority of our security interest would be governed by state law, not Section 10(e). Under these circumstances, the "super lien" priority protection afforded to our security interest under Section 10(e) may not fully apply when we lend to insurance company members. However, our security interests in collateral posted by insurance company members have express statutory protections in the jurisdictions where our members are domiciled. In addition, we monitor applicable states' laws, and take all necessary action to obtain and maintain a prior perfected security interest in the collateral, including by taking possession or control of the collateral when appropriate.

    



Collateral Status Categories. We take collateral under a blanket, specific listings or possession status depending on the credit quality of the borrower, the type of institution, and our lien position on assets owned by the member (i.e., blanket, specific, or partially subordinated). The blanket status is the least restrictive and allows the member to retain possession of the pledged collateral, provided that the member executes a written security agreement and agrees to hold the collateral for our benefit. Under the specific listings status, the member maintains possession of the specific collateral pledged, but the member generally provides listings of loans pledged with detailed loan information such as loan amount, payments, maturity date, interest rate, LTV, collateral type, FICO® scores, etc. Members under possession status are required to place the collateral in possession with our Bank or a third-party custodian in amounts sufficient to secure all outstanding obligations.

Eligible Collateral. Eligible collateral types include certain investment securities, one-to-four family first mortgage loans, multi-family first mortgage loans, deposits in our Bank, certain ORERC assets, such as commercial MBS, commercial real estate loans and home equity loans, and small business loans or farm real estate loans from CFIs. While we only extend credit based on the borrowing capacity for such approved collateral, our contractual arrangements typically allow us to take other assets as collateral to provide additional protection, including (in the case of members and former members) the borrower's stock in our Bank.

We have an Anti-Predatory Lending Policy and a Subprime and Nontraditional Residential Mortgage Policy that establish guidelines for any subprime or nontraditional loans included in the collateral pledged to us. Loans that are delinquent or violate those policies do not qualify as acceptable collateral and are required to be removed from any collateral value calculation. With respect to the home mortgage lending rules adopted by the CFPB for residential loans originated on or after January 10, 2014, we accept loans that comply with or are exempt from the ability-to-pay requirements as collateral.

In order to help mitigate the market, credit, liquidity, operational and business risk associated with collateral, we apply an over-collateralization requirement to the book value or market value of pledged collateral to establish its lending value. Collateral that we have determined to contain a low level of risk, such as United States government obligations, is over-collateralized at a lower rate than collateral that carries a higher level of risk, such as small business loans. Standard requirements range from 100% for deposits (cash) to 140% - 155% for residential mortgages pledged through blanket status. Over-collateralization requirements for eligible securities range from 103% to 190%; less traditional types of collateral have standard over-collateralization ratios up to 360%.

The over-collateralization requirement applied to asset classes may also vary depending on collateral status, since lower requirements are applied as our levels of information and control over the assets increase. Over-collateralization requirements are applied using market values for collateral in listing and possession status and book value for collateral pledged through blanket status. In no event, however, would market values assigned to whole loan collateral exceed par value. See Item 7. Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Risk Management - Credit Risk Management - Advances for more information.    
    
Collateral Review and Monitoring. We verify collateral balances by performing periodic, on-site collateral audits on our borrowers, which allows us to verify loan pledge eligibility, credit strength and documentation quality, as well as adherence to our Anti-Predatory Lending Policy, our Subprime and Nontraditional Residential Mortgage Policy, and other collateral policies. In addition, on-site collateral audit findings are used to adjust over-collateralization amounts to mitigate credit risk and collateral liquidity concerns.

Investments. We maintain a portfolio of investments, purchased from approved counterparties, members and their affiliates, or other FHLBanks, to provide liquidity, utilize balance sheet capacity and supplement our earnings. Our investment portfolio may only include investments deemed investment quality at the time of purchase.

Our portfolio of short-term investments in highly-rated entities ensures the availability of funds to meet our members' credit needs. Our short-term investment portfolio typically includes securities purchased under agreements to resell, which are secured by United States Treasuries or agency MBS passthroughs, and unsecured federal funds sold. Each may be purchased with either overnight or term maturities. In the aggregate, the FHLBanks may represent a significant percentage of the federal funds sold market at any one time, although each FHLBank manages its investment portfolio separately.

The longer term investment portfolio typically generates higher returns and may consist of (i) securities issued by the United States government, its agencies, and certain GSEs, (ii) MBS and ABS issued by Fannie Mae, Freddie Mac and Ginnie Mae that derive credit enhancement from their relationship with the United States government, and (iii) other MBS, ABS, CMOs and REMICs rated AAA or equivalent by at least two NRSROs at the time of purchase.




All unsecured investments, including those with our members or their affiliates, are subject to certain selection criteria. Each unsecured counterparty must be approved and has an exposure limit, which is computed in the same manner regardless of the counterparty's status as a member, affiliate of a member or unrelated party. These criteria determine the permissible amount and maximum term of the investment. See Item 7. Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Risk Management - Credit Risk Management - Investments for more information.

Under Finance Agency regulations, except for certain investments authorized under state trust law for our retirement plans, we are prohibited from investing in the following types of securities:

instruments, such as common stock, that represent an equity ownership in an entity, other than stock in small business investment companies, or certain investments targeted to low-income persons or communities;
instruments issued by non-United States entities, other than those issued by United States branches and agency offices of foreign commercial banks;
non-investment grade debt instruments, other than certain investments targeted to low-income persons or communities and instruments that were downgraded after their purchase;
whole mortgages or other whole loans, except for:
those acquired under the MPP or the MPF Program;
certain investments targeted to low-income persons or communities; and
certain foreign housing loans authorized under Section 12(b) of the Bank Act; and
non-United States dollar denominated securities.

In addition, we are prohibited by a Finance Agency regulation and Advisory Bulletin, as well as internal policy, from purchasing certain types of investments, such as interest-only or principal-only stripped MBS, CMOs, REMICs or ABS; residual-interest or interest-accrual classes of CMOs, REMICs, ABS and MBS; and CMOs or REMICs with underlying collateral containing pay option/negative amortization mortgage loans, unless those loans or securities are guaranteed by the United States government, Fannie Mae, Freddie Mac or Ginnie Mae.

Finance Agency regulation further provides that the total book value of our investments in MBS and ABS must not exceed 300% of our total regulatory capital, consisting of Class B stock, retained earnings, and MRCS, as of the day we purchase the investments, based on the capital amount most recently reported to the Finance Agency. If the outstanding balances of our investments in MBS and ABS exceed the limitation at any time, but were in compliance at the time we purchased the investments, we would not be considered out of compliance with the regulation, but we would not be permitted to purchase additional investments in MBS or ABS until these outstanding balances were within the capital limitation. Generally, our goal is to maintain these investments near the 300% limit.

Deposit Products. Deposit products provide a small portion of our funding resources, while also giving members a high-quality asset that satisfies their regulatory liquidity requirements. We offer several types of deposit products to our members and other institutions including overnight and demand deposits. We may accept uninsured deposits from:

our members;
institutions eligible to become members;
any institution for which we are providing correspondent services;
interest-rate swap counterparties;
other FHLBanks; or
other federal government instrumentalities.

Mortgage Loans. Mortgage loans consist of residential mortgage loans purchased from our members through our MPP and participating interests purchased in 2012-2014 from the FHLBank of Topeka in residential mortgage loans that were originated by certain of its members under the MPF Program. These programs help fulfill the FHLBank System's housing mission and provide an additional source of liquidity to FHLBank members that choose to sell mortgage loans into the secondary market rather than holding them in their own portfolios. These programs are considered AMA, a core mission activity of the FHLBanks, as defined by Finance Agency regulations. For additional information, please refer to Item 7. Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Analysis of Financial Condition - Mortgage Loans Held for Portfolio.




Mortgage Purchase Program.

Overview. We purchase mortgage loans directly from our members through our MPP. Members that participate in the MPP are known as PFIs. By regulation, we are not permitted to purchase loans directly from any institution that is not a member or Housing Associate of the FHLBank System, and we may not use a trust or other entity to purchase the loans. We purchase conforming, medium- or long-term, fixed-rate, fully amortizing, level payment loans predominantly for primary, owner-occupied, detached residences, including single-family properties, and two-, three-, and four-unit properties. Additionally, to a lesser degree, we purchase loans for primary, owner-occupied, attached residences (including condominiums and planned unit developments), second/vacation homes, and investment properties.

Our mortgage loan purchases are governed by the Finance Agency's AMA regulation. Further, while the regulation does not expressly limit us to purchasing fixed-rate loans, before purchasing adjustable-rate loans we would need to analyze whether such purchases would require Finance Agency approval under its New Business Activity regulation. Such regulation provides that any material change to an FHLBank's business activity that results in new risks or operations needs to be pre-approved by the Finance Agency.

Under Finance Agency regulations, all pools of mortgage loans currently purchased by us, other than government-insured mortgage loans, must have sufficient credit enhancement to be rated at least investment grade. In accordance with such regulations, we limit the pools of mortgage loans that we will purchase to those with an implied NRSRO credit rating of at least BBB.

Mortgage Standards. All loans we purchase must meet the guidelines for our MPP or be specifically approved as an exception based on compensating factors. Our guidelines generally meet or exceed the underwriting standards of Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac. For example, the maximum LTV ratio for any conventional mortgage loan at the time of purchase is 95%, and borrowers must meet certain minimum credit scores depending upon the type of property or loan. In addition, we will not knowingly purchase any loan that violates the terms of our Anti-Predatory Lending Policy or our Subprime and Nontraditional Residential Mortgage Policy. Furthermore, we require our members to warrant to us that all of the loans pledged or sold to us are in compliance with all applicable laws, including prohibitions on anti-predatory lending. All loans purchased through our MPP with applications dated on or after January 10, 2014 must qualify as "Safe-Harbor Qualified Mortgages" under CFPB rules.

Under our guidelines, a PFI must:

be an active originator of conventional mortgages and have servicing capabilities, if applicable, or use a servicer that we approve;
advise us if it has been the subject of any adverse action by either Fannie Mae or Freddie Mac; and
along with its parent company, if applicable, meet the capital requirements of each state and federal regulatory agency with jurisdiction over the member's or parent company's activities.

Mortgage Loan Concentration. Our board of directors has established a limit that restricts the current outstanding balance (as determined at the last reported month end balance) of MPP loans previously purchased from any one PFI to 50% of the total MPP portfolio balance.

For the years ended December 31, 2017, 2016, and 2015, no mortgage loans outstanding previously purchased from any one PFI contributed interest income that exceeded 10% of our total interest income. See Item 1A. Risk Factors - A Loss of Significant Borrowers, PFIs, Acceptable Loan Servicers or Other Financial Counterparties Could Adversely Impact Our Profitability, Our Ability to Achieve Business Objectives, Our Ability to Pay Dividends or Redeem or Repurchase Capital Stock, and Our Risk Concentration for additional information.

Credit Enhancement. FHA mortgage loans are backed by insurance provided by the United States government and, therefore, no additional credit enhancements (such as an LRA or SMI) are required.

For conventional mortgage loans, the credit enhancement required to reach the minimum credit rating is determined by using an NRSRO credit risk model. The model is used to evaluate each MCC or pool of MCCs to ensure the LRA percentage as credit enhancement is sufficient. The model evaluates the characteristics of the loans the PFIs actually delivered for the likelihood of timely payment of principal and interest. The model's results are based on numerous standard borrower and loan attributes, such as the LTV ratio, loan purpose (such as purchase of home, refinance, or cash-out refinance), type of documentation, income and debt expense ratios and credit scores. Based on the credit assessment, we are required to hold risk-based capital to help mitigate the potential credit risk in accordance with the Finance Agency regulations.



Our original MPP, which we ceased offering for conventional loans in November 2010, relied on credit enhancement from LRA and SMI to achieve an implied credit rating of at least AA based on an NRSRO model in compliance with Finance Agency regulations. In November 2010, we began offering MPP Advantage for new conventional MPP loans, which utilizes an enhanced fixed LRA for additional credit enhancement, resulting in an implied credit rating of at least BBB, consistent with Finance Agency regulations, instead of utilizing coverage from an SMI provider. The only substantive difference between the two programs is the credit enhancement structure. For both the original MPP and MPP Advantage, the funds in the LRA are established in an amount sufficient to cover expected losses in excess of the borrower's equity and PMI, if any, and used to pay losses on a pool basis.

Credit losses on defaulted mortgage loans in a pool are paid from these sources, until they are exhausted, in the following order:

borrower's equity;
PMI, if applicable;
LRA;
SMI, if applicable; and
our Bank.
            
LRA. We use either a "spread LRA" or a "fixed LRA" for credit enhancement. The spread LRA is used in combination with SMI for credit enhancement of conventional mortgage loans purchased under our original MPP, and the fixed LRA is used for all acquisitions of conventional mortgage loans under MPP Advantage.

Original MPP. The spread LRA is funded through a reduction to the net yield earned on the loans, and the corresponding purchase price paid to the PFI reflects our reduced net yield. The LRA for each pool of loans is funded monthly at an annual rate ranging from 6 to 20 bps, depending on the terms of the MCC, and is used to pay loan loss claims or is held until the LRA accumulates to a required "release point." The release point is 20 to 85 bps of the then outstanding principal balances of the loans in that pool, depending on the terms of the original contract. If the LRA exceeds the required release point, the excess amount is eligible for return to the PFI(s) that sold us the loans in that pool, generally subject to a minimum five-year lock-out period after the pool is closed to acquisitions.

MPP Advantage. The LRA for MPP Advantage differs from our original MPP in that the funding of the fixed LRA occurs at the time we acquire the loan and is based on the principal amount purchased. Depending on the terms of the MCC, the LRA funding amount varies between 110 bps and 120 bps of the principal amount. LRA funds not used to pay loan losses may be returned to the PFI subject to a release schedule detailed in each MCC based on the original LRA amount. No LRA funds are returned to the PFI for the first five years after the pool is closed to acquisitions. We absorb any losses in excess of available LRA funds.
    
SMI. For pools of loans acquired under our original MPP, we have credit protection from loss on each loan, where eligible, through SMI, which provides insurance to cover credit losses to approximately 50% of the property's original value, depending on the SMI contract terms, and subject, in certain cases, to an aggregate stop-loss provision in the SMI policy. Some MCCs that equal or exceed $35 million of total initial principal to be sold on a "best-efforts" basis include an aggregate loss/benefit limit or "stop-loss" that is equal to the total initial principal balance of loans under the MCC multiplied by the stop-loss percentage (ranges from 200 - 400 bps), as is then in effect, and represents the maximum aggregate amount payable by the SMI provider under the SMI policy for that pool. Even with the stop-loss provision, the aggregate of the LRA and the amount payable by the SMI provider under an SMI stop-loss contract will be equal to or greater than the amount of credit enhancement required for the pool to have an implied NRSRO credit rating of at least AA at the time of purchase. Non-credit losses, such as uninsured property damage losses that are not covered by the SMI, can be recovered from the LRA to the extent that there are releasable LRA funds available. We absorb any non-credit losses greater than the available LRA. We do not have SMI coverage on loans purchased under MPP Advantage.

Pool Aggregation. We offer pool aggregation under our MPP. Our pool aggregation program is designed to reduce the credit enhancement costs to small and mid-size PFIs. PFIs are allowed to pool their loans with similar pools of loans originated by other PFIs to create aggregate pools of approximately $100 million original UPB or greater. The combination of small and mid-size PFIs' loans into one pool also assists in the evaluation of the amount of LRA needed for the overall credit enhancement.




Conventional Loan Pricing. We consider the cost of the credit enhancement (LRA and SMI, if applicable) when we formulate conventional loan pricing. Each of these credit enhancement structures is accounted for, not only in our expected return on acquired mortgage loans, but also in the risk review performed during the accumulation/pooling process. The pricing of each structure is dependent on a number of factors and is specific to the PFI or group of PFIs.

We typically receive a 0.25% fee on cash-out refinancing transactions with LTVs between 75% and 80%. Our current guidelines do not allow cash-out refinance loans above 80% LTV. We also adjust the market price we pay for loans depending upon market conditions. We continue to evaluate the scope and rate of such fees as they evolve in the industry. We do not pay a PFI any fees other than the servicing fee when the PFI retains the servicing rights.

Servicing. We do not service the mortgage loans we purchase. PFIs may elect to retain servicing rights for the loans sold to us, or they may elect to sell servicing rights to an MPP-approved servicer.

Those PFIs that retain servicing rights receive a monthly servicing fee and may be required to undergo a review by a third-party quality control contractor that advises the PFIs of any deficiencies in servicing procedures or processes and then notifies us so that we can monitor the PFIs' performance. The PFIs that retain servicing rights can sell those rights at a later date with our approval. Servicing activities, whether retained or released, are subject to review by our master servicer, BNY Mellon. If we deem servicing to be inadequate, we can require that the servicing of those loans be transferred to a servicer that is acceptable to us.

The servicers are responsible for all aspects of servicing, including, among other responsibilities, the administration of any foreclosure and claims processes from the date we purchase the loan until the loan has been fully satisfied. Our MPP was designed to require loan servicers to foreclose and liquidate in the servicer's name rather than in our name. As the servicer progresses through the process from foreclosure to liquidation, we are paid in full for all unpaid principal and accrued interest on the loan through the normal remittance process.

It is the servicer's responsibility to initiate loss claims on the loans. No payments from the LRA (other than excess amounts released to the PFI over a period of time in accordance with each MCC) or SMI are made prior to the claims process. For loans that are credit-enhanced with SMI, if it is determined that a loss is covered, the SMI provider pays the claim in full and seeks reimbursement from the LRA funds. The SMI provider is entitled to reimbursement for credit losses from funds available in the LRA that are equal to the aggregate amounts contributed to the LRA less any amounts paid for previous claims and any amounts that have been released to the PFI from the LRA or paid to us to cover prior claims. If the LRA has been depleted but is still being funded, based on our contractual arrangement, we and/or the SMI provider are entitled to reimbursement from those funds as they are received, up to the full reimbursable amount of the claim. These claim payments would be reflected as additional deductions from the LRA as they were paid. See Item 7. Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Risk Management - Credit Risk Management - Mortgage Loans Held for Portfolio - MPP for additional information.

Housing Goals. The Bank Act requires the Finance Agency to establish low-income housing goals for mortgage purchases. Under its housing goals regulation, the Finance Agency may establish low-income housing goals for FHLBanks that acquire, in any calendar year, more than $2.5 billion of conventional mortgages through an AMA program. If we exceed this volume threshold and fail to meet any affordable housing goals established by the Finance Agency that were determined by the Director to have been feasible, we may be required to submit a housing plan to the Finance Agency.

In 2016 and 2015, our conventional mortgage purchase volume exceeded $2.5 billion. The Finance Agency determined with respect to those two years, however, that it would not require us to submit a housing plan, which could otherwise have been required under the regulation.

Funding Sources

The primary source of funds for each of the FHLBanks is the sale of consolidated obligations, which consist of CO bonds and discount notes. The Finance Agency and the United States Secretary of the Treasury oversee the issuance of this debt in the capital markets. Finance Agency regulations govern the issuance of debt on our behalf and authorize us to issue consolidated obligations through the Office of Finance, under Section 11(a) of the Bank Act. No FHLBank is permitted to issue individual debt without the approval of the Finance Agency.




While the primary liability for consolidated obligations issued to provide funds for a particular FHLBank rests with that FHLBank, consolidated obligations are the joint and several obligations of all of the FHLBanks under Section 11(a). Although each FHLBank is a GSE, consolidated obligations are not obligations of, and are not guaranteed by, the United States government. Consolidated obligations are backed only by the financial resources of all of the FHLBanks. Our consolidated obligations are rated Aaa by Moody's and AA+ by S&P.

Consolidated Obligation Bonds. CO bonds satisfy term funding requirements and are issued with a variety of maturities and terms under various programs. The maturities of these securities may range from 4 months to 30 years, but the maturities are not subject to any statutory or regulatory limit. CO bonds can be fixed or adjustable rate and callable or non-callable. Those issued with adjustable-rate payment terms use a variety of indices for interest rate resets, including LIBOR, Federal Funds, United States Treasury Bill, Constant Maturity Swap, Prime Rate, and others. CO bonds are issued and distributed through negotiated or competitively bid transactions with approved underwriters or selling group members.

Consolidated Obligation Discount Notes. We also issue discount notes to provide short-term funds. These securities can have maturities that range from one day to one year, and are offered daily through a discount note selling group and other authorized securities dealers. Discount notes are generally sold below their face values and are redeemed at par when they mature.

Office of Finance. The issuance of consolidated obligations is facilitated and executed by the Office of Finance, which also services all outstanding debt, provides information on capital market developments to the FHLBanks, and manages our relationship with the NRSROs with respect to consolidated obligations. The Office of Finance also prepares and publishes the FHLBanks' combined quarterly and annual financial reports.

As the FHLBanks' fiscal agent for debt issuance, the Office of Finance can control the timing and amount of each issuance. Through its oversight of the United States financial markets, the United States Treasury can also affect debt issuance for the FHLBanks. See Item 1. Business - Supervision and Regulation - Government Corporations Control Act for additional information.

Community Investment and Affordable Housing Programs

Each FHLBank is required to set aside 10% of its annual net earnings before interest expense on MRCS to fund its AHP, subject to an annual FHLBank System-wide minimum of $100 million. Through our AHP, we may provide cash grants or interest subsidies on advances to our members, which are, in turn, provided to awarded projects or qualified individuals to finance the purchase, construction, or rehabilitation of very low- to moderate-income owner-occupied or rental housing. Our AHP includes the following:

Competitive Program, which is the primary grant program to finance the purchase, construction or rehabilitation of housing for individuals with incomes at or below 80% of the median income for the area, and to finance the purchase, construction, or rehabilitation of rental housing, with at least 20% of the units occupied by, and affordable for, very low-income households. Each year, 65% of our annual available AHP funds are granted through this program.

Set-Aside Programs, which include 35% of our annual available AHP funds, are administered through the following:

Homeownership Opportunities Program, which provides assistance with down payments and closing costs to first-time homebuyers;
Neighborhood Impact Program, which provides rehabilitation assistance to homeowners to help improve neighborhoods;
Accessibility Modifications Program, which provides funding for accessibility modifications and minor home rehabilitation for eligible senior homeowners or owner-occupied households with one or more individuals having a permanent disability; and
Disaster Relief Program, which may be activated at our discretion in cases of federal or state disaster declarations for rehabilitation or down payment assistance targeted to low- or moderate-income homeowner disaster victims.

In addition, we offer a variety of specialized advance programs to support housing and community development needs. Through our Community Investment Program, we offer advances to our members involved in community economic development activities benefiting low- or moderate-income families or neighborhoods. These funds can be used for the development of housing, infrastructure improvements, or assistance to small businesses or businesses that are creating or retaining jobs in the member's community for low- and moderate-income families. These advances have maturities ranging from overnight to 20 years and are priced at our cost of funds plus reasonable administrative expenses.




Use of Derivatives

Derivatives are an integral part of our financial management strategies to manage identified risks inherent in our lending, investing and funding activities and to achieve our risk management objectives. Finance Agency regulations and our Enterprise Risk Management Policy establish guidelines for the use of derivatives. Permissible derivatives include interest-rate swaps, swaptions, interest-rate cap and floor agreements, calls, puts, futures, and forward contracts. We are only permitted to execute derivative transactions to manage interest-rate risk exposure inherent in otherwise unhedged asset or liability positions, hedge embedded options in assets and liabilities including mortgage prepayment risk positions, hedge any foreign currency positions, and act as an intermediary between our members and interest-rate swap counterparties. We are prohibited from trading in or the speculative use of these instruments.

Our use of derivatives is the primary way we align the preferences of investors for the types of debt securities they want to purchase and the preferences of member institutions for the types of advances they want to hold and the types of mortgage loans they want to sell. See Notes to Financial Statements - Note 11 - Derivatives and Hedging Activities and Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk for more information.

Supervision and Regulation

The Bank Act. We are supervised and regulated by the Finance Agency, an independent agency in the executive branch of the United States government, established by HERA.

Under the Bank Act, the Finance Agency's responsibility is to ensure that, pursuant to regulations promulgated by the Finance Agency, each FHLBank:

carries out its housing finance mission;
remains adequately capitalized and able to raise funds in the capital markets; and
operates in a safe and sound manner.

The Finance Agency is headed by a Director, who is appointed to a five-year term by the President of the United States, with the advice and consent of the Senate. The Director appoints a Deputy Director for the Division of Enterprise Regulation, a Deputy Director for the Division of FHLBank Regulation, and a Deputy Director for Housing Mission and Goals, who oversees the housing mission and goals of Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac, as well as the housing finance and community and economic development mission of the FHLBanks. HERA also established the Federal Housing Finance Oversight Board, comprised of the Secretaries of the Treasury and HUD, the Chair of the SEC, and the Director. The Federal Housing Finance Oversight Board functions as an advisory body to the Director. The Finance Agency's operating expenses are funded by assessments on the FHLBanks, Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac. As such, no tax dollars or other appropriations support the operations of the Finance Agency or the FHLBanks. In addition to reviewing our submissions of monthly and quarterly information on our financial condition and results of operations, the Finance Agency conducts annual on-site examinations and performs periodic on- and off-site reviews in order to assess our safety and soundness.

The United States Treasury receives a copy of the Finance Agency's annual report to Congress, monthly reports reflecting the FHLBank System's securities transactions, and other reports reflecting the FHLBank System's operations. Our annual financial statements are audited by an independent registered public accounting firm in accordance with standards issued by the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board, as well as the government auditing standards issued by the United States Comptroller General. The Comptroller General has authority under the Bank Act to audit or examine the Finance Agency and the FHLBank System and to decide the extent to which they fairly and effectively fulfill the purposes of the Bank Act. The Finance Agency's Office of Inspector General also has investigation authority over the Finance Agency and the FHLBank System.

GLB Act Amendments to the Bank Act. The GLB Act amended the Bank Act to require that each FHLBank maintain a capital structure comprised of Class A stock, Class B stock, or both. A member can redeem Class A stock upon six months' prior written notice to its FHLBank. A member can redeem Class B stock upon five years' prior written notice to its FHLBank. Class B stock has a higher weighting than Class A stock for purposes of calculating the minimum leverage requirement applicable to each FHLBank.




The Bank Act requires that each FHLBank maintain permanent capital and total capital in sufficient amounts to comply with specified, minimum risk-based capital and leverage capital requirements. From time to time, for reasons of safety and soundness, the Finance Agency may require one or more individual FHLBanks to maintain more permanent capital or total capital than is required by the regulations. Failure to comply with these requirements or the minimum capital requirements could result in the imposition of operating agreements, cease and desist orders, civil money penalties, and other regulatory action, including involuntary merger, liquidation, or reorganization as authorized by the Bank Act.

HERA Amendments to the Bank Act. In addition to establishing the Finance Agency, HERA eliminated regulatory authority to appoint directors to our board. HERA also eliminated regulatory authority to cap director fees (subject to the Finance Agency's review of reasonableness of such compensation), but placed additional controls over executive compensation.

Government Corporations Control Act. We are subject to the Government Corporations Control Act, which provides that, before we can issue and offer consolidated obligations to the public, the Secretary of the United States Treasury must prescribe the form, denomination, maturity, interest rate, and conditions of the obligations; the way and time issued; and the selling price.

Furthermore, this Act provides that the United States Comptroller General may review any audit of the financial statements of an FHLBank conducted by an independent registered public accounting firm. If the Comptroller General undertakes such a review, the results and any recommendations must be reported to Congress, the Office of Management and Budget, and the FHLBank in question. The Comptroller General may also conduct a separate audit of any of our financial statements.

Federal Securities Laws. Our shares of Class B stock are registered with the SEC under the Exchange Act, and we are generally subject to the information, disclosure, insider trading restrictions, and other requirements under the Exchange Act, with certain exceptions. We are not subject to the registration provisions of the Securities Act. We have been, and continue to be, subject to all relevant liability provisions of the Securities Act and the Exchange Act.

Federal and State Banking Laws. We are generally not subject to the state and federal banking laws affecting United States retail depository financial institutions. However, the Bank Act requires the FHLBanks to submit reports to the Finance Agency concerning transactions involving loans and other financial instruments that involve fraud or possible fraud. In addition, we are required to maintain an anti-money laundering program, under which we are required to report suspicious transactions to the Financial Crimes Enforcement Network pursuant to the Bank Secrecy Act and the USA Patriot Act.

As a wholesale secured lender and a secondary market purchaser of mortgage loans, we are not, in general, directly subject to the various federal and state laws regarding consumer credit protection, such as anti-predatory lending laws. However, as non-compliance with these laws could affect the value of these loans as collateral or acquired assets, we require our members to warrant that all of the loans pledged or sold to us are in compliance with all applicable laws. Federal law requires that, when a mortgage loan (defined to include any consumer credit transaction secured by the principal dwelling of the consumer) is sold or transferred, the new creditor shall, within 30 days of the sale or transfer, notify the borrower of the following: the identity, address and telephone number of the new creditor; the date of transfer; how to contact an agent or party with the authority to act on behalf of the new creditor; the location of the place where the transfer is recorded; and any other relevant information regarding the new creditor. In accordance with this statute, we provide the appropriate notice to borrowers whose mortgage loans we purchase under our MPP and have established procedures to ensure compliance with this notice requirement. In the case of the participating interests in mortgage loans we purchased from the FHLBank of Topeka under the MPF Program, the FHLBank of Chicago (as the MPF Provider) issued the appropriate notice to the affected borrowers and established its own procedures to ensure compliance with the notice requirement.

Regulatory Enforcement Actions. While examination reports are confidential between the Finance Agency and an FHLBank, the Finance Agency may publicly disclose supervisory actions or agreements that the Finance Agency has entered into with an FHLBank. We are not subject to any such Finance Agency actions, and we are not aware of any current Finance Agency actions with respect to other FHLBanks that will have a material adverse effect on our financial results.




Membership

Our membership territory is comprised of the states of Michigan and Indiana. In 2017, we gained 4 new members and lost 16 members (10 depositories as a result of in-district mergers and consolidations as well as 6 captive insurance companies), for a net loss of 12 members.

The following table presents the composition of our members by type of financial institution.
Type of Institution
 
December 31, 2017
 
% of Total
 
December 31, 2016
 
% of Total
Commercial banks and savings associations
 
201

 
53
%
 
210

 
53
%
Credit unions
 
123

 
32
%
 
121

 
31
%
Insurance companies
 
55

 
14
%
 
60

 
15
%
CDFIs
 
3

 
1
%
 
3

 
1
%
Total member institutions
 
382

 
100
%
 
394

 
100
%

Competition

We operate in a highly competitive environment. Member demand for advances is affected by, among other factors, the cost and availability of other sources of funds, including deposits. We compete with other suppliers of wholesale funding, both secured and unsecured. Other suppliers may include the United States government, the Federal Reserve Banks, corporate credit unions, the Central Liquidity Facility, investment banks, commercial banks, and in certain circumstances other FHLBanks. An example of this occurs when a financial holding company has subsidiary banks that are members of different FHLBanks and can, therefore, choose to take advances from the FHLBank with the best terms. Larger institutions may have access to all of these alternatives as well as independent access to the national and global credit markets. The availability of alternative funding sources can be affected by a variety of factors, including market conditions, member creditworthiness, regulatory restrictions, and collateral availability and valuation.

Likewise, our MPP is subject to significant competition. The most direct competition for mortgage purchases comes from other buyers or guarantors of government-guaranteed or conventional, conforming fixed-rate mortgage loans, such as Ginnie Mae, Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac.

We also compete with Fannie Mae, Freddie Mac and other GSEs as well as corporate, sovereign, and supranational entities for funds raised through the issuance of debt instruments. Increases in the supply of competing debt products, in the absence of increases in demand, typically result in higher debt costs to us or lesser amounts of debt issued on our behalf at the same cost than otherwise would be the case.

Employees

As of December 31, 2017, we had 238 full-time employees and 3 part-time employees. Employees are not represented by a collective bargaining unit.




Available Information

Our Annual and Quarterly Reports on Forms 10-K and 10-Q, together with our Current Reports on Form 8-K, are filed with the SEC through the EDGAR filing system. A link to EDGAR is available through our public website at www.fhlbi.com by selecting "News" and then "Investor Relations."

We have a Code of Conduct that is applicable to all directors, officers, and employees and the members of our Affordable Housing Advisory Council. The Code of Conduct is available on our website by scrolling to the bottom of any web page on www.fhlbi.com and then selecting "Corporate Governance" in the navigation menu.

Our 2018 Community Lending Plan describes our plan to address the credit needs and market opportunities in our district states of Michigan and Indiana. It is available on our website at www.fhlbi.com by selecting "Resources" and "Bulletins, Publications and Presentations".

Our Audit Committee operates under a written charter adopted by the board of directors that was most recently amended on March 24, 2017. The Audit Committee charter is available on our website by scrolling to the bottom of any web page on www.fhlbi.com and then selecting "Corporate Governance" in the navigation menu.

We provide our website address and the SEC's website address solely for information. Except where expressly stated, information appearing on our website and the SEC's website is not incorporated into this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Anyone may also request a copy of any of our public financial reports, our Code of Conduct or our 2018 Community Lending Plan through our Corporate Secretary at FHLBank of Indianapolis, 8250 Woodfield Crossing Boulevard, Indianapolis, IN 46240, (317) 465-0200.




ITEM 1A. RISK FACTORS
 
We use acronyms and terms throughout this Item that are defined herein or in the Glossary of Terms.

We have identified the following risk factors that could have a material adverse effect on our Bank.

Changes in the Legal and Regulatory Environment for FHLBanks, Other Housing GSEs or Our Members May Adversely Affect Our Business, Demand for Products, the Cost of Debt Issuance, and the Value of FHLBank Membership

We could be materially adversely affected by: the adoption of new or revised laws, policies, regulations or accounting guidance; new or revised interpretations or applications of laws, policies, or regulations by the Finance Agency, its Office of Inspector General, the SEC, the CFTC, the CFPB, the Financial Stability Oversight Council, the Comptroller General, the FASB or other federal or state financial regulatory bodies; or judicial decisions that alter the present regulatory environment. Likewise, whenever federal elections result in changes in the executive branch or in the balance of political parties’ representation in Congress, there is uncertainty as to potential administrative, regulatory and legislative actions that may materially adversely affect our business.

Changes that restrict the growth or alter the risk profile of our current business or prohibit the creation of new products or services could negatively impact our earnings. For example, our earnings could be negatively impacted by regulatory changes that (i) further restrict the types, characteristics or volume of mortgages that we may purchase through our MPP or otherwise reduce the economic value of MPP to our members, or (ii) require us to change the composition of our assets and liabilities. In addition, the regulatory environment affecting our members could be changed in a manner that would negatively impact their ability to take full advantage of our products and services, our ability to rely on their pledged collateral, or their desire to maintain membership in our Bank. Changes to the regulatory environment that affect our debt underwriters, particularly revised capital and liquidity requirements, could also adversely affect our cost of issuing debt in the capital markets. Similarly, regulatory actions or public policy changes, including those that give preference to certain sectors, business models, regulated entities, or activities, could negatively impact us. For example, changes in the status of Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac during the next phases of their conservatorship or as a result of legislative or regulatory changes, may impact funding costs for the FHLBanks, which could negatively affect our business and results of operations. In addition, negative news articles, industry reports, and other announcements pertaining to GSEs, including Fannie Mae, Freddie Mac or any of the FHLBanks, could cause an increase in interest rates on all GSE debt, as investors may perceive these issuers or their debt instruments as bearing increased risk.

The Finance Agency requires the FHLBanks to maintain sufficient liquidity through short-term investments in an amount at least equal to an FHLBank's cash outflows under two hypothetical scenarios for the treatment of maturing advances. This regulatory guidance is designed to provide sufficient liquidity to protect against temporary disruptions in the capital markets that affect the FHLBanks' access to funding. To satisfy these two scenarios, we maintain balances in shorter-term investments, which may earn lower interest rates than alternate investment options. In certain circumstances we may also need to fund shorter-term advances with short-term discount notes that have maturities beyond those of the related advances, thus increasing our short-term advance pricing or reducing net income through lower net interest spreads. To the extent these increased prices make our advances less competitive, advance levels and net interest income may be negatively affected. In addition, issuance of new regulatory liquidity requirements or guidance in the future could substantially change the amount and characteristics of liquidity that we are required to maintain, which could adversely affect our business, profitability and results of operations.

The CFPB rules include standards for mortgage lenders to follow during the loan approval process to determine whether a borrower has the ability to repay the mortgage loan. The Dodd-Frank Act provides defenses to foreclosure and causes of action for damages if the mortgage lender does not meet the standards in the CFPB rules. A mortgage borrower can assert these defenses and causes of action against the original mortgage lender and against purchasers and other assignees of the mortgage loan, which would include us if we were to purchase a loan under our AMA programs or if we were to direct a servicer to foreclose on mortgage loan collateral. In addition, mortgage lenders unable to sell mortgage loans (whether because they are not qualified mortgages or otherwise) would be expected to retain such loans as assets. If we were to make advances secured, in part, by non-safe harbor qualified mortgages and subsequently liquidate such collateral, we could be subject to these defenses to foreclosure or causes of action for damages by mortgage borrowers. This risk, in turn, could reduce the value of our advances collateral, potentially reducing our likelihood of full repayment on our advances if we were required to sell such collateral.




Regulatory reform since the most recent financial crisis has tended to increase the amount of margin collateral that we must provide to collateralize certain kinds of financial transactions, and has broadened the categories of transactions for which we are required to post margin. For example, the Dodd-Frank Act and related regulatory reform has increased the margin we must provide for cleared and uncleared derivative transactions, and Financial Industry Regulatory Authority Rule 4210 will require us to exchange margin on certain MBS transactions beginning in June 2018. Materially greater margin requirements - due to Dodd-Frank Act derivatives regulatory reform, Financial Industry Regulatory Authority Rule 4210, or otherwise - could adversely affect the availability and pricing of our derivative transactions, making such trades more costly and less attractive as risk management tools. New and expanded margin requirements on derivatives and MBS could also change our risk exposure to our counterparties and may require us to enhance further our systems and processes.
 
Provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act may indirectly affect us due to its effects on our members. For example, this law establishes a solvency framework to address the failure of a financial institution, which could include one or more of our members or financial counterparties. Because the Dodd-Frank Act requires several regulatory bodies to carry out its provisions, its full effect remains uncertain until after the required reports to Congress are issued and implementing regulations are adopted.

Solvency frameworks comparable to the Dodd-Frank Act have been enacted by several members of the European Union pursuant to the European Bank Recovery and Resolution Directive ("BRRD") developed by the Financial Stability Board. We engage in financial transactions with counterparties which are domiciled in countries that have adopted the BRRD. The failure of any such counterparty could subject our transactions with such party to the BRRD solvency framework, the results of which may not be wholly predictable.

In addition, the federal banking regulators are undertaking rulemaking from the Basel Committee on Bank Supervision. The FDIC, OCC, and FRB have established new minimum capital standards for financial institutions that incorporate (which in some cases may further strengthen) the Basel III regulatory capital reforms. Similarly, in 2014, the FRB, OCC and FDIC jointly adopted a rule that incorporates (and in some cases increases) Basel III liquidity requirements. The liquidity coverage ratio ("LCR") rule requires certain non-banking financial organizations ("Covered Organizations") to maintain sufficient amounts of high quality liquid assets ("HQLA") to withstand a 30-day run on the Covered Organization following severe economic stress, based on certain assumptions about outflow rates for HQLAs. If the Covered Organization qualifies as an "advanced approaches" banking organization, the HQLA requirements are also applied on a consolidated basis to each United States-based banking subsidiary of such Covered Organization with more than $10.0 billion in assets. HQLAs must be unencumbered, although they may be pledged as part of a blanket lien to a U.S. central bank or GSE, as long as they do not currently support credit or access to payment services extended to the Covered Organization by such central bank or GSE. HQLAs are divided into three classes or levels. FHLBank consolidated obligations are considered "Level 2A" liquidity assets; as such they can be counted for liquidity purposes, but are subject to a 15% haircut and are capped at 40% of the liquidity requirement. This haircut could make it more costly for any Covered Organization to hold consolidated obligations, which could reduce demand for them. On the other hand, these changes appear to have increased demand for FHLBank advances from the largest depository institution members of the FHLBank System, but do not appear to have affected our members. The LCR rule provisions became fully effective as of January 1, 2017.

The combined effect of these new and amended rules may create unanticipated risks as well. For example, it is thought that the largest members of the FHLBank System have increased their advances levels to meet new Basel III regulatory requirements. At the same time, changes to SEC guidance pertaining to prime money market funds appears to have resulted in a significant increase in demand for government funds and agency debt, as well as FHLBank discount notes. These developments could influence regulatory guidance, particularly with respect to liquidity. We cannot predict what effects, if any, these developments will have on the FHLBank System as a whole or upon our Bank, nor can we predict what additional regulatory actions may be taken as a result.

See Item 7. Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Recent Accounting and Regulatory Developments - Legislative and Regulatory Developments for more information.




Economic Conditions and Policy Could Have an Adverse Effect on Our Business, Liquidity, Financial Condition, and Results of Operations

Our business, liquidity, financial condition, and results of operations are sensitive to general domestic and international business and economic conditions, such as changes in the money supply, inflation, volatility in both debt and equity capital markets, and the strength of the local economies in which we conduct business.

Our business and results of operations are significantly affected by the fiscal and monetary policies of the United States government and its agencies, including the FRB through its regulation of the supply of money and credit in the United States. The FRB's policies either directly or indirectly influence the yield on interest-earning assets, volatility of interest rates, prepayment speeds, the cost of interest-bearing liabilities and the demand for our debt. 

The FOMC continues to maintain its policy of reinvesting principal payments from its holdings of agency debt and agency MBS in agency MBS and of rolling over maturing United States Treasury securities at auction. These policies are intended to help maintain accommodative financial conditions. However, the FRB's continuing substantial participation in both short-term and MBS markets could adversely affect us through lower yields on our investments, higher costs of debt, and disruption of member demand for our products.

Additionally, we are affected by the global economy through member ownership and investments, and through capital markets exposures. Global political, economic, and business uncertainty has led to increased volatility in capital markets and has the potential to drive volatility in the future. Continued economic uncertainties could lead to further global capital market volatility, lower credit availability, and weaker economic growth. As a result, our business could be exposed to unfavorable market conditions, lower demand for mission-related assets, lower earnings, or reduced ability to pay dividends or redeem or repurchase capital stock. 

Our business and results of operations are sensitive to the condition of the housing and mortgage markets, as well as general business and economic conditions. Adverse trends in the mortgage lending sector, including declines in home prices or loan performance trends, could reduce the value of collateral securing member credit and the fair value of our MBS. This change could increase the possibility of under-collateralization, increasing the risk of loss in case of a member's failure, or could increase the risk of loss on our MBS because of additional credit impairment charges. Also, deterioration in the residential mortgage markets could negatively affect the value of our MPP portfolio, resulting in an increase in the allowance for credit losses on mortgage loans and possible additional realized losses if we were forced to liquidate our MPP portfolio.

Our district is comprised of the states of Michigan and Indiana. Increases in unemployment and foreclosure rates or decreases in job or income growth rates in either state could result in less demand for mission-related assets and therefore lower earnings. See Item 7. Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Executive Summary -Economic Environment for more information.

A Failure or Interruption in Our Information Systems, Information Systems of Third-Party Vendors or Service Providers; Unavailability of, or an Interruption of Service at, Our Main Office or Our Backup Facilities; or a Cybersecurity Event Could Adversely Affect Our Business, Risk Management, Financial Condition, Results of Operations, and Reputation

We rely heavily on our information systems and other technology to conduct and manage our business, which inherently involves large financial transactions with our members and other counterparties. Our operations rely on the secure processing, storage and transmission of confidential and other information in our computer systems and networks. These computer systems, software and networks are vulnerable to breaches, unauthorized access, damage, misuse, computer viruses or other malicious code and other events that could potentially jeopardize the confidentiality of such information or otherwise cause interruptions or malfunctions in our operations. In addition, our operations rely on the availability and functioning of our main office, our business resumption center and other facilities. There is no assurance that our business continuity plans, including our security measures, will provide fully effective security or prevent a failure or interruption in our operations. If we experience a significant failure or interruption in our business continuity, disaster recovery or certain information systems, or a significant cybersecurity event, we may be unable to conduct and manage our business functions effectively, we may incur significant expenses in remediating such incidents, and we may suffer reputational harm. Moreover, any of these occurrences could result in increased regulatory scrutiny of our operations.




Despite our policies, procedures, controls and initiatives, some operational risks are beyond our control, and the failure of other parties to adequately address their operational risks could adversely affect us. In addition to internal computer systems, we outsource certain communication and information systems and other critical services to third-party vendors and service providers, including the Office of Finance, derivatives clearing organizations, and loan servicers. Compromised security at any of those third parties could expose us to cyber attacks or other breaches. If one or more of these key external parties were not able to perform their functions for a period of time, at an acceptable service level, or with increased volumes, our business operations could be constrained, disrupted, or otherwise negatively affected. In addition, any failure, interruption or breach in security of these systems, or any disruption of service, could result in failures or interruptions in our ability to conduct and manage our business effectively, including, without limitation, our advances, MPP, funding and hedging activities. There is no assurance that such failures or interruptions will not occur or, if they do occur, that they will be adequately addressed by us or the third parties on which we rely. Any failure, interruption, or breach could significantly harm our customer relations and business operations, which could negatively affect our financial condition, results of operations, or ability to pay dividends or redeem or repurchase capital stock.

We have purchased participating interests in MPF Program mortgage loans that the FHLBank of Topeka acquired from its PFIs. In its role as MPF Provider, the FHLBank of Chicago provides the infrastructure and operational support for the MPF Program and is responsible for publishing and maintaining the MPF Origination, Underwriting and Servicing Guides, which detail the requirements PFIs must follow in originating or selling and servicing MPF Program mortgage loans. If the FHLBank of Chicago changes or ceases to operate the MPF Program or experiences a failure or interruption in its information systems and other technology in its operation of the MPF Program, our MPF business could be adversely impacted, which could negatively affect our financial condition, profitability and cash flows. In the same way, we could be adversely affected if any of the FHLBank of Chicago's third-party vendors that are engaged in the operation of the MPF Program were to experience operational or technical difficulties.

The Inability to Access Capital Markets on Acceptable Terms Could Adversely Affect Our Liquidity, Operations, Financial Condition and Results of Operations, and the Value of Membership in Our Bank

Our primary source of funds is the sale of consolidated obligations in the capital markets. Our ability to obtain funds through the sale of consolidated obligations depends in part on prevailing conditions in the capital markets, such as investor demand and liquidity, and on dealer commitment to inventory and support our debt. Severe financial and economic disruptions in the past, and the United States government's measures to mitigate their effects, including increased capital requirements on dealers' inventory and other regulatory changes affecting dealers, have changed the traditional bases on which market participants value GSE debt securities and consequently could affect our funding costs and practices, which could make it more difficult and more expensive to issue our debt. Any further disruption in the debt market could have an adverse impact on our interest spreads, opportunities to call and reissue existing debt or roll over maturing debt, or ability to meet the Finance Agency's mandates on FHLBank liquidity.

A Loss of Significant Borrowers, PFIs, Acceptable Loan Servicers or Other Financial Counterparties Could Adversely Impact Our Profitability, Our Ability to Achieve Business Objectives, Our Ability to Pay Dividends or Redeem or Repurchase Capital Stock, and Our Risk Concentration
 
The loss of any large borrower or PFI could adversely impact our profitability and our ability to achieve business objectives. The loss of a large borrower or PFI could result from a variety of factors, including acquisition, consolidation of charters within a bank holding company, loss of market share to non-depository institutions, resolution of a financially distressed member, or regulatory changes. As of December 31, 2017, our top two borrowers, Flagstar Bank, FSB and Lincoln National Life Insurance Company, held $5.7 billion and $2.9 billion, respectively, or a total of 25% of total advances outstanding, at par.

At December 31, 2017, 28% of our outstanding par value of MPP loans had been purchased from two PFIs. One of these PFIs originates mortgages on properties in several states, while the other PFI originates mortgages on properties principally in Michigan. We also purchase mortgage loans from many smaller PFIs that predominantly originate mortgage loans on properties in Michigan and Indiana. Therefore, our concentration of MPP loans on properties in Michigan and Indiana could continue to increase over time, as we do not currently limit such concentration.

We do not service the mortgage loans we purchase. PFIs may elect to retain servicing rights for the loans sold to us, or they may elect to sell servicing rights to an MPP-approved servicer. Federal banking regulations and Dodd-Frank Act capital requirements are causing mortgage servicing rights to be transitioned to non-depository institutions, which may reduce the availability of buyers of mortgage servicing rights. A scarcity of mortgage servicers could adversely affect our results of operations.




The number of counterparties that meet our internal and regulatory standards for derivative, repurchase, federal funds sold, TBA, and other financial transactions, such as broker-dealers and their affiliates, has decreased over time. Since the Dodd-Frank Act, however, the requirements for posting margin or other collateral to financial counterparties has tended to increase both in terms of the amount of collateral to be posted and the types of transactions for which margin is now required. Continuing consolidation in the financial services industry has also reduced the number of high-quality counterparties available to us. These factors tend to increase the risk exposure that we have to any one counterparty, and as such may tend to increase our reliance upon each of our counterparties. A failure of any one of our major financial counterparties, or continuing market consolidation, could affect our profitability, results of operations, and ability to enter into additional transactions with existing counterparties without exceeding internal or regulatory risk limits.

Downgrades of Our Credit Rating, the Credit Rating of One or More of the Other FHLBanks, or the Credit Rating of the Consolidated Obligations Could Adversely Impact Our Cost of Funds, Our Ability to Access the Capital Markets, and/or Our Ability to Enter Into Derivative Instrument Transactions on Acceptable Terms

The FHLBanks' consolidated obligations are rated Aaa/P-1 with a stable outlook by Moody's and AA+/A-1+ with a stable outlook by S&P. Rating agencies may from time to time change a rating or issue negative reports. Because each FHLBank has joint and several liability for all FHLBank consolidated obligations, negative developments at any FHLBank may affect these credit ratings or result in the issuance of a negative report regardless of an individual FHLBank's financial condition and results of operations. In addition, because of the FHLBanks' GSE status, the credit ratings of the FHLBanks are generally influenced by the sovereign credit rating of the United States.

Based on the credit rating agencies' criteria, downgrades to the United States' sovereign credit rating and outlook may occur. As a result, similar downgrades in the credit ratings and outlook on the FHLBanks and the FHLBanks' consolidated obligations may also occur, even though they are not obligations of the United States.

Uncertainty remains regarding possible longer-term effects resulting from rating actions. Any future downgrades in our credit ratings and outlook, especially a downgrade to an S&P AA rating or equivalent, could result in higher funding costs, additional collateral posting requirements for certain derivative instrument transactions, or disruptions in our access to capital markets. To the extent that we cannot access funding when needed on acceptable terms to effectively manage our cost of funds, our financial condition and results of operations and the value of membership in our Bank may be negatively affected.

Our Exposure to Credit Losses Could Adversely Affect Our Financial Condition and Results of Operations

We are exposed to credit losses from member products, investment securities and unsecured counterparties.

Member Products.

Advances. If a member fails and the appointed receiver or rehabilitator (or another applicable entity) does not either (i) promptly repay all of the failed institution's obligations to our Bank or (ii) properly assign or assume the outstanding advances, we may be required to liquidate the collateral pledged by the failed institution. The proceeds realized from the liquidation may not be sufficient to fully satisfy the amount of the failed institution's obligations plus the operational cost of liquidation, particularly if market price and interest-rate volatility adversely affect the value of the collateral. Price volatility could also adversely impact our determination of over-collateralization requirements, which could ultimately cause a collateral deficiency in a liquidation scenario. In some cases, we may not be able to liquidate the collateral in a timely manner.

A deterioration of residential or commercial real estate property values could further affect the mortgages pledged as collateral for advances. In order to remain fully collateralized, we may require members to pledge additional collateral, when deemed necessary. If members are unable to fully collateralize their obligations with us, our advances could decrease further, negatively affecting our results of operations or ability to pay dividends or redeem or repurchase capital stock.

Mortgage Loans. Since the inception of the MPP, we have acquired only traditional fixed-rate loans with fixed terms of up to 30 years. If delinquencies in fixed-rate mortgages increase and residential property values decline, we could experience reduced yields or losses exceeding the protection provided by the LRA and SMI credit enhancement and CE obligations, as applicable, on mortgage loans purchased through our MPP or the participating interests in MPF Program loans acquired from the FHLBank of Topeka or another MPF FHLBank.




We are the beneficiary of third-party PMI and SMI (where applicable) coverage on conventional mortgage loans we acquire through our MPP, upon which we rely in part to reduce the risk of losses on those loans. As a result of actions by their respective state insurance regulators, however, certain of our PMI providers are paying less than 100% of the claim amounts. The remaining amounts are deferred until the funds are available or the PMI provider is liquidated. It is possible that insurance regulators may impose restrictions on the ability of our other PMI/SMI providers to pay claims. If our PMI/SMI providers further reduce the portion of mortgage insurance claims they will pay to us or further delay or condition the payment of mortgage insurance claims, or if additional adverse actions are taken by their state insurance regulators, we could experience higher losses on mortgage loans.

We are also exposed to credit losses from servicers for mortgage loans purchased under our MPP or through participating interests in mortgage loans purchased from other FHLBanks under the MPF Program if they fail to perform their contractual obligations.

Investment Securities. The MBS market continues to face uncertainty over the changes in Federal Reserve holdings of MBS and the effect of existing, new or proposed governmental actions. Future declines in the housing price forecast, as well as other factors, such as increased loan default rates and loss severities and decreased prepayment speeds, may result in additional OTTI charges or unrealized losses on private-label RMBS, which could adversely affect our operating results, or ability to pay dividends or redeem or repurchase capital stock.

We are also exposed to credit losses from third-party providers of credit enhancements on the MBS investments that we hold in our investment portfolios, including mortgage insurers, bond insurers and financial guarantors. Our results of operations could be adversely impacted if one or more of these providers fails to fulfill its contractual obligations to us.

Unsecured Counterparties. We assume unsecured credit risk when entering into money market transactions and financial derivatives transactions with domestic and foreign counterparties or through derivatives clearing organizations. A counterparty default could result in losses if our credit exposure to that counterparty is not fully collateralized or if our credit obligations associated with derivative positions are over-collateralized. The insolvency or other inability of a significant counterparty, including a clearing organization, to perform its obligations under such transactions or other agreements could have an adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations, as well as our ability to engage in routine derivative transactions. If we are unable to transact additional business with those counterparties, our ability to effectively use derivatives could be adversely affected, which could impair our ability to manage some aspects of our interest-rate risk.

Our ability to engage in routine derivatives, funding and other transactions could be adversely affected by the actions and commercial soundness of financial institutions that transact business with our counterparties. Financial services institutions are interrelated as a result of trading, clearing, counterparty and/or other relationships. Consequently, financial difficulties experienced by one or more financial services institutions could lead to market-wide disruptions that may impair our ability to find suitable counterparties for routine business transactions.

Changes in Interest Rates or Changes in the Differences Between Short-Term Rates and Long-Term Rates Could Have an Adverse Effect on Our Earnings

Our ability to prepare for changes in interest rates, or to hedge related exposures such as basis risk, significantly affects the success of our asset and liability management activities and our level of net interest income.

The effect of interest rate changes can be exacerbated by prepayment and extension risk, which is the risk that mortgage-based investments will be refinanced by borrowers in low interest-rate environments or will remain outstanding longer than expected at below-market yields when interest rates increase. Decreases in interest rates typically cause mortgage prepayments to increase, which may result in increased premium amortization expense and a decrease in the yield of our mortgage assets as we experience a return of principal that we must re-invest in a lower rate environment. While these prepayments would reduce the asset balance, our balance of consolidated obligations may remain outstanding. Conversely, increases in interest rates typically cause mortgage prepayments to decrease or mortgage cash flows to slow, possibly resulting in the debt funding the portfolio to mature and the replacement debt to be issued at a higher cost, thus reducing our interest spread. A flattening yield curve, in which the difference between short-term interest rates and long-term interest rates is lower relative to prior market conditions, will tend to reduce the net interest margin on new loans added to the MPP portfolio.




In prior years, adverse conditions in the housing and mortgage markets, along with a large drop in market interest rates, allowed us to call a portion of our debt and reissue it at a lower cost, resulting in mortgage spreads that were wider than historic norms and, consequently, higher earnings. More recently, however, we have had fewer opportunities to achieve those wider spreads in that manner. In addition, the outstanding balance of the investment securities that were purchased at higher spreads, as well as the earnings from those investments, have been decreasing. Going forward, we expect these trends to continue to have a moderating effect on our earnings.

Changes to or Replacement of the LIBOR Benchmark Interest Rate Could Adversely Affect Our Business, Financial Condition and Results of Operations

Many of our assets and liabilities are indexed to LIBOR. On July 27, 2017, the Financial Conduct Authority ("FCA"), a regulator of financial services firms and financial markets in the United Kingdom, announced that it intends to stop persuading or compelling banks to submit LIBOR rates after 2021. The FCA has indicated it will support the LIBOR indices through 2021 to allow for an orderly transition to an alternative reference rate. Further, in the United States, efforts to identify a set of alternative U.S. dollar reference interest rates include proposals by the Alternative Reference Rates Committee of the FRB and the Federal Reserve Bank of New York. Other financial services regulators and industry groups are evaluating the possible phase-out of LIBOR and the development of alternate interest rate indices or reference rates.

The transition from LIBOR-referenced assets and liabilities to assets and liabilities indexed to a new reference rate also carries risks. The infrastructure necessary to manage hedging in the alternative reference rate still needs to be built out, and the transition in the markets, and adjustments in our systems, could be disruptive, with disruptions potentially beginning before the currently-planned phase-out of FCA's support of LIBOR. A mechanism does not yet exist to convert the credit and tenor features of LIBOR into any proposed replacement rate, nor has a market been established which could facilitate such conversion. Moreover, there is no guarantee that, if such a market were created and functioning at the time of the transition, the transition will be successful. Similarly, the transition from one reference rate to another could have accounting effects. For example, such transition could have an effect on our hedge effectiveness, which could affect our results of operations. Additionally, our risk management measuring, monitoring and valuation tools factor in LIBOR as a reference rate. Disruptions in the market for LIBOR, and its regulatory framework, could have unanticipated effects on our risk management activities as well.

Given the large volume of LIBOR-based mortgages and financial instruments, the basis adjustment to the replacement floating rate will receive extraordinary scrutiny, but whether the net impact is positive or negative cannot yet be ascertained. We expect that other market participants, including our member institutions, derivatives clearing organizations, and other financial counterparties are also monitoring the LIBOR transition, but we cannot predict how such institutions will react to the transition, or what effects such reactions will have on us. We are not able to predict at this time whether LIBOR will cease to be available after 2021, whether the alternative rates the FRB proposes to publish will become market benchmarks in place of LIBOR, whether the transitions to the new reference rates will be successful, or what the impact of such a transition will be on the Bank's business, financial condition or results of operations.

Competition Could Negatively Impact Advances, the Supply of Mortgage Loans for our MPP, Our Access to Funding and Our Earnings

We operate in a highly competitive environment. Demand for advances is affected by, among other factors, the cost and availability of other sources of liquidity for our members, including deposits. We compete with other suppliers of wholesale funding, both secured and unsecured. Such other suppliers may include the United States government, the Federal Reserve Banks, corporate credit unions, the Central Liquidity Facility, investment banks, commercial banks, and in certain circumstances other FHLBanks. Large institutions may also have independent access to the national and global credit markets. The availability of alternative funding sources to members can significantly influence the demand for advances and can vary as a result of several factors, including market conditions, members' creditworthiness, and availability of collateral. Lower demand for advances could negatively impact our earnings.

Likewise, our MPP is subject to significant competition. The most direct competition for purchases of mortgages comes from other buyers of conventional, conforming, fixed-rate mortgage loans, such as Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac. In addition, PFIs face increased origination competition from originators that are not members of our Bank. Increased competition can result in a smaller share of the mortgages available for purchase through our MPP and, therefore, lower earnings.




We also compete with Fannie Mae, Freddie Mac, and other GSEs as well as corporate, sovereign, and supranational entities for funds raised through the issuance of CO bonds and discount notes. Increases in the supply of competing debt products may, in the absence of increases in demand, result in higher debt costs to us or lesser amounts of debt issued at the same cost than otherwise would be the case. There can be no assurance that our supply of funds through issuance of consolidated obligations will be sufficient to meet our future operational needs.

A Failure of the Business and Financial Models and Related Processes Used to Evaluate Various Financial Risks and Derive Certain Estimates in Our Financial Statements Could Produce Unreliable Projections or Valuations, which Could Adversely Affect Our Business, Financial Condition, Results of Operations and Risk Management

We are exposed to market, business and operational risk, in part due to the significant use of business and financial models when evaluating various financial risks and deriving certain estimates in our financial statements. Our business could be adversely affected if these models fail to produce reliable projections or valuations. These models, which rely on various inputs including, but not limited to, loan volumes and pricing, market conditions for our consolidated obligations, interest-rate spreads and prepayment speeds, implied volatility of options contracts, and cash flows on mortgage-related assets, require management to make critical judgments about the appropriate assumptions that are used in the determinations of such risks and estimates and may overstate or understate the value of certain financial instruments, future performance expectations, or our level of risk exposure. Our models could produce unreliable results for a number of reasons, including, but not limited to, invalid or incorrect assumptions underlying the models, the need for manual adjustments in response to rapid changes in economic conditions, incorrect coding of the models, incorrect data being used by the models or inappropriate application of a model to products or events outside the model's intended use. In particular, models are less dependable when the economic environment is outside of historical experience, as has been the case in recent years. See Item 7. Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates and Risk Management -Operational Risk Management for more information.

A Prolonged Delay in the Initiation or Completion of Foreclosure Proceedings on Mortgage Loans May Have an Adverse Effect on Our Business, Financial Condition and Results of Operations

The processing of foreclosures continues to be slow in certain states due to prolonged foreclosure proceedings resulting from changes in state foreclosure laws, court procedures, post-foreclosure application of state eviction laws and the pipeline of foreclosures resulting from these delays. In addition, inadequate court budgets in certain states could further delay the processing of foreclosures. The foregoing factors continue to have a noticeable effect on the scheduling and enforcement of court-ordered foreclosure sales.

A prolonged delay of mortgage foreclosure proceedings may have adverse effects on our mortgage investments' income and expenses and the market value of the underlying collateral, which could adversely affect our business, financial condition, or results of operations.

A Failure to Meet Minimum Regulatory Capital Requirements Could Affect Our Ability to Pay Dividends, Redeem or Repurchase Capital Stock, and Attract New Members

We are required to maintain sufficient capital to meet specific minimum requirements established by the Finance Agency. If we violate any of these requirements or if our board or the Finance Agency determines that we have incurred, or are likely to incur, losses resulting, or expected to result, in a charge against capital, we would not be able to redeem or repurchase any capital stock while such charges are continuing or expected to continue, even if the statutory redemption period had expired for some or all of such stock. Violations of our capital requirements could also restrict our ability to pay dividends, lend, invest, or purchase mortgage loans or participating interests in mortgage loans, or other business activities. Additionally, the Finance Agency could direct us to call upon our members to purchase additional capital stock to meet our minimum regulatory capital requirements. Members may be unable or unwilling to satisfy such calls for additional capital, thereby adversely affecting their ability to continue doing business with us.

The formula for calculating risk-based capital includes factors that depend on interest rates and other market metrics outside our control and could cause our minimum requirement to increase to a point exceeding our capital level. Further, if our retained earnings were to become inadequate, the Finance Agency could initiate restrictions consistent with those associated with a failure of a minimum capital requirement.




The Dodd-Frank Act requires certain financial companies with total consolidated assets of more than $10.0 billion and that are regulated by a primary federal financial regulatory agency to conduct annual stress tests to determine whether the companies have the capital necessary to absorb losses under adverse economic conditions. The Finance Agency has implemented annual stress testing for the FHLBanks. We must report the results of our stress tests to the Finance Agency and the FRB on an annual basis, and we must also publicly disclose a summary of stress test results for the "severely adverse" scenario on an annual basis.

The severity of the hypothetical scenarios devised by the Finance Agency and the FRB and employed in these stress tests is not defined by law or regulation, and is thus subject to the regulators' discretion. Nonetheless, the results of the stress testing process may affect our approach to managing and deploying capital. The stress testing and capital planning processes may, among other things, require us to increase our capital levels, modify our business strategies, or decrease our exposure to various asset classes.

The stability of our capital is also important in maintaining the value of membership in our Bank. Failure to pay dividends or redeem or repurchase stock at par, or a call upon our members to purchase additional stock to restore capital, could make it more difficult for us to attract new members or retain existing members.

Restrictions on the Redemption, Repurchase, or Transfer of the Bank's Capital Stock Could Result in an Illiquid Investment for the Holder

Under the GLB Act, Finance Agency regulations, and our capital plan, our capital stock may be redeemed upon the expiration of a five-year redemption period, subject to certain conditions. Capital stock may become subject to redemption following the redemption period after a member (i) provides a written redemption notice to the Bank; (ii) gives notice of intention to withdraw from membership; (iii) attains nonmember status by merger or acquisition, charter termination, or other involuntary membership termination; or (iv) has its Bank capital stock transferred by a receiver or other liquidating agent for that member to a nonmember entity. In addition, we may elect to repurchase some or all of the excess capital stock of a shareholder at any time at our sole discretion.

There is no guarantee, however, that we will be able to redeem shareholders' capital stock, even at the end of the prescribed redemption period, or to repurchase their excess capital stock. If a redemption or repurchase of capital stock would cause us to fail to meet our minimum regulatory capital requirements, Finance Agency regulations and our capital plan would prohibit the redemption or repurchase. Moreover, only capital stock that is not required to meet a member's membership capital stock requirement or to support a member or nonmember shareholder's outstanding activity with the Bank (excess capital stock) may be redeemed at the end of the redemption period. Restrictions on the redemption or repurchase of our capital stock could result in an illiquid investment for holders of our stock. In addition, because our capital stock may only be owned by our members (or, under certain circumstances, former members and certain successor institutions), and our capital plan requires our approval before a member or nonmember shareholder may transfer any of its capital stock to another member or nonmember shareholder, we cannot provide assurance that we would allow a member or nonmember shareholder to transfer any excess capital stock to another member or nonmember shareholder at any time.

Providing Financial Support to Other FHLBanks Could Negatively Impact the Bank's Liquidity, Earnings and Capital and Our Members

We are jointly and severally liable with the other FHLBanks for the consolidated obligations issued on behalf of the FHLBanks through the Office of Finance. If another FHLBank were to default on its obligation to pay principal and interest on any consolidated obligations, the Finance Agency may allocate the outstanding liability among one or more of the remaining FHLBanks on a pro rata basis or on any other basis the Finance Agency may determine. In addition to possibly making payments due on consolidated obligations under our joint and several liability, we may voluntarily or involuntarily provide financial assistance to another FHLBank in order to resolve a condition of financial distress. Such assistance could negatively affect our financial condition, our results of operation and the value of membership in our Bank. Moreover, a Finance Agency regulation provides for an FHLBank System-wide annual minimum contribution to AHP of $100 million, and we could be liable for a pro rata share of that amount (based on the FHLBanks' combined net earnings for the previous year), up to 100% of our net earnings for the previous year. Thus, our ability to pay dividends to our members or to redeem or repurchase capital stock could be affected by the financial condition of one or more of the other FHLBanks.




ITEM 2. PROPERTIES

We own an office building containing approximately 117,000 square feet of office and storage space at 8250 Woodfield Crossing Boulevard, Indianapolis, IN, of which we use approximately 65,000 square feet. We lease or hold for lease to various tenants the remaining 52,000 square feet. We also maintain two leased off-site backup facilities of approximately 6,800 square feet and 200 square feet, respectively, that are on electrical distribution grids that are separate from each other and from our office building. In addition, we maintain a third leased off-site backup facility that we plan to begin using as our business resumption center in 2018. See Item 7. Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Risk Management - Operational Risk Management for additional information.

In the opinion of management, our physical properties are suitable and adequate. All of our properties are insured to approximately replacement cost. In the event we were to need more space, our lease terms with tenants generally provide the ability to move tenants to comparable space at other locations at our cost for moving and outfitting any replacement space to meet our tenants' needs.

ITEM 3. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

In the ordinary course of business, we may from time to time become a party to lawsuits involving various business matters. We are unaware of any lawsuits presently pending which, individually or in the aggregate, could have a material effect on our financial condition or results of operations.

ITEM 5. MARKET FOR REGISTRANT'S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES

We use acronyms and terms throughout this Item that are defined herein or in the Glossary of Terms.

No Trading Market

Our Class B capital stock is not publicly traded, and there is no established market for such stock. Members may be required to purchase additional shares of Class B stock from time to time in order to meet minimum stock purchase requirements under our capital plan. Our Class B stock may be redeemed, at a par value of $100 per share, up to five years after we receive a written redemption request by a member, subject to regulatory limits and the satisfaction of any ongoing stock purchase requirements applicable to the member. We may repurchase shares held by members in excess of their required holdings at our discretion at any time in accordance with our capital plan.
 
Our Class B common stock is registered under the Exchange Act. Because our shares of capital stock are "exempt securities" under the Securities Act, purchases and sales of stock by our members are not subject to registration under the Securities Act.

Number of Shareholders

As of February 28, 2018, we had 392 shareholders and $2.0 billion par value of regulatory capital stock, which includes Class B common stock and MRCS issued and outstanding.

Dividends

A cooperative enterprise enjoys the benefits of an integrated customer/shareholder base; however, there are certain tensions inherent in our membership structure that are unusual and unique to the FHLBanks. Because only member institutions and certain former members can own shares of our capital stock and, by statute and regulation, stock can be issued and repurchased only at par, there is no open market for our stock and no opportunity for stock price appreciation. As a result, return on equity can be received only in the form of dividends. 

Dividends may, but are not required to, be paid on our Class B capital stock. Our board of directors may declare and pay dividends in either cash or capital stock or a combination thereof, subject to Finance Agency regulations. Under these regulations, stock dividends cannot be paid if our excess stock is greater than 1% of our total assets. At December 31, 2017, our excess stock was 0.54% of our total assets.





Our board of directors' decisions to declare dividends are influenced by our financial condition, overall financial performance and retained earnings, as well as actual and anticipated developments in the overall economic and financial environment including the level of interest rates and conditions in the mortgage and credit markets. In addition, our board of directors considers several other factors, including our risk profile, regulatory requirements, our relationship with our members and the stability of our current capital stock position and membership.

Our capital plan provides for two sub-series of Class B capital stock: Class B-1 and Class B-2. Class B-1 is stock held by our members that is not subject to a redemption request, while Class B-2 is required stock that is subject to a redemption request. Class B-1 shareholders receive a higher dividend than Class B-2 shareholders. The Class B-2 dividend is presently equal to 80% of the amount of the Class B-1 dividend and can only be changed by an amendment to our capital plan with approval of the Finance Agency. The amount of the dividend to be paid is based on the average number of shares of each sub-series held by a member during the dividend payment period (applicable quarter). For more information, see Notes to Financial Statements - Note 15 - Capital and Item 7. Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Liquidity and Capital Resources - Capital Resources.

We are exempt from federal, state, and local taxation, except for employment and real estate taxes. Despite our tax-exempt status, any cash dividends paid by us to our members are taxable dividends to the members, and our members do not benefit from the exclusion for corporate dividends received. The preceding statement is for general information only; it is not tax advice. Members should consult their own tax advisors regarding particular federal, state, and local tax consequences of purchasing, holding, and disposing of our Class B stock, including the consequences of any proposed change in applicable law.

We paid quarterly cash dividends as set forth in the following table ($ amounts in thousands).
 
 
Class B-1
 
Class B-2
By Quarter Paid
 
Dividend on Capital Stock
 
Interest Expense on MRCS
 
Total
 
Annualized Dividend Rate (1)
 
Dividend on Capital Stock
 
Interest Expense on MRCS
 
Total
 
Annualized Dividend Rate (1)
2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Quarter 1 (2)
 
$
11,481

 
$
1,014

 
$
12,495

 
2.50
%
 
$
6

 
$
20

 
$
26

 
2.00
%
Quarter 1 (2)
 
19,518

 
1,723

 
21,241

 
4.25
%
 
10

 
34

 
44

 
3.40
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Quarter 4
 
$
18,564

 
$
1,724

 
$
20,288

 
4.25
%
 
$
11

 
$
44

 
$
55

 
3.40
%
Quarter 3
 
17,373

 
1,703

 
19,076

 
4.25
%
 
14

 
52

 
66

 
3.40
%
Quarter 2
 
15,803

 
1,701

 
17,504

 
4.25
%
 
15

 
52

 
67

 
3.40
%
Quarter 1 
 
15,545

 
1,824

 
17,369

 
4.25
%
 
19

 
54

 
73

 
3.40
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Quarter 4
 
$
14,966

 
$
1,844

 
$
16,810

 
4.25
%
 
$
11

 
$
57

 
$
68

 
3.40
%
Quarter 3
 
14,637

 
1,804

 
16,441

 
4.25
%
 

 
74

 
74

 
3.40
%
Quarter 2
 
14,384

 
1,930

 
16,314

 
4.25
%
 

 
87

 
87

 
3.40
%
Quarter 1
 
15,797

 
29

 
15,826

 
4.25
%
 

 
98

 
98

 
3.40
%

(1) 
Reflects the annualized dividend rate on all of our average capital stock outstanding in Class B-1 and Class B-2, respectively, regardless of its classification for financial reporting purposes as either capital stock or MRCS. The Class B-2 dividend is paid at 80% of the amount of the Class B-1 dividend.
(2) 
Our board of directors declared a cash dividend of 4.25% (annualized) on our Class B-1 capital stock and 3.40% (annualized) on our Class B-2 capital stock. In addition, our board of directors declared a supplemental cash dividend of 2.50% (annualized) on our Class B-1 capital stock and 2.00% (annualized) on our Class B-2 capital stock.






ITEM 6. SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA
 
We use acronyms and terms throughout this Item that are defined herein or in the Glossary of Terms. The following table should be read in conjunction with the financial statements and related notes and the discussion set forth in Item 7. Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations. The table presents a summary of selected financial information derived from audited financial statements as of and for the years ended as indicated ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
As of and for the Years Ended December 31,
 
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
2013
Statement of Condition:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Advances
 
$
34,055

 
$
28,096

 
$
26,909

 
$
20,789

 
$
17,337

Mortgage loans held for portfolio, net
 
10,356

 
9,501

 
8,146

 
6,820

 
6,168

Cash and investments (1)
 
17,628

 
16,008

 
15,347

 
14,090

 
14,099

Total assets
 
62,349

 
53,907

 
50,608

 
41,853

 
37,764

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Discount notes
 
20,358

 
16,802

 
19,251

 
12,568

 
7,435

CO bonds
 
37,896

 
33,467

 
27,862

 
25,503

 
26,584

Total consolidated obligations
 
58,254

 
50,269

 
47,113

 
38,071

 
34,019

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
MRCS
 
164

 
170

 
14

 
16

 
17

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Capital stock
 
1,858

 
1,493

 
1,528

 
1,551

 
1,610

Retained earnings (2)
 
976

 
887

 
835

 
777

 
730

AOCI
 
112

 
56

 
23

 
47

 
22

Total capital
 
2,946

 
2,436

 
2,386

 
2,375

 
2,362

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Statement of Income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net interest income
 
$
262

 
$
198

 
$
196

 
$
184

 
$
223

Provision for (reversal of) credit losses
 

 

 

 
(1
)
 
(4
)
Net OTTI credit losses
 

 

 

 

 
(2
)
Other income (loss), excluding net OTTI credit losses
 
(6
)
 
6

 
10

 
13

 
71

Other expenses
 
82

 
78

 
72

 
68

 
68

AHP assessments
 
18

 
13

 
13

 
13

 
25

Net income
 
$
156

 
$
113

 
$
121


$
117


$
203

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


 
 
Selected Financial Ratios:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Net interest margin (3)
 
0.45
%
 
0.39
%
 
0.44
%
 
0.47
%
 
0.56
%
Return on average equity
 
5.88
%
 
4.92
%
 
5.13
%
 
4.72
%
 
8.82
%
Return on average assets
 
0.26
%
 
0.22
%
 
0.27
%
 
0.30
%
 
0.51
%
Weighted average dividend rate (4)
 
4.25
%
 
4.25
%
 
4.12
%
 
4.18
%
 
3.50
%
Dividend payout ratio (5)
 
43.05
%
 
53.87
%
 
52.48
%
 
58.96
%
 
28.37
%
Total capital ratio (6)
 
4.72
%
 
4.52
%
 
4.71
%
 
5.68
%
 
6.25
%
Total regulatory capital ratio (7)
 
4.81
%
 
4.73
%
 
4.70
%
 
5.60
%
 
6.24
%
Average equity to average assets
 
4.47
%
 
4.46
%
 
5.23
%
 
6.29
%
 
5.75
%

(1) 
Consists of cash, interest-bearing deposits, securities purchased under agreements to resell, federal funds sold, AFS securities, and HTM securities.
(2) 
Includes restricted and unrestricted retained earnings.
(3) 
Net interest income expressed as a percentage of average interest-earning assets.
(4)  
Dividends paid in cash during the year divided by the average amount of Class B capital stock eligible for dividends under our capital plan, excluding MRCS.
(5) 
Dividends paid in cash during the year divided by net income for the year. The ratio for the year ended December 31, 2014 includes a supplemental dividend of 2.0% related to 2013 results.
(6) 
Capital stock plus retained earnings and AOCI expressed as a percentage of total assets.
(7) 
Capital stock plus retained earnings and MRCS expressed as a percentage of total assets.




ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

Presentation 

This discussion and analysis by management of the Bank's financial condition and results of operations should be read in conjunction with the Financial Statements and related Notes to Financial Statements contained in this Form 10-K.

As used in this Item, unless the context otherwise requires, the terms "we," "us," "our," and the "Bank" refer to the Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolis or its management. We use acronyms and terms throughout this Item that are defined herein or in the Glossary of Terms.

Unless otherwise stated, amounts disclosed in this section of the Form 10-K are rounded to the nearest million; therefore, dollar amounts of less than one million may not be reflected and, due to rounding, may not appear to agree to the amounts presented in thousands in the Financial Statements and related Notes to Financial Statements. Amounts used to calculate dollar and percentage changes are based on numbers in the thousands. Accordingly, calculations based upon the disclosed amounts (millions) may not produce the same results.

Executive Summary
 
Overview. We are a regional wholesale bank that serves as a financial intermediary between the capital markets and our members. We primarily make secured loans in the form of advances to our members and purchase whole mortgage loans from our members. Additionally, we purchase other investments and provide other financial services to our members. Our principal source of funding is the proceeds from the sale to the public of FHLBank debt instruments, called consolidated obligations, which are the joint and several obligation of all FHLBanks. We obtain additional funds from deposits, other borrowings, and the sale of capital stock to our members. As an FHLBank, we are generally designed to expand and contract in asset size as the needs of our members and their communities change over time.

Our primary source of revenue is interest earned on advances, mortgage loans, and long- and short-term investments.
 
Our net interest income is primarily determined by the spread between the interest rate earned on our assets and the interest rate paid on our share of the consolidated obligations. We use funding and hedging strategies to manage the related interest-rate risk.

Due to our cooperative structure and wholesale nature, we typically earn a narrow net interest spread. Accordingly, our net income is relatively low compared to our total assets and capital.

We group our products and services within two operating segments: traditional and mortgage loans.

Economic Environment. The Bank’s financial performance is influenced by a number of national and regional economic and market factors, including the level and volatility of market interest rates, inflation or deflation, monetary policies, and the strength of housing markets.

In the December 2017 FOMC meeting, the FOMC increased the federal funds target range by 0.25% as expected. This was the third increase in 2017, for a total of 1.25% since the tightening cycle began. Several more rate increases are expected by the market during 2018. The FOMC has been able to take a slow and consistent approach to increasing short-term rates as expanding economic activity and a strong labor market have been accompanied by low inflation. The FOMC is still maintaining an accommodative monetary policy, but has begun to reduce its portfolio holdings accumulated during its long quantitative easing cycle. Since 2009, the Federal Reserve has purchased and accumulated over $4 trillion of securities, primarily U.S. Treasury and MBS. The Federal Reserve will continue to reinvest some of the cash flow generated, but intends to reduce its holdings over time. Subsequent to the federal funds target and short-term rate increases, interest rates on longer-maturity U.S. treasuries have increased less than short-term interest rates, resulting in a higher and flattening yield curve.





Real U.S. Gross Domestic Product ("GDP") increased by an annualized rate of 2.5% in the fourth quarter of 2017, moderately lower than the 3.2% increase during the 3rd quarter. The growth deceleration for the quarter has been attributed to a downturn in private inventory investment and increased imports, which is a subtraction in the calculation of GDP. However, this growth marks the current economic expansion at 102 months, compared to a long-term average of 47 months. On an annual basis, real GDP was up 2.3% for all of 2017, according to the advance estimate by the Bureau of Economic Analysis, compared to 1.5% in 2016. Personal consumption expenditures, non-residential fixed investment, and government spending have led GDP growth throughout the year. Strong consumer spending, led by a rebound in the retail sector in the fourth quarter, has been a primary growth factor. The energy sector has experienced a rebound and construction spending remains strong. Manufacturing growth, particularly in light vehicles, has begun to slow in the last quarter of 2017.

Indiana and Michigan’s preliminary unemployment rates for December 2017 improved to 3.4% and 4.7%, respectively. The strong labor market, marked by a 4.1% national unemployment rate in January 2018, has shown regular improvements since the peak unemployment rate of 10% in October 2009. Despite strong continued job growth, wage growth has remained muted throughout most of this expansion cycle. The U.S. economy has produced over two million jobs annually for each of the past five years; however, many of those jobs are part-time or seasonal positions offering lower wages and low or no benefits. This is the likely cause of muted inflation levels despite strong employment and GDP figures through most of the economic cycle. However, markets were surprised with the release of the January 2018 Employment Situation report. The unemployment rate remained unchanged, but wages were up 2.9% from a year earlier, marking the fastest rate of wage growth since 2009.

The housing market has remained strong, showing continued strong price growth, particularly in the starter-home market. Researchers from Zillow, Mortgage Bankers Association, National Association of Realtors and Redfin all forecast that inventories of entry-level homes will remain tight and prices will continue to rise throughout 2018. They all also project rising mortgage rates, contributing to overall less affordable housing than we have enjoyed in recent years.

Indiana University’s Business Research Center projects the average economic growth rate for Indiana to virtually match the rate of national growth through 2020. Personal income growth in the state has lagged national growth levels, though the unemployment rate has been better. Personal income growth through 2020 is forecast to grow at an annual rate of 4.4%. The University of Michigan Research Seminar in Quantitative Economics has reported continued growth in personal income and real disposable income for the state in the past three years and projects continuing improvement in 2018. Michigan is entering its ninth year of economic expansion. Job growth has outpaced the national level through 2016, slowing to an annual rate of +0.9% in the first three quarters of 2017. Projected job growth through 2019 is expected to increase by 1.2%.

Impact on Operating Results. Market interest rates and trends affect yields and margins on earning assets, including advances, purchased mortgage loans, and our investment portfolio, which contribute to our overall profitability. Additionally, market interest rates drive mortgage origination and prepayment activity, which can lead to both favorable and unfavorable interest margin volatility in our MPP and MBS portfolios. A flat yield curve, in which the difference between short-term interest rates and long-term interest rates is low, can have an unfavorable impact on our net interest margins.

Lending and investing activity by our member institutions is a key driver for our balance sheet and income growth. Such activity is a function of both prevailing interest rates and economic activity. Positive economic trends could drive interest rates higher, which could impair growth of the mortgage market. A less active mortgage market could affect demand for advances and activity levels in our mortgage program. However, borrowing patterns between our insurance company and depository members tend to differ during various economic and market conditions, thereby easing the potential magnitude of core business fluctuations during business cycles. Member demand for liquidity during stressed market conditions can lead to advances growth.

Local economic factors, particularly relating to the housing and mortgage markets, influence demand for advances and MPP sales activity by our member institutions.





Results of Operations and Changes in Financial Condition
 
Results of Operations for the Years Ended December 31, 2017 and 2016. The following table presents the comparative highlights of our results of operations ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
 
 
 
Comparative Highlights
 
2017
 
2016
 
$ Change
 
% Change
Net interest income
 
$
262

 
$
198

 
$
64

 
33
%
Provision for (reversal of) credit losses
 

 

 

 
 
Net interest income after provision for credit losses
 
262

 
198

 
64

 
33
%
Other income (loss)
 
(6
)
 
6

 
(12
)
 
 
Other expenses
 
82

 
78

 
4

 
 
Income before assessments
 
174

 
126

 
48

 
38
%
AHP assessments
 
18

 
13

 
5

 
 
Net income
 
156

 
113

 
43

 
38
%
Total other comprehensive income (loss)
 
55

 
33

 
22

 
 
Total comprehensive income
 
$
211

 
$
146

 
$
65

 
44
%

The increase in net income for the year ended December 31, 2017 compared to 2016 was primarily due to higher net interest income as a result of asset growth and higher spreads, partially offset by net losses on derivatives and hedging activities.

The increase in total other comprehensive income for the year ended December 31, 2017 compared to 2016 was primarily due to larger unrealized gains on non-OTTI AFS securities.

Results of Operations for the Years Ended December 31, 2016 and 2015. The following table presents the comparative highlights of our results of operations ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
 
 
 
Comparative Highlights
 
2016
 
2015
 
$ Change
 
% Change
Net interest income
 
$
198

 
$
196

 
$
2

 
1
%
Provision for (reversal of) credit losses
 

 

 

 
 
Net interest income after provision for credit losses
 
198

 
196

 
2

 
1
%
Other income (loss)
 
6

 
10

 
(4
)
 
 
Other expenses
 
78

 
72

 
6

 
 
Income before assessments
 
126

 
134

 
(8
)
 
(6
%)
AHP assessments
 
13

 
13

 

 
 
Net income
 
113

 
121

 
(8
)
 
(7
%)
Total other comprehensive income (loss)
 
33

 
(24
)
 
57

 
 
Total comprehensive income
 
$
146

 
$
97

 
$
49

 
51
%

The decrease in net income for the year ended December 31, 2016 compared to 2015 was primarily due to higher other expenses and lower net proceeds from litigation settlements related to certain private-label RMBS, partially offset by higher net interest income.

The increase in total other comprehensive income for the year ended December 31, 2016 compared to 2015 was primarily due to unrealized gains on non-OTTI AFS securities in 2016 compared to unrealized losses on those securities in 2015.





Changes in Financial Condition for the Year Ended December 31, 2017. The following table presents the comparative highlights of our changes in financial condition ($ amounts in millions).
Condensed Statements of Condition
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
 
$ Change
 
% Change
Advances
 
$
34,055

 
$
28,096

 
$
5,959

 
21
%
Mortgage loans held for portfolio, net
 
10,356

 
9,501

 
855

 
9
%
Cash and investments (1)
 
17,628

 
16,008

 
1,620

 
10
%
Other assets
 
310

 
302

 
8

 
2
%
Total assets
 
$
62,349

 
$
53,907

 
$
8,442

 
16
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Consolidated obligations
 
$
58,254

 
$
50,269

 
$
7,985

 
16
%
MRCS
 
164

 
170

 
(6
)
 
(3
%)
Other liabilities
 
985

 
1,032

 
(47
)
 
(5
%)
Total liabilities
 
59,403

 
51,471

 
7,932

 
15
%
Capital stock
 
1,858

 
1,493

 
365

 
24
%
Retained earnings (2)
 
976

 
887

 
89

 
10
%
AOCI
 
112

 
56

 
56

 
98
%
Total capital
 
2,946

 
2,436

 
510

 
21
%
Total liabilities and capital
 
$
62,349

 
$
53,907

 
$
8,442

 
16
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total regulatory capital (3)
 
$
2,998

 
$
2,550

 
$
448

 
18
%

(1) 
Includes cash, interest-bearing deposits, securities purchased under agreements to resell, federal funds sold, AFS securities, and HTM securities.
(2) 
Includes restricted retained earnings at December 31, 2017 and 2016 of $183 million and $152 million, respectively.
(3) 
Total capital less AOCI plus MRCS.

The increase in total assets at December 31, 2017 compared to December 31, 2016 was primarily attributable to an increase in advances outstanding.

The increase in total liabilities was attributable to a net increase in consolidated obligations to fund our asset growth.

The increase in total capital was primarily as a result of additional capital stock issued to members in connection with the increase in advances. The growth of retained earnings also contributed to the increase.

Outlook. We believe that our financial performance will continue to provide reasonable, risk-adjusted returns for our members across a wide range of business, financial, and economic environments. 

Events in the capital and housing markets in the last several years have provided opportunities for us to generate spreads well above historical levels on certain types of transactions. Lower-cost debt issuances have allowed us to enjoy higher spreads on advances, MPP, MBS and other investments over the past three years, in particular. However, we anticipate spreads normalizing across the balance sheet in coming quarters.

During recent years, our advances business has experienced solid growth in both depository and insurance sectors. However, continued consolidation among our depository members and the run-off from our captive insurance company advances will continue to pressure overall advances levels. Although we believe that advances outstanding to our member institutions could continue to increase, we anticipate more modest growth in our total advances balance in coming quarters.

The steady growth of our mortgage loans held for portfolio over the past several years reflects MPP Advantage purchases outpacing mortgage repayments. Factors that impact the volume of mortgage loans purchased include interest rates, competition, the general level of housing activity in the United States, the level of mortgage refinancing activity, and consumer product preferences. Interest rates are expected to continue to trend upward, which may lead to slowing mortgage market activity, particularly refinancing activity, and a resulting decline in mortgage purchase volume. However, the impact of a decline in purchase volume would be eased by a slower pace of portfolio attrition. We anticipate modest growth in our purchased mortgage portfolio in 2018.





Our investment securities portfolio continued to increase through 2017 as a result of purchases of GSE debentures and agency MBS, while our private-label RMBS portfolio continues to run off. We expect to continue to increase our MBS holdings in 2018, along with an increasing level of non-MBS short-term liquid investments. The Finance Agency has announced that it intends to issue new minimum regulatory liquidity requirements for the FHLBanks in a separate rulemaking or guidance that may increase the Bank's liquidity requirements in the near future. A significant increase in required liquidity could cause a change in the mix of our investment portfolio and have an adverse impact on our earnings and capital adequacy.

Access to debt markets has been reliable. Institutional investors, driven by increased liquidity preferences, risk aversion, and the effects of money market fund reform, increased the market demand for FHLBank debt, which led to advantageous funding opportunities in 2017. The cost of our consolidated obligations in 2018 will depend on several factors, including the direction and level of market interest rates, competition from other issuers of agency debt, changes in the investment preferences of potential buyers of agency debt securities, global demand, pricing in the interest-rate swap market, and other technical market factors.

In addition to having embedded prepayment options and basis risk exposure, which increase both our market risk and earnings volatility, the amortization of purchased premiums on mortgage assets could also cause volatility in our earnings. However, we do not anticipate any major changes in the composition of our statement of condition that would increase earnings sensitivity to changes in the market environment. 

We will continue to engage in various hedging strategies and use derivatives to assist in mitigating the volatility of earnings and the MVE that arises from the maturity structure of our financial assets and liabilities. Although derivatives are used to mitigate market risk, they also introduce the potential for short-term earnings volatility due to basis risk since we must use the OIS curve in place of the LIBOR rate curve as the discount rate to estimate the fair values of collateralized LIBOR-based interest-rate-related derivatives while the hedged items are still valued using the LIBOR rate curve.

We strive to keep our operating expense ratios relatively low while maintaining adequate systems, support and staffing. We expect operating expenses to continue to increase modestly through 2019 as we continue to strategically invest in operating and risk management systems and member service capabilities.

Our board of directors' decisions to declare dividends are influenced by our financial condition, overall financial performance and retained earnings, as well as actual and anticipated developments in the overall economic and financial environment including the level of interest rates and conditions in the mortgage and credit markets. In addition, our board considers several other factors, including our risk profile, regulatory requirements, our relationship with our members and the stability of our current capital stock position and membership.





Analysis of Results of Operations for the Years Ended December 31, 2017, 2016 and 2015.

Net Interest Income. Net interest income, which is primarily the interest income on advances, mortgage loans held for portfolio, short-term investments, and investment securities less the interest expense on consolidated obligations and interest-bearing deposits, is our primary source of earnings. 
 
The following table presents average daily balances, interest income/expense, and average yields of our major categories of interest-earning assets and their funding sources ($ amounts in millions).
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
 
Average
Balance
 
Interest
Income/
Expense
 
Average
Yield
 
Average
Balance
 
Interest
Income/
Expense
 
Average
Yield
 
Average
Balance
 
Interest
Income/
Expense
 
Average
Yield
Assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell
$
4,919

 
$
50

 
1.02
%
 
$
4,215

 
$
17

 
0.40
%
 
$
3,698

 
$
4

 
0.12
 %
Investment securities (1)
12,621

 
240

 
1.90
%
 
11,872

 
182

 
1.53
%
 
10,012

 
149

 
1.48
 %
Advances (2)
31,209

 
406

 
1.30
%
 
25,974

 
220

 
0.85
%
 
22,988

 
127

 
0.55
 %
Mortgage loans held for
portfolio (2)
9,922

 
315

 
3.17
%
 
8,792

 
274

 
3.12
%
 
7,734

 
264

 
3.42
 %
Other assets (interest-earning) (3) 
364

 
5

 
1.47
%
 
313

 
2

 
0.63
%
 
213

 

 
(0.17
)%
Total interest-earning assets
59,035

 
1,016

 
1.72
%
 
51,166

 
695

 
1.36
%
 
44,645

 
544

 
1.22
 %
Other assets (4)
444

 
 
 
 
 
326

 
 
 
 
 
378

 
 
 
 
Total assets
$
59,479

 
 
 
 
 
$
51,492

 
 
 
 
 
$
45,023

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Liabilities and Capital:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-bearing deposits
$
555

 
5

 
0.86
%
 
$
597

 
1

 
0.12
%
 
$
706

 

 
0.01
 %
Discount notes
20,116

 
182

 
0.91
%
 
16,129

 
64

 
0.40
%
 
12,617

 
19

 
0.16
 %
CO bonds (2)
35,302

 
560

 
1.59
%
 
31,662

 
425

 
1.34
%
 
28,546

 
328

 
1.15
 %
MRCS
167

 
7

 
4.22
%
 
152

 
7

 
4.35
%
 
15

 
1

 
3.53
 %
Total interest-bearing liabilities
56,140

 
754

 
1.34
%
 
48,540

 
497

 
1.02
%
 
41,884

 
348

 
0.83
 %
Other liabilities
679

 
 
 
 
 
653

 
 
 
 
 
782

 
 
 
 
Total capital
2,660

 
 
 
 
 
2,299

 
 
 
 
 
2,357

 
 
 
 
Total liabilities and capital
$
59,479

 
 
 
 
 
$
51,492

 
 
 
 
 
$
45,023

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net interest income
 
 
$
262

 
 
 
 
 
$
198

 
 
 
 
 
$
196

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net spread on interest-earning assets less interest-bearing liabilities
 
 
 
 
0.38
%
 
 
 
 
 
0.34
%
 
 
 
 
 
0.39
 %
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net interest margin (5)
 
 
 
 
0.45
%
 
 
 
 
 
0.39
%
 
 
 
 
 
0.44
 %
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Average interest-earning assets to interest-bearing liabilities
1.05

 
 
 
 
 
1.05

 
 
 
 
 
1.07

 
 
 
 

(1) 
Consists of AFS and HTM securities. The average balances of investment securities are based on amortized cost; therefore, the resulting yields do not reflect changes in the estimated fair value of AFS securities that are included as a component of OCI, nor do they reflect OTTI-related non-credit losses. Interest income/expense includes the effect of associated derivative transactions.
(2) 
Interest income/expense and average yield include all other components of interest, including the impact of net interest payments or receipts on derivatives in qualifying hedge relationships, amortization of hedge accounting adjustments, and prepayment fees on advances.
(3) 
Consists of interest-bearing deposits, loans to other FHLBanks (if applicable), and grantor trust assets that are carried at estimated fair value. Includes the rights or obligations to cash collateral, except for variation margin payments characterized as daily settled contracts.
(4) 
Includes changes in the estimated fair value of AFS securities and the effect of OTTI-related non-credit losses on AFS and HTM securities.
(5) 
Net interest income expressed as a percentage of the average balance of interest-earning assets. 




Changes in both volume and interest rates determine changes in net interest income and net interest margin. Changes in interest income and interest expense that are not identifiable as either volume-related or rate-related, but are attributable to both volume and rate changes, have been allocated to the volume and rate categories based upon the proportion of the volume and rate changes. The following table presents the changes in interest income and interest expense by volume and rate ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
 
2017 vs. 2016
 
2016 vs. 2015
Components
 
Volume
 
Rate
 
Total
 
Volume
 
Rate
 
Total
Increase (decrease) in interest income:
 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell
 
$
3

 
$
30

 
$
33

 
$
1

 
$
12

 
$
13

Investment securities
 
16

 
42

 
58

 
15

 
18

 
33

Advances
 
51

 
135

 
186

 
18

 
75

 
93

Mortgage loans held for portfolio
 
36

 
5

 
41

 
34

 
(24
)
 
10

Other assets (interest earning)
 

 
3

 
3

 

 
2

 
2

Total
 
106

 
215

 
321

 
68

 
83

 
151

Increase (decrease) in interest expense:
 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-bearing deposits
 

 
4

 
4

 

 
1

 
1

Discount notes
 
19

 
99

 
118

 
7

 
38

 
45

CO bonds
 
53

 
82

 
135

 
38

 
59

 
97

MRCS
 

 

 

 
6

 

 
6

Total
 
72

 
185

 
257

 
51

 
98

 
149

Increase (decrease) in net interest income
 
$
34

 
$
30

 
$
64

 
$
17

 
$
(15
)
 
$
2

 
Yields. The average yield on total interest-earning assets for the year ended December 31, 2017 was 1.72%, an increase of 36 bps compared to 2016, resulting primarily from increases in market interest rates that led to higher yields on advances and investment securities. The cost of total interest-bearing liabilities for the year ended December 31, 2017 was 1.34%, an increase of 32 bps from the prior year due to higher funding costs on consolidated obligations. The net effect was an increase in the net interest spread to 0.38% for the year ended December 31, 2017 from 0.34% for the year ended December 31, 2016.

The average yield on total interest-earning assets for the year ended December 31, 2016 was 1.36%, an increase of 14 bps compared to 2015, resulting primarily from increases in market interest rates that led to higher yields on advances and investment securities, partially offset by lower yields on mortgage loans. The decrease in the yields on mortgage loans was due to an increase in prepayments of our higher-yielding MPP loans, resulting in accelerated amortization of purchase premiums on our newer loans. The cost of total interest-bearing liabilities for the year ended December 31, 2016 was 1.02%, an increase of 19 bps from the prior year due to higher funding costs on consolidated obligations and accelerated amortization of concession fees associated with the exercise of our call option on certain CO bonds that funded our mortgage portfolios and which were reissued at a lower cost. The net effect was a reduction in the net interest spread to 0.34% for the year ended December 31, 2016 from 0.39% for the year ended December 31, 2015.

Average Balances. The average balances of interest-earning assets for the year ended December 31, 2017 increased compared to 2016, largely due to advances and, to a lesser extent, mortgage loans and investment securities. The average amount of advances outstanding increased by 20%, generally due to members' higher funding needs. The average amount of mortgage loans held for portfolio outstanding increased by 13% due to higher purchases from members under MPP Advantage. Additionally, the increase in the average balances of investment securities was due primarily to purchases of agency MBS. The increase in average interest-bearing liabilities for the year ended December 31, 2017, compared to 2016, was due to an increase in consolidated obligations to fund the increases in the average balances of all interest-earning assets.

The average balances of interest-earning assets for the year ended December 31, 2016 increased compared to 2015, largely due to advances, investment securities and mortgage loans. The average amount of advances outstanding increased by 13%, generally due to members' higher funding needs. The increase in the average balances of investment securities was due primarily to purchases of GSE debentures and agency MBS. Additionally, the average amount of mortgage loans held for portfolio outstanding increased by 14% due to higher purchases from members under MPP Advantage. The increase in average interest-bearing liabilities for the year ended December 31, 2016, compared to 2015, was due to an increase in consolidated obligations to fund the increases in the average balances of all interest-earning assets.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 




Provision for (Reversal of) Credit Losses. The change in the provision for (reversal of) credit losses for the year ended December 31, 2017 compared to 2016 was insignificant.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The change in the provision for (reversal of) credit losses for the year ended December 31, 2016 compared to 2015 was due to a lower reversal of estimated MPP losses resulting from modeling updates.

Other Income (Loss). The following table presents a comparison of the components of other income ($ amounts in millions). 
 
 
Years Ended December 31,
Components
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
Total OTTI losses
 
$

 
$

 
$

Non-credit portion reclassified to (from) other comprehensive income
 

 

 

Net OTTI credit losses
 

 

 

Net gains (losses) on derivatives and hedging activities
 
(9
)
 
2

 
3

Other
 
 
 
 
 
 
Litigation settlements, net (1)
 
1

 

 
5

Other miscellaneous
 
2

 
4

 
2

Total other income (loss)
 
$
(6
)
 
$
6

 
$
10


(1) 
See Notes to Financial Statements - Note 20 - Commitments and Contingencies and Item 3. Legal Proceedings for additional information on litigation settlements.

The net decrease in total other income for the year ended December 31, 2017 compared to 2016 was primarily due to net losses on derivatives and hedging activities.

The decrease in total other income for the year ended December 31, 2016 compared to 2015 was primarily due to lower net proceeds from litigation settlements related to certain of our private-label RMBS.

OTTI Losses. As described in detail in Notes to Financial Statements - Note 6 - Other-Than-Temporary Impairment, OTTI credit losses recorded on private-label RMBS are derived from projections of the future cash flows of the individual securities. These projections are based on a number of assumptions and expectations, which are updated on a quarterly basis. OTTI losses over the past several years have been insignificant due to the continuing economic recovery, particularly in the housing market, and its favorable impact on housing prices.

Net Gains (Losses) on Derivatives and Hedging Activities. Our net gains (losses) on derivatives and hedging activities fluctuate due to volatility in the overall interest-rate environment as we hedge our asset or liability risk exposures. In general, we hold derivatives and associated hedged items to the maturity, call, or put date. Therefore, due to timing, nearly all of the cumulative net gains and losses for these financial instruments will generally reverse over the remaining contractual terms of the hedged item. However, there may be instances when we terminate these instruments prior to the maturity, call or put date. Terminating the financial instrument or hedging relationship may result in a realized gain or loss. See Notes to Financial Statements - Note 11 - Derivatives and Hedging Activities for more information.

The Bank uses interest-rate swaps to hedge the risk of changes in the fair value of certain of its advances, consolidated obligations and AFS securities due to changes in market interest rates. These hedging relationships are designated as fair value hedges. Changes in the estimated fair value of the derivative and, to the extent these relationships qualify for hedge accounting, changes in the fair value of the hedged item that are attributable to the hedged risk are recorded in earnings. The estimated fair values are based on a wide range of factors, including current and projected levels of interest rates, credit spreads and volatility.





For those hedging relationships that qualified for hedge accounting, the differences between the change in the estimated fair value of the hedged items and the change in the estimated fair value of the associated interest-rate swaps, i.e., hedge ineffectiveness, resulted in a net loss of $7 million for the year ended December 31, 2017 compared to a net gain of $4 million for each of the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015. The losses for the year ended December 31, 2017 were primarily due to marginal mismatches in durations on, and the increase in volume of, swapped GSE MBS, particularly Fannie Mae Delegated Underwriting and Servicing (DUS) MBS. There is less offsetting hedge ineffectiveness on the related funding due to the increased issuance of floating rate notes.

To the extent these hedges do not qualify for hedge accounting, or cease to qualify because they are determined to be ineffective, only the change in the fair value of the derivative is recorded in earnings with no offsetting change in the fair value of the hedged item.

For derivatives not qualifying for hedge accounting (economic hedges), the net interest settlements and the changes in the estimated fair value of the derivatives are recorded in net gains (losses) on derivatives and hedging activities. For economic hedges, the Bank recorded a net loss of $2 million for each of the years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016, respectively and a net loss of $1 million for the year ended December 31, 2015.





The tables below present the net effect of derivatives on net interest income and other income (loss), within the net gains (losses) on derivatives and hedging activities, by type of hedge and hedged item ($ amounts in millions).
Year Ended December 31, 2017
 
Advances
 
Investments
 
Mortgage Loans
 
CO Bonds
 
Discount Notes
 
Other
 
Total
Net interest income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Amortization/accretion of hedging activities (1)
 
$

 
$
2

 
$
(1
)
 
$

 
$

 
$

 
$
1

Net interest settlements (2)
 
(31
)
 
(48
)
 

 
16

 

 

 
(63
)
Total net interest income
 
(31
)
 
(46
)
 
(1
)
 
16

 

 

 
(62
)
Net gains (losses) on derivatives and hedging activities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gains (losses) on fair-value hedges
 
(1
)
 
(4
)
 

 
(2
)
 

 

 
(7
)
Gains (losses) on derivatives not qualifying for hedge accounting (3)
 

 

 
(1
)
 

 
(1
)
 

 
(2
)
Other (4)
 



 

 

 

 

 

Net gains (losses) on derivatives and hedging activities
 
(1
)
 
(4
)
 
(1
)
 
(2
)
 
(1
)
 

 
(9
)
Total net effect of derivatives and hedging activities
 
$
(32
)
 
$
(50
)
 
$
(2
)
 
$
14

 
$
(1
)
 
$

 
$
(71
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Year Ended December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net interest income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Amortization/accretion of hedging activities (1)
 
$

 
$
9

 
$
(2
)
 
$

 
$

 
$

 
$
7

Net interest settlements (2)
 
(91
)
 
(94
)
 

 
17

 

 

 
(168
)
Total net interest income
 
(91
)
 
(85
)
 
(2
)
 
17

 

 

 
(161
)
Net gains (losses) on derivatives and hedging activities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gains (losses) on fair-value hedges
 
1

 
(1
)
 

 
4

 

 

 
4

Gains (losses) on derivatives not qualifying for hedge accounting (3)
 

 

 
(2
)
 

 

 

 
(2
)
Net gains (losses) on derivatives and hedging activities
 
1

 
(1
)
 
(2
)
 
4

 

 

 
2

Total net effect of derivatives and hedging activities
 
$
(90
)
 
$
(86
)
 
$
(4
)
 
$
21

 
$

 
$

 
$
(159
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Year Ended December 31, 2015
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net interest income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Amortization/accretion of hedging activities (1)
 
$

 
$
12

 
$
(1
)
 
$
(4
)
 
$

 
$

 
$
7

Net interest settlements (2)
 
(155
)
 
(98
)
 

 
57

 

 

 
(196
)
Total net interest income
 
(155
)
 
(86
)
 
(1
)
 
53

 

 

 
(189
)
Net gains (losses) on derivatives and hedging activities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gains (losses) on fair-value hedges
 
2

 
(4
)
 

 
6

 

 

 
4

Gains (losses) on derivatives not qualifying for hedge accounting (3)
 

 

 
(3
)
 
2

 

 

 
(1
)
Net gains (losses) on derivatives and hedging activities
 
2

 
(4
)
 
(3
)
 
8

 

 

 
3

Total net effect of derivatives and hedging activities
 
$
(153
)
 
$
(90
)
 
$
(4
)
 
$
61

 
$

 
$

 
$
(186
)

(1) 
Represents the amortization/accretion of fair value hedge accounting adjustments for both current and terminated hedge positions.
(2) 
Represents interest income/expense on derivatives in qualifying hedge relationships. Excludes the interest income/expense of the respective hedged items, which fully offset the interest income/expense of the derivatives, except to the extent of any hedge ineffectiveness.
(3) 
Includes net interest settlements on derivatives not qualifying for hedge accounting. See Notes to Financial Statements - Note 11 - Derivatives and Hedging Activities for additional information.
(4) 
Consists of price alignment amounts on derivatives for which variation margin payments are characterized as daily settled contracts.




Other Expenses. The following table presents a comparison of the components of other expenses ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
Years Ended December 31,
Components
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
Compensation and benefits
 
$
48

 
$
46

 
$
43

Other operating expenses
 
26

 
25

 
22

Finance Agency and Office of Finance expenses
 
7

 
6

 
6

Other
 
1

 
1

 
1

Total other expenses
 
$
82

 
$
78

 
$
72


The increase in total other expenses for the year ended December 31, 2017 compared to 2016 was due primarily to increases in compensation and benefits, primarily driven by salary increases and higher head count. The increase in headcount was primarily due to strengthening our information security, business continuity and risk management capabilities and reducing our reliance on contractual resources.

The increase in total other expenses for the year ended December 31, 2016 compared to 2015 was driven primarily by increases in compensation and benefits and other operating expenses. The increase in compensation and benefits was due to merit increases, higher head count, and higher incentive compensation achievement. The increase in other operating expenses was primarily due to higher professional fees and services.

Office of Finance Expenses. The FHLBanks fund the costs of the Office of Finance as a joint office that facilitates issuing and servicing consolidated obligations, preparation of the FHLBanks' combined quarterly and annual financial reports, and certain other functions. For each of the years ended December 31, 2017, 2016 and 2015, our assessments to fund the Office of Finance totaled approximately $4 million, $3 million, and $3 million, respectively.

Finance Agency Expenses. Each FHLBank is assessed a portion of the operating costs of our regulator, the Finance Agency. We have no direct control over these costs. For each of the years ended December 31, 2017, 2016 and 2015, our Finance Agency assessments totaled approximately $3 million.

AHP Assessments. The FHLBanks are required to set aside annually, in the aggregate, the greater of $100 million or 10% of their net earnings to fund the AHP. For purposes of the AHP calculation, net earnings is defined as income before assessments, plus interest expense related to MRCS, if applicable. For each of the years ended December 31, 2017, 2016 and 2015, our AHP expense was approximately $18 million, $13 million, and $13 million, respectively. Our AHP expense fluctuates in accordance with our net earnings.

If we experienced a net loss during a quarter but still had net earnings for the year to date, our obligation to the AHP would be calculated based on our year-to-date net earnings. If we experienced a net loss for a full year, we would have no obligation to the AHP for the year, since our required annual contribution is limited to annual net earnings.

If the FHLBanks' aggregate 10% contribution were less than $100 million, each FHLBank would be required to contribute an additional pro rata amount. The proration would be based on the net earnings of each FHLBank in relation to the net earnings of all FHLBanks for the previous year, up to the Bank's annual net earnings. There was no shortfall in 2017, 2016 or 2015.

If we determine that our required AHP contributions are adversely affecting our financial stability, we may apply to the Finance Agency for a temporary suspension of our contributions. We did not make such an application in 2017, 2016 or 2015.

Total Other Comprehensive Income (Loss). Total other comprehensive income (loss) for the years ended 2017, 2016 and 2015 was $55 million, $33 million and $(24) million, respectively. Total other comprehensive income for the years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016 consisted substantially of unrealized gains on non-OTTI AFS securities. Total other comprehensive loss for the year ended December 31, 2015 consisted primarily of decreases in the fair value of AFS securities, primarily agency AFS securities, and, to a lesser extent, an increase in the amortized cost basis of OTTI AFS MBS not offset by an increase in the fair value.





Operating Segments
 
Our products and services are grouped within two operating segments: traditional and mortgage loans.
 
Traditional. The traditional segment consists of (i) credit products (including advances, letters of credit, and lines of credit), (ii) investments (including federal funds sold, securities purchased under agreements to resell, AFS securities and HTM securities), and (iii) and correspondent services and deposits. The following table presents the financial performance of our traditional segment ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
Years Ended December 31,
Traditional
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
Net interest income
 
$
193

 
$
144

 
$
128

Provision for (reversal of) credit losses
 

 

 

Other income (loss)
 
(5
)
 
7

 
13

Other expenses
 
70

 
66

 
62

Income before assessments
 
118

 
85

 
79

Total assessments
 
12

 
9

 
8

Net income
 
$
106

 
$
76

 
$
71


The increase in net income for the traditional segment for the year ended December 31, 2017 compared to 2016 was due to higher net interest income primarily as a result of higher yields on and higher average balances of advances and investments outstanding, partially offset by higher funding costs. This net increase was partially offset by higher expenses and net losses on derivatives and hedging activities.

The increase in net income for the traditional segment for the year ended December 31, 2016 compared to 2015 was due to higher net interest income primarily as a result of higher yields on and higher average balances of advances and investments outstanding, partially offset by higher funding costs. This net increase was partially offset by lower net proceeds from litigation settlements related to certain private-label RMBS.

Mortgage Loans. The mortgage loans segment includes (i) mortgage loans purchased from our members through our MPP and (ii) participating interests purchased in 2012 - 2014 from the FHLBank of Topeka in mortgage loans originated by certain of its PFIs under the MPF Program. The following table presents the financial performance of our mortgage loans segment ($ amounts in millions). 
 
 
Years Ended December 31,
Mortgage Loans
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
Net interest income
 
$
69

 
$
54

 
$
68

Provision for (reversal of) credit losses
 

 

 

Other income (loss)
 
(1
)
 
(1
)
 
(3
)
Other expenses
 
12

 
12

 
10

Income before assessments
 
56

 
41

 
55

Total assessments
 
6

 
4

 
5

Net income
 
$
50

 
$
37

 
$
50


The increase in net income for the mortgage loans segment for the year ended December 31, 2017 compared to 2016 was due to higher net interest income resulting from an increase in the average outstanding balance of mortgage loans held for portfolio, a decrease in amortization of concession fees on called consolidated obligations, and a decrease in amortization of purchased premiums resulting from lower prepayments.

The decrease in net income for the mortgage loans segment for the year ended December 31, 2016 compared to 2015 was primarily due to a decrease in net interest income resulting from higher prepayments of MPP loans, which caused accelerated amortization of purchased premiums on our newer loans. The decrease also resulted from higher funding costs and the accelerated amortization of concession fees associated with the exercise of our call option on certain CO bonds funding our mortgage loan portfolio which were reissued at a lower cost. Partially offsetting this decrease was an increase in the average outstanding balance of mortgage loans held for portfolio.
 




Analysis of Financial Condition
 
Total Assets. The table below presents the comparative highlights of our major asset categories ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Major Asset Categories
 
Carrying Value
 
% of Total
 
Carrying Value
 
% of Total
Advances
 
$
34,055

 
55
%
 
$
28,096

 
52
%
Mortgage loans held for portfolio, net
 
10,356

 
17
%
 
9,501

 
18
%
Cash and short-term investments
 
4,601

 
7
%
 
4,128

 
8
%
Investment securities
 
13,027

 
21
%
 
11,880

 
22
%
Other assets (1)
 
310

 
%
 
302

 
%
Total assets
 
$
62,349

 
100
%
 
$
53,907

 
100
%

(1) 
Includes accrued interest receivable, premises, software and equipment, derivative assets and other miscellaneous assets.

Total assets were $62.3 billion as of December 31, 2017, an increase of 16% compared to December 31, 2016. This increase of $8.4 billion was primarily due to an increase in advances. The mix of our total assets changed slightly during 2017, primarily due to the growth in advances.

Under the Finance Agency's Prudential Management and Operations Standards, if our non-advance assets were to grow by more than 30% over the six calendar quarters preceding a Finance Agency determination that we have failed to meet any of these standards, the Finance Agency would be required to impose one or more sanctions on us, which could include, among others, a limit on asset growth, an increase in the level of retained earnings, and a prohibition on dividends or the redemption or repurchase of capital stock. Through the six-quarter period ended December 31, 2017, our growth in non-advance assets did not exceed 30%.

Advances. In general, advances fluctuate in accordance with our members' funding needs, primarily determined by their deposit levels, mortgage pipelines, loan growth, investment opportunities, available collateral, other balance sheet strategies, and the cost of alternative funding options.

Advances at carrying value totaled $34.1 billion at December 31, 2017, a net increase of 21% compared to December 31, 2016, in spite of the 10% decline in advances outstanding to captive insurers. In accordance with the Final Membership Rule, by February 19, 2017, the memberships of the six captive insurers that were admitted as members on or after September 12, 2014 were terminated and all of their outstanding advances were fully repaid.

Advances to depository members - comprising commercial banks, savings institutions and credit unions - increased by 42%. Advances to insurance company members (excluding captive insurance companies) increased by 8%. The significant increase in advances to depository members resulted in a change in the mix of advances by member type during the year. Advances to depository institutions, as a percent of total advances outstanding, increased from 47% at December 31, 2016 to 55% at December 31, 2017, while advances to all insurance companies decreased from 53% to 45% at those dates.





The table below presents advances outstanding by type of financial institution ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Borrower Type
 
Par Value
 
% of Total
 
Par Value
 
% of Total
Depository institutions:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial banks and saving institutions
 
$
15,818

 
46
%
 
$
10,805

 
39
%
Credit unions
 
2,901

 
9
%
 
2,385

 
8
%
Total depository institutions
 
18,719

 
55
%
 
13,190

 
47
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Insurance companies:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Captive insurance companies (1)
 

 
%
 
56

 
%
Captive insurance companies (2)
 
3,020

 
9
%
 
3,310

 
12
%
Other insurance companies
 
12,389

 
36
%
 
11,482

 
41
%
Total insurance companies
 
15,409

 
45
%
 
14,848

 
53
%
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
Total members
 
34,128

 
100
%
 
28,038

 
100
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Former members
 
41

 
%
 
94

 
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total advances
 
$
34,169

 
100
%
 
$
28,132

 
100
%

(1)  
Membership terminated by February 19, 2017.
(2)
Membership must terminate no later than February 19, 2021.
 
 
 
 
 




Our advance portfolio includes fixed- and variable-rate advances, as well as callable or prepayable and putable advances. For prepayable advances, the advance can be prepaid on specified dates without incurring repayment or termination fees. All other advances may only be prepaid by the borrower paying a fee that is sufficient to make us financially indifferent to the prepayment of the advance.

The following table presents the par value of advances outstanding by product type and contractual maturity dates, some of which contain call or put options ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Product Type and Contractual Maturity
 
Par Value
 
% of Total
 
Par Value
 
% of Total
Fixed-rate:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fixed-rate (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Due in 1 year or less
 
$
15,950

 
47
%
 
$
11,386

 
41
%
Due after 1 year
 
6,880

 
20
%
 
7,245

 
26
%
Total
 
22,830

 
67
%
 
18,631

 
67
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Callable or prepayable
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Due in 1 year or less
 

 
%
 
4

 
%
Due after 1 year
 
28

 
%
 
28

 
%
Total
 
28

 
%
 
32

 
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Putable
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Due in 1 year or less
 
28

 
%
 
43

 
%
Due after 1 year
 
1,825

 
5
%
 
901

 
3
%
Total
 
1,853

 
5
%
 
944

 
3
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other (2)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Due in 1 year or less
 
127

 
%
 
31

 
%
Due after 1 year
 
295

 
1
%
 
565

 
2
%
Total
 
422

 
1
%
 
596

 
2
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total fixed-rate
 
25,133

 
73
%
 
20,203

 
72
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Variable-rate:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Variable-rate (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Due in 1 year or less
 
37

 
%
 
59

 
%
Due after 1 year
 
2,193

 
7
%
 
2,346

 
8
%
Total
 
2,230

 
7
%
 
2,405

 
8
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Callable or prepayable
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Due in 1 year or less
 
793

 
2
%
 
1,076

 
4
%
Due after 1 year
 
6,013

 
18
%
 
4,448

 
16
%
Total
 
6,806

 
20
%
 
5,524

 
20
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total variable-rate
 
9,036

 
27
%
 
7,929

 
28
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total advances
 
$
34,169

 
100
%
 
$
28,132

 
100
%

(1) 
Includes advances without call or put options and callable advances whose lockout dates have not yet passed.
(2) 
Includes hybrid, fixed-rate amortizing/mortgage matched advances.

Callable advances with lockout dates that have not yet passed have not been classified as callable or prepayable, but instead as either fixed- or variable-rate. If the lockout dates were ignored, total callable or prepayable advances would total $8.9 billion or 26%, and $7.8 billion or 28%, of advances outstanding, at par, at December 31, 2017 and 2016, respectively.

Advances due in one year or less increased from 45% of the total outstanding, at par, at December 31, 2016 to 50% of the total outstanding, at par, at December 31, 2017, reflecting members' increased demand for short-term funding. However, longer-term advances also grew during the year. See Notes to Financial Statements - Note 7 - Advances for more information.





Mortgage Loans Held for Portfolio. We purchase mortgage loans from our members to support our housing mission, provide an additional source of liquidity to our members, diversify our assets, and generate additional earnings. In general, our volume of mortgage loans purchased is affected by several factors, including interest rates, competition, the general level of housing and refinancing activity in the United States, consumer product preferences and regulatory considerations.

In 2010, we began offering MPP Advantage for new conventional MPP loans, which utilizes an enhanced fixed LRA account for credit enhancement consistent with Finance Agency regulations, instead of utilizing coverage from SMI providers. The only substantive difference between our original MPP and MPP Advantage for conventional mortgage loans is the credit enhancement structure. Upon implementation of MPP Advantage, the original MPP was phased out and is no longer being used for acquisitions of new conventional loans. See Item 1. Business - Operating Segments - Mortgage Loans for more detailed information about the credit enhancement structures for our original MPP and MPP Advantage.

In 2012 - 2014, we purchased participating interests from the FHLBank of Topeka in mortgage loans originated by certain of its PFIs through their participation in the MPF Program.

To continue to meet the needs of our members and maintain an appropriate level of mortgage loans held for portfolio on our statement of condition, in December 2016, we agreed to sell a 90% participating interest in a $100 million MCC of certain newly acquired MPP loans to the FHLBank of Atlanta. Principal settled in December 2016 totaled $72 million, and the remaining $18 million settled in January 2017.

A breakdown of mortgage loans held for portfolio by primary product type is presented below ($ amounts in millions). 
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Product Type
 
UPB
 
% of Total
 
UPB
 
% of Total
MPP:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Conventional Advantage
 
$
8,608

 
85
%
 
$
7,412

 
80
%
Conventional Original
 
850

 
8
%
 
1,096

 
12
%
FHA
 
361

 
4
%
 
422

 
4
%
Total MPP
 
9,819

 
97
%
 
8,930

 
96
%
MPF Program:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Conventional
 
243

 
2
%
 
288

 
3
%
Government
 
62

 
1
%
 
75

 
1
%
Total MPF Program
 
305

 
3
%
 
363

 
4
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total mortgage loans held for portfolio
 
$
10,124


100
%
 
$
9,293

 
100
%

The increase in the UPB of mortgage loans held for portfolio was due to purchases under MPP Advantage exceeding repayments of outstanding MPP and MPF Program loans. Over time, the aggregate outstanding balance of mortgage loans purchased under our original MPP and MPF Program will continue to decrease.

We have established and maintain an allowance for loan losses based on our best estimate of probable losses over the loss emergence period, which we have estimated to be 24 months. Our estimate of MPP losses remaining after borrowers' equity, but before credit enhancements, was $5 million at December 31, 2017 and $9 million at December 31, 2016. The decrease from December 31, 2016 to December 31, 2017 was primarily the result of a smaller delinquent loan population and improvements in third-party modeled values. After consideration of the portion recoverable under the associated credit enhancements, the resulting allowance for MPP loan losses was $750 thousand at December 31, 2017 and 2016. See Notes to Financial Statements - Note 9 - Allowance for Credit Losses, Item 7. Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates, and Risk Management - Credit Risk Management - Mortgage Loans Held for Portfolio - MPP for more information.

During the third quarter of 2017, major hurricanes caused substantial damage to property in several states on the southeastern coasts of the United States. In response to those hurricanes, the Bank communicated to its mortgage loan servicers that special relief would be available for borrowers in Federal Emergency Management Agency ("FEMA") designated disaster areas. Under this relief, mortgage loan servicers are authorized to grant forbearance or temporarily suspend mortgage payments for up to 90 days for borrowers whose income is adversely affected by the disaster or for borrowers whose property is located in a FEMA designated disaster area. Mortgage loan servicers were also directed to suspend collections and foreclosure proceedings in these areas for 90 days. Based on the circumstances of individual borrowers, additional forbearance time may be granted.





The Bank has sought to analyze the potential impact of the hurricanes on the Bank’s mortgage loans held for portfolio. Because all or a portion of any incurred losses would be covered by the credit enhancements in place and because there is no concentration of the Bank's loans in the affected states, we do not expect that any net losses resulting from the hurricanes will have a material effect on the Bank’s financial condition or results of operations. Based on the limited information currently available, we did not record any additional allowance for loan losses as of December 31, 2017. If additional information becomes available indicating that any losses are probable and the amount of the loss can be reasonably estimated, we will record an appropriate addition to the allowance at that time.

Cash and Investments. We maintain our investment portfolio for liquidity purposes, to use balance sheet capacity and to supplement our earnings. The earnings on our investments bolster our capacity to meet our commitments to affordable housing and community investments and to cover operating expenses. The following table presents a comparison of the components of our cash and investments at carrying value ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
December 31,
Components of Cash and Investments
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
Cash and short-term investments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks
 
$
55

 
$
547

 
$
4,932

Interest-bearing deposits
 
660

 
150

 

Securities purchased under agreements to resell
 
2,606

 
1,781

 

Federal funds sold
 
1,280

 
1,650

 

Total cash and short-term investments
 
4,601

 
4,128

 
4,932

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investment securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
AFS securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
GSE and TVA debentures
 
4,404


4,715


3,481

GSE MBS
 
2,507


1,076


269

Private-label RMBS
 
218


269


319

Total AFS securities
 
7,129


6,060


4,069

HTM securities:
 
 


 




GSE debentures
 




100

Other U.S. obligations - guaranteed MBS
 
3,299


2,679


2,895

GSE MBS
 
2,553


3,082


3,268

Private-label RMBS and ABS
 
46

 
59

 
83

Total HTM securities
 
5,898

 
5,820

 
6,346

Total investment securities
 
13,027

 
11,880

 
10,415

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total cash and investments, carrying value
 
$
17,628

 
$
16,008

 
$
15,347


Cash and Short-Term Investments. The total outstanding balance and composition of our short-term investment portfolio is influenced by our liquidity needs, regulatory requirements, member advance activity, market conditions and the availability of short-term investments at attractive interest rates, relative to our cost of funds. See Item 7. Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Liquidity and Capital Resources for more information.

Cash and short-term investments totaled $4.6 billion at December 31, 2017, an increase of 11% compared to December 31, 2016. However, cash and short-term investments as a percent of total assets were 7% at December 31, 2017 compared to 8% at December 31, 2016.

Cash and short-term investments totaled $4.1 billion at December 31, 2016, a decrease of 16% compared to December 31, 2015. Cash and short-term investments as a percent of total assets were 8% at December 31, 2016 compared to 10% at December 31, 2015. The concentration of cash at December 31, 2015 was due to a lack of short-term investments that met our minimum return thresholds on that date.

Investment Securities. AFS securities totaled $7.1 billion at December 31, 2017, a net increase of 18% compared to $6.1 billion at December 31, 2016. Because regulatory capital increased during 2017 as a result of additional capital stock issued to support advance growth, we purchased additional GSE MBS to maintain a ratio of MBS and ABS to total regulatory capital of up to 300%.

Net unrealized gains on AFS securities totaled $122 million at December 31, 2017, an increase of $55 million compared to December 31, 2016, primarily due to changes in interest rates, credit spreads and volatility, and higher volume.




AFS securities totaled $6.1 billion at December 31, 2016, a net increase of 49% compared to $4.1 billion at December 31, 2015. The increase resulted from purchases of GSE debentures and MBS, partially offset by principal paydowns of private-label RMBS. See Notes to Financial Statements - Note 4 - Available-for-Sale Securities for more information.

HTM securities totaled $5.9 billion at December 31, 2017, relatively unchanged from December 31, 2016. At December 31, 2017, the estimated fair value of our HTM securities in an unrealized loss position totaled $2.8 billion, a decrease of 19% from $3.4 billion at December 31, 2016, primarily due to changes in interest rates, credit spreads and volatility. The associated unrealized losses decreased from $23 million at December 31, 2016 to $12 million at December 31, 2017.

HTM securities totaled $5.8 billion at December 31, 2016, a decrease of 8% compared to $6.3 billion at December 31, 2015, primarily due to principal paydowns. See Notes to Financial Statements - Note 5 - Held-to-Maturity Securities for more information.

Interest-Rate Payment Terms. Our AFS and HTM securities are presented below at amortized cost by MBS and non-MBS and interest-rate payment terms ($ amounts in millions).    
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Interest-Rate Payment Terms
 
Amortized Cost
 
% of Total
 
Amortized Cost
 
% of Total
AFS Securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total non-MBS fixed rate
 
$
4,357

 
62
%
 
$
4,693

 
78
%
MBS:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fixed-rate
 
2,463

 
35
%
 
1,061

 
18
%
Variable-rate
 
187

 
3
%
 
239

 
4
%
Total MBS
 
2,650

 
38
%
 
1,300

 
22
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total AFS securities
 
$
7,007

 
100
%
 
$
5,993

 
100
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
HTM Securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
MBS and ABS:
 
 

 
 
 
 

 
 
Fixed-rate
 
$
1,141

 
19
%
 
$
1,512

 
26
%
Variable-rate
 
4,757

 
81
%
 
4,308

 
74
%
Total MBS and ABS
 
5,898

 
100
%
 
5,820

 
100
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total HTM securities
 
$
5,898

 
100
%
 
$
5,820

 
100
%

Our purchases of MBS AFS in 2017 were substantially fixed rate and our purchases of MBS HTM in 2017 were substantially variable rate, which caused the changes in the mix of fixed- vs. variable-rate securities from December 31, 2016 to December 31, 2017.




Issuer Concentration. As of December 31, 2017, we held securities classified as AFS and HTM from the following issuers with a carrying value greater than 10% of our total capital. The MBS issuers listed below include one or more trusts established as separate legal entities by the issuer. Therefore, the associated carrying and estimated fair values are not necessarily indicative of our exposure to that issuer ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
December 31, 2017
Name of Issuer
 
Carrying Value
 
Estimated Fair Value
Non-MBS:
 
 
 
 
Fannie Mae debentures
 
$
1,621

 
$
1,621

Federal Farm Credit Bank debentures
 
1,906

 
1,906

Freddie Mac debentures
 
701

 
701

MBS:
 
 
 
 
Freddie Mac
 
1,191

 
1,206

Fannie Mae
 
3,869

 
3,876

Ginnie Mae
 
3,299

 
3,299

Subtotal
 
12,587

 
12,609

All other issuers
 
440

 
439

Total investment securities
 
$
13,027

 
$
13,048


Investments by Year of Redemption. The following table provides, by year of redemption, carrying values and yields for AFS and HTM securities as well as carrying values for short-term investments ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
 
 
Due after
 
Due after
 
 
 
 
 
 
Due in
 
one year
 
five years
 
Due after
 
 
 
 
one year
 
through
 
through
 
ten
 
 
Investments
 
or less
 
five years
 
 ten years
 
years
 
Total
AFS securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
GSE and TVA debentures
 
$
84

 
$
2,337

 
$
1,792

 
$
191

 
$
4,404

GSE MBS (1)
 

 

 
2,507

 

 
2,507

Private-label RMBS (1)
 

 

 

 
218

 
218

Total AFS securities
 
84

 
2,337

 
4,299

 
409

 
7,129

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
HTM securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other U.S. obligations - guaranteed MBS (1)
 

 

 
1

 
3,298

 
3,299

GSE MBS (1)
 

 
1,020

 
503

 
1,030

 
2,553

Private-label RMBS and ABS (1)
 
1

 

 
7

 
38

 
46

Total HTM securities
 
1

 
1,020

 
511

 
4,366

 
5,898

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total investment securities
 
85

 
3,357

 
4,810

 
4,775

 
13,027

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Short-term investments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-bearing deposits
 
660

 

 

 

 
660

Securities purchased under agreements to resell
 
2,606

 

 

 

 
2,606

Federal funds sold
 
1,280

 

 

 

 
1,280

Total short-term investments
 
4,546

 

 

 

 
4,546

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total investments, carrying value
 
$
4,631

 
$
3,357

 
$
4,810

 
$
4,775

 
$
17,573

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Yield on AFS securities
 
3.77
%
 
1.69
%
 
2.58
%
 
4.56
%
 
 
Yield on HTM securities
 
3.59
%
 
3.37
%
 
1.76
%
 
1.80
%
 
 
Yield on total investment securities
 
3.77
%
 
2.20
%
 
2.50
%
 
2.04
%
 
 

(1) 
Year of redemption on our MBS and ABS is based on contractual maturity. Their actual maturities will likely differ from contractual maturities as borrowers have the right to prepay their obligations with or without prepayment fees.

The percentage of non-MBS AFS securities due in one year or less decreased to 2% at December 31, 2017 from 21% at December 31, 2016, and the percentage due after one year through five years increased to 53% at December 31, 2017 from 39% at December 31, 2016. The percentage due after 5 years through 10 years increased to 41% at December 31, 2017 from 37% at December 31, 2016. The changes were due to reinvestments in longer-term securities during 2017.




See Notes to Financial Statements - Note 4 - Available-for-Sale Securities, Note 5 - Held-to-Maturity Securities and Note 6 - Other-Than-Temporary Impairment for more information about our investments. See Item 7. Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Risk Management - Credit Risk Management - Investments for more information on the credit quality of our investments.

Total Liabilities. Total liabilities were $59.4 billion at December 31, 2017, an increase of 15% compared to December 31, 2016, substantially due to an increase in consolidated obligations.

Deposits (Liabilities). Total deposits were $565 million at December 31, 2017, an increase of 8% compared to December 31, 2016. These deposits represent a relatively small portion of our funding. The balances of these accounts can fluctuate from period to period and vary depending upon such factors as the attractiveness of our deposit pricing relative to the rates available on alternative money market instruments, members' preferences with respect to the maturity of their investments, and members' liquidity.

The following table presents the average amount of, and the average rate paid on, each category of deposits that exceeds 10% of average total deposits ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
Years Ended December 31,
Category of Deposit
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
Interest-bearing overnight deposits:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Average balance
 
$
125

 
$
176

 
$
291

Average rate paid
 
0.75
%
 
0.14
%
 
0.01
%
Interest-bearing demand deposits:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Average balance
 
$
379

 
$
415

 
$
414

Average rate paid
 
0.71
%
 
0.09
%
 
0.01
%

We had no individual time deposits in amounts of $100 thousand or more at December 31, 2017 or 2016.
 
 
 
 
 
Consolidated Obligations. The overall balance of our consolidated obligations fluctuates in relation to our total assets and the availability of alternative sources of funds. The composition of our consolidated obligations can fluctuate significantly based on comparative changes in their cost levels, supply and demand conditions, demand for advances, and our overall balance sheet management strategy. Discount notes are issued to provide short-term funds, while CO bonds are generally issued to provide a longer-term mix of funding.

The carrying value of consolidated obligations outstanding at December 31, 2017 totaled $58.3 billion, a net increase of $8.0 billion or 16% from December 31, 2016, which included an increase in discount notes and CO bonds to fund our asset growth.

The following table presents a breakdown by term of our consolidated obligations outstanding ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
By Term
 
Par Value
 
% of Total
 
Par Value
 
% of Total
Consolidated obligations due in 1 year or less:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Discount notes
 
$
20,394

 
35
%
 
$
16,820

 
34
%
CO bonds
 
14,021

 
24
%
 
16,234

 
32
%
Total due in 1 year or less
 
34,415

 
59
%
 
33,054

 
66
%
Long-term CO bonds
 
23,962

 
41
%
 
17,274

 
34
%
Total consolidated obligations
 
$
58,377

 
100
%
 
$
50,328

 
100
%

SEC guidance limiting the ability of prime money market funds to invest in commercial paper created a pricing advantage for FHLBank funding and led to increased demand for FHLBank debt instruments by money market funds.






The table below presents certain information for each category of our short-term borrowings for which the average balance outstanding during each year exceeded 30% of capital at year end ($ amounts in millions).
 
 

Discount Notes
 
CO Bonds With Original Maturities of One Year or Less
Short-term Borrowings
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
Outstanding at year end
 
$
20,358

 
$
16,802

 
$
19,252

 
$
6,795

 
$
7,499

 
$
7,632

Weighted average rate at year end
 
1.22
%
 
0.51
%
 
0.31
%
 
1.26
%
 
0.66
%
 
0.28
%
Daily average outstanding for the year
 
$
20,116

 
$
16,129

 
$
12,617

 
$
6,315

 
$
8,656

 
$
8,484

Weighted average rate for the year
 
0.91
%
 
0.40
%
 
0.16
%
 
0.91
%
 
0.52
%
 
0.19
%
Highest outstanding at any month end
 
$
22,413

 
$
19,511

 
$
19,252

 
$
7,279

 
$
10,247

 
$
10,164


We maintain a liquidity and funding balance between our financial assets and financial liabilities. Additionally, the FHLBanks work collectively to manage FHLB System-wide liquidity and funding and jointly monitor System-wide refinancing risk. In managing and monitoring the amounts of assets that require refunding, the FHLBanks may consider contractual maturities of the financial assets, as well as certain assumptions regarding expected cash flows (i.e., estimated prepayments and scheduled amortizations). See Notes to Financial Statements - Note 4 - Available-for-Sale Securities, Note 5 - Held-to-Maturity Securities, Note 7 - Advances, and Note 13 - Consolidated Obligations for more detailed information regarding contractual maturities of certain of our financial assets and liabilities.

Derivatives. We classify interest-rate swaps as derivative assets or liabilities according to the net estimated fair value of the interest-rate swaps with each counterparty. As of December 31, 2017 and 2016, we had derivative assets, net of collateral held or posted, including accrued interest, with estimated fair values of $128 million and $135 million, respectively, and derivative liabilities, net of collateral held or posted, including accrued interest, with estimated fair values of $3 million and $25 million, respectively. Increases and decreases in the fair value of derivatives are primarily caused by changes in the derivatives' respective underlying interest-rate indices.

The volume of derivative hedges is often expressed in terms of notional amounts, which is the amount upon which interest payments are calculated. The following table presents the notional amounts by type of hedged item whether or not it is in a qualifying hedge relationship ($ amounts in millions).
Hedged Item
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Advances
 
$
11,296

 
$
9,382

Investments
 
7,238

 
6,244

Mortgage loans
 
144

 
548

CO bonds
 
13,524

 
8,865

Discount notes
 
298

 
773

Total notional
 
$
32,500

 
$
25,812


Total Capital. Total capital at December 31, 2017 was $2.9 billion, a net increase of $510 million, or 21%, compared to December 31, 2016. This increase was due primarily to additional capital stock issued to members in connection with the increase in advances. Retained earnings growth and, to a lesser extent, other comprehensive income also contributed to the increase.

The following table presents a percentage breakdown of the components of GAAP capital.
Components
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Capital stock
 
63
%
 
61
%
Retained earnings
 
33
%
 
37
%
AOCI
 
4
%
 
2
%
Total GAAP capital
 
100
%
 
100
%

The following table presents a reconciliation of GAAP capital to regulatory capital ($ amounts in millions).
Reconciliation
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Total GAAP capital
 
$
2,946

 
$
2,436

Exclude: AOCI
 
(112
)
 
(56
)
Add: MRCS
 
164

 
170

Total regulatory capital
 
$
2,998

 
$
2,550





Liquidity and Capital Resources
 
Liquidity. We manage our liquidity in order to be able to satisfy our members' needs for short- and long-term funds, repay maturing consolidated obligations, redeem or repurchase excess stock and meet other financial obligations. We are required to maintain liquidity in accordance with the Bank Act, certain Finance Agency regulations and related policies established by our management and board of directors.

Our primary sources of liquidity are holdings of cash and short-term investments and the issuance of consolidated obligations. Our cash and short-term investments portfolio totaled $4.6 billion at December 31, 2017. Our short-term investments generally consist of high-quality financial instruments, many of which mature overnight. We manage our short-term investment portfolio in response to economic conditions and market events and uncertainties. As a result, the overall level of our short-term investment portfolio may fluctuate accordingly.

Historically, our status as a GSE and favorable credit ratings have provided us with excellent access to capital markets. Our consolidated obligations are not obligations of, and they are not guaranteed by, the United States government, although they have historically received the same credit rating as the United States government bond credit rating. The rating has not been affected by rating actions taken with respect to individual FHLBanks. During the year ended December 31, 2017, we maintained sufficient access to funding; our net proceeds from the issuance of consolidated obligations totaled $239.9 billion.

In addition, by statute, the United States Secretary of the Treasury may acquire our consolidated obligations up to an aggregate principal amount outstanding of $4.0 billion. The authority provided by this statute may be exercised only if alternative means cannot be effectively employed to permit us to continue to supply reasonable amounts of funds to the mortgage market, and the ability to supply such funds is substantially impaired because of monetary stringency and a high level of interest rates. Any funds borrowed would be repaid at the earliest practicable date. As of this date, this authority has not been exercised.

To protect us against temporary disruptions in access to the debt markets in response to increased capital market volatility, the Finance Agency requires us to: (i) maintain contingent liquidity sufficient to meet liquidity needs that shall, at a minimum, cover five calendar days of inability to access consolidated obligations in the debt markets; (ii) have available at all times an amount greater than or equal to our members' current deposits invested in specific assets; (iii) maintain, in the aggregate, unpledged qualifying assets in an amount at least equal to our participation in total consolidated obligations outstanding; and (iv) maintain, through short-term investments, an amount at least equal to our anticipated cash outflows under two hypothetical adverse scenarios.

To support deposits, the Bank Act requires us to have at all times a liquidity deposit reserve in an amount equal to the current deposits received from our members invested in (i) obligations of the United States, (ii) deposits in eligible banks or trust companies, or (iii) advances with a maturity not exceeding five years. The following table presents our excess liquidity deposit reserves ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Liquidity deposit reserves
 
$
32,016

 
$
26,945

Less: total deposits
 
565

 
524

Excess liquidity deposit reserves
 
$
31,451

 
$
26,421


We must maintain assets that are free from any lien or pledge in an amount at least equal to the amount of our consolidated obligations outstanding from among the following types of qualifying assets:

cash;
obligations of, or fully guaranteed by, the United States;
advances;
mortgages that have any guaranty, insurance, or commitment from the United States or any agency of the United States; and
investments described in Section 16(a) of the Bank Act, which include, among others, securities that a fiduciary or trustee may purchase under the laws of the state in which the FHLBank is located.





The following table presents the aggregate amount of our qualifying assets to the total amount of our consolidated obligations outstanding ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Aggregate qualifying assets
 
$
62,093

 
$
53,670

Less: total consolidated obligations outstanding
 
58,254

 
50,269

Aggregate qualifying assets in excess of consolidated obligations
 
$
3,839

 
$
3,401

 
 
 
 
 
Ratio of aggregate qualifying assets to consolidated obligations
 
1.07

 
1.07


We also maintain a contingency liquidity plan designed to enable us to meet our obligations and the liquidity needs of our members in the event of short-term capital market disruptions, or operational disruptions at our Bank and/or the Office of Finance.

We have not identified any trends, demands, commitments or events that are likely to materially increase or decrease our liquidity. However, as discussed in our Outlook, the Finance Agency has announced that it intends to issue new minimum regulatory liquidity requirements for the FHLBanks in a separate rulemaking or guidance that may increase the Bank's liquidity requirements in the near future.

Changes in Cash Flow. The cash flows from our assets and liabilities support our mission to provide our members with competitively priced funding, a reasonable return on their investment in our capital stock, and support for community investment activities. The balances of our assets and liabilities can vary significantly in the normal course of business due to the amount and timing of cash flows, which are affected by member-driven activities and market conditions. However, our net cash flows from operations have been stable. Net cash provided by operating activities was $264 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, compared to $239 million for the year ended December 31, 2016 and $251 million for the year ended December 31, 2015.

Capital Resources.

Total Regulatory Capital. A breakdown of our outstanding capital stock, categorized by type of member institution, and MRCS is provided in the following table ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
By Type of Member Institution
 
Amount
 
% of Total
 
Amount
 
% of Total
Depository institutions:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial banks and savings institutions
 
$
945

 
47
%
 
$
691

 
41
%
Credit unions
 
240

 
12
%
 
212

 
14
%
Total depository institutions
 
1,185

 
59
%
 
903

 
55
%
Insurance companies
 
673

 
33
%
 
590

 
35
%
CDFIs
 

 
%
 

 
%
Total capital stock, putable at par value
 
1,858

 
92
%
 
1,493

 
90
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
MRCS:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Captive insurance companies (1)

 

 
%
 
3

 
%
Captive insurance companies (2)
 
152

 
7
%
 
152

 
9
%
Former members (3)
 
12

 
1
%
 
15

 
1
%
Total MRCS
 
164

 
8
%
 
170

 
10
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total regulatory capital stock
 
$
2,022

 
100
%
 
$
1,663

 
100
%

(1) 
Memberships terminated by February 19, 2017.
(2) 
Memberships must terminate no later than February 19, 2021.
(3) 
Balances at December 31, 2017 and 2016 include $3 million and $6 million, respectively, of MRCS that had reached the end of the five-year redemption period but will not be redeemed until the associated credit products and other obligations are no longer outstanding.





Our remaining captive insurance company members that do not meet the new definition of "insurance company" or fall within another category of institution that is eligible for FHLBank membership shall have their memberships terminated no later than February 19, 2021. Upon termination, all of their outstanding Class B capital stock will be repurchased or redeemed in accordance with the Final Membership Rule.

Excess Capital Stock. Excess capital stock is capital stock that is not required as a condition of membership or to support outstanding obligations of members or former members to us. In general, the level of excess capital stock fluctuates with our members' level of advances.

The following table presents the composition of our excess capital stock ($ amounts in millions).
Components
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Member capital stock not subject to outstanding redemption requests
 
$
302

 
$
238

Member capital stock subject to outstanding redemption requests
 
4

 
2

MRCS
 
31

 
25

Total excess capital stock
 
$
337

 
$
265

 
 
 
 
 
Excess capital stock as a percentage of regulatory capital stock
 
17
%
 
16
%

Finance Agency rules limit the ability of an FHLBank to issue excess stock under certain circumstances, including when its total excess stock exceeds 1% of total assets or if the issuance of excess stock would cause total excess stock to exceed 1% of total assets. Our excess stock at December 31, 2017 was 0.5% of our total assets. Therefore, we are currently permitted to issue new excess stock to members and distribute stock dividends, should we choose to do so, subject to these regulatory limitations.

Under our capital plan, we are not required to redeem or repurchase excess stock from a member until five years after the earliest of (i) termination of the membership, (ii) our receipt of notice of voluntary withdrawal from membership, or (iii) the member's request for redemption of its excess stock. At our discretion, we may repurchase, and have repurchased from time to time, excess stock without a member request, upon approval of our board of directors and with 15 days' notice to the member in accordance with our capital plan.

Statutory and Regulatory Restrictions on Capital Stock Redemption. In accordance with the Bank Act, each class of FHLBank stock is considered putable by the member. However, there are significant statutory and regulatory restrictions on our obligation to redeem, or right to repurchase, the outstanding stock, including the following:

We may not redeem or repurchase any capital stock if, following such action, we would fail to satisfy any of our minimum capital requirements. By law, no FHLBank stock may be redeemed or repurchased at any time at which we are undercapitalized.
We may not redeem or repurchase any capital stock without approval of the Finance Agency if either our board of directors or the Finance Agency determines that we have incurred, or are likely to incur, losses resulting, or expected to result, in a charge against capital while such charges are continuing or expected to continue.

Additionally, we may not redeem or repurchase shares of capital stock from any member if (i) the principal or interest due on any consolidated obligation has not been paid in full when due; (ii) we fail to certify in writing to the Finance Agency that we will remain in compliance with our liquidity requirements and will remain capable of making full and timely payment of all of our current obligations; (iii) we notify the Finance Agency that we cannot provide the foregoing certification, project that we will fail to comply with statutory or regulatory liquidity requirements or will be unable to timely and fully meet all of our obligations; (iv) we actually fail to comply with statutory or regulatory liquidity requirements or to timely and fully meet all of our current obligations; or (v) we enter or negotiate to enter into an agreement with one or more FHLBanks to obtain financial assistance to meet our current obligations.

If, during the period between receipt of a stock redemption notification from a member and the actual redemption (which may last indefinitely if any of the restrictions on capital stock redemption discussed above have occurred), the Bank is liquidated, merged involuntarily, or merges upon our board of directors' approval or consent with one or more other FHLBanks, the consideration for the stock or the redemption value of the stock will be established after the settlement of all senior claims. Generally, no claims would be subordinated to the rights of our shareholders.





Our capital plan permits us, at our discretion, to retain the proceeds of redeemed or repurchased stock if we determine that there is an existing or anticipated collateral deficiency related to a member's obligations to us until the member delivers other collateral to us, such obligations have been satisfied or the anticipated collateral deficiency is otherwise resolved to our satisfaction.

If the Bank were to be liquidated, after payment in full to our creditors, our shareholders would be entitled to receive the par value of their capital stock as well as retained earnings, if any, in an amount proportional to the shareholder's allocation of total shares of capital stock at the time of liquidation. In the event of a merger or consolidation, our board of directors must determine the rights and preferences of our shareholders, subject to any terms and conditions imposed by the Finance Agency.

Capital Distributions. We may, but are not required to, pay dividends on our capital stock. Dividends are non-cumulative and may be paid in cash or Class B capital stock out of current net earnings or from unrestricted retained earnings, as authorized by our board of directors and subject to Finance Agency regulations. No dividend may be declared or paid if we are or would be, as a result of such payment, in violation of our minimum capital requirements. Moreover, we may not pay dividends if any principal or interest due on any consolidated obligation issued on behalf of any of the FHLBanks has not been paid in full or, under certain circumstances, if we fail to satisfy liquidity requirements under applicable Finance Agency regulations. See Item 5. Market for Registrant's Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities for more information.

On February 20, 2018, our board of directors declared a cash dividend of 4.25% (annualized) on our Class B-1 capital stock and 3.40% (annualized) on our Class B-2 capital stock. In addition, our board of directors declared a supplemental cash dividend of 2.50% (annualized) on our Class B-1 capital stock and 2.00% (annualized) on our Class B-2 capital stock.

Restricted Retained Earnings. We allocate 20% of our net income each quarter to a restricted retained earnings account until the balance of that account equals at least 1% of the average balance of outstanding consolidated obligations for the previous quarter. These restricted retained earnings will not be available from which to pay dividends except to the extent the restricted retained earnings balance exceeds 1.5% of our average balance of outstanding consolidated obligations for the previous quarter. We do not expect either level to be reached for several years.

Adequacy of Capital. In addition to possessing the authority to prohibit stock redemptions, our board of directors has the right to require our members to make additional capital stock purchases as needed to satisfy statutory and regulatory capital requirements.

Our board of directors has a statutory obligation to review and adjust member capital stock requirements in order to comply with our minimum capital requirements, and each member must comply promptly with any such requirement. However, a member could reduce its outstanding business with us as an alternative to purchasing stock.

Our board of directors assesses the adequacy of our capital every quarter, prior to the declaration of our quarterly dividend, by reviewing various measures set forth in our capital policy. We developed our capital policy based on guidance from the Finance Agency.

We must maintain sufficient permanent capital to meet the combined credit risk, market risk and operations risk components of the risk-based capital requirement.

Permanent capital is defined as the amount of our Class B stock (including MRCS) plus our retained earnings. We are required to maintain permanent capital at all times in an amount equal to our risk-based capital requirement, which includes the following components:

Credit risk, which represents the sum of our credit risk charges for all assets, off-balance sheet items and derivative contracts, calculated using the methodologies and risk weights assigned to each classification in the regulations;
Market risk, which represents the sum of the market value of our portfolio at risk from movements in interest rates, foreign exchange rates, commodity prices, and equity prices that could occur during periods of market stress, and the amount by which the market value of total capital is less than 85% of the book value of total capital; and
Operations risk, which represents 30% of the sum of our credit risk and market risk capital requirements.





As presented in the following table, we were in compliance with the risk-based capital requirement at December 31, 2017 and 2016 ($ amounts in millions).
Risk-Based Capital Components
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Credit risk
 
$
360

 
$
346

Market risk
 
336

 
239

Operations risk
 
208

 
176

Total risk-based capital requirement
 
$
904

 
$
761

 
 
 
 
 
Permanent capital
 
$
2,998

 
$
2,550


The increase in our total risk-based capital requirement was primarily caused by an increase in both the credit risk and market risk components. The increase in credit risk was mainly the result of longer maturities of our GSE debentures while the increase in market risk was due to changes in portfolio composition and market environment, including interest rates, spreads and volatility, and an update of the vendor prepayment model used in market risk modeling. The operations risk component is calculated as 30% of the credit and market risk capital components.

By regulation, the Finance Agency may mandate us to maintain a greater amount of permanent capital than is generally required by the risk-based capital requirements as defined, in order to promote safe and sound operations. In addition, a Finance Agency rule authorizes the Director to issue an order temporarily increasing the minimum capital level for an FHLBank if the Director determines that the current level is insufficient to address such FHLBank's risks. The rule sets forth several factors that the Director may consider in making this determination.

Under the Dodd-Frank Act, as implemented by the Finance Agency, each FHLBank is required to perform an annual stress test to assess the potential impact of various financial and economic conditions on capital adequacy. Our annual stress test was completed and published in November 2017, based on our financial condition as of December 31, 2016, using the methodology prescribed by the Finance Agency. Our stress test results demonstrated our capital adequacy under the severely adverse economic scenario defined by the Finance Agency.

The Finance Agency has established four capital classifications for the FHLBanks - adequately capitalized, undercapitalized, significantly undercapitalized, and critically undercapitalized - and implemented the prompt corrective action provisions of HERA that apply to FHLBanks that are not deemed to be adequately capitalized. The Finance Agency determines our capital classification on at least a quarterly basis. If we are determined to be other than adequately capitalized, we would become subject to additional supervisory authority by the Finance Agency. Before implementing a reclassification, the Director would be required to provide us with written notice of the proposed action and an opportunity to respond. The Finance Agency's most recent determination is that we hold sufficient capital to be adequately capitalized and meet both our minimum capital and risk-based capital requirements. See Notes to Financial Statements - Note 15 - Capital for more information.





Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements
 
The following table summarizes our off-balance-sheet arrangements (notional $ amounts in millions).
Types
 
December 31, 2017
Letters of credit outstanding 
 
$
224

Unused lines of credit (1)
 
1,084

Commitments to fund additional advances (2)
 
4

Commitments to fund or purchase mortgage loans, net (3)
 
71

Unsettled CO bonds, at par
 
28


(1) 
Maximum line of credit amount is $50 million.
(2) 
Generally for periods up to six months.
(3) 
Generally for periods up to 91 days.

A standby letter of credit is a financing arrangement between us and one of our members for which we charge a fee. If we are required to make payment on a beneficiary's draw, the payment amount is converted into a collateralized advance to the member. The original terms of these standby letters of credit, including related commitments, range from 3 months to 20 years. Lines of credit allow members to fund short-term cash needs (up to one year) without submitting a new application for each request for funds.

Our MPP was designed to require loan servicers to foreclose and liquidate in the servicer's name rather than in our name. As the servicer progresses through the process from foreclosure to liquidation, we are paid in full for all unpaid principal and accrued interest on the loan through the normal remittance process and the servicer files a claim against the various credit enhancements for reimbursement of losses incurred. The claim is then reviewed and paid as appropriate under the various credit enhancement policies or guidelines. Subsequently, the servicer may submit claims to us for any remaining losses. At December 31, 2017, principal previously paid in full by our MPP servicers totaling $2 million remains subject to potential claims by those servicers for any losses resulting from past or future liquidations of the underlying properties. An estimate of the losses is included in the MPP allowance for loan losses. See Notes to Financial Statements - Note 1 - Summary of Significant Accounting Policies and Note 9 - Allowance for Credit Losses for more information. See Notes to Financial Statements - Note 20 - Commitments and Contingencies for information on additional commitments and contingencies.

Contractual Obligations

The following table presents the payments due or expiration terms by specified contractual obligation type ($ amounts in millions).
December 31, 2017
 
< 1 year
 
1 to 3 years
 
3 to 5 years
 
> 5 years
 
Total
Contractual obligations:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Long-term debt (1)
 
$
14,021

 
$
14,242

 
$
4,093

 
$
5,627

 
$
37,983

Operating leases
 

 
1

 

 
1

 
2

Benefit payments (2)
 
3

 
6

 
9

 
4

 
22

MRCS (3)
 
8

 

 
4

 
152

 
164

Total
 
$
14,032

 
$
14,249

 
$
4,106

 
$
5,784

 
$
38,171


(1) 
Includes CO bonds reported at par and based on contractual maturities but excludes discount notes due to their short-term nature. See Notes to Financial Statements - Note 13 - Consolidated Obligations for more information on consolidated obligations.
(2) 
Amounts represent actuarial estimates of future benefit payments in accordance with the provisions of our SERP. See Notes to Financial Statements - Note 17 - Employee and Director Retirement and Deferred Compensation Plans for more information.
(3) 
See Notes to Financial Statements - Note 15 - Capital for more information.





Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates
 
The preparation of financial statements in accordance with GAAP requires management to make a number of judgments, estimates, and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities (if applicable), and the reported amounts of income and expenses during the reporting period. We review these estimates and assumptions based on historical experience, changes in business conditions and other relevant factors that we believe to be reasonable under the circumstances. Changes in estimates and assumptions have the potential to significantly affect our financial position and results of operations. In any given reporting period, our actual results may differ from the estimates and assumptions used in preparing our financial statements.

We determined that four of our accounting policies and estimates are critical because they require management to make particularly difficult, subjective, and/or complex judgments about matters that are inherently uncertain and because of the likelihood that materially different amounts could be reported under different conditions or using different assumptions. These accounting policies pertain to:

Derivatives and hedging activities (see Notes to Financial Statements - Note 11 - Derivatives and Hedging Activities for more detail);
Fair value estimates (see Notes to Financial Statements - Note 19 - Estimated Fair Values for more detail);
Provision for credit losses (see Notes to Financial Statements - Note 9 - Allowance for Credit Losses for more detail); and
OTTI (see Notes to Financial Statements - Note 6 - Other-Than-Temporary Impairment for more detail).

We believe the application of our accounting policies on a consistent basis enables us to provide financial statement users with useful, reliable and timely information about our results of operations, financial position and cash flows.

Accounting for Derivatives and Hedging Activities. All derivatives are recorded in the statement of condition at their estimated fair values. Changes in the estimated fair value of our derivatives are recorded in current period earnings regardless of how changes in the estimated fair value of the assets or liabilities being hedged may be treated. Therefore, even though derivatives are used to mitigate market risk, derivatives introduce the potential for earnings volatility. Specifically, a mismatch can exist between the timing of income and expense recognition from assets or liabilities and the income effects of derivative instruments positioned to mitigate the market risk associated with those assets or liabilities. Therefore, during periods of significant changes in interest rates and other market factors, our earnings may experience greater volatility.

Generally, we strive to use derivatives that effectively hedge specific assets or liabilities and qualify for fair-value hedge accounting. Fair-value hedge accounting allows for offsetting changes in the estimated fair value attributable to the hedged risk in the hedged item to also be recorded in current period earnings.

Although substantially all of our derivatives qualify for fair-value hedge accounting, we treat all derivatives that do not qualify for fair-value hedge accounting as economic hedges for asset/liability management purposes. The changes in the estimated fair value of these economic hedges are recorded in other income (loss) as net gains (losses) on derivatives and hedging activities with no offsetting fair value adjustments for the hedged assets, liabilities, or firm commitments.

The use of estimates based on market prices to determine the derivative's estimated fair value can have a significant impact on current period earnings for all hedges, both those in fair-value hedging relationships and those in economic hedging relationships. Although this estimation and valuation process can cause earnings volatility during the periods the derivative instruments are held, the estimation and valuation process for hedges that qualify for fair-value hedge accounting does not have any net long-term economic effect or result in any net cash flows if the derivative and the hedged item are held to maturity. Since these estimated fair values eventually return to zero (or par value) on the maturity date, the effect of such fluctuations throughout the hedge period is usually only a timing issue.





Fair Value Estimates. We report certain assets and liabilities on the statement of condition at estimated fair value, including investments classified as AFS, grantor trust assets, and all derivatives. "Fair value" is defined as the price that would be received to sell an asset, or paid to transfer a liability, in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date (i.e., an exit price). We are required to consider factors specific to the asset or liability, the principal or most advantageous market for the asset or liability, and the participants with whom we would transact in that market. In general, the transaction price will equal the exit price and, therefore, represents the fair value of the asset or liability at initial recognition.

Estimated fair values are based on quoted market prices or market-based prices, if such prices are available. If quoted market prices or market-based prices are not available, estimated fair values are determined based on valuation models that use either:
 
discounted cash flows, using market estimates of interest rates and volatility; or 
dealer prices on similar instruments.

For external pricing models, we review the vendors' pricing processes, methodologies, and control procedures for reasonableness. For internal pricing models, the underlying assumptions are based on management's best estimates for:
 
discount rates;
prepayments;
market volatility; and
other factors.

The assumptions used in both external and internal pricing models could have a significant effect on the reported fair values of assets and liabilities, including the related income and expense. The use of different assumptions, as well as changes in market conditions, could result in materially different values. We continue to refine our valuation methodologies as markets and products develop and the pricing for certain products becomes more or less transparent.

We categorize our financial instruments reported at estimated fair value into a three-level hierarchy. The valuation hierarchy is based upon the transparency (observable or unobservable) of inputs to the valuation of an asset or liability as of the measurement date. Observable inputs reflect market data obtained from independent sources, while unobservable inputs reflect our market assumptions. Level 1 instruments are those for which inputs to the valuation methodology are observable and are derived from quoted prices (unadjusted) for identical assets or liabilities in active markets that we can access on the measurement date. Level 2 instruments are those for which inputs are observable, either directly or indirectly, and include quoted prices for similar assets and liabilities. Finally, level 3 instruments are those for which inputs are unobservable or are unable to be corroborated by external market data.

To the extent possible, we use observable inputs in our valuation models. However, as certain markets continue to remain illiquid, we may utilize more unobservable inputs if they better reflect market values. With respect to our private-label RMBS, we concluded that, overall, the inputs used to determine fair value are unobservable (i.e., level 3). We have sufficient information to conclude that level 3 is appropriate based on our knowledge of the dislocation of the private-label RMBS market and the distribution of prices received from multiple third-party pricing services, which is generally wider than would be expected if observable inputs were used.

Provision for Credit Losses.

Mortgage Loans Acquired under the MPP. Our loan loss allowance policy requires management to determine if it is probable that impairment has occurred in the mortgage loan portfolio as of the statement of condition date and whether the amount of loss can be reasonably estimated. Losses shall not be recognized before it is probable that they have been incurred, even though it may be probable based on past experience that losses will be incurred in the future. Probable impairment occurs when management determines, using current and historical information and events, that it is likely that not all amounts due according to the contractual terms of the loan agreement will be collected by the Bank.

We have developed a systematic approach for reviewing the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses. Using this methodology, we perform a review designed to identify probable impairment as well as determine a reasonable estimate of loss, if any. This review consists of a separate review of (i) performing conventional loans collectively evaluated for impairment, (ii) delinquent conventional loans collectively evaluated for impairment, and (iii) certain other conventional loans individually evaluated for impairment. FHA loans are government-guaranteed and, consequently, we have determined that no allowance for losses is necessary for such loans.





For performing conventional loans current to 179 days past due and collectively evaluated for impairment, our analysis incorporates the use of a recognized third-party credit and prepayment model to estimate potential ranges of credit loss exposure. The loss projection is based upon distinct underlying loan characteristics, including loan vintage (year of origination), geographic location, credit support features and other factors, and a projected migration of loans through the various stages of delinquency.

For delinquent conventional loans past due 180 days or more and collectively evaluated for impairment, we evaluate the pools based on current and historical information and events.

Certain conventional mortgage loans that are impaired, primarily TDRs, are specifically identified for purposes of calculating the allowance for loan losses. The measurement of the allowance for individually evaluated loans considers loan-specific attribute data similar to loans evaluated on a collective basis.

Our allowance for loan losses also includes specifically identified probable claims by servicers for any remaining losses of principal on delinquent loans that were previously paid in full by the servicers, and thus no longer included in the UPB on the statement of condition. We individually evaluate the properties included in this balance and obtain HUD statements, sales listings or other evidence of current expected liquidation amounts.

Our allowance for loan losses also compares, or benchmarks, our estimated losses on conventional mortgage loans, after credit enhancements, to actual losses occurring in the portfolio. Further, the third-party credit and prepayment model serves as a secondary review of the allowance for loan losses determined using the systematic approach. The projected losses from the model have historically been lower than our estimate of loan losses under the systematic approach.

These estimates require significant judgments, especially considering the inability to readily determine the fair value of all underlying properties and the uncertainty in other macroeconomic factors that make estimating defaults and severity imprecise. Because of variability in the data underlying the assumptions made in the process of determining the allowance for loan losses, estimates of the portfolio's inherent risks will change as warranted by changes in the economy. The degree to which any particular change would affect the allowance for loan losses would depend on the severity of the change.

We considered an adverse scenario whereby we used a haircut on our underlying collateral values of 20% for delinquent conventional loans, including individually evaluated loans. We consider such a haircut to represent the most distressed scenario that is reasonably possible to occur over the loss emergence period of 24 months. In this distressed scenario, while holding all other assumptions constant, our estimated incurred losses remaining after borrowers' equity, but before credit enhancements, would increase by approximately $3.1 million. However, such increase would be substantially offset by credit enhancements. Therefore, the allowance for loan losses continues to be based upon our best estimate of the probable losses over the loss emergence period that would not be recovered from the credit enhancements.





Other-Than-Temporary Impairment. We evaluate our AFS and HTM investment securities on a quarterly basis to determine if any unrealized losses are other-than-temporary. Our evaluation is based in part on the creditworthiness of the issuers, and in part on the security's underlying collateral and expected cash flows. An OTTI has occurred if our cash flow analysis determines that a credit loss exists, i.e., the present value of the cash flows expected to be collected is less than the security’s amortized cost, irrespective of whether management will be required to sell such security.

The following table presents the significant modeling assumptions used to determine whether any of our private-label RMBS and ABS was OTTI during the year ended December 31, 2017, as well as the related current credit enhancement ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
 
 
Significant Modeling Assumptions (1)
 
Current Credit Enhancement (3)
Classification (2)
 
UPB
 
Prepayment Rates
 
Default Rates
 
Loss Severities
 
Private-label RMBS:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total Prime
 
$
262

 
13
%
 
7
%
 
22
%
 
4
%
Total Alt-A
 

 
11
%
 
6
%
 
11
%
 
11
%
Total private-label RMBS
 
$
262

 
13
%
 
7
%
 
22
%
 
4
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Home equity loan ABS:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total subprime - home equity loans (4)
 
$
1

 
7
%
 
29
%
 
39
%
 
%

(1) 
Weighted average based on UPB.
(2) 
The classification (prime, Alt-A or subprime) is based on the model used to project the cash flows for the security, which may not be the same as the rating agency's classification at the time of origination.
(3) 
Credit enhancement is defined as the percentage of subordinated tranches, excess spread, and over-collateralization, if any, in a security structure that will generally absorb losses before we will experience a loss on the security. A credit enhancement percentage of zero reflects a security that has no remaining credit support and is likely to have experienced an actual principal loss.
(4) 
Modeling assumptions assume no payout from monoline bond insurers.

In addition to evaluating our private-label RMBS under a best estimate scenario, we perform a cash flow analysis for each of these securities under a more stressful housing price scenario. This more stressful scenario is primarily based on a short-term housing price forecast that is 5% lower than the best estimate scenario, followed by a recovery path with annual rates of housing price growth that are 33% lower than the best estimate.

The actual OTTI-related credit losses recognized in earnings for the three months ended December 31, 2017 totaled $0. Under the more stressful scenario, the estimated OTTI-related credit losses for the same period totaled $0. The adverse scenario and associated results do not represent our current expectations and, therefore, should not be construed as a prediction of our future results, market conditions or the performance of these securities. Rather, the results from this hypothetical adverse scenario provide a measure of the credit losses that we might incur if home price declines (and subsequent recoveries) are more adverse than those projected in our OTTI evaluation.

Additional information regarding OTTI of our private-label RMBS and ABS is provided in Notes to Financial Statements - Note 6 - Other-Than-Temporary Impairment herein.




Recent Accounting and Regulatory Developments
 
Accounting Developments. See Notes to Financial Statements - Note 2 - Recently Adopted and Issued Accounting Guidance for a description of how recent accounting developments may impact our financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.

Legislative and Regulatory Developments.

Finance Agency Proposed Rule on Capital Requirements. On July 3, 2017, the Finance Agency published a proposed rule to adopt, with amendments, the Finance Board regulations pertaining to the capital requirements for the FHLBanks. The proposed rule would carry over most of the existing regulations without material change, but would substantively revise the credit risk component of the risk-based capital requirement, as well as the limitations on extensions of unsecured credit and derivative exposure. The main revisions would remove requirements that the FHLBanks calculate credit-risk capital charges and unsecured credit limits based on ratings issued by an NRSRO, and instead would require that the FHLBanks establish and use their own internal rating methodology. With respect to derivatives, the proposed rule would impose a new capital charge for cleared derivatives, which under the existing rule do not carry a capital charge, and would change the way that the capital charge and risk limits are calculated for uncleared derivatives, in both cases to align with the Dodd-Frank Act’s clearing mandate and derivatives reforms. The proposed rule also would revise the percentages used in the regulation’s tables to calculate credit-risk capital charges for advances and for non-mortgage assets. The Finance Agency proposes to retain for now the percentages used in the tables to calculate capital charges for mortgage-related assets, and to address at a later date the methodology for residential mortgage assets. While a March 2009 regulatory directive pertaining to certain liquidity matters would remain in place, the Finance Agency also proposes to rescind certain minimum regulatory liquidity requirements and address these liquidity requirements in a new regulatory directive.

We submitted a joint comment letter with the other FHLBanks on August 31, 2017. We continue to evaluate the proposed rule and to evaluate the process of converting from the current rule on capital requirements to a new final rule. At this time, we do not expect this rule, if adopted as proposed, to materially affect our financial condition or results of operations. However, we expect that any final rule could require us to make changes to our systems, which could carry operational and other risks.

Information Security Management Advisory Bulletin. On September 28, 2017, the Finance Agency issued Advisory Bulletin 2017-02, which supersedes previous guidance on an FHLBank’s information security program. The advisory bulletin describes three main components of an information security program and reflects the expectation that each FHLBank will use a risk-based approach to implement its information security program. The advisory bulletin contains expectations related to (i) governance, including guidance related to roles and responsibilities, risk assessments, industry standards, and cyber-insurance; (ii) engineering and architecture, including guidance on network security, software security, and security of endpoints; and (iii) operations, including guidance on continuous monitoring, vulnerability management, baseline configuration, asset life cycle, awareness and training, incident response and recovery, user access management, data classification and protection, oversight of third parties, and threat intelligence sharing.

We do not expect this advisory bulletin to materially affect our financial condition or results of operations, but we anticipate that it may result in increased costs relating to enhancements to our information security program.

FRB, FDIC and OCC Final Rules on Mandatory Contractual Stay Requirements for Qualified Financial Contracts ("QFCs"). On September 12, 2017, the FRB published a final rule, effective November 13, 2017, requiring certain global systemically important banking institutions ("GSIB") regulated by the FRB to amend their covered QFCs to limit a counterparty’s immediate termination or exercise of default rights under the QFCs in the event of bankruptcy or receivership of the GSIB or an affiliate of the GSIB. Covered QFCs include derivatives, repurchase agreements (known as "repos") and reverse repos, and securities lending and borrowing agreements. On September 27, 2017, and November 29, 2017, the FDIC and OCC respectively adopted final rules that are both substantively identical to the FRB rule, both effective January 1, 2018, with respect to QFCs entered into with certain FDIC- and OCC-supervised institutions.

Although we are not a covered entity under these rules, as a counterparty to covered entities under QFCs, we may be required to amend QFCs entered into with FRB-regulated GSIBs or applicable FDIC- and OCC-supervised institutions. These rules may impact our ability to terminate business relationships with covered entities and could adversely impact the amount we recover in the event of the bankruptcy or receivership of a covered entity. However, we do not expect these final rules to materially affect our financial condition or results of operations.




OCC, FRB, FDIC, Farm Credit Administration, and Finance Agency Proposed Rule on Margin and Capital Requirements for Covered Swap Entities. On February 21, 2018, OCC, FRB, FDIC, Farm Credit Administration, and the Finance Agency published a joint proposed amendment to each agency’s final rule on Margin and Capital Requirements for Covered Swap Entities ("Swap Margin Rules") to conform the definition of "eligible master netting agreement" in such rules to the FRB’s, OCC’s, and FDIC’s final QFC rules, and to clarify that a legacy swap will not be deemed to be a covered swap under the Swap Margin Rules if it is amended to conform to the QFC Rules.

Comments on the proposed rule are due by April 23, 2018. We continue to evaluate the proposed rule, but we do not expect this rule, if adopted substantially as proposed, to materially affect our financial condition or results of operations.

Risk Management

We have exposure to a number of risks in pursuing our business objectives. These risks may be broadly classified as market, credit, liquidity, operational, and business. Market risk is discussed in detail in Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk.

Active risk management is an integral part of our operations because these risks are an inherent part of our business activities. We manage these risks by, among other actions, setting and enforcing appropriate limits and developing and maintaining internal policies and processes to ensure an appropriate risk profile. In order to enhance our ability to manage Bank-wide risk, our risk management function is aligned to segregate risk measurement, monitoring, and evaluation from our business units where risk-taking occurs through financial transactions and positions.

The Finance Agency establishes certain risk-related compliance requirements. In addition, our board of directors has established a Risk Appetite Statement that summarizes the amounts, levels and types of enterprise-wide risk that our management is authorized to undertake in pursuit of achieving our mission and executing our strategic plans. The Risk Appetite Statement incorporates high level qualitative and quantitative risk limits and tolerances from our Enterprise Risk Management Policy, which serves as a key policy to address our exposures to market, credit, liquidity, operational and business risks, and various other key risk-related policies approved by our board of directors, including the Operational Risk Management Policy, the Model Risk Management Policy, the Credit Policy, the Capital Markets Policy, and the Enterprise Information Security Policy.

Effective risk management programs include not only conformance of specific risk management practices to the Enterprise Risk Management Policy and other key risk-related policy requirements, but also the active involvement of our board of directors. Our board of directors has established a Risk Oversight Committee that provides focus, direction and accountability for our risk management process. Further, pursuant to the Enterprise Risk Management Policy, the following internal management committees focus on risk management, among other duties:

Executive Management Committee
Facilitates planning, coordination and communication among our operating divisions and the other committees;
Focuses on leadership, teamwork and our resources to best serve organizational priorities; and
Generally oversees the following committees' activities.
Member Services Committee
Focuses on new and existing member services and products and oversees the effectiveness of the risk mitigation framework for member services and products; and
Promotes cross-functional communication and exchange of ideas pertaining to member products offered to achieve financial objectives established by the board of directors and senior management while remaining within prescribed risk parameters.
Capital Markets Committee
Focuses on the Bank's investment and funding activities as they relate to financial performance, risk profile and the Bank's strategic direction; and
Deliberates proposed strategies to meet funding needs and achieve financial performance objectives established by the board of directors and senior management, while remaining within established risk control parameters.
IT Steering Committee
Monitors our technology-related activities, strategies, risk positions and issues; and
Promotes cross-functional communication and exchange of ideas pertaining to the technology directions and actions undertaken to achieve our strategic and financial objectives.




Strategy Risk Management Committee
Provides strategic direction in the management of key risk exposures and risk policies, and adjudicates strategic risk issues as they arise (credit, market, liquidity, advance lending, AMA, investment portfolio, treasury, operations, regulatory and reputation); and
Identifies and understands current and emerging risks and opportunities - makes course corrections as circumstances and events dictate.

Each of the committees is responsible for overseeing its respective business activities in accordance with specified policies, in addition to ongoing consideration of pertinent risk-related issues.

We have a formal process for the assessment of Bank-wide risk and risk-related issues. Our risk assessment process is designed to identify and evaluate material risks, including both quantitative and qualitative aspects, which could adversely affect achievement of our financial performance objectives and compliance with applicable requirements. Business unit managers play a significant role in this process, as they are best positioned to understand and identify the risks inherent in their respective operations. These assessments evaluate the inherent risks within each of the key processes as well as the controls and strategies in place to manage those risks, identify primary weaknesses, and recommend actions that should be undertaken to address the identified weaknesses. The results of these assessments are summarized in an annual risk assessment report, which is reviewed by senior management and our board of directors. 

Credit Risk Management. Credit risk is the risk that members or other counterparties may be unable to meet their contractual obligations to us, or that the values of those obligations will decline as a result of deterioration in the members' or other counterparties' creditworthiness. Credit risk arises when our funds are extended, committed, invested or otherwise exposed through actual or implied contractual agreements. We face credit risk on advances and other credit products, investments, mortgage loans, derivative financial instruments, and AHP grants. 

The most important step in the management of credit risk is the initial decision to extend credit. We also manage credit risk by following established policies, evaluating the creditworthiness of our members and counterparties, and utilizing collateral agreements and settlement netting. Periodic monitoring of members and other counterparties is performed whenever we are exposed to credit risk.
 
Advances and Other Credit Products. We manage our exposure to credit risk on advances primarily through a combination of our security interests in assets pledged by our borrowers and ongoing reviews of our borrowers' financial strength. Credit analyses are performed on existing borrowers, with the frequency and scope determined by the financial strength of the borrower and/or the amount of our credit products outstanding to that borrower. We establish limits and other requirements for advances and other credit products.

Section 10(a) of the Bank Act prohibits us from making an advance without sufficient collateral to fully secure the advance. Security is provided via thorough underwriting and establishing a perfected position in eligible assets pledged by the borrower as collateral before an advance is made by filing Uniform Commercial Code financing statements in the appropriate jurisdictions. Each member's collateral reporting requirement is based on its collateral status, which reflects its financial condition and type of institution, and our review of conflicting liens, with our level of control increasing when a borrower's financial performance deteriorates. We continually evaluate the quality and value of collateral pledged to support advances and work with members to improve the accuracy of valuations.

As of December 31, 2017 and 2016, advances to our insurance company members represented 45% and 53%, respectively, of our total advances, at par. We believe that advances outstanding to our insurance company members and the relative percentage of their advances to the total could increase, based upon the significant portion of total financial assets held by insurance companies in our district. Although insurance companies represent significant growth opportunities for our credit products, they have different risk characteristics than our depository members. Some of the ways we mitigate this risk include requiring insurance companies to deliver collateral to us or our custodian and using industry-specific underwriting approaches as part of our ongoing evaluation of our insurance company members' financial strength.

A captive insurance company insures risks of its parent, affiliated companies and/or other entities under common control. We generally require captive insurance company members to, among other requirements: (i) pledge the collateral free of other encumbrances, (ii) collateralize all obligations to us, including prepayment fees, accrued interest and any outstanding AHP or MPP obligations, (iii) obtain our prior approval before pledging whole loan collateral, and (iv) provide annual audit reports of the member entity and its ultimate parent, as well as quarterly unaudited financial statements.




Borrowing Limits. Generally, we maintain a credit products borrowing limit of 50% of a depository member's adjusted assets, defined as total assets less borrowings from all sources. As of December 31, 2017, we had no advances outstanding to a depository member whose total credit products exceeded 50% of its adjusted assets.

On March 18, 2016, our board of directors modified the initial borrowing limit for our insurance company members (excluding captive insurance companies) to 25% of their total general account assets less money borrowed. Credit extensions to insurance company members whose total credit products exceed this threshold require an additional approval by our Bank as provided in our credit policy. The approval is based upon a number of factors that may include the member's financial condition, collateral quality, business plan and earnings stability. We also monitor these members more closely on an ongoing basis. As of December 31, 2017, we had advances outstanding, at par, of $325 million to one of our insurance company members whose total credit products exceeded 25% of their general account assets, net of money borrowed.

Effective February 19, 2016, new or renewed credit extensions to captive insurance companies that became members prior to September 12, 2014 are subject to certain restrictions relating to maturity dates and cannot exceed 40% of the member's total assets. As of December 31, 2017, one such captive insurance company member's total credit products exceeded the percentage limit. Therefore, no new or renewed credit extensions have been extended to this member. We may impose additional restrictions on extensions of credit to our members, including captive insurance companies, at our discretion.

Concentration. Our credit risk is magnified due to the concentration of advances in a few borrowers. As of December 31, 2017, our top borrower held 17% of total advances outstanding, at par, and our top five borrowers held 45% of total advances outstanding, at par. As a result of this concentration, we perform frequent credit and collateral reviews on our largest borrowers. In addition, we analyze the implications to our financial management and profitability if we were to lose the business of one or more of these borrowers.
 
Collateral Requirements. We generally require all borrowers to execute a security agreement that grants us a blanket lien on substantially all assets of the member. Our agreements with borrowers require each borrowing entity to fully secure all outstanding extensions of credit at all times, including advances, accrued interest receivable, standby letters of credit, correspondent services, certain AHP transactions, and all indebtedness, liabilities or obligations arising or incurred as a result of a member transacting business with our Bank. We may also require a member to pledge additional collateral to cover exposure resulting from any applicable prepayment fees on advances.

The assets that constitute eligible collateral to secure extensions of credit are set forth in Section 10(a) of the Bank Act. In accordance with the Bank Act, we accept the following assets as collateral:

fully disbursed, whole first mortgages on improved residential property, or securities representing a whole interest in such mortgages;
securities issued, insured, or guaranteed by the United States government or any agency thereof (including, without limitation, MBS issued or guaranteed by Fannie Mae, Freddie Mac, or Ginnie Mae);
cash or deposits in an FHLBank; and
ORERC acceptable to us if such collateral has a readily ascertainable value and we can perfect our interest in the collateral.

Additionally, for any CFI, as defined in accordance with the Bank Act, we may also accept secured loans for small business, agricultural and community development activities.





In addition to our internal credit risk management policies and procedures, Section 10(e) of the Bank Act affords priority of any security interest granted to us, by a member or such member's affiliate, over the claims or rights of any other party, including any receiver, conservator, trustee, or similar entity that has the rights of a lien creditor, except for claims held by bona fide purchasers for value or by parties that are secured by prior perfected security interests, provided that such claims would otherwise be entitled to priority under applicable law. Moreover, with respect to federally-insured depository institution borrowers, our claims are given certain preferences pursuant to the receivership provisions of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act. With respect to insurance company members, however, Congress provided in the McCarran-Ferguson Act of 1945 that state law generally governs the regulation of insurance and shall not be preempted by federal law unless the federal law expressly regulates the business of insurance. Thus, if a court were to determine that the priority provision of Section 10(e) of the Bank Act conflicts with state insurance law applicable to our insurance company members, the court might then determine that the priority of our security interest would be governed by state law, not Section 10(e). Under these circumstances, the "super lien" priority protection afforded to our security interest under Section 10(e) may not fully apply when we lend to such insurance company members. However, we monitor applicable states' laws, and our security interests in collateral posted by insurance company members have express statutory protections in the jurisdictions where our members are domiciled. In addition, we take all necessary action under applicable state law to obtain and maintain a prior perfected security interest in the collateral, including by taking possession or control of the collateral as appropriate.

Collateral Status. When an institution becomes a member of our Bank, we assign the member to a collateral status after the initial underwriting review. The assignment of a member to a collateral status category reflects, in part, our philosophy of increasing our level of control over the collateral pledged by the member, when warranted, based on our underwriting conclusions and a review of our lien priority. Some members pledge and report collateral under a blanket lien established through the security agreement, while others are placed on specific listings or possession status or a combination of the three via a hybrid status. We take possession of all collateral posted by insurance companies to further ensure our position as a first-priority secured creditor. Members may elect a more restrictive collateral status to receive a higher lendable value for their collateral.

The primary features of these three collateral status categories are:

Blanket:

only certain financially sound depository institutions are eligible;
institutions that have granted a blanket lien to another creditor are ineligible;
review and approval by credit services management is required;
member retains possession of eligible whole loan collateral pledged to us;
member executes a written security agreement and agrees to hold such collateral for our benefit; and
member provides periodic reports of all eligible collateral.

Specific Listings:

applicable to depository institutions that demonstrate potential weakness in their financial condition or seek lower over-collateralization requirements;
may be available to institutions that have granted a blanket lien to another creditor if an inter-creditor or subordination agreement is executed;
member retains possession of eligible whole loan collateral pledged to us;
member executes a written security agreement and agrees to hold such collateral for our benefit; and
member provides loan level detail on the pledged collateral on at least a monthly basis.

Possession:

applicable to all insurance companies and those depository institutions demonstrating less financial strength than those approved for specific listings;
required for all de novo institutions and institutions that have granted a blanket lien to another creditor but have not executed an inter-creditor or subordination agreement;
safekeeping for securities pledged as collateral can be with us or a third-party custodian that we have pre-approved;
original notes and other documents related to whole loans pledged as collateral are held with a third-party custodian that we have pre-approved; and
member provides loan level detail on the pledged collateral on at least a monthly basis.





Collateral Valuation. In order to mitigate the market, credit, liquidity, operational and business risk associated with collateral, we apply an over-collateralization requirement to the book value or market value of pledged collateral to establish its lendable value. Collateral that we have determined to contain a low level of risk, such as United States government obligations, is over-collateralized at a lower rate than collateral that carries a higher level of risk, such as small business loans. The over-collateralization requirement applied to asset classes may vary depending on collateral status, since lower requirements are applied as our levels of information and control over the assets increase.

We have made changes to, and continue to update, our internal valuation model to gain greater consistency between model-generated valuations and observed market prices, resulting in adjustments to lendable values on whole loan collateral. We routinely engage outside pricing vendors to benchmark our modeled pricing on residential and commercial real estate collateral, and we modify valuations where appropriate.

The following table provides information regarding credit products outstanding with member and non-member borrowers based on their reporting status at December 31, 2017, along with their corresponding collateral balances. The table only lists collateral that was identified and pledged by members and non-members with outstanding credit products at December 31, 2017, and therefore does not include all assets against which we have liens via our security agreements and Uniform Commercial Code filings ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
 
 
Collateral Types
 
 
 
 
 
 
Collateral Status
 
# of Borrowers
 
1st lien Residential
 
ORERC/CFI
 
Securities/Delivery
 
Total Collateral
 
Lendable Value (1)
 
Credit Outstanding (2)
Blanket
 
56

 
$
7,675

 
$
6,624

 
$

 
$
14,299

 
$
8,908

 
$
3,943

Specific listings
 
77

 
16,685

 
2,683

 
2,995

 
22,363

 
16,411

 
10,238

Possession
 
31

 
4,805

 
10,683

 
9,788

 
25,276

 
18,397

 
15,650

Hybrid (3)
 
36

 
7,306

 
3,072

 
2,313

 
12,691

 
8,667

 
4,562

Total
 
200

 
$
36,471

 
$
23,062

 
$
15,096

 
$
74,629

 
$
52,383

 
$
34,393


(1) 
Lendable Value is the borrowing capacity, based upon collateral pledged after a market value has been estimated (excluding blanket-pledged collateral) and an over-collateralization requirement has been applied.
(2) 
Credit outstanding includes advances (at par value), lines of credit used, and letters of credit.
(3) 
Hybrid collateral status is a combination of any of the others: blanket, specific listings and possession.

Collateral Review and Monitoring. Our agreements with borrowers allow us, at any time and in our sole discretion, to refuse to make extensions of credit against any collateral, require substitution of collateral, or adjust the over-collateralization requirements applied to collateral. We also may require borrowers to pledge additional collateral regardless of whether the collateral would be eligible to originate a new extension of credit. Our agreements with our borrowers also afford us the right, in our sole discretion, to declare any borrower to be in default if we deem our Bank to be inadequately secured.

Credit services management continually monitors members' collateral status and may require a member to change its collateral status based upon deteriorating financial performance, results of on-site collateral reviews, or a high level of borrowings as a percentage of its assets. The blanket lien created by the security agreement remains in place regardless of a member's collateral status.

The Bank conducts regular on-site reviews of collateral pledged by members to confirm the existence of the pledged collateral, confirm that the collateral conforms to our eligibility requirements, and score the collateral for concentration and credit risk. Based on the results of such on-site reviews, a member may have its over-collateralization requirements adjusted, limitations may be placed on the amount of certain asset types accepted as collateral or, in some cases, the member may be changed to a more stringent collateral status. We may conduct a review of any borrower's collateral at any time.

Credit Review and Monitoring. We monitor the financial condition of all member and non-member borrowers by reviewing certain available financial data, such as regulatory call reports filed by depository institution borrowers, regulatory financial statements filed with the appropriate state insurance department by insurance company borrowers, SEC filings, and rating agency reports, to ensure that potentially troubled institutions are identified as soon as possible. In addition, we have the ability to obtain borrowers' regulatory examination reports and, when appropriate, may contact borrowers' management teams to discuss performance and business strategies. We analyze this information on a regular basis and use it to determine the appropriate collateral status for a borrower.





We use models to assign a quarterly financial performance measure for all depository institution borrowers. This measure, combined with other credit monitoring tools and the level of a member's usage of credit products, determines the frequency and depth of underwriting analysis for these institutions.

Investments. We are also exposed to credit risk through our investment portfolios. Our policies restrict the acquisition of investments to high-quality, short-term money market instruments and high-quality long-term securities.

Short-Term Investments. Our short-term investment portfolio typically includes federal funds sold, which can be overnight or term placements of our funds. We place these funds with large, high-quality financial institutions with investment-grade long-term credit ratings on an unsecured basis for terms of up to 275 days. Our short-term investment portfolio also typically includes securities purchased under agreements to resell, which are secured by United States Treasuries or Agency MBS passthroughs. Although we are permitted to purchase these securities for terms of up to 275 days, most mature overnight.

We monitor counterparty creditworthiness, ratings, performance, and capital adequacy in an effort to mitigate unsecured credit risk on the short-term investments, with an emphasis on the potential impacts of changes in global economic conditions. As a result, we may limit or suspend exposure to certain counterparties.

Finance Agency regulations include limits on the amount of unsecured credit we may extend to a private counterparty or to a group of affiliated counterparties. This limit is based on a percentage of eligible regulatory capital and the counterparty's long-term NRSRO credit rating. Under these regulations, (i) the level of eligible regulatory capital is determined as the lesser of our total regulatory capital or the eligible amount of regulatory capital of the counterparty; (ii) the eligible amount of regulatory capital is then multiplied by a stated percentage; and (iii) the percentage that we may offer for term extensions of unsecured credit ranges from 1% to 15% based on the counterparty's NRSRO credit rating. The calculation of term extensions of unsecured credit includes on-balance sheet transactions, off-balance sheet commitments and derivative transactions.

The Finance Agency regulation also permits us to extend additional unsecured credit for overnight and term federal funds sold up to a total unsecured exposure to a single counterparty of 2% to 30% of the eligible amount of regulatory capital, based on the counterparty's credit rating.

Additionally, we are prohibited by Finance Agency regulation from investing in financial instruments issued by non-United States entities other than those issued by United States branches and agency offices of foreign commercial banks. Our unsecured credit exposures to United States branches and agency offices of foreign commercial banks include the risk that, as a result of political or economic conditions in a country, the counterparty may be unable to meet its contractual repayment obligations. During the year ended December 31, 2017, our unsecured investment credit exposure to United States branches and agency offices of foreign commercial banks was limited to federal funds sold. Our unsecured credit exposures to domestic counterparties and United States subsidiaries of foreign commercial banks include the risk that these counterparties have extended credit to foreign counterparties.

The following table presents the unsecured investment credit exposures to private counterparties, categorized by the domicile of the counterparty's ultimate parent, based on the lowest of the counterparty's NRSRO long-term credit ratings, stated in terms of the S&P equivalent. The table does not reflect the foreign sovereign government's credit rating ($ amounts in millions).
December 31, 2017
 
AA
 
A
 
Total
Domestic
 
$

 
$
1,160

 
$
1,160

Australia
 
780

 

 
780

Total unsecured credit exposure
 
$
780

 
$
1,160

 
$
1,940






Long-Term Investments. Our long-term investments include MBS guaranteed by the housing GSEs (Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac), other U.S. obligations - guaranteed MBS (Ginnie Mae), and debentures issued by Fannie Mae, Freddie Mac, the TVA and the Federal Farm Credit Banks.

Our long-term investments also include private-label RMBS and ABS, which are directly or indirectly secured by underlying mortgage loans. Investments in private-label RMBS and ABS may be purchased as long as the investments are rated with an S&P equivalent rating of AAA at the time of purchase. However, we are subject to credit risk on these investments. To mitigate that risk, each of the private-label RMBS and ABS contains one or more of the following forms of credit protection:

Subordination - represents the structure of classes of the security, where subordinated classes absorb any credit losses before senior classes;
Excess spread - the average coupon rate of the underlying mortgage loans in the pool is higher than the coupon rate on the MBS and the spread differential may be used to offset any losses that may be realized;
Over-collateralization - the total outstanding balance of the underlying mortgage loans in the pool is greater than the outstanding MBS balance and the excess collateral is available to offset any losses that may be realized; and
Insurance wrap - a third-party bond insurance company guarantees timely payment of principal and interest to certain classes of the security.

Our private-label RMBS and ABS are backed by collateral located only in the United States and the District of Columbia. The top five states, by percentage of collateral located in those states as of December 31, 2017, were California (65%), New York (7%), Florida (4%), Connecticut (3%), and Virginia (2%).

A Finance Agency regulation provides that the total amount of our investments in MBS and ABS, calculated using amortized historical cost, must not exceed 300% of our total regulatory capital, as of the day we purchase the securities, based on the capital amount most recently reported to the Finance Agency. These investments totaled 288% of total regulatory capital at December 31, 2017. Generally, our goal is to maintain these investments near the 300% limit in order to enhance earnings and capital for our members and diversify our revenue stream.





The following table presents the carrying values of our investments, excluding accrued interest, grouped by credit rating and investment category. Applicable rating levels are determined using the lowest relevant long-term rating from S&P, Moody's and Fitch Ratings, Inc., each stated in terms of the S&P equivalent. Rating modifiers are ignored when determining the applicable rating level for a given counterparty or investment. Amounts reported do not reflect any subsequent changes in ratings, outlook, or watch status ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Below
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investment
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
AAA
 
AA
 
A
 
BBB
 
Grade
 
Total 
Short-term investments:
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-bearing deposits
 
$

 
$

 
$
660

 
$

 
$

 
$
660

Securities purchased under agreements to resell
 

 
2,606

 

 

 

 
2,606

Federal funds sold
 

 
780

 
500

 

 

 
1,280

Total short-term investments
 

 
3,386

 
1,160

 

 

 
4,546

Long-term investments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
GSE and TVA debentures
 

 
4,404

 

 

 

 
4,404

GSE MBS
 

 
5,060

 

 

 

 
5,060

Other U.S. obligations - guaranteed RMBS
 

 
3,299

 

 

 

 
3,299

Private-label RMBS and ABS
 


4


16


2


242


264

Total long-term investments
 


12,767


16


2


242


13,027

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total investments, carrying value
 
$

 
$
16,153

 
$
1,176

 
$
2

 
$
242

 
$
17,573

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Percentage of total
 
%
 
92
%
 
7
%
 
%
 
1
%
 
100
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Short-term investments:
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-bearing deposits
 
$

 
$

 
$
150

 
$

 
$

 
$
150

Securities purchased under agreements to resell
 

 
1,781

 

 

 

 
1,781

Federal funds sold
 

 
660

 
990

 

 

 
1,650

Total short-term investments
 

 
2,441

 
1,140

 

 

 
3,581

Long-term investments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
GSE and TVA debentures
 

 
4,715

 

 

 

 
4,715

GSE MBS
 

 
4,158

 

 

 

 
4,158

Other U.S. obligations - guaranteed RMBS
 

 
2,679

 

 

 

 
2,679

Private-label RMBS and ABS
 


7


19


5


297


328

Total long-term investments
 


11,559


19


5


297


11,880

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total investments, carrying value
 
$

 
$
14,000

 
$
1,159

 
$
5

 
$
297

 
$
15,461

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Percentage of total
 
%
 
91
%
 
7
%
 
%
 
2
%
 
100
%

Private-label RMBS and ABS. Private-label RMBS and ABS are classified as prime, Alt-A or subprime based on the originator's classification at the time of origination or based on classification by an NRSRO upon issuance. Because there is no universally accepted definition of prime, Alt-A or subprime underwriting standards, such classifications are subjective. All private-label RMBS and ABS were rated with an S&P equivalent rating of AAA at the date of purchase.





Mortgage Loans Held for Portfolio.

MPP. We are exposed to credit risk on the loans purchased from our PFIs through the MPP. Each loan we purchase must meet the guidelines for our MPP or be specifically approved as an exception based on compensating factors. For example, the maximum LTV ratio for any conventional mortgage loan purchased is 95%, and the borrowers must meet certain minimum credit scores depending upon the type of loan or property.
 
Credit Enhancements. Credit enhancements for conventional loans include (in order of priority):

PMI (when applicable);
LRA; and
SMI (as applicable) purchased by the seller from a third-party provider naming us as the beneficiary.
        
PMI. For a conventional loan, PMI, if applicable, covers losses or exposure down to approximately an LTV ratio between 65% and 80% based upon the original appraisal, original LTV ratio, term, and amount of PMI coverage. As of December 31, 2017, we had PMI coverage on $1.6 billion or 17% of our conventional MPP mortgage loans, which included coverage of $1.2 million on seriously delinquent loans, i.e., 90 days or more past due or in the process of foreclosure,
of $3.9 million.

LRA. We use either a "spread LRA" or a "fixed LRA" for credit enhancement. The spread LRA was used in combination with SMI for credit enhancement of conventional mortgage loans purchased under our original MPP, and the fixed LRA is used for credit enhancement of conventional mortgage loans purchased under MPP Advantage. At this time, substantially all of the additions are from MPP Advantage, and substantially all of the claims paid and distributions are from the original MPP.

The following table presents the changes in the LRA for original MPP and MPP Advantage ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
2017
 
2016
LRA Activity
 
Original
 
Advantage
 
Total
 
Original
 
Advantage
 
Total
Liability, beginning of year
 
$
8

 
$
118

 
$
126

 
$
9

 
$
83

 
$
92

Additions
 
1

 
24

 
25

 
1

 
35

 
36

Claims paid
 
(1
)
 

 
(1
)
 
(1
)
 

 
(1
)
Distributions to PFIs
 
(1
)
 

 
(1
)
 
(1
)
 

 
(1
)
Liability, end of year
 
$
7

 
$
142

 
$
149

 
$
8

 
$
118

 
$
126

    
SMI. Losses that exceed available LRA funds are covered by SMI (for original MPP loans) up to a severity of approximately 50% of the original property value of the loan, depending on the SMI contract terms. We absorb any losses in excess of available LRA funds and SMI.

Our current SMI providers are Mortgage Guaranty Insurance Corporation and Genworth Mortgage Insurance Corporation. For pools of loans acquired under the original MPP, we entered into the insurance contracts directly with the SMI providers, including a contract for each pool or aggregate pool. Pursuant to Finance Agency regulation, the PFI must be responsible for all expected credit losses on the mortgages sold to us. Therefore, the PFI was the purchaser of the SMI policy, and we are designated as the beneficiary. The premiums are the PFI's obligation. As an administrative convenience, we collect the SMI premiums from the monthly mortgage remittances received from the PFIs or their designated servicer and remit them to the SMI provider.
    
Credit Risk Exposure to SMI Providers. As of December 31, 2017, we were the beneficiary of SMI coverage, under our original MPP, on conventional mortgage pools with a total UPB of $851 million.

We evaluate the recoverability related to PMI and SMI for mortgage loans that we hold, including insurance companies placed under enhanced supervision of state regulators. We also evaluate the recoverability of outstanding receivables from our PMI and SMI providers related to outstanding and unpaid claims.





The following table presents the lowest credit rating from S&P, Moody's and Fitch Ratings, Inc., stated in terms of the S&P equivalent, for our SMI companies and the estimated SMI exposure as of December 31, 2017 ($ amounts in millions).
Mortgage Insurance Company
 
Credit Rating
 
SMI Exposure
Mortgage Guaranty Insurance Corporation
 
BBB
 
$
2

Genworth Mortgage Insurance Corporation
 
BB+
 
1

Total
 
 
 
$
3


See Notes to Financial Statements - Note 9 - Allowance for Credit Losses for our estimates of recovery associated with the expected amount of our claims for all providers of these policies in determining our allowance for loan losses.    

MPF Program. Credit risk arising from AMA activities under our participation in mortgage loans originated under the MPF Program falls into three categories: (i) the risk of credit losses arising from our FLA and last loss positions; (ii) the risk that a PFI will not perform as promised with respect to its loss position provided through its CE Obligations on mortgage loan pools; and (iii) the risk that a third-party insurer (obligated under PMI arrangements) will fail to perform as expected. Should a PMI third-party insurer fail to perform, our credit risk exposure would increase because our FLA is the next layer to absorb credit losses on mortgage loan pools.

Credit Enhancements. Our management of credit risk in the MPF Program considers the several layers of loss protection that are defined in agreements among the FHLBank of Topeka and its PFIs. The availability of loss protection may differ slightly among MPF products. Our loss protection consists of the following loss layers, in order of priority:

(i) Borrower equity;
(ii) PMI (when applicable);
(iii) FLA, which functions as a tracking mechanism for determining our potential loss exposure under each pool prior to the PFI’s CE Obligation; and
(iv) CE Obligation, which absorbs losses in excess of the FLA in order to limit our loss exposure to that of an investor in an MBS deemed to be investment-grade.

PMI. For a conventional loan, PMI, if applicable, covers losses or exposure down to approximately an LTV ratio between 65% and 80% based upon the original appraisal, original LTV ratio, term, and amount of PMI coverage. As of December 31, 2017, we had PMI coverage on $28 million or 11% of our conventional MPF Program mortgage loans. 
    
FLA and CE Obligation. If losses occur in a pool, these losses will either be: (i) recovered through the withholding of future performance-based CE fees from the PFI or (ii) absorbed by us in the FLA. As of December 31, 2017, our exposure under the FLA was $4 million, and CE obligations available to cover losses in excess of the FLA were $2 million. PFIs must fully collateralize their CE Obligation with assets considered acceptable by the FHLBank of Topeka.

MPP and MPF Program Loan Characteristics. Two indicators of credit quality are LTV ratios and credit scores provided by FICO®. FICO® provides a commonly used measure to assess a borrower’s credit quality, with scores ranging from a low of 300 to a high of 850. The combination of a lower FICO® score and a higher LTV ratio is a key driver of potential mortgage delinquencies and defaults.





The following tables present these two characteristics of our MPP and MPF Program conventional loan portfolios as a percentage of the UPB outstanding ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
% of UPB Outstanding
FICO® SCORE (1)
 
UPB
 
Current
 
Past Due 30-59 Days
 
Past Due 60-89 Days
 
Past Due 90 Days or More
619 or less
 
$
3

 
76.6
%
 
16.1
%
 
3.0
%
 
4.3
%
620-659
 
78

 
89.0
%
 
5.1
%
 
1.8
%
 
4.1
%
660-699
 
673

 
96.6
%
 
2.1
%
 
0.4
%
 
0.9
%
700-739
 
1,883

 
98.6
%
 
0.9
%
 
0.2
%
 
0.3
%
740 or higher
 
7,064

 
99.5
%
 
0.4
%
 
0.0
%
 
0.1
%
Total
 
$
9,701

 
99.0
%
 
0.7
%
 
0.1
%
 
0.2
%

For borrowers in our conventional loan portfolio at December 31, 2017, 99% of the borrowers had FICO® scores greater than 660 at origination and the weighted average FICO® Score at origination was 761.

LTV Ratio (2)
 
December 31, 2017
< = 60%
 
16
%
> 60% to 70%
 
15
%
> 70% to 80%
 
53
%
> 80% to 90% (3)
 
11
%
> 90% (3)
 
5
%
Total
 
100
%

(1) 
Represents the FICO® score at origination of the lowest scoring borrower for the related loan.
(2) 
At origination.
(3) 
These conventional loans were required to have PMI at origination.

For borrowers in our conventional loan portfolio at December 31, 2017, 84% of the borrowers had an LTV ratio of 80% or lower at origination and the weighted average LTV ratio at origination was 73%.

We believe these two measures indicate that these loans have a low risk of default.

We do not knowingly purchase any loan that violates the terms of our Anti-Predatory Lending Policy. In addition, we require our members to warrant to us that all of the loans pledged or sold to us are in compliance with all applicable laws, including prohibitions on anti-predatory lending.

MPP and MPF Program Loan Concentration. The following table presents the percentage of UPB of MPP and MPF Program conventional loans outstanding at December 31, 2017 for the five largest state concentrations, with comparable percentages at December 31, 2016
By State
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Indiana
 
31
%
 
31
%
Michigan
 
31
%
 
29
%
California
 
13
%
 
14
%
Virginia
 
3
%
 
3
%
Colorado
 
2
%
 
3
%
All others
 
20
%
 
20
%
Total
 
100
%
 
100
%

The mortgage loans in our MPP and MPF Program portfolios are dispersed across 50 states and the District of Columbia. The median original size of each mortgage loan was approximately $156 thousand and $150 thousand at December 31, 2017 and 2016, respectively. 





MPP and MPF Program Credit Performance. The UPB of our MPP and MPF Program conventional and FHA loans 90 days or more past due and accruing interest, non-accrual loans and TDRs, along with the allowance for loan losses, are presented in the table below ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
As of and for the Years Ended December 31,
 
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
2013
Past Due, Non-Accrual and Restructured Loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Past due 90 days or more and still accruing interest
 
$
19

 
$
27

 
$
34

 
$
50

 
$
80

Non-accrual loans (1) (2)
 
3

 
5

 
9

 
7

 
1

TDRs (3)
 
14

 
14

 
15

 
14

 
17

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for Loan Losses on Mortgage Loans (4)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for loan losses, beginning of the year
 
$
1

 
$
1

 
$
3

 
$
5

 
$
10

Charge-offs
 

 

 
(1
)
 
(1
)
 
(1
)
Provision for (reversal of) loan losses
 

 

 
(1
)
 
(1
)
 
(4
)
Allowance for loan losses, end of the year
 
$
1

 
$
1

 
$
1

 
$
3

 
$
5


(1) 
Non-accrual loans are defined as conventional mortgage loans where either (i) the collection of interest or principal is doubtful, or (ii) interest or principal is past due for 90 days or more, except when the loan is well secured and in the process of collection (e.g., through credit enhancements and monthly servicer remittances on a scheduled/scheduled basis).
(2) 
The interest income shortfall on non-accrual loans was less than $1 million for the years ended December 31, 2017, 2016, 2015, 2014, and 2013.
(3) 
Represents TDRs that are still performing. TDRs related to mortgage loans are considered to have occurred when a concession is granted to the debtor related to the debtor's financial difficulties that would not otherwise be considered for economic or legal reasons. We do not participate in government-sponsored loan modification programs. See Notes to Financial Statements - Note 1 - Summary of Significant Accounting Policies and Note 9 - Allowance for Credit Losses for more information on modifications and TDRs.
(4) 
Our allowance for loan losses also included $2 million, $3 million, $5 million, $6 million, and $14 million of principal previously paid in full by the servicers that remained subject to potential claims by those servicers for any losses resulting from past or future liquidations of the underlying properties at December 31, 2017, 2016, 2015, 2014, and 2013, respectively.

The serious delinquency rate for government-guaranteed or -insured mortgages was 0.59% and 0.46% at December 31, 2017 and 2016, respectively. We rely on insurance provided by the FHA, which generally provides coverage for 100% of the principal balance of the underlying mortgage loan and defaulted interest at the debenture rate. However, we would receive defaulted interest at the contractual rate from the servicer. The serious delinquency rate for conventional mortgages was 0.20% at December 31, 2017, compared to 0.32% at December 31, 2016. Both rates were below the national serious delinquency rate.
 
Although we establish credit enhancements in each mortgage pool purchased under our original MPP at the time of the pool's origination that are sufficient to absorb loan losses up to approximately 50% of the property's original value (subject, in certain cases, to an aggregate stop-loss provision in the SMI policy), the magnitude of the declines in home prices and increases in the time to complete foreclosures in past years resulted in losses in some of the mortgage pools that have exhausted the LRA; however, credit enhancement support is still available through the SMI coverage. Some of our mortgage pools have loans originated in states and localities (e.g., Florida, Illinois, Pennsylvania, New Jersey and New York) that have had the most lengthy foreclosure processes. We purchased most of these loan pools from institutions that are no longer members of our Bank and, thus, have stopped selling mortgage loans to us. When a mortgage pool's credit enhancements are exhausted, we will incur any additional loan losses in that pool.

Overall, the trends in the credit performance of our mortgage loans held for portfolio over the last five years have been positive.




Derivatives. The Dodd-Frank Act provides statutory and regulatory requirements for derivatives transactions, including those we use to hedge our interest rate and other risks. Since June 2013, we have been required to clear certain interest-rate swaps that fall within the scope of the first mandatory clearing determination. Beginning in February 2014, certain derivatives designated by the CFTC as "made available to trade" were required to be executed on a swap execution facility.

Our over-the-counter derivative transactions are either (i) held with a counterparty (uncleared derivatives) or (ii) cleared through a Futures Commission Merchant (i.e., clearing agent) with a clearinghouse (cleared derivatives).
Uncleared Derivatives. We are subject to credit risk due to the potential non-performance by the counterparties to our uncleared derivative transactions. We require collateral agreements with our uncleared derivative counterparties. The exposure thresholds above which collateral must be delivered vary; the threshold is zero in some cases.
Cleared Derivatives. We are subject to credit risk due to the potential non-performance by the clearinghouse and clearing agent because we are required to post initial and variation margin through the clearing agent, on behalf of the clearinghouse, which exposes us to institutional credit risk if either the clearing agent or the clearinghouse fails to meet its obligations. Collateral is required to be posted daily for changes in the value of cleared derivatives to mitigate each counterparty's credit risk. In addition, all derivative transactions are subject to mandatory reporting and record-keeping requirements.
The contractual or notional amount of derivative transactions reflects the extent of our participation in the various classes of financial instruments. Our credit risk with respect to derivative transactions is the estimated cost of replacing the derivative positions if there is a default, minus the value of any related collateral. In determining credit risk, we consider accrued interest receivables and payables as well as the requirements to net assets and liabilities. See Notes to Financial Statements - Note 11 - Derivatives and Hedging Activities for more information.

The following table presents key information on derivative counterparties on a settlement date basis using the lowest credit ratings from S&P or Moody's, stated in terms of the S&P equivalent ($ amounts in millions).
December 31, 2017
 
Notional
Amount
 
Net Estimated
Fair Value
Before Collateral
 
Cash Collateral
Pledged To (From)
Counterparty (1)
 
Net Credit
Exposure
Non-member counterparties:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Asset positions with credit exposure
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Uncleared derivatives - AA
 
$
2,789

 
$
16

 
$
(12
)
 
$
4

Uncleared derivatives - A
 
164

 
1

 

 
1

Cleared derivatives (2)
 
19,173

 
132

 
(9
)
 
123

Total derivative positions with credit exposure to non-member counterparties
 
22,126

 
149

 
(21
)
 
128

Total derivative positions with credit exposure to member institutions (3)
 
39

 

 

 

Subtotal - derivative positions with credit exposure
 
22,165

 
$
149

 
$
(21
)
 
$
128

Derivative positions without credit exposure
 
10,335

 

 

 
 
Total derivative positions
 
$
32,500

 
 
 
 
 
 

(1) 
Includes variation margin for daily settled contracts of $25 million at December 31, 2017.
(2) 
Represents derivative transactions cleared with a clearinghouse, which is not rated.
(3) 
Includes MDCs from member institutions (MPP).

AHP. Our AHP requires members and project sponsors to make commitments with respect to the usage of the AHP grants to assist very low-, low-, and moderate-income families, as defined by regulation. If these commitments are not met, we may have an obligation to recapture these funds from the member or project sponsor to replenish the AHP fund. This credit exposure is addressed in part by evaluating project feasibility at the time of an award and the member’s ongoing monitoring of AHP projects.





Liquidity Risk Management. The primary objectives of liquidity risk management are to maintain the ability to meet obligations as they come due and to meet the credit needs of our member borrowers in a timely and cost-efficient manner. We routinely monitor the sources of cash available to meet liquidity needs and use various tests and guidelines to manage our liquidity risk.

Daily projections of required liquidity are prepared to help us maintain adequate funding for our operations. Operational liquidity levels are determined assuming sources of cash from both the FHLBank System's ongoing access to the capital markets and our holding of liquid assets to meet operational requirements in the normal course of business. Contingent liquidity levels are determined based upon the assumption of an inability to readily access the capital markets for a period of five business days. These analyses include projections of cash flows and funding needs, targeted funding terms, and various funding alternatives for achieving those terms. A contingency plan allows us to maintain sufficient liquidity in the event of operational disruptions at our Bank, at the Office of Finance, or in the capital markets.

Operational Risk Management. Operational risk is the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, people, and systems, or from external events. Our management has established policies, procedures, and controls and acquired insurance coverage to mitigate operational risk. Our Internal Audit department, which reports directly to the Audit Committee of the board of directors, regularly monitors our adherence to established policies, procedures, applicable regulatory requirements and best practices.

Our enterprise risk management function and business units complete a comprehensive annual risk and control assessment that serves to reinforce our focus on maintaining strong internal controls by identifying significant inherent risks and the mitigating internal controls in order for the residual risks to be assessed and the appropriate strategy designed to accept, transfer, avoid or mitigate such risks. The risk assessment process provides management and the board of directors with a detailed and transparent view of our identified risks and related internal control structure.

We use various financial models to quantify financial risks and analyze potential strategies. We maintain a model risk management program that includes a validation program intended to mitigate the risk of loss resulting from model errors or the incorrect use or application of model output, which could potentially lead to inappropriate business or operational decisions.

Our operations rely on the secure processing, storage and transmission of confidential and other information in our computer systems, software and networks. As a result, our Cyber Risk Management Program is designed to protect our information assets, information systems and sensitive data from internal, external, vendor and third party cyber risks, including due diligence, risk assessments, and ongoing monitoring of critical vendors by our Vendor Management Office. The Cyber Risk Management Program includes processes for monitoring existing, emerging and imminent threats as well as cyber attacks impacting our industry in order to develop appropriate risk management strategies. Protective security controls, detective controls, and responsive controls are in place for critical infrastructure, systems and services. Periodically, we engage external third parties to assess our Cyber Risk Management Program and perform testing to validate the effectiveness of the program.

In order to ensure our ongoing ability to provide liquidity and service to our members, we have business continuity plans designed to restore critical business processes and systems in the event of a business interruption. We operate both a business resumption center and a disaster recovery data center, at separate locations, with the objective of being able to fully recover all critical activities in a timely manner. Both facilities are subject to periodic testing to demonstrate the Bank can recover operations in the event of a disaster. We also have a back-up agreement in place with the FHLBank of Cincinnati in the event the Bank's primary and back-up facilities are inoperable.

We have insurance coverage for cybersecurity, employee fraud, forgery and wrongdoing, as well as Directors' and Officers' liability coverage that provides protection for claims alleging breach of duty, misappropriation of funds, neglect, acts of omission, employment practices, and fiduciary liability. We also have property, casualty, computer equipment, automobile, and other various types of insurance coverage.

Business Risk Management. Business risk is the risk of an adverse impact on profitability resulting from external factors that may occur in both the short and long term. Business risk includes political, strategic, reputation and/or regulatory events that are beyond our control. Our board of directors and management seek to mitigate these risks by, among other actions, maintaining an open and constructive dialogue with regulators, providing input on potential legislation, conducting long-term strategic planning and continually monitoring general economic conditions and the external environment.





ITEM 7A. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

As used in this Item, unless the context otherwise requires, the terms "Bank," "we," "us," and "our" refer to the Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolis or its management. We use acronyms and terms throughout this Item that are defined herein or in the Glossary of Terms.

Market risk is the risk that the market value or estimated fair value of our overall portfolio of assets and liabilities, including derivatives, or our net earnings will decline as a result of changes in interest rates or financial market volatility. Market risk includes the risks related to:

movements in interest rates over time;
changes in mortgage prepayment speeds over time;
advance prepayments;
actual and implied interest-rate volatility;
the change in the relationship between short-term and long-term interest rates (i.e., the slope of the consolidated obligation and LIBOR yield curves);
the change in the relationship of FHLBank System debt spreads to relevant indices, primarily LIBOR (commonly referred to as "basis" risk); and
the change in the relationship between fixed rates and variable rates.

The goal of market risk management is to preserve our financial strength at all times, including during periods of significant market volatility and across a wide range of possible interest-rate scenarios. We regularly assess our exposure to changes in interest rates using a diverse set of analyses and measures. As appropriate, we may rebalance our portfolio to help attain our risk management objectives.

Our general approach toward managing interest-rate risk is to acquire and maintain a portfolio of assets and liabilities that, together with their associated hedges, limit our expected interest-rate sensitivity to within our specified tolerances. Derivative financial instruments, primarily interest-rate swaps, are frequently employed to hedge the interest-rate risk and/or embedded option risk on advances, debt, GSE debentures and agency MBS held as investments.

The prepayment option on an advance can create interest-rate risk. If a member prepays an advance, we could suffer lower future income if the principal portion of the prepaid advance is reinvested in lower yielding assets that continue to be funded by higher cost debt. To protect against this risk, we charge a prepayment fee, thereby substantially reducing market risk. See Item 7. Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Analysis of Financial Condition - Total Assets - Advances for more information on prepayment fees and their impact on our financial results.

We have significant investments in mortgage loans and MBS. The prepayment options embedded in mortgages can result in extensions or contractions in the expected weighted average life of these investments, depending on changes in interest rates and other economic factors. We primarily manage the interest-rate and prepayment risk associated with mortgages through debt issuance, which includes both callable and non-callable debt, to achieve cash-flow patterns and liability durations similar to those expected on the mortgage portfolios. Due to the use of call options and lockouts, and by selecting appropriate maturity sectors, callable debt provides an element of protection for the prepayment risk in the mortgage portfolios. The duration of callable debt, like that of a mortgage, shortens when interest rates decrease and lengthens when interest rates increase.

Significant resources, including analytical computer models and an experienced professional staff, are devoted to assuring that the level of interest-rate risk in the balance sheet is properly measured, thus allowing us to monitor the risk against policy and regulatory limits. We use asset and liability models to calculate market values under alternative interest-rate scenarios. The models analyze our financial instruments, including derivatives, using broadly accepted algorithms with consistent and appropriate behavioral assumptions, market prices, market data (such as rates, volatility, etc.) and current position data. On at least an annual basis, we review the major assumptions and methodologies used in the models, including discounting curves, spreads for discounting, and prepayment assumptions.





Types of Key Market Risks

Our market risk results from various factors, such as:

Interest Rates - parallel and non-parallel shifts in the yield curve;
Basis Risk - the risk that changes to one interest-rate index will not perfectly offset changes to another interest-rate index;
Volatility - varying values of assets or liabilities with embedded options, such as mortgages and callable bonds, created by the changing expectations of the magnitude or frequency of changes in interest rates;
Option-Adjusted Spread - an estimate of the incremental yield spread between a particular financial instrument (i.e., an advance, investment or derivative contract) and a benchmark yield (e,g,, LIBOR). This includes consideration of potential variability in the instrument's cash flows resulting from any options embedded in the instrument, such as prepayment options; and
Prepayment Speeds - expected levels of principal payments on mortgage loans held in a portfolio or supporting an MBS, variations from which alter their cash flows, yields, and values, particularly in cases where the loans or MBS are acquired at a premium or discount.

Measuring Market Risks
 
To evaluate market risk, we utilize multiple risk measurements, including duration of equity, duration gap, convexity, VaR, earnings at risk, and changes in MVE. Periodically, we conduct stress tests to measure and analyze the effects that extreme movements in the level of interest rates and the shape of the yield curve would have on our risk position.

Market Risk-Based Capital Requirement. We are subject to the Finance Agency's risk-based capital regulations. This regulatory framework requires the maintenance of sufficient permanent capital to meet the combined credit risk, market risk, and operations risk components. The market risk-based capital component is the sum of two factors. The first factor is the market value of the portfolio at risk from movements in interest rates that could occur during times of market stress. This estimation is accomplished through an internal VaR-based modeling approach that was approved by the Finance Board before the implementation of our capital plan. The second factor is the amount, if any, by which the current market value of total regulatory capital is less than 85% of the book value of total regulatory capital.

The VaR approach used for calculating the first factor is primarily based upon historical simulation methodology. The estimation incorporates scenarios that reflect interest-rate shifts, interest-rate volatility, and changes in the shape of the yield curve. These observations are based on historical information from 1978 to the present. When calculating the risk-based capital requirement, the VaR comprising the first factor of the market risk component is defined as the potential dollar loss from adverse market movements, for a holding period of 120 business days, with a 99% confidence interval, based on those historical prices and market rates. The table below presents the VaR ($ amounts in millions).
Years Ended
 
VaR
 
High
 
Low
 
Average
December 31, 2017
 
$
336

 
$
336

 
$
227

 
$
275

December 31, 2016
 
239

 
239

 
110

 
150


Duration of Equity. Duration of equity is a measure of interest-rate risk and is a primary metric used to manage our market risk exposure. It is an estimate of the percentage change in our MVE that could be caused by a 100 bps parallel upward or downward shift in the interest-rate curves. We value our portfolios using the LIBOR curve, the OIS curve, the consolidated obligation curve or external prices. The market value and interest-rate sensitivity of each asset, liability, and off-balance sheet position is determined to compute our duration of equity. We calculate duration of equity using the interest-rate curve as of the date of calculation and for scenarios for which the interest-rate curve is 200 bps higher or lower than the base level. Our board of directors determines acceptable ranges for duration of equity. A negative duration of equity suggests adverse exposure to falling rates and a favorable response to rising rates, while a positive duration suggests adverse exposure to rising rates and a favorable response to falling rates.

As part of our overall interest-rate risk management process, we continue to evaluate strategies to manage interest-rate risk. Certain strategies, if implemented, could have an adverse impact on future earnings.





Certain Market and Interest-Rate Risk Metrics under Potential Interest-Rate Scenarios. We also monitor the sensitivities of MVE and duration of equity to potential interest-rate scenarios. We measure potential changes in the market value to book value of equity based on the current month-end level of rates versus large parallel rate shifts. This measurement provides information related to the sensitivity of our interest-rate position. The following table presents certain market and interest-rate metrics under different interest-rate scenarios ($ amounts in millions).
December 31, 2017
 
Down 200 (1)
 
Down 100 (1)
 
Base
 
Up 100
 
Up 200
MVE
 
$
3,302

 
$
3,200

 
$
3,096

 
$
3,001

 
$
2,895

Percent change in MVE from base
 
6.7
%
 
3.4
%
 
0
%
 
(3.1
)%
 
(6.5
)%
MVE/book value of equity (2)
 
106.2
%
 
102.9
%
 
99.5
%
 
96.5
 %
 
93.1
 %
Duration of equity (3)
 
2.3
 
3.7
 
2.9
 
3.4
 
3.7
December 31, 2016
 
Down 200 (1)
 
Down 100 (1)
 
Base
 
Up 100
 
Up 200
MVE
 
$
2,545

 
$
2,634

 
$
2,604

 
$
2,546

 
$
2,467

Percent change in MVE from base
 
(2.3
)%
 
1.1
%
 
0
%
 
(2.2
)%
 
(5.3
)%
MVE/book value of equity (2)
 
97.7
 %
 
101.1
%
 
99.9
%
 
97.7
 %
 
94.7
 %
Duration of equity (3)
 
(5.3)
 
(0.1)
 
1.7
 
2.8
 
3.4

(1)  
Given the current low interest-rate environment, we adjusted the downward rate shocks to prevent the assumed interest rate from becoming negative.
(2) 
The change in the base MVE/book value of equity from December 31, 2016 resulted primarily from the change in market value of the assets and liabilities in response to changes in the market environment and changes in portfolio composition. The changes in the MVE sensitivity from December 31, 2016 was primarily due to an update of the vendor prepayment model used in market risk modeling.
(3) 
We use interest-rate shocks in 50 bps increments to determine duration of equity.

Convexity. Convexity measures the rate of change of duration as a function of interest-rate changes. Measurement of convexity is important because of the optionality embedded in the mortgage assets and callable debt liabilities. The mortgage assets exhibit negative convexity due to embedded prepayment options. Callable debt liabilities exhibit positive convexity due to embedded options that we can exercise to redeem the debt prior to maturity. Management routinely reviews the net convexity exposure and considers it when developing funding and hedging strategies for the acquisition of mortgage-based assets. A primary strategy for managing convexity risk arising from our mortgage portfolio is the issuance of callable debt. The negative convexity of the mortgage assets tends to be partially offset by the positive convexity contributed by underlying callable debt liabilities.

Duration Gap. A related measure of interest-rate risk is duration gap, which is the difference between the estimated durations (market value sensitivity) of assets and liabilities. Duration gap measures the sensitivity of assets and liabilities to interest-rate changes. Duration generally indicates the expected change in an instrument's market value resulting from an increase or a decrease in interest rates. Higher duration numbers, whether positive or negative, indicate greater volatility of market value in response to changing interest rates. The base case duration gap was 0.10% at December 31, 2017, compared to 0.03% at December 31, 2016.





Use of Derivative Hedges
 
We use derivatives to hedge our market risk exposures. The primary types of derivatives used are interest-rate swaps and caps. Interest-rate swaps and caps increase the flexibility of our funding alternatives by providing specific cash flows or characteristics that might not be as readily available or cost effective if obtained in the cash debt market. We do not speculate using derivatives and do not engage in derivatives trading. 

Hedging Debt Issuance. When CO bonds are issued, we often use the derivatives market to create funding that is more attractively priced than the funding available in the consolidated obligations market. To reduce funding costs, we may enter into interest-rate swaps concurrently with the issuance of consolidated obligations. A typical hedge of this type occurs when a CO bond is issued, while we simultaneously execute a matching interest rate swap. The counterparty pays a rate on the swap to us, which is designed to mirror the interest rate we pay on the CO bond. In this transaction we typically pay a variable interest rate, generally LIBOR, which closely matches the interest payments we receive on short-term or variable-rate advances or investments. This intermediation between the capital and swap markets permits the acquisition of funds by us at lower all-in costs than would otherwise be available through the issuance of simple fixed- or floating-rate consolidated obligations in the capital markets. The continued attractiveness of such debt depends on yield relationships between the debt and derivative markets. If conditions in these markets change, we may alter the types or terms of the CO bonds that we issue. Occasionally, interest rate swaps are executed to hedge discount notes.

Hedging Advances. Interest-rate swaps are also used to increase the flexibility of advance offerings by effectively converting the specific cash flows or characteristics that the borrower prefers into cash flows or characteristics that may be more readily or cost effectively funded in the debt markets.

Hedging Mortgage Loans. We use agency TBAs to hedge MDC positions. 

Hedging Investments. Some interest-rate swaps are executed to hedge investments. In addition, interest-rate caps are purchased to reduce the risk inherent in floating-rate instruments that include caps as part of the structure.

Other Hedges. We occasionally use derivatives, such as swaptions, to maintain our risk profile within the approved risk limits set forth in our Enterprise Risk Management Policy. On an infrequent basis, we may act as an intermediary between certain smaller member institutions and the capital markets by executing interest-rate swaps with members.





The volume of derivative hedges is often expressed in terms of notional amount, which is the amount upon which interest payments are calculated. The following table highlights the notional amounts by type of hedged item, hedging instrument, and hedging objective ($ amounts in millions).
Hedged Item/Hedging Instrument
 
Hedging Objective
 
Hedge Accounting Designation
 
December 31,
2017
 
December 31,
2016
Advances:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Pay fixed, receive floating interest-rate swap (without options)
 
Converts the advance’s fixed rate to a variable-rate index.
 
Fair-value
 
$
9,335

 
$
8,273

 
 
Economic
 
29

 
128

Pay fixed, receive floating interest-rate swap (with options)
 
Converts the advance’s fixed rate to a variable-rate index and offsets option risk in the advance.
 
Fair-value
 
1,880

 
976

Pay floating with embedded features, receive floating interest-rate swap (non-callable)
 
Reduces interest-rate sensitivity and repricing gaps by converting the advance’s variable rate to a different variable-rate index and/or offsets embedded option risk in the advance.
 
Fair-value
 
2

 
5

Pay floating with embedded features, receive floating interest-rate swap (callable)
 
Reduces interest-rate sensitivity and repricing gaps by converting the advance’s variable rate to a different variable-rate index and/or offsets embedded option risk in the advance.
 
Fair-value
 
50

 

Sub-total advances
 
 
 
 
 
11,296


9,382

Investments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Pay fixed, receive floating interest-rate swap
 
Converts the investment’s fixed rate to a variable-rate index.
 
Fair-value
 
4,464

 
4,762

Pay fixed, receive floating interest-rate swap (with options)
 
Converts the investment's fixed rate to a variable-rate index and offsets option risk in the investment.
 
Fair-value
 
2,528

 
1,117

Interest-rate cap
 
Offsets the interest-rate cap embedded in a variable-rate investment.
 
Economic
 
246

 
365

Sub-total investments
 
 
 
 
 
7,238


6,244

Mortgage loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-rate swaption
 
Provides the option to enter into an interest-rate swap to offset interest-rate or prepayment risk in a pooled mortgage portfolio hedge.
 
Economic
 

 
350

Forward settlement agreement
 
Protects against changes in market value of fixed-rate MDCs resulting from changes in interest rates.
 
Economic
 
73

 
99

Sub-total mortgage loans
 
 
 
 
 
73


449

CO bonds:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Receive fixed, pay floating interest-rate swap (without options)
 
Converts the bond’s fixed rate to a variable-rate index.
 
Fair-value
 
6,916

 
6,030

 
Economic
 
100

 

Receive fixed or structured, pay floating interest-rate swap (with options)
 
Converts the bond’s fixed rate to a variable-rate index and offsets option risk in the bond.
 
Fair-value
 
5,908

 
2,815

Receive float with embedded features, pay floating interest rate swap (non-callable)
 
Reduces interest-rate sensitivity and repricing gaps by converting the bond's variable rate to a different variable-rate index and/or offsets embedded option risk in the bond.
 
Fair-value
 

 
20

Receive-float, pay-float basis swap
 
Reduces interest-rate sensitivity and repricing gaps by converting the bond’s variable rate to a different variable-rate index.
 
Economic
 
600

 

Sub-total CO bonds
 
 
 
 
 
13,524


8,865

Discount notes:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Receive fixed, pay floating interest-rate swap
 
Converts the discount note’s fixed rate to a variable-rate index.
 
Economic
 
298

 
773

Sub-total discount notes
 
 
 
 
 
298


773

Stand-alone derivatives:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
MDCs
 
Protects against fair value risk associated with fixed-rate mortgage purchase commitments.
 
Economic
 
71


99

Sub-total stand-alone derivatives
 
 
 
 
 
71

 
99

Total notional
 
 
 
 
 
$
32,500

 
$
25,812





Complex swaps include, but are not limited to, step-up bonds. The level of different types of derivatives is contingent upon and tends to vary with our balance sheet size, our members' demand for advances, mortgage loan purchase activity, and consolidated obligation issuance levels.

Interest-Rate Swaps. The following table presents the amount swapped by interest-rate payment terms for AFS securities, advances, CO bonds, and discount notes ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016

Interest-Rate Payment Terms
 
Total Outstanding
 
Amount Swapped
 
% Swapped
 
Total Outstanding
 
Amount Swapped
 
% Swapped
AFS securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total fixed-rate
 
$
6,820

 
$
6,818

 
100
%
 
$
5,755

 
$
5,631

 
98
%
Total variable-rate
 
187

 

 
%
 
239

 

 
%
Total AFS securities, amortized cost
 
$
7,007

 
$
6,818

 
97
%
 
$
5,994

 
$
5,631

 
94
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Advances:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total fixed-rate
 
$
25,133

 
$
11,244

 
45
%
 
$
20,203

 
$
9,377

 
46
%
Total variable-rate
 
9,036

 
52

 
1
%
 
7,929

 
5

 
%
Total advances, par value
 
$
34,169

 
$
11,296

 
33
%
 
$
28,132

 
$
9,382

 
33
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
CO bonds:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total fixed-rate
 
$
25,033

 
$
12,924

 
52
%
 
$
19,583

 
$
8,845

 
45
%
Total variable-rate
 
12,950

 
600

 
5
%
 
13,925

 
20

 
%
Total CO bonds, par value
 
$
37,983

 
$
13,524

 
36
%
 
$
33,508

 
$
8,865

 
26
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Discount notes:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total fixed-rate
 
$
20,394

 
$
300

 
1
%
 
$
16,820

 
$
775

 
5
%
Total variable-rate
 

 

 
%
 

 

 
%
Total discount notes, par value
 
$
20,394

 
$
300

 
1
%
 
$
16,820

 
$
775

 
5
%

See Item 7. Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Risk Management - Credit Risk Management - Derivatives for information on credit risk related to derivatives.







 
Page
Item 8.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA
Number
 
 
 
 
Management's Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting
 
 
 
 
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
 
 
 
 
Statements of Condition as of December 31, 2017 and 2016
 
 
 
 
Statements of Income for the Years Ended December 31, 2017, 2016, and 2015
 
 
 
 
Statements of Comprehensive Income for the Years Ended December 31, 2017, 2016, and 2015
 
 
 
 
Statements of Capital for the Years Ended December 31, 2015, 2016, and 2017
 
 
 
 
Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended December 31, 2017, 2016, and 2015
 
 
 
 
Notes to Financial Statements:
 
 
Note 1 - Summary of Significant Accounting Policies
 
Note 2 - Recently Adopted and Issued Accounting Guidance
 
Note 3 - Cash and Due from Banks
 
Note 4 - Available-for-Sale Securities
 
Note 5 - Held-to-Maturity Securities
 
Note 6 - Other-Than-Temporary Impairment
 
Note 7 - Advances
 
Note 8 - Mortgage Loans Held for Portfolio
 
Note 9 - Allowance for Credit Losses
 
Note 10 - Premises, Software and Equipment
 
Note 11 - Derivatives and Hedging Activities
 
Note 12 - Deposits
 
Note 13 - Consolidated Obligations
 
Note 14 - Affordable Housing Program
 
Note 15 - Capital
 
Note 16 - Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)
 
Note 17 - Employee and Director Retirement and Deferred Compensation Plans
 
Note 18 - Segment Information
 
Note 19 - Estimated Fair Values
 
Note 20 - Commitments and Contingencies
 
Note 21 - Related Party and Other Transactions
 
 
 
 
Glossary of Terms




Management's Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting

Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over our financial reporting ("ICFR"), as defined in Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) of the Exchange Act. Our ICFR is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles and includes those policies and procedures that:
 
pertain to the maintenance of our records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect our transactions and asset dispositions; 
provide reasonable assurance that our transactions are recorded as necessary to permit the preparation of our financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that our receipts and expenditures are being made only in accordance with authorizations of our management and board of directors; and
provide reasonable assurance regarding the prevention or timely detection of any unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of our assets that could have a material effect on our financial statements.

Reasonable assurance, as defined in Section 13(b)(7) of the Exchange Act, is the level of detail and degree of assurance that would satisfy prudent officials in the conduct of their own affairs in devising and maintaining a system of internal accounting controls.

Because of its inherent limitations, ICFR may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

Under the supervision and with the participation of our management, including our principal executive officer, principal financial officer and principal accounting officer, we assessed the effectiveness of our ICFR as of December 31, 2017. Our assessment included extensive documentation, evaluation, and testing of the design and operating effectiveness of our ICFR. In making this assessment, our management used the criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. These criteria include the areas of control environment, risk assessment, control activities, information and communication, and monitoring. Based on our assessment using these criteria, our management concluded that we maintained effective ICFR as of December 31, 2017.




Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of the
Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolis

Opinions on the Financial Statements and Internal Control over Financial Reporting

We have audited the accompanying statements of condition of the Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolis (the "FHLBank") as of December 31, 2017 and 2016, and the related statements of income, comprehensive income, capital and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2017, including the related notes (collectively referred to as the "financial statements"). We also have audited the FHLBank's internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2017, based on criteria established in Internal Control —Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO).

In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the FHLBank as of December 31, 2017 and 2016, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2017 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Also in our opinion, the FHLBank maintained in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2017, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the COSO.

Basis for Opinions

The FHLBank's management is responsible for these financial statements, for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting, and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management's Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express opinions on the FHLBank's financial statements and on the FHLBank's internal control over financial reporting based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) ("PCAOB") and are required to be independent with respect to the FHLBank in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud, and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects.

Our audits of the financial statements included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audits also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinions.

Definition and Limitations of Internal Control over Financial Reporting

A company's internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company's internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company's assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.




Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
Indianapolis, Indiana
March 9, 2018

We have served as the FHLBank's auditor since 1990.






Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolis
Statements of Condition
($ amounts in thousands, except par value)
 
December 31,
2017
 
December 31,
2016
Assets:
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks (Note 3)
$
55,269

 
$
546,612

Interest-bearing deposits
660,342

 
150,225

Securities purchased under agreements to resell
2,605,460

 
1,781,309

Federal funds sold
1,280,000

 
1,650,000

Available-for-sale securities (Notes 4 and 6)
7,128,758

 
6,059,835

Held-to-maturity securities (estimated fair values of $5,919,299 and $5,848,692, respectively) (Notes 5 and 6)
5,897,668

 
5,819,573

Advances (Note 7)
34,055,064

 
28,095,953

Mortgage loans held for portfolio, net of allowance for loan losses of $(850) and $(850), respectively (Notes 8 and 9)
10,356,341

 
9,501,397

Accrued interest receivable
105,314

 
93,716

Premises, software, and equipment, net (Note 10)
36,795

 
37,638

Derivative assets, net (Note 11)
128,206

 
134,848

Other assets
39,689

 
36,294

 
 
 
 
Total assets
$
62,348,906

 
$
53,907,400

 
 
 
 
Liabilities:
 

 
 
Deposits (Note 12)
$
564,799

 
$
524,073

Consolidated obligations (Note 13):
 
 
 
Discount notes
20,358,157

 
16,801,763

Bonds
37,895,653

 
33,467,279

Total consolidated obligations, net
58,253,810

 
50,269,042

Accrued interest payable
135,691

 
98,411

Affordable Housing Program payable (Note 14)
32,166

 
26,598

Derivative liabilities, net (Note 11)
2,718

 
25,225

Mandatorily redeemable capital stock (Note 15)
164,322

 
170,043

Other liabilities
249,894

 
357,812

Total liabilities
59,403,400

 
51,471,204

 
 
 
 
Commitments and contingencies (Note 20)


 


 
 
 
 
Capital (Note 15):
 

 
 
Capital stock (putable at par value of $100 per share):
 
 
 
Class B-1 issued and outstanding shares: 18,566,388 and 14,897,390, respectively
1,856,639

 
1,489,739

Class B-2 issued and outstanding shares: 11,271 and 28,416, respectively
1,127

 
2,842

Total capital stock
1,857,766

 
1,492,581

Retained earnings:
 
 
 
Unrestricted
792,783

 
734,982

Restricted
183,551

 
152,265

Total retained earnings
976,334

 
887,247

Total accumulated other comprehensive income (Note 16)
111,406

 
56,368

Total capital
2,945,506

 
2,436,196

 
 
 
 
Total liabilities and capital
$
62,348,906

 
$
53,907,400


The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.

88


Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolis
Statements of Income
($ amounts in thousands)
 
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
Interest Income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Advances
 
$
404,494

 
$
219,061

 
$
126,216

Prepayment fees on advances, net
 
1,369

 
477

 
696

Interest-bearing deposits
 
3,397

 
808

 
217

Securities purchased under agreements to resell
 
6,144

 
6,481

 
1,534

Federal funds sold
 
44,054

 
10,494

 
2,821

Available-for-sale securities
 
121,049

 
69,106

 
32,858

Held-to-maturity securities
 
119,347

 
112,959

 
115,752

Mortgage loans held for portfolio
 
314,827

 
274,343

 
264,199

Other interest income (loss), net
 
1,955

 
1,162

 
(570
)
Total interest income
 
1,016,636

 
694,891

 
543,723

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest Expense:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Consolidated obligation discount notes
 
182,104

 
64,370

 
19,750

Consolidated obligation bonds
 
559,711

 
425,006

 
327,932

Deposits
 
4,784

 
709

 
94

Mandatorily redeemable capital stock
 
7,034

 
6,613

 
522

Other interest expense
 

 

 

Total interest expense
 
753,633

 
496,698

 
348,298

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net interest income
 
263,003

 
198,193

 
195,425

Provision for (reversal of) credit losses
 
51

 
(45
)
 
(456
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net interest income after provision for credit losses
 
262,952

 
198,238

 
195,881

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other Income (Loss):
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total other-than-temporary impairment losses
 

 

 

Non-credit portion reclassified to (from) other comprehensive income, net
 
(207
)
 
(197
)
 
(61
)
Net other-than-temporary impairment losses, credit portion
 
(207
)
 
(197
)
 
(61
)
Net gains (losses) on derivatives and hedging activities
 
(9,258
)
 
2,272

 
2,832

Service fees
 
947

 
1,200

 
967

Standby letters of credit fees
 
747

 
736

 
657

Other, net (Note 20)
 
1,775

 
1,647

 
6,086

Total other income (loss)
 
(5,996
)
 
5,658

 
10,481

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other Expenses:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Compensation and benefits
 
47,631

 
45,647

 
42,307

Other operating expenses
 
26,349

 
24,945

 
22,382

Federal Housing Finance Agency
 
3,328

 
2,955

 
2,703

Office of Finance
 
3,687

 
3,020

 
3,118

Other
 
1,367

 
1,032

 
1,384

Total other expenses
 
82,362

 
77,599

 
71,894

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Income before assessments
 
174,594

 
126,297

 
134,468


 
 
 
 
 
 
Affordable Housing Program assessments
 
18,163

 
13,291

 
13,499


 
 
 
 
 
 
Net income
 
$
156,431

 
$
113,006

 
$
120,969


The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.

89


Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolis
Statements of Comprehensive Income
($ amounts in thousands)
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net income
$
156,431

 
$
113,006

 
$
120,969

 
 
 
 
 
 
Other Comprehensive Income (Loss):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in unrealized gains (losses) on available-for-sale securities
53,051

 
39,371

 
(15,981
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net non-credit portion of other-than-temporary impairment losses on available-for-sale securities
2,384

 
(3,291
)
 
(7,943
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net non-credit portion of other-than-temporary impairment losses on held-to-maturity securities
52

 
29

 
43

 
 
 
 
 
 
Pension benefits, net (Note 17)
(449
)
 
(2,619
)
 
99

 
 
 
 
 
 
Total other comprehensive income (loss)
55,038

 
33,490

 
(23,782
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total comprehensive income
$
211,469

 
$
146,496

 
$
97,187



The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.

90


Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolis
Statements of Capital
Years Ended December 31, 2015, 2016, and 2017
($ amounts and shares in thousands)

 
 
Capital Stock
Class B Putable
 
Retained Earnings
 
Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Income (Loss)
 
Total
Capital
 
 
Shares
 
Par Value
 
Unrestricted
 
Restricted
 
Total
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, December 31, 2014
 
15,510

 
$
1,550,981

 
$
672,159

 
$
105,470

 
$
777,629

 
$
46,660

 
$
2,375,270

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
96,775

 
24,194

 
120,969

 
(23,782
)
 
97,187

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from issuance of capital stock
 
2,171

 
217,160

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
217,160

Repurchase/redemption of capital stock
 
(2,403
)
 
(240,335
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(240,335
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash dividends on capital stock (4.12%)
 
 
 
 
 
(63,485
)
 

 
(63,485
)
 
 
 
(63,485
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, December 31, 2015
 
15,278

 
$
1,527,806

 
$
705,449

 
$
129,664

 
$
835,113

 
$
22,878

 
$
2,385,797

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
90,405

 
22,601

 
113,006

 
33,490

 
146,496

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from issuance of capital stock
 
1,478

 
147,831

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
147,831

Shares reclassified to mandatorily redeemable capital stock, net
 
(1,830
)
 
(183,056
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(183,056
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Distributions on mandatorily redeemable capital stock
 
 
 
 
 
(1,072
)
 

 
(1,072
)
 
 
 
(1,072
)
Cash dividends on capital stock (4.25%)
 
 
 
 
 
(59,800
)
 

 
(59,800
)
 
 
 
(59,800
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, December 31, 2016
 
14,926

 
$
1,492,581

 
$
734,982

 
$
152,265

 
$
887,247

 
$
56,368

 
$
2,436,196

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
125,145

 
31,286

 
156,431

 
55,038

 
211,469

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from issuance of capital stock
 
3,652

 
365,185

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
365,185

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash dividends on capital stock (4.25%)
 
 
 
 
 
(67,344
)
 

 
(67,344
)
 
 
 
(67,344
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, December 31, 2017
 
18,578

 
$
1,857,766

 
$
792,783


$
183,551

 
$
976,334

 
$
111,406

 
$
2,945,506





The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.

91


Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolis
Statements of Cash Flows
($ amounts in thousands)
 
 
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
Operating Activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Net income
$
156,431

 
$
113,006

 
$
120,969

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Amortization and depreciation
69,111

 
57,040

 
52,556

Prepayment fees on advances, net of related swap termination fees

 
(526
)
 
(2,508
)
Changes in net derivative and hedging activities
(13,643
)
 
22,701

 
56,171

Net other-than-temporary impairment losses, credit portion
207

 
197

 
61

Provision for (reversal of) credit losses
51

 
(45
)
 
(456
)
Changes in:
 
 
 
 
 
Accrued interest receivable
(11,783
)
 
(5,541
)
 
(5,650
)
Other assets
(1,867
)
 
(2,674
)
 
(5,853
)
Accrued interest payable
37,343

 
16,597

 
4,802

Other liabilities
27,890

 
38,187

 
30,702

Total adjustments, net
107,309

 
125,936

 
129,825

 
 
 
 
 
 
Net cash provided by operating activities
263,740

 
238,942

 
250,794

 
 
 
 
 
 
Investing Activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in:
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-bearing deposits
(464,287
)
 
(39,205
)
 
55,309

Securities purchased under agreements to resell
(824,151
)
 
(1,781,309
)
 

Federal funds sold
370,000

 
(1,650,000
)
 

Available-for-sale securities:
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from maturities
1,041,227

 
855,927

 
82,567

Purchases
(2,213,866
)
 
(2,906,310
)
 
(635,954
)
Held-to-maturity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from maturities
1,245,438

 
1,351,512

 
1,577,327

Purchases
(1,325,424
)
 
(983,718
)
 
(802,687
)
Advances:
 
 
 
 
 
Principal repayments
280,448,048

 
146,368,448

 
96,180,660

Disbursements to members
(286,485,558
)
 
(147,692,939
)
 
(102,357,927
)
Mortgage loans held for portfolio:
 
 
 
 
 
Principal collections
1,245,983

 
1,701,633

 
1,323,072

Purchases from members
(2,144,552
)
 
(3,074,847
)
 
(2,663,395
)
Purchases of premises, software, and equipment
(5,176
)
 
(4,957
)
 
(4,494
)
Loans to other Federal Home Loan Banks:
 
 
 
 
 
Principal repayments
100,000

 
300,000

 

Disbursements
(100,000
)
 
(300,000
)
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
Net cash used in investing activities
(9,112,318
)
 
(7,855,765
)
 
(7,245,522
)
 


(continued)

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.

92


Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolis
Statements of Cash Flows, continued
($ amounts in thousands)
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
Financing Activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Changes in deposits
73,891

 
22,268

 
(528,048
)
Net payments on derivative contracts with financing elements
(16,683
)
 
(32,898
)
 
(57,828
)
Net proceeds from issuance of consolidated obligations:
 
 
 
 
 
Discount notes
216,011,184

 
331,383,919

 
101,485,730

Bonds
23,856,245

 
31,636,349

 
22,234,991

Payments for matured and retired consolidated obligations:
 
 
 
 
 
Discount notes
(212,480,262
)
 
(333,840,103
)
 
(94,808,634
)
Bonds
(19,379,260
)
 
(25,997,585
)
 
(19,862,550
)
Proceeds from issuance of capital stock
365,185

 
147,831

 
217,160

Payments for redemption/repurchase of capital stock

 

 
(240,335
)
Payments for redemption/repurchase of mandatorily redeemable
capital stock
(5,721
)
 
(28,148
)
 
(1,610
)
Dividend payments on capital stock
(67,344
)
 
(59,800
)
 
(63,485
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net cash provided by financing activities
8,357,235

 
3,231,833

 
8,375,391

 
 
 
 
 
 
Net increase (decrease) in cash and due from banks
(491,343
)
 
(4,384,990
)
 
1,380,663

 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks at beginning of year
546,612

 
4,931,602

 
3,550,939

 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks at end of year
$
55,269

 
$
546,612

 
$
4,931,602

 
 
 
 
 
 
Supplemental Disclosures:
 
 
 
 
 
Interest payments
$
525,403

 
$
415,261

 
$
321,227

Purchases of securities, traded but not yet settled

 
120,266

 
179,580

Affordable Housing Program payments
12,595

 
17,796

 
19,295

Capitalized interest on certain held-to-maturity securities
3,282

 
975

 
1,483

Par value of shares reclassified to mandatorily redeemable
capital stock, net

 
183,056

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.

93



Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolis
Notes to Financial Statements
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


These Notes to Financial Statements should be read in conjunction with the Statements of Condition as of December 31, 2017 and 2016, and the Statements of Income, Comprehensive Income, Capital, and Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2017, 2016, and 2015. We use acronyms and terms throughout these Notes to Financial Statements that are defined herein or in the Glossary of Terms. Unless the context otherwise requires, the terms "Bank," "we," "us," and "our" refer to the Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolis or its management.

Background Information

The Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolis, a federally chartered corporation, is one of 11 regional wholesale FHLBanks in the United States. The FHLBanks are GSEs that serve the public by enhancing the availability of credit for residential mortgages and targeted community development. Even though we are part of the FHLBank System, we operate as a separate entity with our own management, employees and board of directors.

Each FHLBank is a financial cooperative that provides a readily available, competitively-priced source of funds to its member institutions. Regulated financial depositories and non-captive insurance companies engaged in residential housing finance that have their principal place of business located in, or are domiciled in, our district states of Michigan or Indiana are eligible for membership in our Bank. Additionally, qualified CDFIs are eligible to be members. Housing Associates, including state and local housing authorities, that meet certain statutory and regulatory criteria may also borrow from us. While eligible to borrow, Housing Associates are not members and, as such, are not allowed to hold our capital stock.

Each member must purchase a minimum amount of our capital stock based on the amount of its total mortgage assets. A member may be required to purchase additional activity-based capital stock as it engages in certain business activities with us. Members and former members own all of our capital stock. Former members (including certain non-member institutions that own our capital stock as a result of a merger with or acquisition of a member) hold our capital stock solely to support credit products or mortgage loans still outstanding on our statement of condition. All owners of our capital stock, to the extent declared by our board of directors, receive dividends on their capital stock, subject to the applicable regulations as discussed in Note 15 - Capital. See Note 21 - Related Party and Other Transactions for more information about transactions with related parties.

The FHLBanks' Office of Finance was established to facilitate the issuance and servicing of the debt instruments of the FHLBanks, known as consolidated obligations, consisting of bonds and discount notes, and to prepare and publish the FHLBanks' combined quarterly and annual financial reports.

Consolidated obligations are the primary source of funds for the FHLBanks. Deposits, other borrowings and capital stock sold to members provide additional funds. We primarily use these funds to:
    
disburse advances to members;
acquire mortgage loans from PFIs through our MPP;
maintain liquidity; and
invest in other opportunities to support the residential housing market.

We also provide correspondent services, such as wire transfer, security safekeeping, and settlement services, to our members.

The Finance Agency is the independent federal regulator of the FHLBanks, Freddie Mac, and Fannie Mae. The Finance Agency's stated mission is to ensure that the housing GSEs operate in a safe and sound manner so that they serve as a reliable source of liquidity and funding for housing finance and community investment.




Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Note 1 - Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

Basis of Presentation. The accompanying financial statements have been prepared in accordance with GAAP and SEC requirements.

The financial statements contain all adjustments that are, in the opinion of management, necessary for a fair statement of our financial position, results of operations and cash flows for the periods presented. All such adjustments were of a normal recurring nature.

Use of Estimates. When preparing financial statements in accordance with GAAP, we are required to make subjective assumptions and estimates that may affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities, and the reported amounts of income and expense. The most significant estimates pertain to derivatives and hedging activity, fair value, the provision for credit losses, and OTTI. Although the reported amounts and disclosures reflect our best estimates, actual results could differ significantly from these estimates.

Estimated Fair Value. The estimated fair value amounts, recorded on the statement of condition and presented in the accompanying disclosures, have been determined based on the assumptions that we believe market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability and reflect our best judgment of appropriate valuation methods. Although we use our best judgment in estimating fair value, there are inherent limitations in any valuation technique. Therefore, these estimated fair values may not be indicative of the amounts that would have been realized in market transactions on the reporting dates. See Note 19 - Estimated Fair Values for more information.

Reclassifications. We have reclassified certain amounts from the prior period to conform to the current period presentation. These reclassifications had no effect on total assets, total liabilities, total capital, net income, total comprehensive income or net cash flows.

Interest-Bearing Deposits, Securities Purchased under Agreements to Resell, and Federal Funds Sold. These investments provide short-term liquidity and are carried at cost. Interest-bearing deposits may include certificates of deposit and bank notes not meeting the definition of a security. Securities purchased under agreements to resell are considered short-term collateralized financings. These securities are held in safekeeping in our name by third-party custodians approved by us. If the market value of the underlying assets declines below the market value required as collateral, the counterparty must (i) place an equivalent amount of additional securities in safekeeping in our name, and/or (ii) remit an equivalent amount of cash, or the dollar value of the resale agreement will be reduced accordingly. Federal funds sold consist of short-term, unsecured loans made to investment-grade counterparties.

Investment Securities. Purchases and sales of securities are recorded on a trade date basis. We classify investments as trading, HTM or AFS at the date of acquisition. We did not have any investments classified as trading during the years ended December 31, 2017, 2016 or 2015.

HTM Securities. Securities for which we have both the positive intent and ability to hold to maturity are classified as HTM. The carrying value includes adjustments made to the cost basis of the security for accretion, amortization, collection of principal, and, if applicable, OTTI recognized in earnings (credit losses) and OCI (non-credit losses).

Certain changes in circumstances may cause us to change our intent to hold a particular security to maturity without necessarily calling into question our intent to hold other debt securities to maturity. Thus, the sale or transfer of an HTM security due to certain changes in circumstances, such as evidence of significant deterioration in the issuer's creditworthiness or changes in regulatory requirements, is not considered to be inconsistent with its original classification. Other isolated, non-recurring, and unusual events, which could not have been reasonably anticipated, may also cause us to sell or transfer an HTM security without necessarily calling into question our intent to hold other debt securities to maturity.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


In addition, sales of HTM debt securities that meet either of the following two conditions may be considered as maturities for purposes of the classification of securities: (i) the sale occurs near enough to its maturity date (or call date, if exercise of the call is probable) that interest-rate risk is substantially eliminated as a pricing factor and any changes in market interest rates would not have a significant effect on the security's fair value, or (ii) the sale occurs after we have already collected a substantial portion (at least 85%) of the principal outstanding at acquisition due either to prepayments or to scheduled payments payable in equal installments (both principal and interest) over its term.

AFS Securities. Securities that have readily determinable fair values and are not classified as trading or HTM are classified as AFS and carried at estimated fair value. We record changes in the fair value of these securities in OCI as net change in unrealized gains (losses) on AFS securities, except for AFS securities that have been hedged and for which the hedging relationship qualifies as a fair-value hedge. For these securities, we record the portion of the change in fair value attributable to the risk being hedged in other income (loss) as net gains (losses) on derivatives and hedging activities together with the related change in the fair value of the derivative, and record the remainder of the change in the fair value of the securities in OCI. For AFS securities that are OTTI, changes in fair value, net of any credit loss, are recorded in OCI as the non-credit portion.

Premiums and Discounts. We amortize purchased premiums and accrete purchased discounts on MBS and ABS at an individual security level using the retrospective level-yield method (retrospective interest method) over the estimated remaining cash flows of each security. This method requires that we estimate prepayments over the estimated life of the securities and make a retrospective adjustment of the effective yield each time we change the estimated remaining cash flows of the securities as if the new estimates had been used since the acquisition date. Changes in interest rates are a significant assumption used in prepayment speed estimates.

We amortize purchased premiums and accrete purchased discounts on all other investment securities at an individual security level using a contractual level-yield methodology, under which prepayments are only taken into account as they actually occur.

Gains and Losses on Sales. We compute gains and losses on sales of investment securities using the specific identification method and include these gains and losses in other income (loss) as net realized gains from sale of securities.

Investment Securities - Other-Than-Temporary Impairment. On a quarterly basis, we evaluate our individual AFS and HTM securities that have been previously OTTI or are in an unrealized loss position to determine if any such securities are OTTI. A security is in an unrealized loss position (i.e., impaired) when its estimated fair value is less than its amortized cost. We consider an impaired debt security to be OTTI under any of the following conditions:
 
we intend to sell the debt security; 
based on available evidence, we believe it is more likely than not that we will be required to sell the debt security before the anticipated recovery of its remaining amortized cost; or 
we do not expect to recover the entire amortized cost of the debt security.

Recognition of OTTI. If either of the first two conditions above is met, we recognize an OTTI loss in earnings equal to the entire difference between the debt security's amortized cost and its estimated fair value as of the statement of condition date. For those impaired securities that meet neither of these two conditions, we perform a cash flow analysis to determine whether we expect to recover the entire amortized cost of each security.

If the present value of the cash flows expected to be collected is less than the amortized cost of the debt security, a credit loss equal to that difference is recorded, and the carrying value of the debt security is adjusted to its estimated fair value. However, rather than recognizing the entire difference between the amortized cost and estimated fair value in earnings, only the amount of the impairment representing the credit loss (i.e., the credit component) is recognized in earnings, while the remaining amount, if any, related to all other factors (i.e., the non-credit component) is recognized in OCI. The credit loss on a debt security is capped at the amount of that security's unrealized loss. The new amortized cost basis of the OTTI security, which reflects the credit loss, will not be adjusted for any subsequent recoveries of fair value.

The total OTTI loss is presented in other income (loss) with an offset for the portion recognized in OCI. The remaining amount represents the credit loss.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Additional OTTI. Subsequent to any recognition of OTTI, if the present value of cash flows expected to be collected is less than the amortized cost basis (which reflects previous credit losses), we record an additional credit loss equal to that difference as additional OTTI. The total amount of additional OTTI (both credit and non-credit component, if any) is determined as the difference between the security's amortized cost, less the amount of OTTI recognized in AOCI prior to the determination of this additional OTTI, and its fair value. For certain AFS or HTM securities that were previously impaired and have subsequently incurred additional credit losses, an amount equal to the additional credit losses, up to the amount of non-credit losses remaining in AOCI, is reclassified out of AOCI and into other income (loss).

Subsequent increases and decreases (if not an additional OTTI) in the estimated fair value of OTTI AFS securities are netted against the non-credit component of OTTI recognized previously in AOCI. For HTM securities, the OTTI in AOCI is accreted to the carrying value of each security on a prospective basis, based on the amount and timing of future projected cash flows (with no effect on earnings unless the security is subsequently sold, matures or additional OTTI is recognized). For debt securities classified as AFS, we do not accrete the OTTI in AOCI to the carrying value because the subsequent measurement basis for these securities is estimated fair value.

Interest Income Recognition. As of the initial OTTI measurement date, a new accretable yield is calculated for the OTTI debt security. This yield is then used to calculate the portion of the credit losses included in the amortized cost of the security to be recognized into interest income each period over the remaining life of the security so as to match the amount and timing of future cash flows expected to be collected.

On a quarterly basis, we re-evaluate the estimated cash flows and accretable yield. If there is no additional OTTI and there is either (i) a significant increase in the security's expected cash flows or (ii) a favorable change in the timing and amount of the security's expected cash flows, we adjust the accretable yield on a prospective basis.

Variable Interest Entities. We do not have any special purpose entities or any other type of off-balance sheet conduits. We have investments in VIEs that consist of senior interests in private-label RMBS and ABS. The carrying amounts of the investments are included in HTM or AFS securities. We have no liabilities related to these VIEs. The maximum loss exposure on these VIEs is limited to our carrying value.

On an annual basis, or more frequently as needed, we conduct an evaluation to determine whether we are the primary beneficiary of any VIE. To make this determination, we consider whether we possess both of the following characteristics:

the power to direct the VIE's activities that most significantly affect the VIE's economic performance; and
the obligation to absorb the VIE's losses, or the right to receive benefits from the VIE, that could potentially be significant to the VIE.

Based on an evaluation of the above characteristics, we have determined that we are not the primary beneficiary of a VIE and, therefore, consolidation is not required for our investments in VIEs as of December 31, 2017 or 2016. In addition, we have not provided financial or other support (explicitly or implicitly) to any VIE during the years ended December 31, 2017, 2016, or 2015. Furthermore, we were not previously contractually required to provide, nor do we intend to provide, that support to any VIE in the future.

Advances. We record advances at amortized cost, adjusted for unamortized premiums, discounts, prepayment fees and swap termination fees, unearned commitment fees, and fair-value hedging adjustments. We amortize/accrete premiums, discounts, hedging basis adjustments, deferred prepayment fees, and deferred swap termination fees, and recognize unearned commitment fees on advances, to interest income using a level-yield methodology. When an advance is prepaid, any remaining premium or discount is amortized at the time of prepayment. We record interest on advances to interest income as earned.

Prepayment Fees. We charge a borrower a prepayment fee when the borrower repays certain advances prior to the original maturity. We report prepayment fees net of any swap termination fees and hedge accounting basis adjustments.

Advance Modifications. When we fund a new advance concurrent with, or within a short period of time after, the prepayment of an original advance, we determine whether the transaction is effectively either (i) two separate transactions (the prepayment of an original advance and the disbursement of a new advance), defined as an advance extinguishment, or (ii) the continuation of the original advance as modified, defined as an advance modification.




Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


We account for the transaction as an extinguishment if both of the following criteria are met: (i) the effective yield of the new advance is at least equal to the effective yield for a comparable advance to a member with similar collection risks who is not prepaying, and (ii) modifications of the original advance are determined to be more than minor, i.e., if the present value of the cash flows under the terms of the new advance is at least 10% different from the present value of the remaining cash flows under the terms of the original advance or through an evaluation of qualitative factors which may include changes in the interest-rate exposure to the member by moving from a fixed to an adjustable rate advance. In all other instances, the transaction is accounted for as an advance modification.

If the transaction is determined to be an advance extinguishment, we recognize income from nonrefundable prepayment fees, net of swap termination fees, in the period that the extinguishment occurs. Alternatively, if no prepayment fees are received (e.g., the member requests that we embed the prepayment fee into the rate of the new advance), the difference between the present value of the cash flows of the new advance and that of a current market rate advance of comparable terms is recognized in current income, and the basis of the new advance is adjusted accordingly.

If the transaction is determined to be an advance modification, the income from nonrefundable prepayment fees, net of swap termination fees, associated with the modification of the original advance is not recognized in current income but is (i) included in the carrying value of the modified advance and amortized into interest income using a level-yield methodology when the prepayment fee is received up front or (ii) embedded into the rate of the modified advance and recorded as an adjustment to the interest accrual. If the modified advance is hedged in a qualifying hedge relationship, the modified advance is marked to fair value, and subsequent fair value changes attributable to the hedged risk are recorded in other income (loss).

Mortgage Loans Held for Portfolio. We classify mortgage loans, for which we have the intent and ability to hold for the foreseeable future or until maturity or payoff, as held for portfolio. Accordingly, these mortgage loans are reported at cost, adjusted for premiums paid to and discounts received from PFIs, deferred loan fees or costs, hedging basis adjustments, and the allowance for loan losses.

Premiums and Discounts. We defer and amortize/accrete premiums and discounts, certain loan fees or costs, and hedging basis adjustments to interest income using the contractual level-yield interest method. When a loan is prepaid, any remaining premium or discount is amortized to interest income in the period in which the loan is prepaid and derecognized. For partial prepayments, a proportionate share of any remaining premium or discount is amortized to interest income in the period in which the prepayment occurs.

Non-accrual Loans. We place a conventional mortgage loan on non-accrual status if it is determined that either (i) the collection of interest or principal is doubtful, or (ii) interest or principal is past due for 90 days or more, except when the loan is well secured and in the process of collection (e.g., through credit enhancements and monthly servicer remittances on a scheduled/scheduled basis). Monthly servicer remittances on MPP loans on an actual/actual basis may also be well secured; however, servicers on actual/actual remittance do not advance principal and interest due until the payments are received from the borrower or when the loan is repaid.

A government-guaranteed or -insured mortgage loan is not placed on non-accrual status when the collection of the contractual principal or interest is 90 days or more past due because of the contractual obligation of the loan servicer to pay defaulted interest at the contractual rate.

For those mortgage loans placed on non-accrual status, accrued but uncollected interest is reversed against interest income (for any interest accrued in the current year) and/or the allowance for loan losses (for any interest accrued in the previous year). We record cash payments received on non-accrual loans as a direct reduction of the recorded investment in the loan. When the recorded investment has been fully collected, any additional amounts collected are recognized as interest income. A loan on non-accrual status may be restored to accrual status when it becomes current (zero days past due) and three consecutive and timely monthly payments have been made.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


REO. Our MPP was designed to require loan servicers to foreclose and liquidate in the servicer's name rather than in our name. Therefore, we do not take title to any foreclosed property or enter into any other legal agreement under which the borrower conveys all interest in the property to us to satisfy the loan. As the servicer progresses through the process from foreclosure to liquidation, we are paid in full for all unpaid principal and accrued interest on the loan through the normal remittance process. Upon full receipt, the mortgage loan is removed from our statement of condition. As a result of these factors, we do not classify as REO any foreclosed properties collateralizing MPP loans that were previously recorded on our statement of condition. 

Under the MPF Program, REO is recorded in other assets and includes assets that have been received in satisfaction of debt through foreclosures. REO is recorded at the lower of cost or fair value less estimated selling costs. We recognize a charge-off to the allowance for credit losses if the fair value of the REO less estimated selling costs is less than the recorded investment in the loan at the date of the transfer from mortgage loans to REO. Any subsequent gains, losses, and carrying costs are included in other expense.

Loan Participations. We may sell participating interests in MPP loans acquired from our PFIs to other FHLBanks. The terms of the sale of these participating interests meet the accounting requirements for a sale and, therefore, the participating interests are de-recognized from our reported mortgage loan balances and a pro-rata portion of the fixed LRA is assumed by the participating FHLBank for its use in loss mitigation. As a result, available funds remaining in our LRA include our pro-rata portion only of the fixed LRA associated with the participating interests retained by us. The portion of the participation fees received related to our upfront costs is recognized immediately into income, while the remaining portion related to our ongoing costs is deferred and amortized to income over the remaining life of the loans.

Allowance for Credit Losses. An allowance for credit losses is separately established for each identified portfolio segment if it is probable that impairment has occurred as of the statement of condition date and the amount of loss can be reasonably estimated. See Note 9 - Allowance for Credit Losses for details on each allowance methodology.

Portfolio Segments. A portfolio segment is defined as the level at which an entity develops and documents a systematic methodology for determining its allowance for credit losses. We have developed and documented a systematic methodology for determining an allowance for credit losses, where applicable, for (i) credit products (advances, letters of credit, and other extensions of credit to members); (ii) term securities purchased under agreements to resell and term federal funds sold; (iii) government-guaranteed or -insured mortgage loans held for portfolio; and (iv) conventional mortgage loans held for portfolio.

Classes of Financing Receivables. Classes of financing receivables generally are a disaggregation of a portfolio segment to the extent that they are needed to understand the exposure to credit risk arising from these financing receivables. We determined that no further disaggregation of our portfolio segments is needed, as the credit risk arising from these financing receivables is adequately assessed and measured at the portfolio segment level.

Troubled Debt Restructuring. TDRs related to MPP loans occur when a concession is granted to a borrower for economic or legal reasons related to the borrower's financial difficulties that would not have been otherwise considered. Although we do not participate in government-sponsored loan modification programs, we do consider certain conventional loan modifications to be TDRs when the modification agreement permits the recapitalization of past due amounts, generally up to the original loan amount. If a borrower is having financial difficulty and a concession has been granted by the PFI with our approval, the loan modification is considered a TDR. No other terms of the original loan are modified, except for the possible extension of the contractual maturity date on a case-by-case basis. In no event does the borrower's original interest rate change.

MPP loans discharged in Chapter 7 bankruptcy proceedings without a reaffirmation of the debt are considered TDRs unless they are covered by SMI policies. Loans discharged in Chapter 7 bankruptcy proceedings with SMI policies are also considered to be TDRs unless (i) we will not suffer more than an insignificant delay in receiving all principal and interest due or (ii) we are not relinquishing a legal right to pursue the borrower for deficiencies for those loans not affirmed.

TDRs related to MPF Program loans occur when a concession is granted to a borrower for economic or legal reasons related to the borrower's financial difficulties that would not have been otherwise considered. Such TDRs generally involve modifying the borrower's monthly payment for a period of up to 36 months. MPF Program loans discharged in Chapter 7 bankruptcy proceedings without a reaffirmation of the debt are also considered TDRs.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


For both the MPP and the MPF Program, modifications of government loans are not considered or accounted for as TDRs because we anticipate no loss of principal or interest accrued at the original contract rate, without significant delay, due to the government-guarantee or insurance.

Impairment Methodology. A loan is considered impaired when, based on current and historical information and events, it is probable that not all amounts due according to the contractual terms of the loan agreement will be collected.

Loans that are considered collateral dependent are subject to individual evaluation for impairment instead of collective evaluation. Loans are considered collateral dependent if repayment is expected to be provided solely by the sale of the underlying property, i.e., there is no other available and reliable source of repayment (including LRA and SMI). We consider all impaired loans to be collateral dependent and, therefore, measure impairment based on the fair value of the underlying collateral less costs to sell.

Interest income on impaired loans is recognized in the same manner as non-accrual loans.

Charge-Off Policy. A charge-off is recorded to the extent that the recorded investment (including UPB, accrued interest, unamortized premiums or discounts, and hedging adjustments) in a loan will not be fully recovered. We record a charge-off on a conventional mortgage loan against the loan loss allowance upon the occurrence of a confirming event. Confirming events include, but are not limited to, the settlement of a claim against any of the credit enhancements, delinquency in excess of 180 days, and filing for bankruptcy protection. We charge-off the portion of the outstanding conventional mortgage loan balance in excess of the fair value of the underlying property, less cost to sell and adjusted for any available credit enhancements.

Derivatives. We record derivative instruments, related cash collateral (including initial and variation margin received or pledged/posted) and associated accrued interest on a net basis, by clearing agent and/or by counterparty when the netting requirements have been met, as either derivative assets or derivative liabilities at their estimated fair values. For derivative instruments that meet the netting requirements, any excess cash collateral received or pledged is recognized as a derivative liability or derivative asset, respectively.

Cash flows associated with derivatives are reported as cash flows from operating activities in the statement of cash flows unless the derivatives contain financing elements, in which case they are reflected as cash flows from financing activities. Derivative instruments that include non-standard terms, or require an upfront cash payment, or both, often contain a financing element.

Changes in the estimated fair value of derivatives are recorded in earnings regardless of how changes in the estimated fair value of the assets or liabilities being hedged may be recorded.

Designations. Each derivative is designated as one of the following:

(i)
a qualifying fair-value hedge of the change in fair value of a recognized asset or liability, an unrecognized firm commitment, or a forecasted transaction (a fair-value hedge); or
(ii)
a non-qualifying hedge (economic hedge) for asset/liability management purposes.

Derivatives are recorded beginning on the trade date and typically executed and designated in a qualifying hedging relationship at the same time as the acquisition of the hedged item. We may also designate the hedging relationship upon the Bank's commitment to disburse an advance, purchase mortgage loans, or trade a consolidated obligation in which settlement occurs within the shortest period of time possible for the type of instrument based on market settlement conventions.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Accounting for Qualifying Hedges. Hedging relationships must meet certain criteria to qualify for hedge accounting including, but not limited to, formal documentation of the hedging relationship and an expectation to be highly effective. Two approaches to hedge accounting include:

(i)
Long-haul hedge accounting - The application of long-haul hedge accounting requires us to formally assess (both at the hedge's inception and at least quarterly) whether the derivatives used in hedging transactions are highly effective in offsetting changes in the fair value of hedged items or forecasted transactions and whether those derivatives may be expected to remain highly effective in future periods. 
(ii)
Short-cut hedge accounting - Transactions that meet certain criteria qualify for the short-cut method of hedge accounting in which an assumption can be made that the entire change in fair value of a hedged item, due to changes in the benchmark rate, exactly offsets the entire change in fair value of the related derivative. Therefore, the derivative is considered to be highly effective at achieving offsetting changes in fair values of the hedged asset or liability. For all existing hedging relationships entered into prior to April 1, 2008, we continue to use the short-cut method of accounting provided they still meet the assumption of "no ineffectiveness." We no longer apply this method to any other hedging relationships.

Changes in the fair value of a derivative that is designated and qualifies as a fair-value hedge, along with changes in the fair value of the hedged asset or liability that are attributable to the hedged risk (including changes that reflect losses or firm commitments), are recorded in other income (loss) as net gains (losses) on derivatives and hedging activities. As a result, for fair-value hedges, any hedge ineffectiveness (which represents the amount by which the change in the fair value of the derivative differs from the change in the fair value of the hedged item attributable to the hedged risk) is recorded in other income (loss) as net gains (losses) on derivatives and hedging activities.

Accounting for Non-Qualifying Hedges. An economic hedge is defined as a derivative that hedges specific or non-specific underlying assets, liabilities, or firm commitments and does not qualify, or was not designated, for hedge accounting. As a result, we recognize only the net interest settlement and the change in fair value of these derivatives in other income (loss) as net gains (losses) on derivatives and hedging activities with no offsetting fair value adjustments in earnings for the hedged assets, liabilities, or firm commitments. An economic hedge by definition, therefore, introduces the potential for earnings variability.

Accrued Interest Receivables and Payables. The difference between the interest receivable and payable on a derivative designated as a qualifying hedge is recognized as an adjustment to the income or expense of the designated hedged item.

Discontinuance of Hedge Accounting. We discontinue hedge accounting prospectively when: (i) the hedging relationship ceases to be highly effective; (ii) the derivative and/or the hedged item expires or is sold, terminated, or exercised; (iii) a hedged firm commitment no longer meets the definition of a firm commitment; or (iv) we elect to discontinue hedge accounting.

When hedge accounting is discontinued, we either terminate the derivative or continue to carry the derivative at its fair value, cease to adjust the hedged asset or liability for changes in fair value and amortize the cumulative basis adjustment on the hedged item into interest income over the remaining life of the hedged item using a level-yield methodology.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Embedded Derivatives. We may issue consolidated obligations, disburse advances, or purchase financial instruments in which a derivative instrument is embedded. In order to determine whether an embedded derivative must be bifurcated from the host instrument and separately valued, we must assess, upon execution of the transaction, whether the economic characteristics of the embedded derivative are clearly and closely related to the economic characteristics of the remaining component of the consolidated obligation, advance or purchased financial instrument (the host contract) and whether a separate, non-embedded instrument with the same terms as the embedded instrument would meet the definition of a derivative instrument. If we determine that (i) the embedded derivative has economic characteristics that are not clearly and closely related to the economic characteristics of the host contract and (ii) a separate, stand-alone instrument with the same terms would qualify as a derivative instrument, the embedded derivative is separated from the host contract, carried at fair value, and designated as a stand-alone derivative instrument pursuant to an economic hedge, and the host contract is accounted for based on the guidance applicable to instruments of that type that are not hedged. However, if (i) the entire contract (the host contract and the embedded derivative) is required to be measured at fair value, with changes in fair value reported in earnings (such as an investment security classified as trading), or (ii) we cannot reliably identify and measure the embedded derivative for purposes of separating that derivative from its host contract, the entire contract is carried at fair value, and no portion of the contract is designated as a hedging instrument.

Financial Instruments Meeting Netting Requirements. We present certain financial instruments, including our derivative asset and liability positions as well as cash collateral received or pledged, on a net basis when we have a legal right of offset and all other requirements for netting are met (collectively referred to as the netting requirements).

The net exposure for these financial instruments can change on a daily basis; therefore, there may be a delay between the time a change in the exposure is identified and additional collateral is requested, and the time the additional collateral is received or pledged. Likewise, there may be a delay before excess collateral is returned. For derivative instruments that meet the netting requirements, any excess cash collateral received or pledged is recognized as a derivative liability or derivative asset, respectively. Additional information regarding these transactions is provided in Note 11 - Derivatives and Hedging Activities.

Premises, Software, and Equipment. We record premises, software, and equipment at cost, less accumulated depreciation and amortization, and compute depreciation and amortization using the straight-line method over their respective estimated useful lives, which range from 1 to 40 years. We capitalize improvements and major renewals, but expense maintenance and repairs when incurred. We depreciate building improvements using the straight-line method over the shorter of the estimated useful life of the improvement or the remaining life of the building. In addition, we capitalize software development costs for internal use software with an estimated economic useful life of at least one year. If capitalized, we use the straight-line method for computing amortization. We include any gain or loss on disposal (other than abandonment) of premises, software, and equipment in other income (loss). Any loss on abandonment of premises, software, and equipment is included in other operating expenses.

Consolidated Obligations. Consolidated obligations are recorded at amortized cost, adjusted for concessions, accretion of discounts, amortization of premiums, principal payments, and fair-value hedging adjustments.

Discounts and Premiums. We accrete/amortize the discounts and premiums as well as hedging basis adjustments on CO bonds to interest expense using the level-yield interest method over the term to contractual maturity of the corresponding CO bonds. Any remaining unamortized premium or discount is recognized upon prepayment.

Concessions. Concessions are paid to dealers in connection with the issuance of certain consolidated obligations. The Office of Finance prorates the amount of our concession based upon the percentage of the debt issued on our behalf. We record concessions paid on consolidated obligations as a direct deduction from their carrying amounts, consistent with the presentation of discounts on consolidated obligations. The concessions are deferred and amortized, using the level-yield interest method, to interest expense over the term to contractual maturity of the corresponding consolidated obligations. Any remaining unamortized concessions are recognized upon prepayment.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Mandatorily Redeemable Capital Stock. When a member withdraws or attains non-member status by merger or acquisition, charter termination, relocation or other involuntary termination from membership, the member's shares are then subject to redemption, at which time a five-year redemption period commences. Since the shares meet the definition of a mandatorily redeemable financial instrument, the shares are reclassified from capital to liabilities as MRCS at estimated fair value, which is equal to par value. Dividends declared on shares classified as a liability are accrued at the expected dividend rate and reported as interest expense.

We reclassify MRCS from liabilities to capital when non-members subsequently become members through either acquisition, merger, or election. After the reclassification, dividends declared on that capital stock are no longer classified as interest expense.

Employee Retirement and Deferred Compensation Plans. We recognize the minimum required contribution to the DB plan as expense ratably over the plan year to which it relates. Without a prefunding election, any contribution made in excess of the minimum required contribution is recorded as an expense in the quarterly reporting period in which the contribution is made.

Restricted Retained Earnings. In accordance with the Bank's JCE Agreement, we allocate 20% of our net income each quarter to a separate restricted retained earnings account until the balance of that account equals at least 1% of the average balance of our outstanding consolidated obligations for the previous quarter.

Gains on Litigation Settlements. Litigation settlement gains, net of related legal fees and litigation expenses, are recorded in other income when realized. A litigation settlement gain is considered realized when we receive cash or assets that are readily convertible to known amounts of cash or claims to cash. In addition, a settlement gain is considered realized when we enter into a signed agreement not subject to appeal, the counterparty has the ability to pay, and the amount to be received can be reasonably estimated. Prior to being realized, we consider potential litigation settlement gains to be gain contingencies and, therefore, they are not recorded in the statement of income.

Finance Agency Expenses. The portion of the Finance Agency's expenses and working capital fund not allocated to Freddie Mac and Fannie Mae is allocated among the FHLBanks as assessments, which are based on the ratio of each FHLBank's minimum required regulatory capital to the aggregate minimum required regulatory capital of every FHLBank.
 
Office of Finance Expenses. Our proportionate share of the Office of Finance's operating and capital expenditures is calculated based upon two components as follows: (i) two-thirds based on our share of total consolidated obligations outstanding and (ii) one-third based on equal pro rata allocation. We record our share of these expenditures in other expenses.

Affordable Housing Program Assessments. The Bank Act requires each FHLBank to establish and fund an AHP, which provides subsidies to members to assist in the purchase, construction, or rehabilitation of housing for very low- to moderate-income households. Each period, we charge/(credit) the required funding for AHP to earnings and increase/(decrease) the associated liability. We typically make the AHP subsidy available to members as a grant. As an alternative, we can issue AHP advances at interest rates below the customary interest rate for non-subsidized advances.

Cash Flows. We consider cash and due from banks on the statement of condition as cash and cash equivalents within the statement of cash flows because of their highly liquid nature. Federal funds sold, securities purchased under agreements to resell, and interest-bearing deposits are not treated as cash and cash equivalents, but instead are treated as short-term investments. Accordingly, their associated cash flows are reported in the investing activities section of the statement of cash flows.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Note 2 - Recently Adopted and Issued Accounting Guidance

Recently Adopted Accounting Guidance.

Contingent Put and Call Options in Debt Instruments (Accounting Standards Update (ASU) 2016-06). On March 14, 2016, the FASB issued amendments to clarify the requirements for assessing whether contingent call (put) options that can accelerate the payment of principal on debt instruments are clearly and closely related to their debt host contracts. The amendments require entities to apply only the four-step decision sequence when assessing whether the economic characteristics and risks of call (put) options are clearly and closely related to the economic characteristics and risks of their debt hosts. Consequently, when a call (put) option is contingently exercisable, an entity does not have to assess whether the event that triggers the ability to exercise a call (put) option is related to interest rates or credit risks.

This amended guidance was effective for the interim and annual periods beginning on January 1, 2017. The adoption of this guidance on January 1, 2017 had no effect on our financial condition, results of operations, or cash flows.

Recently Issued Accounting Guidance.

Revenue from Contracts with Customers (ASU 2014-09). On May 28, 2014, the FASB issued new guidance on revenue from contracts with customers. This guidance outlines a comprehensive model for recognizing revenue arising from contracts with customers and supersedes most current revenue recognition guidance, including industry specific guidance. In addition, this guidance amends the existing requirements for the recognition of a gain or loss on the transfer of nonfinancial assets that are not in a contract with a customer. This guidance applies to all contracts with customers except those that are within the scope of certain other standards, such as financial instruments, certain guarantees, insurance contracts, or lease contracts.

On August 12, 2015, the FASB issued an amendment to defer the effective date of the guidance by one year. In 2016, the FASB issued additional amendments to clarify certain aspects of the guidance; however, the amendments do not change the core principle in the guidance.

The guidance became effective for interim and annual periods beginning on January 1, 2018. The guidance provides entities with the option of using either of the following two methods upon adoption: (i) a full retrospective method, applied to each prior reporting period presented; or (ii) a modified retrospective method, with the cumulative effect of initially applying this guidance recognized at the date of initial adoption. The adoption of this guidance will have no effect on our financial condition, results of operations, or cash flows.

Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities (ASU 2016-01). On January 5, 2016, the FASB issued amended guidance on certain aspects of recognition, measurement, presentation, and disclosure of financial instruments. This guidance includes, but is not limited to, the following provisions:

equity investments (with certain exceptions) to be measured at fair value with changes in fair value recognized in net income;
separate presentation in other comprehensive income of the portion of the total change in the fair value of a liability resulting from a change in the instrument-specific credit risk when the entity has elected to measure the liability at fair value in accordance with the fair value option for financial instruments;
separate presentation of financial assets and financial liabilities by measurement category and form of financial asset (i.e., securities or loans and receivables) on the statement of condition or in the accompanying notes to the financial statements; and
elimination of the requirement for public entities to disclose the method(s) and significant assumptions used to estimate the fair value that is required to be disclosed for financial instruments measured at amortized cost on the balance sheet.

The guidance became effective for the interim and annual periods beginning on January 1, 2018. The amendments, in general, should be applied by means of a cumulative-effect adjustment to the statement of condition as of the beginning of the period of adoption. The adoption of this guidance will have no effect on our financial condition, results of operations, or cash flows.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Classification of Certain Cash Receipts and Cash Payments (ASU 2016-15). On August 26, 2016, the FASB issued amendments to clarify existing guidance on the classification of certain cash receipts and payments on the statement of cash flows to reduce current and potential future diversity in practice regarding eight specific cash flow issues.

These amendments became effective for interim and annual periods beginning on January 1, 2018. These amendments should be applied using a retrospective transition method to each period presented. The adoption of these amendments will have no effect on our financial condition, results of operations, or cash flows.

Improving the Presentation of Net Periodic Pension Cost and Net Periodic Postretirement Benefit Cost (ASU 2017-07). On March 10, 2017, the FASB issued amendments to improve the presentation of net periodic pension cost and net periodic postretirement benefit cost. The amendments require that an employer disaggregate the service cost component from the other components of net pension and benefit cost. The amendments also provide explicit guidance on how to present the service cost component and the other components of net benefit cost in the income statement.

These amendments became effective for interim and annual periods beginning on January 1, 2018. The amendments should be applied retrospectively for the presentation of the service cost component and the other components of net periodic pension cost and net periodic postretirement benefit cost in the income statement and prospectively, on and after the effective date, for the capitalization of the service cost component of net periodic pension cost and net periodic postretirement benefit cost. The adoption of these amendments will have no effect on our financial condition, results of operations, or cash flows. However, the adoption will result in a reclassification within other expenses on the income statement of the non-service components of our net periodic pension cost.

Leases (ASU 2016-02). On February 25, 2016, the FASB issued guidance which requires recognition of lease assets and lease liabilities on the statement of condition and disclosure of key information about leasing arrangements. In particular, this guidance requires a lessee, in an operating or finance lease, to recognize on the statement of condition a liability to make lease payments and a right-of-use asset representing its right to use the underlying asset for the lease term. However, for a lease with a term of 12 months or less, a lessee is permitted to make an accounting policy election not to recognize a lease asset and lease liability. Under previous guidance, a lessee was not required to recognize a lease asset and lease liability arising from an operating lease on the statement of condition. While this guidance does not fundamentally change lessor accounting, some changes have been made to align that guidance with the lessee guidance and other areas within GAAP.

This guidance is effective for the interim and annual periods beginning on January 1, 2019, and early adoption is permitted. However, we plan to adopt this guidance on the effective date. The guidance requires lessors and lessees to recognize and measure leases at the beginning of the earliest period presented in the financial statements using a modified retrospective approach. Upon adoption, we expect to report higher assets and liabilities as a result of including right-of-use assets and lease liabilities on the statement of condition, but we do not expect its effect on our financial condition, results of operations, or cash flows to be material.

Premium Amortization on Purchased Callable Debt Securities (ASU 2017-08). On March 30, 2017, the FASB issued amendments to shorten the amortization period for certain callable debt securities purchased at a premium. Specifically, the amendments require the premium to be amortized to the earliest call date. No change is required for securities purchased at a discount.

These amendments are effective beginning on January 1, 2019. Early adoption is permitted; however, we plan to adopt the amendments on the effective date. The amendments should be applied using a modified retrospective method through a cumulative-effect adjustment directly to retained earnings as of the beginning of the period of adoption. The adoption of this guidance will have no effect on our financial condition, results of operations, or cash flows.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Targeted Improvements to Accounting for Hedging Activities (ASU 2017-12). On August 28, 2017, the FASB issued amended guidance to improve the financial reporting of hedging relationships to better portray the economic results of an entity's risk management activities in its financial statements. This guidance requires that, for fair value hedges, the entire change in the fair value of the hedging instrument included in the assessment of hedge effectiveness be presented in the same income statement line that is used to present the earnings effect of the hedged item. For cash flow hedges, the entire change in the fair value of the hedging instrument included in the assessment of hedge effectiveness must be recorded in OCI. In addition, the amendments include certain targeted improvements to the assessment of hedge effectiveness and permit, among other things, the following:

Measurement of the change in fair value of the hedged item on the basis of the benchmark rate component of the contractual coupon cash flows determined at hedge inception.
Measurement of the hedged item in a partial-term fair value hedge of interest-rate risk by assuming the hedged item has a term that reflects only the designated cash flows being hedged.
Consideration only of how changes in the benchmark interest rate affect a decision to settle a prepayable instrument before its scheduled maturity in calculating the change in the fair value of the hedged item attributable to interest-rate risk.

This guidance is effective beginning January 1, 2019. Early adoption is permitted; however, we plan to adopt the guidance on the effective date. We are in the process of evaluating this guidance; but we currently expect its adoption to have no effect on our financial condition, results of operations, or cash flows. However, the amended presentation and disclosure guidance will result in a prospective reclassification on the income statement of the change in fair value of hedging instruments and related hedged items in fair value hedging relationships from other income to interest income.

Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments (ASU 2016-13). On June 16, 2016, the FASB issued amended guidance for the measurement of credit losses on financial instruments. The amendments require entities to measure expected losses over the entire estimated life of a financial instrument instead of incurred losses. Such measurement must be based on relevant information about past events, including historical experience, current conditions, and reasonable and supportable forecasts that affect the collectability of the reported amount. An entity must use judgment in determining the relevant information and estimation methods that are appropriate in its circumstances.

The amended guidance requires a financial asset, or a group of financial assets, measured at amortized cost basis to be presented at the net amount expected to be collected over the contractual term of the financial asset. The guidance also requires, among other provisions, the following:

The statement of income must reflect the measurement of credit losses for newly recognized financial assets, as well as the increases or decreases in expected credit losses that have taken place during the period.    
Entities must determine the allowance for credit losses for purchased financial assets with a more-than-insignificant amount of credit deterioration since origination in a manner similar to other financial assets measured at amortized cost. The initial allowance for credit losses is required to be added to the purchase price.
Entities must record credit losses relating to AFS debt securities through an allowance for credit losses. The amendments limit the allowance for credit losses to the amount by which fair value is below amortized cost.
Public entities must further disaggregate the current disclosure of credit quality indicators in relation to the amortized cost of financing receivables by the year of origination (i.e., vintage).

This guidance is effective for the interim and annual periods beginning on January 1, 2020. Early adoption is permitted as of the interim and annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2018; however, we plan to adopt this guidance on the effective date. This guidance should be applied using a modified-retrospective approach whereby a cumulative-effect adjustment is recorded to retained earnings as of the beginning of the first reporting period in which the guidance is adopted. In addition, the guidance requires the use of a prospective transition approach for purchased financial assets with a more-than-insignificant amount of credit deterioration since origination and for debt securities for which OTTI had been recognized before the effective date. We are in the process of evaluating this guidance, but expect the adoption to result in an increase to the allowance for credit losses, including an allowance for debt securities, primarily due to the requirement to measure losses for the entire estimated life of the financial asset. The impact on our financial condition, results of operations, and cash flows will depend upon the composition of financial assets held at the adoption date as well as the economic conditions and forecasts at that time.




Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)



Note 3 - Cash and Due from Banks

Compensating Balances. We maintain cash balances with commercial banks in return for certain services. These agreements contain no legal restrictions on the withdrawal of funds. The average cash balances were $35,592, $101,311, and $81,853 for the years ended December 31, 2017, 2016, and 2015, respectively.

Pass-through Deposit Reserves. We act as a pass-through correspondent for member institutions required to deposit reserves with the Federal Reserve Banks. The amount reported as cash and due from banks includes pass-through reserves deposited with the Federal Reserve Banks of $51,576 and $29,118 at December 31, 2017 and 2016, respectively.

Note 4 - Available-for-Sale Securities

Major Security Types. The following table presents our AFS securities by type of security.
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gross
 
Gross
 
 
 
 
Amortized
 
Non-Credit
 
Unrealized
 
Unrealized
 
Estimated
December 31, 2017
 
Cost (1)
 
OTTI
 
Gains
 
Losses
 
Fair Value
GSE and TVA debentures
 
$
4,357,250

 
$

 
$
46,679

 
$

 
$
4,403,929

GSE MBS
 
2,460,455

 

 
45,840

 

 
2,506,295

Private-label RMBS
 
189,212

 
(68
)
 
29,390

 

 
218,534

Total AFS securities
 
$
7,006,917

 
$
(68
)
 
$
121,909

 
$

 
$
7,128,758

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
GSE and TVA debentures
 
$
4,693,211

 
$

 
$
25,624

 
$
(4,201
)
 
$
4,714,634

GSE MBS
 
1,058,037

 

 
18,279

 
(234
)
 
1,076,082

Private-label RMBS
 
242,181

 
(263
)
 
27,201

 

 
269,119

Total AFS securities
 
$
5,993,429

 
$
(263
)
 
$
71,104

 
$
(4,435
)
 
$
6,059,835


(1) 
Includes adjustments made to the cost basis of an investment for accretion, amortization, collection of principal, and, if applicable, OTTI recognized in earnings (credit losses) and fair-value hedge accounting adjustments.

Unrealized Loss Positions. The following table presents impaired AFS securities (i.e., in an unrealized loss position), aggregated by major security type and length of time that individual securities have been in a continuous unrealized loss position.
 
 
Less than 12 months
 
12 months or more
 
Total
 
 
Estimated
 
Unrealized
 
Estimated
 
Unrealized
 
Estimated
 
Unrealized
December 31, 2017
 
Fair Value
 
Losses
 
Fair Value
 
Losses
 
Fair Value
 
Losses
GSE and TVA debentures
 
$

 
$

 
$

 
$

 
$

 
$

GSE MBS
 

 

 

 

 

 

Private-label RMBS
 

 

 
2,494

 
(68
)
 
2,494

 
(68
)
Total impaired AFS securities
 
$

 
$

 
$
2,494

 
$
(68
)
 
$
2,494

 
$
(68
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
GSE and TVA debentures
 
$
525,722

 
$
(3,604
)
 
$
176,104

 
$
(597
)
 
$
701,826

 
$
(4,201
)
GSE MBS
 

 

 
78,704

 
(234
)
 
78,704

 
(234
)
Private-label RMBS
 

 

 
3,002

 
(263
)
 
3,002

 
(263
)
Total impaired AFS securities
 
$
525,722


$
(3,604
)

$
257,810


$
(1,094
)

$
783,532

 
$
(4,698
)





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Contractual Maturity. The amortized cost and estimated fair value of non-MBS AFS securities are presented below by contractual maturity. MBS are not presented by contractual maturity because their actual maturities will likely differ from their contractual maturities as borrowers have the right to prepay their obligations with or without prepayment fees.
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
 
 
Amortized
 
Estimated
 
Amortized
 
Estimated
Year of Contractual Maturity
 
Cost
 
Fair Value
 
Cost
 
Fair Value
Due in 1 year or less
 
$
83,666

 
$
83,754

 
$
972,508

 
$
974,215

Due after 1 year through 5 years
 
2,317,516

 
2,336,699

 
1,841,488

 
1,855,517

Due after 5 years through 10 years
 
1,766,440

 
1,791,829

 
1,734,156

 
1,740,029

Due after 10 years
 
189,628

 
191,647

 
145,059

 
144,873

Total non-MBS
 
4,357,250

 
4,403,929

 
4,693,211

 
4,714,634

Total MBS
 
2,649,667

 
2,724,829

 
1,300,218

 
1,345,201

Total AFS securities
 
$
7,006,917

 
$
7,128,758

 
$
5,993,429

 
$
6,059,835


Realized Gains and Losses. There were no sales of AFS securities during the years ended December 31, 2017, 2016, or 2015. As of December 31, 2017, we had no intention of selling the AFS securities in an unrealized loss position nor did we consider it more likely than not that we will be required to sell these securities before our anticipated recovery of each security's remaining amortized cost basis.

Note 5 - Held-to-Maturity Securities

Major Security Types. The following table presents our HTM securities by type of security.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gross
 
Gross
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Unrecognized
 
Unrecognized
 
Estimated
 
 
Amortized
 
Non-Credit
 
Carrying
 
Holding
 
Holding
 
Fair
December 31, 2017
 
Cost (1)
 
OTTI
 
Value
 
Gains
 
Losses
 
Value
MBS and ABS:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other U.S. obligations -guaranteed MBS
 
$
3,299,157

 
$

 
$
3,299,157

 
$
6,555

 
$
(6,690
)
 
$
3,299,022

GSE MBS
 
2,553,193

 

 
2,553,193

 
26,727

 
(4,529
)
 
2,575,391

Private-label RMBS
 
37,889

 

 
37,889

 
240

 
(307
)
 
37,822

Private-label ABS
 
7,480

 
(51
)
 
7,429

 
40

 
(405
)
 
7,064

Total HTM securities
 
$
5,897,719

 
$
(51
)
 
$
5,897,668

 
$
33,562

 
$
(11,931
)
 
$
5,919,299

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
MBS and ABS:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other U.S. obligations -guaranteed MBS
 
$
2,678,437

 
$

 
$
2,678,437

 
$
5,412

 
$
(12,720
)
 
$
2,671,129

GSE MBS
 
3,082,343

 

 
3,082,343

 
46,480

 
(8,841
)
 
3,119,982

Private-label RMBS
 
49,748

 

 
49,748

 
61

 
(533
)
 
49,276

Private-label ABS
 
9,148

 
(103
)
 
9,045

 
40

 
(780
)
 
8,305

Total HTM securities
 
$
5,819,676

 
$
(103
)
 
$
5,819,573

 
$
51,993

 
$
(22,874
)
 
$
5,848,692


(1) 
Includes adjustments made to the cost basis of an investment for accretion, amortization, collection of principal, and, if applicable, OTTI recognized in earnings (credit losses).





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Unrealized Loss Positions. The following table presents impaired HTM securities (i.e., in an unrealized loss position), aggregated by major security type and length of time that individual securities have been in a continuous unrealized loss position.
 
 
Less than 12 months
 
12 months or more
 
Total
 
 
Estimated
 
Unrealized
 
Estimated
 
Unrealized
 
Estimated
 
Unrealized
December 31, 2017
 
Fair Value
 
Losses
 
Fair Value
 
Losses
 
Fair Value
 
Losses (1)
MBS and ABS:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other U.S. obligations - guaranteed MBS
 
$
1,140,624

 
$
(3,274
)
 
$
886,359

 
$
(3,416
)
 
$
2,026,983

 
$
(6,690
)
GSE MBS
 
513,244

 
(2,191
)
 
203,401

 
(2,338
)
 
716,645

 
(4,529
)
Private-label RMBS
 
14,712

 
(26
)
 
11,369

 
(281
)
 
26,081

 
(307
)
Private-label ABS
 

 

 
7,064

 
(416
)
 
7,064

 
(416
)
Total impaired HTM securities
 
$
1,668,580

 
$
(5,491
)
 
$
1,108,193

 
$
(6,451
)
 
$
2,776,773

 
$
(11,942
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
MBS and ABS:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other U.S. obligations - guaranteed MBS
 
$
367,474

 
$
(997
)
 
$
1,426,182

 
$
(11,723
)
 
$
1,793,656

 
$
(12,720
)
GSE MBS
 
1,281,827

 
(7,915
)
 
320,141

 
(926
)
 
1,601,968

 
(8,841
)
Private-label RMBS
 
18,166

 
(62
)
 
15,770

 
(471
)
 
33,936

 
(533
)
Private-label ABS
 

 

 
8,304

 
(843
)
 
8,304

 
(843
)
Total impaired HTM securities
 
$
1,667,467

 
$
(8,974
)
 
$
1,770,397

 
$
(13,963
)
 
$
3,437,864

 
$
(22,937
)

(1) 
For private-label ABS, the total of unrealized losses does not agree to total gross unrecognized holding losses at December 31, 2017 and 2016 of $405 and $780, respectively. Total unrealized losses include non-credit-related OTTI losses recorded in AOCI of $51 and $103, respectively, and gross unrecognized holding gains on previously OTTI securities of $40 and $40, respectively.

Contractual Maturity. MBS and ABS are not presented by contractual maturity because their actual maturities will likely differ from contractual maturities as certain borrowers have the right to prepay their obligations with or without prepayment fees.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Note 6 - Other-Than-Temporary Impairment

OTTI Evaluation Process and Results - Private-label RMBS and ABS. As described in Note 1 - Summary of Significant Accounting Policies, on a quarterly basis we evaluate our individual AFS and HTM investment securities for OTTI.

To ensure consistency in the determination of OTTI for private-label RMBS and ABS, all FHLBanks use a common framework and formal governance process to determine and approve the key OTTI modeling assumptions used for purposes of our cash flow analysis for substantially all of these securities.

Our evaluation includes a projection of future cash flows based on an assessment of the structure of each security and certain assumptions (some of which are determined based upon other assumptions) such as:

the remaining payment terms for the security;
market interest rates;
expected housing price changes; and
based on underlying loan-level borrower and loan characteristics:
prepayment speed;
default rate; and
loss severity on the collateral supporting our security.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


A significant modeling assumption is the forecast of future housing price changes for the relevant states and CBSAs, which are based upon an assessment of the individual housing markets. As currently defined, a CBSA must contain at least one urban area with a population of 10,000 or more people. The FHLBanks developed a short-term housing price forecast with projected changes ranging from a decrease of 5.0% to an increase of 12.0% over a twelve-month period. For the vast majority of markets, the changes range from an increase of 2.0% to an increase of 6.0%. Thereafter, a unique path is projected for each geographic area based on an internally developed framework derived from historical data.

The following table presents the other significant modeling assumptions used to determine the amount of credit loss recognized in earnings during the year ended December 31, 2017 on the two private-label RMBS for which an OTTI was determined to have occurred, as well as the related current credit enhancement.
 
 
Significant Modeling Assumptions

 
Current Credit
Classification (1)
 
Prepayment Rates
 
Default Rates
 
Loss Severities
 
Enhancement (2)
Prime
 
9
%
 
11
%
 
26
%
 
%
Subprime (3)
 
8
%
 
40
%
 
42
%
 
%

(1) 
The classification (prime, Alt-A or subprime) is based on the model used to project the cash flows for the security, which may not be the same as the rating agency's classification at the time of origination.
(2) 
Credit enhancement is defined as the percentage of subordinated tranches, excess spread, and over-collateralization, if any, in a security structure that will generally absorb losses before we will experience a loss on the security. A credit enhancement percentage of zero reflects a security that has no remaining credit support and is likely to have experienced an actual principal loss.
(3) 
Modeling assumptions assume no payout from monoline bond insurers.

Our cash flow analysis uses two third-party models to assess whether the entire amortized cost basis of each of our private-label RMBS and ABS will be recovered. Since the projected cash flows are based on a number of assumptions and expectations, the results of these models can vary significantly with changes in those assumptions and expectations. The scenario of cash flows determined based on the model approach reflects a best estimate scenario.

The first third-party model considers borrower characteristics, collateral characteristics and the particular attributes of the loans underlying our securities, in conjunction with the assumptions.

The month-by-month projections of future loan performance derived from the first model are then input into a second model that allocates the projected loan level cash flows and losses to the various security classes in the securitization structure in accordance with its prescribed cash flow and loss allocation rules. In a securitization in which the credit enhancement for the senior securities is derived from the presence of subordinate securities, losses are generally allocated first to the subordinate securities until their principal balances are reduced to zero.

In performing the detailed cash flow analysis, we determine the present value of the cash flows expected to be collected, discounted at the security's effective yield. For variable-rate and hybrid private-label RMBS, we use the effective interest rate derived from a variable-rate index (e.g., 12-month LIBOR) plus the contractual spread, plus or minus a fixed spread adjustment. As the implied forward curve of the index changes over time, the effective interest rates derived from that index will also change over time.

Results of OTTI Evaluation Process - Private-label RMBS and ABS. As part of our evaluation as described in Note 1 - Summary of Significant Accounting Policies, we did not have any change in intent to sell, nor were we required to sell, any OTTI security during the years ended December 31, 2017, 2016, or 2015. Therefore, we performed a cash flow analysis to determine whether we expect to recover the entire amortized cost of each security. As a result of our cash flow analysis, we recognized credit losses of $207, $197, and $61 during the years ended December 31, 2017, 2016, and 2015, respectively. We determined that the unrealized losses on the remaining private-label RMBS and ABS were temporary as we expect to recover the entire amortized cost.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


The following table presents a rollforward of the amounts related to credit losses recognized in earnings. The rollforward excludes accretion of credit losses for securities that have not experienced a significant increase in cash flows.
Credit Loss Rollforward
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
Balance at beginning of year
 
$
51,514

 
$
60,673

 
$
69,626

Additions:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Additional credit losses for which OTTI was previously recognized (1)
 
207

 
197

 
61

Reductions:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Increases in cash flows expected to be collected (accreted as interest income over the remaining lives of the applicable securities)
 
(6,786
)
 
(9,356
)
 
(9,014
)
Balance at end of year
 
$
44,935

 
$
51,514

 
$
60,673


(1) 
Relates to all securities impaired prior to January 1, 2017, 2016, and 2015, respectively.

The following table presents the December 31, 2017 classification and balances of OTTI securities impaired prior to that date (i.e., life-to-date) but not necessarily as of that date.
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
 
HTM Securities
 
AFS Securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Estimated
 
 
 
 
 
Estimated
OTTI Life-to-Date (1)
 
UPB
 
Amortized Cost
 
Carrying Value
 
Fair
Value
 
UPB
 
Amortized Cost
 
Fair
Value
Private-label RMBS - prime
 
$

 
$

 
$

 
$

 
$
224,574

 
$
189,212

 
$
218,534

Private-label ABS - subprime
 
552

 
487

 
436

 
476

 

 

 

Total
 
$
552

 
$
487

 
$
436

 
$
476

 
$
224,574

 
$
189,212

 
$
218,534


(1) 
Securities are classified based on the originator's classification at the time of origination or based on the classification by the NRSROs upon issuance. Because there is no universally accepted definition of prime, Alt-A or subprime underwriting standards, such classifications are subjective.

Evaluation Process and Results - All Other AFS and HTM Securities.

Other U.S. and GSE Obligations and TVA Debentures. For other U.S. obligations, GSE obligations, and TVA debentures, we determined that, based on current expectations, the strength of the issuers' guarantees through direct obligations of or support from the United States government is sufficient to protect us from any losses. As a result, all of the gross unrealized losses as of December 31, 2017 are considered temporary.

Note 7 - Advances

We offer a wide range of fixed- and adjustable-rate advance products with different maturities, interest rates, payment characteristics and optionality. Adjustable-rate advances have interest rates that reset periodically at a fixed spread to LIBOR or another specified index. Longer-term advances may be available subject to market conditions for both fixed-rate and adjustable-rate products.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


The following table presents advances outstanding by year of contractual maturity.
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Year of Contractual Maturity
 
Amount
 
WAIR %
 
Amount
 
WAIR %
Overdrawn demand and overnight deposit accounts
 
$

 

 
$

 

Due in 1 year or less
 
16,935,411

 
1.46

 
12,598,864

 
0.91

Due after 1 year through 2 years
 
2,701,784

 
1.96

 
2,752,629

 
1.74

Due after 2 years through 3 years
 
2,682,073

 
1.69

 
1,920,962

 
2.10

Due after 3 years through 4 years
 
2,172,549

 
1.78

 
2,605,198

 
1.38

Due after 4 years through 5 years
 
2,213,319

 
1.93

 
2,009,395

 
1.47

Thereafter
 
7,464,333

 
1.66

 
6,244,912

 
1.20

Total advances, par value
 
34,169,469

 
1.61

 
28,131,960

 
1.22

Fair-value hedging adjustments
 
(126,137
)
 
 

 
(57,716
)
 
 

Unamortized swap termination fees associated with modified advances, net of deferred prepayment fees
 
11,732

 
 

 
21,709

 
 

Total advances
 
$
34,055,064

 
 

 
$
28,095,953

 
 


We offer our members certain advances that provide them the right, at predetermined future dates, to call (i.e., prepay) the advance prior to maturity without incurring prepayment or termination fees. Borrowers typically exercise their call options for fixed-rate advances when interest rates decline. We also offer certain adjustable-rate advances that may be contractually prepaid by the borrower at the interest-rate reset date without incurring prepayment or termination fees. All other advances may only be prepaid by paying a fee that is sufficient to make us financially indifferent to the prepayment of the advance. We also offer putable advances. Under the terms of a putable advance, we retain the right to extinguish or put the fixed-rate advance to the member on predetermined future dates and offer replacement funding at prevailing market rates, subject to certain conditions.

The following table presents advances outstanding by the earlier of the year of contractual maturity or the next call date and next put date.
 
 
Year of Contractual Maturity
or Next Call Date
 
Year of Contractual Maturity
or Next Put Date
 
 
December 31,
2017
 
December 31,
2016
 
December 31,
2017
 
December 31,
2016
Overdrawn demand and overnight deposit accounts
 
$

 
$

 
$

 
$

Due in 1 year or less
 
25,067,272

 
19,390,714

 
17,032,411

 
12,767,364

Due after 1 year through 2 years
 
2,412,184

 
2,502,629

 
2,701,784

 
2,757,629

Due after 2 years through 3 years
 
1,716,873

 
1,856,463

 
3,406,673

 
1,915,962

Due after 3 years through 4 years
 
928,649

 
1,548,998

 
2,718,049

 
2,605,198

Due after 4 years through 5 years
 
1,494,529

 
900,095

 
2,524,619

 
2,535,895

Thereafter
 
2,549,962

 
1,933,061

 
5,785,933

 
5,549,912

Total advances, par value
 
$
34,169,469

 
$
28,131,960

 
$
34,169,469

 
$
28,131,960


In accordance with the Final Membership Rule, captive insurance companies that were admitted as FHLBank members on or after September 12, 2014 repaid all of their outstanding advances and had their memberships terminated by February 19, 2017.

Under the Final Membership Rule, captive insurance companies that were admitted as FHLBank members prior to September 12, 2014, and do not meet the new definition of "insurance company" or fall within another category of institution that is eligible for FHLBank membership, shall have their memberships terminated no later than February 19, 2021. Prior to termination, new or renewed extensions of credit to such members will be subject to certain restrictions relating to maturity dates and the ratio of advances to the captive insurer's total assets and may be subject to additional restrictions at our discretion. The outstanding advances to these captive insurers mature on various dates through 2025.
 
 
 
 
 




Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Credit Risk Exposure and Security Terms. We lend to members according to Federal statutes, including the Bank Act. The Bank Act requires each FHLBank to hold, or have access to, collateral to fully secure its advances. At December 31, 2017 and 2016, our top five borrowers held 45% and 43%, respectively, of total advances outstanding, at par. As security for the advances to these and our other borrowers, we held, or had access to, collateral with an estimated fair value at December 31, 2017 and 2016 that was well in excess of the advances outstanding on those dates, respectively. See Note 9 - Allowance for Credit Losses for information related to credit risk on advances and allowance methodology for credit losses.

Note 8 - Mortgage Loans Held for Portfolio

Mortgage loans held for portfolio consist of residential loans acquired from our members through the MPP and participating interests purchased in 2012 - 2014 from the FHLBank of Topeka in residential loans that were originated by certain of its PFIs through their participation in the MPF Program offered by the FHLBank of Chicago. The MPP and MPF Program loans are fixed rate and either credit enhanced by PFIs, if conventional, or guaranteed or insured by government agencies.

The following tables present information on mortgage loans held for portfolio by term and type.
Term
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Fixed-rate long-term mortgages
 
$
8,989,545

 
$
8,086,412

Fixed-rate medium-term (1) mortgages
 
1,134,303

 
1,206,978

Total mortgage loans held for portfolio, UPB
 
10,123,848


9,293,390

Unamortized premiums
 
234,519

 
210,116

Unamortized discounts
 
(2,426
)
 
(2,383
)
Fair-value hedging adjustments
 
1,250

 
1,124

Allowance for loan losses
 
(850
)
 
(850
)
Total mortgage loans held for portfolio, net
 
$
10,356,341


$
9,501,397


(1) 
Defined as a term of 15 years or less at origination.
Type
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Conventional
 
$
9,701,600

 
$
8,796,407

Government -guaranteed or -insured
 
422,248

 
496,983

Total mortgage loans held for portfolio, UPB
 
$
10,123,848

 
$
9,293,390

 
 
 
 
 
In December 2016, we agreed to sell a 90% participating interest in a $100 million MCC of certain newly acquired MPP loans to the FHLBank of Atlanta. Principal amounts settled in December 2016 totaled $72 million, and the remaining $18 million settled in January 2017.

See Note 9 - Allowance for Credit Losses for information related to our credit risk on mortgage loans and allowance methodology for loan losses.

Note 9 - Allowance for Credit Losses

We have established a methodology to determine the allowance for credit losses for each of our portfolio segments: credit products (advances, letters of credit, and other extensions of credit to members); term securities purchased under agreements to resell and term federal funds sold; government-guaranteed or -insured mortgage loans held for portfolio; and conventional mortgage loans held for portfolio.

Credit Products. We manage our exposure to credit products through an integrated approach that generally includes establishing a credit limit for each borrower, and an ongoing review of each borrower's financial condition, coupled with conservative collateral/lending policies to limit the risk of loss while balancing the borrower's needs for a reliable source of funding. In addition, we lend to eligible borrowers in accordance with federal statutes and Finance Agency regulations. Specifically, we comply with the Bank Act, which requires us to obtain sufficient collateral to fully secure credit products. We evaluate and update our collateral guidelines, as necessary, based on current market conditions.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


We accept certain investment securities, residential mortgage loans, deposits, and other real estate-related assets as collateral. In addition, certain members that qualify as CFIs are eligible to utilize expanded statutory collateral provisions for small business and agriculture loans. Under the Bank Act, our members' capital stock in our Bank serves as additional security. Collateral arrangements may vary depending upon borrower credit quality, financial condition and performance; borrowing capacity; and overall credit exposure to the borrower. To ensure that we are sufficiently protected, we evaluate and determine whether a member may retain physical possession of its collateral that is pledged to us or must specifically deliver the collateral to us or our safekeeping agent. We perfect our security interest in all pledged collateral and we can also require additional or substitute collateral to protect our security interest.

We determine the estimated value of the collateral required to secure each member's credit products by applying collateral discounts, or haircuts, to the market value or UPB of the collateral, as applicable. Using a risk-based approach, we consider the amount and quality of the collateral pledged and the borrower's financial condition to be the primary indicators of credit quality on the borrower's credit products. At December 31, 2017 and 2016, we had rights to collateral on a borrower-by-borrower basis with an estimated value in excess of our outstanding extensions of credit.

At December 31, 2017 and 2016, we did not have any credit products that were past due, on non-accrual status, or considered impaired. In addition, there were no TDRs related to credit products during the years ended December 31, 2017, 2016, or 2015.

Based upon the collateral held as security, our credit extension and collateral policies, our credit analysis and the repayment history on credit products, we have not recorded any allowance for credit losses on credit products, and no liability was recorded to reflect an allowance for credit losses for off-balance sheet credit exposures. For additional information about off-balance sheet credit exposure, see Note 20 - Commitments and Contingencies.

Term Securities Purchased Under Agreements to Resell and Term Federal Funds Sold. These assets generally have maturities ranging from 1 to 270 days. Given their short-term nature and the credit quality of the counterparties, credit risk is minimal and, as such, we have not established an allowance for credit losses for these products.

Government-Guaranteed or -Insured Mortgage Loans. We invest in fixed-rate mortgage loans that are guaranteed or insured by the FHA, Department of Veterans Affairs, Rural Housing Service of the Department of Agriculture, or HUD. The servicer provides and maintains a guaranty or insurance from the applicable government agency. The servicer is responsible for compliance with all government agency requirements and for obtaining the benefit of the applicable guaranty or insurance with respect to defaulted government-guaranteed or -insured mortgage loans. Any losses incurred on these loans that are not recovered from the insurer or guarantor are absorbed by the servicers. Therefore, we did not establish an allowance for credit losses for government-guaranteed or -insured mortgage loans at December 31, 2017 or 2016.

Conventional Mortgage Loans. We invest in conventional mortgage loans primarily through the MPP. Additionally, we hold participating interests in conventional mortgage loans that were originated by PFIs of the FHLBank of Topeka through the MPF Program.

Conventional MPP. Our management of credit risk considers the several layers of loss protection that are defined in our agreements with the PFIs. Our loss protection consists of the following loss layers, in order of priority, (i) borrower equity; (ii) PMI up to coverage limits (when applicable for the acquisition of mortgages with an initial LTV ratio of over 80% at the time of purchase); (iii) available funds remaining in the LRA; and (iv) SMI coverage (as applicable) purchased by the seller from a third-party provider naming the Bank as the beneficiary, up to the policy limits. Any losses not absorbed by the loss protection are borne by the Bank.

For conventional mortgage loans under our original MPP, credit enhancement is provided through allocating a portion of the periodic interest payments on the loans into an LRA. In addition, the PFI selling conventional loans to us is required to purchase SMI, paid through periodic interest payments, as an enhancement to cover credit losses over and above those covered by the LRA, but the covered losses are limited to the terms of the policy.

Beginning with MPP Advantage, we discontinued the use of SMI for all loan purchases and replaced it with a fixed LRA. The fixed LRA is funded with a portion of each loan's purchase proceeds.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


The LRA is segregated by pools of loans and used to cover losses in a pool beyond those covered by an individual loan's PMI (as applicable), but is limited to covering losses of that specific pool only. Any excess funds are ultimately distributed to the member in accordance with a step-down schedule that is established upon execution of an MCC, subject to performance of the related pool.

The following table presents the activity in the LRA, which is reported in other liabilities.
LRA Activity
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
Liability, beginning of year
 
$
125,683

 
$
91,552

 
$
61,949

Additions
 
25,350

 
36,341

 
31,573

Claims paid
 
(617
)
 
(1,054
)
 
(1,576
)
Distributions to PFIs
 
(1,701
)
 
(1,156
)
 
(394
)
Liability, end of year
 
$
148,715

 
$
125,683

 
$
91,552


We determine our allowance for loan losses based on our best estimate of probable losses over the loss emergence period. We use the MPP portfolio's delinquency migration (movement of loans through the various stages of delinquency) to determine whether a loss event is probable. Once a loss event is deemed to be probable, we utilize a systematic methodology that incorporates all credit enhancements and servicer advances to establish the allowance for loan losses. Although we do not reserve for any estimated losses that would be recovered from the credit enhancements, as part of the estimate of the recoverable credit enhancements, we evaluate the recovery and collectability of amounts under our PMI/SMI policies.

Conventional MPF Program. Our management of credit risk in the MPF Program considers the several layers of loss protection that are defined in agreements among the FHLBank of Topeka and its PFIs. The availability of loss protection may differ slightly among MPF products. The loss layers, in order of priority, are (i) borrower equity; (ii) PMI, (when applicable for the purchase of mortgages with an initial LTV ratio of over 80% at the time of purchase); (iii) FLA, which represents the first layer or portion of credit losses that we absorb after the borrower's equity, PMI, and recoverable CE fees; and (iv) the CE Obligation of a PFI, which absorbs losses in excess of the FLA in order to limit our loss exposure to that of an investor in an MBS deemed to be investment-grade. Any losses not absorbed by the loss protection are shared among the participating FHLBanks based upon the applicable percentage of participation.

PFIs retain a portion of the credit risk on the loans they sell by providing credit enhancement through a direct liability to pay credit losses up to a specified amount. PFIs are paid a CE fee for assuming credit risk and, in some instances, all or a portion of the CE fee may be performance-based. To the extent the Bank is responsible for losses in a pool, it may be able to recapture CE fees paid to that PFI to offset those losses. All CE fees are paid monthly based on the remaining UPB of the loans in a pool.

The allowance for MPF Program conventional loans is determined by analyzing the portfolio's delinquency migration and charge-offs over a historical period to determine the probability of default and loss severity rates. The analysis of conventional loans evaluated for impairment (i) considers loan pool-specific attribute data; (ii) applies estimated default probabilities and loss severities; and (iii) incorporates the applicable credit enhancements in order to determine our best estimate of probable losses.

Collectively Evaluated Mortgage Loans.

MPP. For performing conventional loans current to 179 days past due and collectively evaluated for impairment, we use a recognized third-party credit model to estimate potential ranges of credit loss exposure. The loss projection is based upon distinct underlying loan characteristics, including loan vintage (year of origination), geographic location, credit support features and other factors, and a projected migration of loans through the various stages of delinquency.

For delinquent conventional loans past due 180 days or more and collectively evaluated for impairment, we evaluate the pools based on current and historical information and events. This loan loss analysis incorporates third-party modeled values and considers MPP pool-specific attribute data, estimated liquidation values of real estate collateral held, estimated costs associated with maintaining and disposing of the collateral, and credit enhancements.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


MPF Program. Our loan loss analysis includes collectively evaluating conventional loans for impairment within each pool. The measurement of the allowance for loan losses consists of (i) evaluating homogeneous pools of current and delinquent mortgage loans; and (ii) estimating credit losses in the pool based upon the default probability ratios, loss severity rates, FLAs and CE obligations. Additional analyses include consideration of various data observations such as past performance, current performance, loan portfolio characteristics, collateral-related characteristics, industry data and prevailing economic conditions.

Individually Evaluated Mortgage Loans.

The measurement of our allowance for loans individually evaluated for loss considers loan-specific attribution data similar to homogeneous pools of delinquent loans evaluated on a collective basis, including the use of loan-level property values from a third-party.

We also individually evaluate any remaining exposure to delinquent MPP conventional loans paid in full by the servicers. An estimate of the loss, if any, is equal to the estimated cost associated with maintaining and disposing of the property (which includes the UPB, interest owed on the delinquent loan to date, and estimated costs associated with disposing of the collateral) less the estimated fair value of the collateral (net of estimated selling costs) and the amount of credit enhancements including the PMI, LRA and SMI. The fair value of the collateral is obtained from HUD statements, sales listings or other evidence of current expected liquidation amounts.

Individually Evaluated Impaired Loans. The tables below present the conventional loans individually evaluated for impairment with and without an allowance for loan losses. Due to the minimal change in terms of modified loans (i.e., no principal forgiven), our pre-modification recorded investment in TDRs was not materially different than the post-modification recorded investment.
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016


Individually Evaluated
Impaired Loans
 
Recorded Investment
 
UPB
 
Related Allowance for Loan Losses
 
Recorded Investment
 
UPB
 
Related Allowance for Loan Losses
MPP conventional loans without allowance for loan losses (1)
 
$
13,261

 
$
13,343

 
$

 
$
15,158

 
$
15,219

 
$

MPP conventional loans with allowance for loan losses
 
1,270

 
1,272

 
54

 
349

 
358

 
30

Total
 
$
14,531

 
$
14,615

 
$
54

 
$
15,507

 
$
15,577

 
$
30


(1) 
No allowance for loan losses was recorded on these impaired loans after consideration of the underlying loan-specific attribute data, estimated liquidation value of real estate collateral held, estimated costs associated with maintaining and disposing of the collateral, and credit enhancements.
 
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015


Individually Evaluated Impaired Loans
 
Average Recorded Investment
 
Interest
Income Recognized
 
Average Recorded Investment
 
Interest
Income Recognized
 
Average Recorded Investment
 
Interest Income Recognized
MPP conventional loans without allowance for loan losses
 
$
14,011

 
$
675

 
$
16,623

 
$
758

 
$
17,967

 
$
872

MPP conventional loans with allowance for loan losses
 
1,259

 
69

 
353

 
39

 
881

 
105

Total
 
$
15,270

 
$
744

 
$
16,976

 
$
797

 
$
18,848

 
$
977






Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Credit Quality Indicators. The tables below present the key credit quality indicators for our mortgage loans held for portfolio.
Delinquency Status as of December 31, 2017
 
Conventional
 
Government
 
Total
Past due:
 
 
 
 
 
 
30-59 days
 
$
63,670

 
$
11,848

 
$
75,518

60-89 days
 
9,944

 
2,121

 
12,065

90 days or more
 
19,576

 
2,555

 
22,131

Total past due
 
93,190

 
16,524

 
109,714

Total current
 
9,878,030

 
412,869

 
10,290,899

Total mortgage loans, recorded investment (1)
 
$
9,971,220

 
$
429,393

 
$
10,400,613

Delinquency Status as of December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
Past due:
 
 
 
 
 
 
30-59 days
 
$
46,118

 
$
17,183

 
$
63,301

60-89 days
 
11,044

 
3,548

 
14,592

90 days or more
 
29,098

 
2,350

 
31,448

Total past due
 
86,260

 
23,081

 
109,341

Total current
 
8,949,441

 
482,316

 
9,431,757

Total mortgage loans, recorded investment (1)
 
$
9,035,701

 
$
505,397

 
$
9,541,098


Other Delinquency Statistics as of December 31, 2017
 
Conventional
 
Government
 
Total
In process of foreclosure (2)
 
$
11,081

 
$

 
$
11,081

Serious delinquency rate (3)
 
0.20
%
 
0.59
%
 
0.21
%
Past due 90 days or more still accruing interest (4)
 
$
16,603

 
$
2,555

 
$
19,158

On non-accrual status
 
$
3,464

 
$

 
$
3,464

Other Delinquency Statistics as of December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
In process of foreclosure (2)
 
$
17,749

 
$

 
$
17,749

Serious delinquency rate (3)
 
0.32
%
 
0.46
%
 
0.33
%
Past due 90 days or more still accruing interest (4)
 
$
25,375

 
$
2,350

 
$
27,725

On non-accrual status
 
$
4,699

 
$

 
$
4,699


(1) 
The recorded investment in a loan is the UPB of the loan, adjusted for accrued interest, net of any deferred loan fees or costs, unamortized premiums or discounts (which may include the basis adjustment related to any gain or loss on a delivery commitment prior to being funded) and direct charge-offs. The recorded investment is not net of any valuation allowance.
(2) 
Includes loans for which the decision of foreclosure or similar alternative, such as pursuit of deed-in-lieu of foreclosure, has been reported. Loans in process of foreclosure are included in past due categories depending on their delinquency status, but are not necessarily considered to be on non-accrual status.
(3) 
Represents loans 90 days or more past due (including loans in process of foreclosure) expressed as a percentage of the total recorded investment in mortgage loans. The percentage excludes principal and interest amounts previously paid in full by the servicers on conventional loans that are pending resolution of potential loss claims. Our servicers repurchase seriously delinquent government loans, including FHA loans, when certain criteria are met.
(4) 
Although our past due scheduled/scheduled MPP loans are classified as loans past due 90 days or more based on the mortgagor's payment status, we do not consider these loans to be on non-accrual status.

Qualitative Factors. We also assess qualitative factors in the estimation of loan losses. These factors represent a subjective management judgment based on facts and circumstances that exist as of the reporting date that is not ascribed to any specific measurable economic or credit event and is intended to address other inherent losses that may not otherwise be captured in our methodology.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Allowance for Loan Losses on Mortgage Loans. Our loan loss analysis also compares, or benchmarks, our estimated losses, after credit enhancements, to actual losses occurring in the portfolio. As a result of our methodology, our allowance for loan losses reflects our best estimate of the probable losses in our original MPP, MPP Advantage, and MPF Program portfolios.

The following table presents the components of the allowance for loan losses, including the credit enhancement waterfall for MPP.
Components of Allowance
 
December 31,
2017
 
December 31,
2016
MPP estimated incurred losses remaining after borrower's equity, before credit enhancements (1)
 
$
5,360

 
$
8,689

Portion of estimated incurred losses recoverable from credit enhancements:
 
 
 
 
PMI
 
(995
)
 
(1,981
)
LRA (2)
 
(1,262
)
 
(2,418
)
SMI
 
(2,383
)
 
(3,590
)
Total portion recoverable from credit enhancements
 
(4,640
)
 
(7,989
)
Allowance for unrecoverable PMI/SMI
 
30

 
50

Allowance for MPP loan losses
 
750

 
750

Allowance for MPF Program loan losses
 
100

 
100

Total allowance for loan losses
 
$
850

 
$
850


(1) 
Based on a loss emergence period of 24 months.
(2) 
Amounts recoverable are limited to (i) the estimated losses remaining after borrower's equity and PMI and (ii) the remaining balance in each pool's portion of the LRA. The remainder of the total LRA balance is available to cover any losses not yet incurred and to distribute any excess funds to the PFIs.

The tables below present a rollforward of our allowance for loan losses, the allowance for loan losses by impairment methodology, and the recorded investment in mortgage loans by impairment methodology.
Rollforward of Allowance for Loan Losses
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
Balance, beginning of year
 
$
850

 
$
1,125

 
$
2,500

Charge-offs
 
(647
)
 
(857
)
 
(1,168
)
Recoveries
 
596

 
627

 
249

Provision for (reversal of) loan losses
 
51

 
(45
)
 
(456
)
Balance, end of year
 
$
850

 
$
850

 
$
1,125


Allowance for Loan Losses by Impairment Methodology
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Conventional loans collectively evaluated for impairment
 
$
652

 
$
750

Conventional loans individually evaluated for impairment (1)
 
198

 
100

Total allowance for loan losses
 
$
850

 
$
850

 
 
 
 
 
Recorded Investment by Impairment Methodology
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Conventional loans collectively evaluated for impairment
 
$
9,956,689

 
$
9,020,194

Conventional loans individually evaluated for impairment (1)
 
14,531

 
15,507

Total recorded investment in conventional loans
 
$
9,971,220

 
$
9,035,701


(1) 
The recorded investment in our MPP conventional loans individually evaluated for impairment excludes principal previously paid in full by the servicers as of December 31, 2017 and 2016 of $2,498 and $2,814, respectively, that remains subject to potential claims by those servicers for any losses resulting from past or future liquidations of the underlying properties. However, the MPP allowance for loan losses as of December 31, 2017 and 2016 includes $144 and $70, respectively, for these potential claims.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Note 10 - Premises, Software and Equipment

The following table presents information on our premises, software and equipment.
Type
 
December 31,
2017
 
December 31,
2016
Premises
 
$
15,242

 
$
14,958

Computer software
 
38,559

 
38,497

Data processing equipment
 
8,846

 
7,505

Furniture and equipment
 
4,539

 
3,920

Other
 
563

 
513

Premises, software and equipment, in service
 
67,749

 
65,393

Accumulated depreciation and amortization
 
(36,085
)
 
(30,121
)
Premises, software and equipment, in service, net
 
31,664

 
35,272

Capitalized assets in progress
 
5,131

 
2,366

Premises, software and equipment, net
 
$
36,795

 
$
37,638


For the years ended December 31, 2017, 2016, and 2015, the depreciation and amortization expense for premises, software and equipment was $5,965, $5,820, and $5,461, respectively, including amortization of computer software costs of $4,276, $4,055, and $3,633, respectively.

Note 11 - Derivatives and Hedging Activities

Nature of Business Activity. We are exposed to interest-rate risk primarily from the effect of changes in market interest rates on our interest-earning assets and our interest-bearing liabilities that finance those assets. The goal of our interest-rate risk management strategies is not to eliminate interest-rate risk, but to manage it within appropriate limits. To mitigate the risk of loss, we have established policies and procedures, which include guidelines on the amount of exposure to interest rate changes we are willing to accept. In addition, we monitor the risk to our interest income, net interest margin and average maturity of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities.

Consistent with Finance Agency regulation, we enter into derivatives to (i) manage the interest-rate risk exposures inherent in our otherwise unhedged assets and funding positions, (ii) achieve our risk management objectives, and (iii) act as an intermediary between our members and counterparties. Finance Agency regulation and our Capital Markets Policy prohibit trading in, or the speculative use of, these derivative instruments and limit credit risk arising from these instruments. However, the use of derivatives is an integral part of our financial management strategy.

We use derivative financial instruments when they are considered to be the most cost-effective alternative to achieve our financial and risk management objectives. The most common ways in which we use derivatives are to:

reduce funding costs by executing a derivative concurrently with the issuance of a consolidated obligation as the cost of a combined funding structure can be lower than the cost of a comparable CO bond;
reduce the interest-rate sensitivity and repricing gaps of assets and liabilities;
preserve a favorable interest-rate spread between the yield of an asset (e.g., an advance) and the cost of the related liability (e.g., CO bond used to fund advance);
mitigate the adverse earnings effects of the shortening or extension of the duration of certain assets (e.g., advances or mortgage assets) and liabilities;
protect the value of existing asset and liability positions or of commitments and forecasted transactions;
manage embedded options in assets and liabilities; and
manage our overall asset/liability structure.

We reevaluate our hedging strategies from time to time and, consequently, we may adopt new strategies or change our hedging techniques.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


We transact most of our derivatives with large banks and major broker-dealers. Some of these banks and broker-dealers or their affiliates buy, sell, and distribute consolidated obligations. We are not a derivatives dealer and thus do not trade derivatives for short-term profit. Over-the-counter derivative transactions may be either executed with a counterparty (uncleared derivatives) or cleared through a Futures Commission Merchant (i.e., clearing agent) with a clearinghouse (cleared derivatives). Once a derivative transaction has been accepted for clearing by a clearinghouse, the derivative transaction is novated, and the executing counterparty is replaced with the clearinghouse.

Types of Derivatives. We use the following derivative instruments to reduce funding costs and to manage our exposure to interest-rate risks inherent in the normal course of business.

Interest-Rate Swaps. An interest-rate swap is an agreement between two entities to exchange cash flows in the future. The agreement sets forth the manner in which the cash flows will be determined and the dates on which they will be paid. One of the simplest forms of interest-rate swap involves the promise by one party to pay cash flows equivalent to the interest on a notional amount at a predetermined fixed rate for a given period of time. In return for this promise, the party receives cash flows equivalent to the interest on the same notional amount at a variable-rate index for the same period of time. The variable rate we receive or pay in most interest-rate swaps is indexed to LIBOR.

Interest-Rate Cap and Floor Agreements. In an interest-rate cap agreement, a cash flow is generated if the price or rate of an underlying variable rises above a certain threshold (or "cap") price. In an interest-rate floor agreement, a cash flow is generated if the price or rate of an underlying variable falls below a certain threshold (or "floor") price. Caps may be used in conjunction with liabilities, and floors may be used in conjunction with assets. Caps and floors are designed to protect against the interest rate on a variable-rate asset or liability falling below or rising above a certain level.

Interest-Rate Swaptions. A swaption is an option on a swap that gives the buyer the right, but not the obligation, to enter into a specified interest-rate swap with the following agreed upon terms with the seller: option premium, time until expiration, fixed vs. floating rates, and notional amount. When used as a hedge, a swaption can protect the buyer against sudden adverse moves in interest rates. To protect against the adverse effects of a sudden decrease in interest rates, a receiver swaption may be utilized in which the buyer has the option to enter into a swap to receive the fixed rate and pay the floating rate. To protect against the adverse effects of a sudden increase in interest rates, a payer swaption may be utilized in which the buyer has the option to enter into a swap to pay the fixed rate and receive the floating rate.

Forward Contracts. Forward contracts give the buyer the right to buy or sell a specific type of asset at a specific time at a given price. We may use forward contracts in order to hedge interest-rate risk. For example, certain MDCs entered into by us are considered derivatives. We may hedge these MDCs by selling TBAs for forward settlement.

Types of Hedged Items. We document at inception all relationships between the derivatives designated as hedging instruments and the hedged items, our risk management objectives and strategies for undertaking various hedge transactions, and our method of assessing effectiveness. This process includes linking all derivatives that are designated as fair-value hedges to (i) assets and liabilities on the statements of condition, or (ii) firm commitments. We also formally assess (both at the hedge's inception and at least quarterly), using regression analyses, whether the derivatives that are used in hedging transactions have been effective in offsetting changes in the fair value of the hedged items attributable to the hedged risk and whether those derivatives may be expected to remain effective in future periods. We have the following types of hedged items:

Investments. We primarily invest in agency MBS and GSE debentures, which may be classified as HTM or AFS securities. The interest-rate and prepayment risks associated with these investment securities are managed through a combination of debt issuance and derivatives. We may manage the prepayment, interest-rate and duration risks by funding investment securities with consolidated obligations that contain call features or by hedging the prepayment risk with caps or floors, callable swaps or swaptions. We may also manage the risk and volatility arising from changing market prices of investment securities by matching the cash outflow on the derivatives with the cash inflow on the investment securities. On occasion, we may hold derivatives that are associated with HTM securities and are designated as economic hedges. Derivatives associated with AFS securities may qualify as a fair-value hedge or be designated as an economic hedge.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Advances. We offer a wide range of fixed and variable-rate advance products with different maturities, interest rates, payment characteristics, and optionality. We may use derivatives to manage the repricing and/or options characteristics of advances in order to more closely match the characteristics of our funding liabilities. In general, whenever a member executes a fixed-rate advance or an adjustable-rate advance with embedded options, we may simultaneously execute a derivative with terms that offset the terms and embedded options in the advance. For example, we may hedge a fixed-rate advance with an interest-rate swap where we pay a fixed-rate and receive a variable-rate effectively converting the fixed-rate advance to an adjustable-rate advance. This type of hedge is typically treated as a fair-value hedge. In addition, we may hedge a callable, prepayable or putable advance by entering into a cancellable interest-rate swap.

Mortgage Loans. We invest in fixed-rate mortgage loans. The prepayment options embedded in these mortgage loans can result in extensions or contractions in the expected repayment of these loans, depending on changes in prepayment speeds. We manage the interest-rate and prepayment risks associated with mortgage loans through a combination of debt issuance and derivatives. We issue both callable and noncallable debt and prepayment-linked consolidated obligations to achieve cash flow patterns and liability durations similar to those expected on the mortgage loans. Interest-rate swaps, to the extent the payments on the mortgages loans result in a simultaneous reduction of the notional amount of the swaps, may qualify for fair-value hedge accounting.

We may also purchase interest-rate caps and floors, swaptions, callable swaps, calls, and puts to minimize the prepayment risk embedded in the loans. Although these derivatives are valid economic hedges against the prepayment risk of the loans, they are not specifically linked to individual loans and, therefore, do not qualify for fair-value hedge accounting. These derivatives are marked to market value through earnings.

Consolidated Obligations. We may enter into derivatives to hedge the interest-rate risk associated with our debt issues. We manage the risk and volatility arising from changing market prices of a consolidated obligation by matching the cash inflow on the derivative with the cash outflow on the consolidated obligation.

In a typical transaction, we issue a fixed-rate consolidated obligation and simultaneously enter into a matching derivative in which the counterparty pays fixed cash flows to us designed to match in timing and amount the cash outflows we pay on the consolidated obligation. In turn, we pay a variable cash flow to the counterparty that closely matches the interest payments we receive on short-term or variable-rate advances (typically one- or three-month LIBOR). These transactions are typically treated as fair-value hedges. Additionally, we may issue variable-rate CO bonds indexed to LIBOR, the United States prime rate, or federal funds rate and simultaneously execute interest-rate swaps to hedge the basis risk of the variable-rate debt.

Firm Commitments. Certain MDCs are considered derivatives. We normally hedge these commitments by selling TBA MBS or other derivatives for forward settlement. The MDC and the TBA used in the firm commitment hedging strategy are treated as an economic hedge and are marked to market through earnings. When the MDC derivative settles, the current market value of the commitment is included with the basis of the mortgage loan and amortized accordingly.

Managing Credit Risk on Derivatives. We are subject to credit risk due to the risk of nonperformance by the counterparties to our derivative transactions. We manage counterparty credit risk through credit analysis, collateral requirements and adherence to the requirements set forth in our policies, CFTC regulations, and Finance Agency regulations. See Note 19 - Estimated Fair Values for discussion regarding our fair value methodology for derivative assets and liabilities, including an evaluation of the potential for the estimated fair value of these instruments to be affected by counterparty credit risk.

Uncleared Derivatives. For uncleared derivatives, the degree of credit risk depends on the extent to which master netting arrangements are included in such contracts to mitigate the risk. We require collateral agreements with our uncleared derivatives. The exposure thresholds above which collateral must be delivered vary; the threshold is zero in some cases. Additionally, collateral related to derivatives with member institutions includes collateral assigned to us as evidenced by a written security agreement and held by the member institution for our benefit.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


For certain of our uncleared derivatives, we have credit support agreements that contain provisions requiring us to post additional collateral with our counterparties if there is deterioration in our credit rating. If our credit rating is lowered by an NRSRO, we could be required to deliver additional collateral on uncleared derivative instruments in net liability positions. The aggregate estimated fair value of all uncleared derivative instruments with credit-risk-related contingent features that were in a net liability position (before cash collateral and related accrued interest on cash collateral) at December 31, 2017 was $644, for which we have posted collateral, including accrued interest, with an estimated fair value of $34 in the normal course of business. In addition, we held other derivative instruments in a net liability position of $49 that are not subject to credit support agreements containing credit-risk related contingent features. If our credit rating had been lowered by an NRSRO (from an S&P equivalent of AA+ to AA), we would not have been required to deliver additional collateral to our uncleared derivative counterparties at December 31, 2017.

Cleared Derivatives. For cleared derivatives, the clearinghouse is our counterparty. We use LCH and CME as clearinghouses for all cleared derivative transactions. Collateral is required to be posted daily for changes in the value of cleared derivatives to mitigate each counterparty's credit risk. The clearinghouse notifies the clearing agent of the required initial and variation margin, and the clearing agent notifies us. The requirement that we post initial and variation margin through the clearing agent for the benefit of the clearinghouse exposes us to institutional credit risk in the event that the clearing agent or clearinghouse fails to meet its obligations.

Effective January 3, 2017, CME made certain amendments to its rulebook, including changing the legal characterization of variation margin payments to be daily settled contracts, rather than cash collateral. Variation margin payments related to LCH contracts were characterized as cash collateral until January 16, 2018, when LCH changed the characterization of variation margin payments to be daily settled contracts, consistent with CME. Initial margin continues to be considered by both clearinghouses as cash collateral.

The clearinghouse determines margin requirements which are generally not based on credit ratings. However, clearing agents may require additional margin to be posted by us based on credit considerations, including but not limited to any credit rating downgrades. At December 31, 2017, we were not required by our clearing agents to post any additional margin.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Financial Statement Effect and Additional Financial Information.

Derivative Notional Amounts. The notional amount of derivatives serves as a factor in determining periodic interest payments, or cash flows received and paid. The notional amount of derivatives also reflects the extent of our involvement in the various classes of financial instruments but represents neither the actual amounts exchanged nor our overall exposure to credit and market risk; the overall risk is much smaller. The risks of derivatives can be measured meaningfully on a portfolio basis that takes into account the counterparties, the types of derivatives, the items being hedged and any offsets between the derivatives and the items being hedged. The following table presents the notional amount and estimated fair value of derivative assets and liabilities.
 
 
Notional
 
Estimated Fair Value
 
Estimated Fair Value
 
 
Amount of
 
of Derivative
 
of Derivative
December 31, 2017
 
Derivatives
 
Assets
 
Liabilities
Derivatives designated as hedging instruments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-rate swaps
 
$
31,084,068

 
$
298,625

 
$
76,205

Total derivatives designated as hedging instruments
 
31,084,068

 
298,625

 
76,205

Derivatives not designated as hedging instruments:
 
 

 
 

 
 

Interest-rate swaps
 
1,026,778

 
1,187

 
734

Swaptions
 

 

 

Interest-rate caps/floors
 
245,500

 
92

 

Interest-rate forwards
 
72,800

 
37

 
1

MDCs
 
70,831

 
73

 
48

Total derivatives not designated as hedging instruments
 
1,415,909

 
1,389

 
783

Total derivatives before adjustments
 
$
32,499,977

 
300,014

 
76,988

Netting adjustments (1)
 
 

 
(150,868
)
 
(150,868
)
Cash collateral and variation margin for daily settled contracts (1)
 
 

 
(20,940
)
 
76,598

Total derivatives, net
 
 

 
$
128,206

 
$
2,718

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
Derivatives designated as hedging instruments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-rate swaps
 
$
23,998,498

 
$
230,705

 
$
102,201

Total derivatives designated as hedging instruments
 
23,998,498

 
230,705

 
102,201

Derivatives not designated as hedging instruments:
 
 

 
 

 
 

Interest-rate swaps
 
901,344

 
1,430

 
31

Swaptions
 
350,000

 
2

 
50

Interest-rate caps/floors
 
364,500

 
322

 
2

Interest-rate forwards
 
99,100

 
339

 
352

MDCs
 
99,002

 
303

 
471

Total derivatives not designated as hedging instruments
 
1,813,946

 
2,396

 
906

Total derivatives before adjustments
 
$
25,812,444

 
233,101

 
103,107

Netting adjustments (1)
 
 

 
(133,089
)
 
(133,089
)
Cash collateral (1)
 
 

 
34,836

 
55,207

Total derivatives, net
 
 

 
$
134,848

 
$
25,225


(1) 
Represents the application of the netting requirements that allow us to settle (i) positive and negative positions and (ii) cash collateral and related accrued interest held or placed, with the same clearing agent and/or counterparty (including fair value adjustments on derivatives for which variation margin payments are characterized as daily settled contracts). Cash collateral pledged to counterparties at December 31, 2017 and 2016 totaled $16,437 and $35,422, respectively. Cash collateral received from counterparties at December 31, 2017 and 2016 totaled $89,021 and $55,793, respectively. Variation margin for daily settled contracts totaled $24,954 at December 31, 2017.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


The following table presents separately the estimated fair value of derivative instruments meeting and not meeting netting requirements, including the effect of the related collateral received from or pledged to counterparties and variation margin for daily settled contracts.
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
 
 
Derivative Assets
 
Derivative Liabilities
 
Derivative Assets
 
Derivative Liabilities
Derivative instruments meeting netting requirements:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gross recognized amount
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Uncleared
 
$
118,932

 
$
27,491

 
$
86,606

 
$
45,449

Cleared
 
180,972

 
49,448

 
145,853

 
56,835

Total gross recognized amount
 
299,904

 
76,939

 
232,459

 
102,284

Gross amounts of netting adjustments, cash collateral and variation margin for daily settled contracts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Uncleared
 
(113,842
)
 
(24,822
)
 
(76,255
)
 
(21,047
)
Cleared (1)
 
(57,966
)
 
(49,448
)
 
(21,998
)
 
(56,835
)
Total gross amounts of netting adjustments, cash collateral and variation margin for daily settled contracts
 
(171,808
)
 
(74,270
)
 
(98,253
)
 
(77,882
)
Net amounts after netting adjustments, cash collateral and variation margin for daily settled contracts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Uncleared
 
5,090

 
2,669

 
10,351

 
24,402

Cleared
 
123,006

 

 
123,855

 

Total net amounts after netting adjustments, cash collateral and variation margin for daily settled contracts
 
128,096

 
2,669

 
134,206

 
24,402

Derivative instruments not meeting netting requirements (2)
 
110

 
49

 
642

 
823

Total derivatives, at estimated fair value
 
$
128,206

 
$
2,718

 
$
134,848

 
$
25,225


(1) 
Variation margin for daily settled contracts totaled $24,954 at December 31, 2017.
(2) 
Includes MDCs and certain interest-rate forwards.

The following table presents the components of net gains (losses) on derivatives and hedging activities reported in other income (loss).
 
 
Years Ended December 31,
Type of Hedge
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
Net gain (loss) related to fair-value hedge ineffectiveness:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-rate swaps
 
$
(7,414
)
 
$
4,488

 
$
4,146

Total net gain (loss) related to fair-value hedge ineffectiveness
 
(7,414
)
 
4,488

 
4,146

Net gain (loss) on derivatives not designated as hedging instruments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Economic hedges:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-rate swaps
 
122

 
(196
)
 
1,497

Swaptions
 
(200
)
 
(290
)
 

Interest-rate caps/floors
 
(228
)
 
87

 
(251
)
Interest-rate forwards
 
(1,728
)
 
(207
)
 
(3,372
)
Net interest settlements
 
(416
)
 
(381
)
 
392

MDCs
 
835

 
(1,229
)
 
420

Total net gain (loss) on derivatives not designated as hedging instruments
 
(1,615
)
 
(2,216
)
 
(1,314
)
Other (1)
 
(229
)
 

 

Net gains (losses) on derivatives and hedging activities
 
$
(9,258
)
 
$
2,272

 
$
2,832


(1) 
Consists of price alignment amounts on derivatives for which variation margin payments are characterized as daily settled contracts.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


The following table presents, by type of hedged item, the gains (losses) on the derivatives and the related hedged items in fair-value hedging relationships and the effect of those derivatives on net interest income.
 
 
Gain (Loss)
 
Gain (Loss)
 
Net Fair-
 
 
Effect on
 
 
on
 
on Hedged
 
Value Hedge
 
 
Net Interest
Year Ended December 31, 2017
 
Derivative
 
Item
 
Ineffectiveness
 
 
Income (1)
Advances
 
$
61,439

 
$
(62,324
)
 
$
(885
)
 
 
$
(31,461
)
AFS securities
 
35,620

 
(39,843
)
 
(4,223
)
 
 
(48,144
)
CO bonds
 
(46,299
)
 
43,993

 
(2,306
)
 
 
16,289

Total
 
$
50,760

 
$
(58,174
)
 
$
(7,414
)

 
$
(63,316
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Year Ended December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Advances
 
$
118,029

 
$
(117,201
)
 
$
828

 
 
$
(91,219
)
AFS securities
 
193,305

 
(194,083
)
 
(778
)
 
 
(94,018
)
CO bonds
 
(30,252
)
 
34,690

 
4,438

 
 
16,888

Total
 
$
281,082

 
$
(276,594
)
 
$
4,488

 
 
$
(168,349
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Year Ended December 31, 2015
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Advances
 
$
22,761

 
$
(21,196
)
 
$
1,565

 
 
$
(155,082
)
AFS securities
 
42,219

 
(46,145
)
 
(3,926
)
 
 
(98,063
)
CO bonds
 
1,696

 
4,811

 
6,507

 
 
56,976

Total
 
$
66,676

 
$
(62,530
)
 
$
4,146

 

$
(196,169
)

(1) 
Includes the effect of derivatives in fair-value hedging relationships on net interest income that is recorded in the interest income/expense line item of the respective hedged items. Excludes the interest income/expense of the respective hedged items, which fully offsets the interest income/expense of the derivatives, except to the extent of any hedge ineffectiveness. Net interest settlements on derivatives that are not in fair-value hedging relationships are reported in other income (loss). These amounts do not include the effect of amortization/accretion related to fair value hedging activities.

Note 12 - Deposits

We offer demand and overnight deposits to members and qualifying non-members. In addition, we offer short-term interest-bearing deposit programs to members. A member that services mortgage loans may deposit funds collected in connection with the mortgage loans, pending disbursement of such funds to the owners of the mortgage loans. We classify these items as other deposits.

Demand, overnight, and other deposits pay interest based on a daily interest rate. Time deposits pay interest based on a fixed rate determined at the origination of the deposit. The WAIR paid on interest-bearing deposits was 0.86%, 0.12% and 0.01% during the years ended December 31, 2017, 2016 and 2015, respectively.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


The following table presents interest-bearing and non-interest-bearing deposits.
Type
 
December 31,
2017
 
December 31,
2016
Interest-bearing:
 
 
 
 
Demand and overnight
 
$
513,150

 
$
494,880

Time
 
50

 
50

Other
 
23

 
25

Total interest-bearing
 
513,223

 
494,955

Non-interest-bearing: 
 
 

 
 

Other (1)
 
51,576

 
29,118

Total non-interest-bearing
 
51,576

 
29,118

Total deposits
 
$
564,799

 
$
524,073


(1) 
Includes pass-through deposit reserves from members.

Note 13 - Consolidated Obligations

Consolidated obligations consist of CO bonds and discount notes. CO bonds may be issued to raise short, intermediate and long-term funds for the FHLBanks and are not subject to any statutory or regulatory limits on maturity. Discount notes are issued primarily to raise short-term funds and have original maturities of up to one year. These notes generally sell at less than their face amount and are redeemed at par value when they mature.

The FHLBanks issue consolidated obligations through the Office of Finance as our agent under the oversight of the Finance Agency and the United States Secretary of the Treasury. In connection with each debt issuance, each FHLBank specifies the amount of debt to be issued on its behalf. Each FHLBank records as a liability the specific portion of consolidated obligations issued on its behalf and for which it is the primary obligor.

In addition to being the primary obligor for all consolidated obligations issued on our behalf, we are jointly and severally liable with each of the other FHLBanks for the payment of the principal and interest on all FHLBank outstanding consolidated obligations. The par values of the FHLBanks' outstanding consolidated obligations at December 31, 2017 and 2016 totaled $1.0 trillion and $989.3 billion, respectively. As provided by the Bank Act and applicable regulations, consolidated obligations are backed only by the financial resources of all FHLBanks.

The Finance Agency, in its discretion, may require any FHLBank to make principal or interest payments due on any consolidated obligation whether or not the consolidated obligation represents a primary liability of that FHLBank. Although an FHLBank has never paid the principal or interest payments due on a consolidated obligation on behalf of another FHLBank, if that event should occur, Finance Agency regulations provide that the paying FHLBank is entitled to reimbursement for any payments made on behalf of another FHLBank and other associated costs, including interest to be determined by the Finance Agency. If, however, the Finance Agency determines that such other FHLBank is unable to satisfy its repayment obligations to the paying FHLBank, then the Finance Agency may allocate the outstanding liability of such other FHLBank among the remaining FHLBanks on a pro-rata basis in proportion to their participation in all outstanding consolidated obligations, or in any other manner it may determine to ensure that the FHLBanks operate in a safe and sound manner. We do not believe that it is probable that we will be asked or required to make principal or interest payments on behalf of another FHLBank.

Discount Notes. The following table presents our discount notes outstanding, all of which are due within one year of issuance.
Discount Notes
 
December 31,
2017
 
December 31,
2016
Book value
 
$
20,358,157

 
$
16,801,763

Par value
 
$
20,394,192

 
$
16,819,659

 
 
 
 
 
Weighted-average effective interest rate
 
1.22
%
 
0.51
%





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


CO Bonds. The following table presents our CO bonds outstanding by contractual maturity.
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Year of Contractual Maturity
 
Amount
 
WAIR%
 
Amount
 
WAIR%
Due in 1 year or less
 
$
14,021,190

 
1.27

 
$
16,234,460

 
0.85

Due after 1 year through 2 years
 
9,392,470

 
1.46

 
6,122,190

 
0.96

Due after 2 years through 3 years
 
4,849,960

 
2.23

 
2,718,945

 
1.65

Due after 3 years through 4 years
 
1,294,470

 
2.17

 
1,684,530

 
3.17

Due after 4 years through 5 years
 
2,798,000

 
2.29

 
1,040,000

 
2.17

Thereafter
 
5,626,500

 
3.02

 
5,708,000

 
2.92

Total CO bonds, par value
 
37,982,590

 
1.80

 
33,508,125

 
1.44

Unamortized premiums
 
27,333

 
 

 
27,462

 
 

Unamortized discounts
 
(13,782
)
 
 

 
(12,059
)
 
 

Unamortized concessions
 
(14,188
)
 
 
 
(13,705
)
 
 
Fair-value hedging adjustments
 
(86,300
)
 
 

 
(42,544
)
 
 

Total CO bonds
 
$
37,895,653

 
 

 
$
33,467,279

 
 


Consolidated obligations are issued with either fixed-rate or variable-rate coupon payment terms that may use a variety of indices for interest-rate resets, such as LIBOR. To meet the specific needs of certain investors in CO bonds, both fixed-rate and variable-rate CO bonds may contain features that result in complex coupon payment terms and call options. When these CO bonds are issued, we may enter into derivatives containing features that offset the terms and embedded options, if any, of the CO bonds.

CO bonds may also be callable. Such bonds may be redeemed in whole or in part, at our discretion, on predetermined call dates according to the terms of the offerings.

The following tables present our CO bonds outstanding by redemption feature and the earlier of the year of contractual maturity or next call date.
Redemption Feature
 
December 31,
2017
 
December 31,
2016
Non-callable / non-putable
 
$
26,277,590

 
$
25,627,125

Callable
 
11,705,000

 
7,881,000

Total CO bonds, par value
 
$
37,982,590

 
$
33,508,125

Year of Contractual Maturity or Next Call Date
 
December 31,
2017
 
December 31,
2016
Due in 1 year or less
 
$
24,449,190


$
23,825,460

Due after 1 year through 2 years
 
9,098,470

 
4,675,190

Due after 2 years through 3 years
 
2,125,960

 
2,240,945

Due after 3 years through 4 years
 
584,470

 
1,257,530

Due after 4 years through 5 years
 
579,000

 
474,000

Thereafter
 
1,145,500

 
1,035,000

Total CO bonds, par value
 
$
37,982,590

 
$
33,508,125


Interest-Rate Payment Types. CO bonds, beyond having fixed-rate or simple variable-rate interest payment terms, may also have the following features:

Step-up CO bonds pay interest at increasing fixed rates for specified intervals over their lives. These CO bonds generally contain provisions enabling us to call them at our option on the step-up dates;
Ratchet CO bonds pay a floating interest rate indexed on a reference range such as LIBOR. Each floating rate is subject to increasing floors, such that subsequent rates may not be lower than the previous rate; or
Conversion CO bonds have interest rates that convert from fixed to variable, or variable to fixed, or from one index to another, on predetermined dates according to the terms of the offerings.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


The following table presents CO bonds outstanding by interest-rate payment type.
Interest-Rate Payment Type
 
December 31,
2017
 
December 31,
2016
Fixed-rate
 
$
24,747,590

 
$
18,928,125

Step-up
 
285,000

 
655,000

Simple variable-rate
 
12,950,000

 
13,905,000

Ratchet
 

 
20,000

Total CO bonds, par value
 
$
37,982,590

 
$
33,508,125


Note 14 - Affordable Housing Program

The Bank Act requires each FHLBank to establish an AHP, in which the FHLBank provides subsidies in the form of direct grants and below-market-rate advances to members that use the funds to assist in the purchase, construction, or rehabilitation of housing for very low-, low-, and moderate-income households. Annually, the FHLBanks must set aside for the AHP the greater of the aggregate of $100 million or 10% of each FHLBank's net earnings. For purposes of the AHP calculation, net earnings is defined in a Finance Agency Advisory Bulletin as income before assessments, plus interest expense related to MRCS.

The following table summarizes the activity in our AHP funding obligation.
AHP Activity
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
Liability at beginning of year
 
$
26,598

 
$
31,103

 
$
36,899

Assessment (expense)
 
18,163

 
13,291

 
13,499

Subsidy usage, net (1)
 
(12,595
)
 
(17,796
)
 
(19,295
)
Liability at end of year
 
$
32,166

 
$
26,598

 
$
31,103


(1) 
Subsidies disbursed are reported net of returns/recaptures of previously disbursed subsidies.

We made no AHP-related advances during the years ended December 31, 2017, 2016 or 2015 and had no outstanding principal at December 31, 2017 or 2016.

Note 15 - Capital
    
We are a cooperative whose member and former member institutions own all of our capital stock. Former members (including certain non-member institutions that own our capital stock as a result of a merger with or acquisition of a member) own our capital stock solely to support credit products or mortgage loans still outstanding on our statement of condition. Member shares cannot be purchased or sold except between us and our members or, with our written approval, among our members, at the par value of one hundred dollars per share, as mandated by our capital plan and Finance Agency regulation.

Our capital plan divides our Class B stock into two sub-series: Class B-1 and Class B-2. Class B-2 stock consists solely of required stock that is subject to a redemption request. The Class B-2 dividend is presently calculated at 80% of the amount of the Class B-1 dividend; this ratio can only be changed by amendment of our capital plan by our board of directors with approval of the Finance Agency.

Our board of directors may, but is not required to, declare and pay dividends on our Class B stock in either cash or capital stock or a combination thereof, as long as we are in compliance with Finance Agency rules. The amount of the dividend to be paid is based on the average number of shares of each sub-series held by the member during the dividend payment period (applicable quarter).





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Stock Redemption and Repurchase. In accordance with the Bank Act, our Class B stock is considered putable by the member. Members can redeem Class B stock, subject to certain restrictions, by giving five years' written notice. Any member that withdraws from membership may not be readmitted as a member for a period of five years from the divestiture date for all capital stock that was held as a condition of membership, as set forth in our capital plan, unless the member has canceled or revoked its notice of withdrawal prior to the end of the five-year redemption period. This restriction does not apply if the member is transferring its membership from one FHLBank to another on an uninterrupted basis.

We may repurchase, at our sole discretion, any member's Class B stock that exceeds the required minimum amount. However, there are significant statutory and regulatory restrictions on our right to repurchase, or obligation to redeem, the outstanding stock. As a result, whether or not a member may have its Class B stock repurchased or redeemed will depend, in part, on whether we are in compliance with those restrictions.

Consistent with our capital plan, we are not required to redeem activity-based stock until the expiration of the notice of redemption, or until the activity to which the capital stock relates no longer remains outstanding, whichever is later. If activity-based stock becomes excess stock (i.e., the amount of stock held by a member or former member in excess of our stock ownership requirement for that institution) as a result of an activity no longer remaining outstanding, we may redeem the excess stock at our discretion, subject to the statutory and regulatory restrictions on capital stock redemption.

A member may cancel or revoke its written notice of redemption or its notice of withdrawal from membership prior to the five-year redemption period. However, our capital plan provides that we will charge a cancellation fee to a member that cancels or revokes its withdrawal notice. Our board of directors may change the cancellation fee with at least 15 days prior written notice to members.

At December 31, 2017 and 2016, certain members had requested redemptions of their Class B stock, but the related stock totaling $5,144 at December 31, 2017 and 2016 was not considered mandatorily redeemable and reclassified to MRCS because the requesting members may revoke their requests, without substantial penalty, throughout the five-year waiting period. Therefore, these requests are not considered sufficiently substantive in nature. However, we consider redemption requests related to merger, acquisition or charter termination, as well as involuntary terminations from membership, to be sufficiently substantive when made and, therefore, the related stock is considered mandatorily redeemable and reclassified to MRCS.

Mandatorily Redeemable Capital Stock. The following table presents the activity in our MRCS.
MRCS Activity
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
Liability at beginning of year
 
$
170,043

 
$
14,063

 
$
15,673

Reclassifications from capital stock
 

 
183,056

 

Redemptions/repurchases
 
(5,721
)
 
(28,148
)
 
(1,610
)
Accrued distributions
 

 
1,072

 

Liability at end of year
 
$
164,322

 
$
170,043

 
$
14,063


As a result of, and effective with, the Final Membership Rule in February 2016, we reclassified all of the outstanding Class B stock of our captive insurance company members totaling $178,898 to MRCS.

In accordance with the Final Membership Rule, captive insurance companies that were admitted as FHLBank members on or after September 12, 2014 had their memberships terminated by February 19, 2017. As a result, all of their outstanding Class B stock, totaling $3,021 at December 31, 2016, was repurchased on or before February 19, 2017.

Captive insurance companies that were admitted as FHLBank members prior to September 12, 2014, and do not meet the new definition of "insurance company" or fall within another category of institution that is eligible for FHLBank membership, shall have their memberships terminated no later than February 19, 2021. Upon termination, their outstanding Class B stock will be repurchased or redeemed in accordance with the Final Membership Rule.




Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


The following table presents MRCS by contractual year of redemption. The year of redemption is the later of: (i) the final year of the five-year redemption period, or (ii) the first year in which a non-member no longer has an activity-based stock requirement.
MRCS Contractual Year of Redemption
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Year 1(1)
 
$
7,963

 
$
8,630

Year 2
 
13

 
5,054

Year 3
 

 
13

Year 4
 
4,158

 

Year 5
 

 
4,158

Thereafter (2)
 
152,188

 
152,188

Total MRCS
 
$
164,322

 
$
170,043


(1) 
Balances at December 31, 2017 and 2016 include $2,909 and $5,609, respectively, of Class B stock that had reached the end of the five-year redemption period but will not be redeemed until the associated credit products and other obligations are no longer outstanding.
(2) 
Represents the five-year redemption period of Class B stock held by certain captive insurance companies which begins immediately upon their termination of memberships no later than February 19, 2021, in accordance with the Final Membership Rule.

When a member's membership status changes to a non-member, the member's capital stock is reclassified to MRCS. If such change occurs during a quarterly period, but not at the beginning or the end of a quarterly period, any dividends for that quarterly period are allocated between distributions from retained earnings for the shares held as capital stock during that period and interest expense for the shares held as MRCS during that period. Therefore, the distributions from retained earnings represent dividends to former members for only the portion of the period that they were members. The amounts recorded to interest expense represent dividends to former members for the portion of that period and subsequent periods that they were not members.

The following table presents the distributions related to MRCS.
 
 
Years Ended December 31,
MRCS Distributions
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
Recorded as interest expense
 
$
7,034

 
$
6,613

 
$
522

Recorded as distributions from retained earnings
 

 
1,072

 

Total
 
$
7,034

 
$
7,685

 
$
522


Restricted Retained Earnings. In 2011, we entered into a JCE Agreement with all of the other FHLBanks to enhance the capital position of each FHLBank. In accordance with the JCE Agreement, we allocate 20% of our net income to a separate restricted retained earnings account until the balance of that account equals at least 1% of the average balance of our outstanding consolidated obligations for the previous quarter. These restricted retained earnings are not available from which to pay dividends except to the extent the restricted retained earnings balance exceeds 1.5% of the average balance of our outstanding consolidated obligations for the previous quarter.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Capital Requirements. We are subject to three capital requirements under our capital plan and Finance Agency regulations:

(i)
Risk-based capital. We must maintain at all times permanent capital, defined as Class B stock (including MRCS) and retained earnings, in an amount at least equal to the sum of our credit risk, market risk, and operations risk capital requirements, all of which are calculated in accordance with Finance Agency regulations. The Finance Agency may require us to maintain a greater amount of permanent capital than is required by the risk-based capital requirements as defined.
(ii)
Total regulatory capital. We are required to maintain at all times a total capital-to-assets ratio of at least 4%. Total regulatory capital is the sum of permanent capital, any general loss allowance, if consistent with GAAP and not established for specific assets, and other amounts from sources determined by the Finance Agency as available to absorb losses. For regulatory capital purposes, AOCI is not considered capital.
(iii)
Leverage capital. We are required to maintain at all times a leverage capital-to-assets ratio of at least 5%. Leverage capital is defined as the sum of (i) permanent capital weighted 1.5 times and (ii) all other capital without a weighting factor.

As presented in the following table, we were in compliance with the Finance Agency's capital requirements at December 31, 2017 and 2016.
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Regulatory Capital Requirements
 
Required
 
Actual
 
Required
 
Actual
Risk-based capital
 
$
903,806

 
$
2,998,422

 
$
760,946

 
$
2,549,871

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total regulatory capital-to-asset ratio
 
4.00
%
 
4.81
%
 
4.00
%
 
4.73
%
Total regulatory capital
 
$
2,493,956

 
$
2,998,422

 
$
2,156,296

 
$
2,549,871

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Leverage ratio
 
5.00
%
 
7.21
%
 
5.00
%
 
7.10
%
Leverage capital
 
$
3,117,445

 
$
4,497,633

 
$
2,695,370

 
$
3,824,806






Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Note 16 - Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)

The following table presents a summary of the changes in the components of AOCI.
AOCI Rollforward
 
Unrealized Gains (Losses) on AFS Securities
 
Non-Credit OTTI on AFS Securities
 
Non-Credit OTTI on HTM Securities
 
Pension Benefits
 
Total AOCI
Balance, December 31, 2014
 
$
16,078

 
$
38,172

 
$
(175
)
 
$
(7,415
)
 
$
46,660

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
OCI before reclassifications:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


Net change in unrealized gains (losses)
 
(15,981
)
 
(7,766
)
 

 

 
(23,747
)
Net change in fair value
 

 
(238
)
 

 

 
(238
)
Accretion of non-credit losses
 

 

 
43

 

 
43

Reclassifications from OCI to net income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


Non-credit portion of OTTI losses
 

 
61

 

 

 
61

Pension benefits, net
 

 

 

 
99

 
99

Total other comprehensive income (loss)
 
(15,981
)

(7,943
)

43


99


(23,782
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, December 31, 2015
 
$
97


$
30,229


$
(132
)

$
(7,316
)

$
22,878

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
OCI before reclassifications:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in unrealized gains (losses)
 
39,371

 
(3,332
)
 

 

 
36,039

Net change in fair value
 

 
(156
)
 

 

 
(156
)
Accretion of non-credit losses
 

 

 
29

 

 
29

Reclassifications from OCI to net income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-credit portion of OTTI losses
 

 
197

 

 

 
197

Pension benefits, net
 

 

 

 
(2,619
)
 
(2,619
)
Total other comprehensive income (loss)
 
39,371

 
(3,291
)
 
29

 
(2,619
)
 
33,490

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, December 31, 2016
 
$
39,468

 
$
26,938

 
$
(103
)
 
$
(9,935
)
 
$
56,368

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
OCI before reclassifications:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in unrealized gains (losses)
 
53,051

 
2,189

 

 

 
55,240

Net change in fair value
 

 
29

 

 

 
29

Accretion of non-credit losses
 

 

 
10

 

 
10

Reclassifications from OCI to net income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-credit portion of OTTI losses
 

 
166

 
42

 

 
208

Pension benefits, net
 

 

 

 
(449
)
 
(449
)
Total other comprehensive income (loss)
 
53,051

 
2,384

 
52

 
(449
)
 
55,038

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, December 31, 2017
 
$
92,519

 
$
29,322

 
$
(51
)
 
$
(10,384
)
 
$
111,406






Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Note 17 - Employee and Director Retirement and Deferred Compensation Plans

Qualified Defined Benefit Pension Plan. We participate in a tax-qualified, defined-benefit pension plan for financial institutions administered by Pentegra Retirement Services. This DB plan is treated as a multiemployer plan for accounting purposes but operates as a multiple-employer plan under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 and the Internal Revenue Code. As a result, certain multiemployer plan disclosures are not applicable.

Under the DB plan, contributions made by a participating employer may be used to provide benefits to employees of other participating employers because assets contributed by an employer are not segregated in a separate account or restricted to provide benefits to employees of that employer only. Also, in the event that a participating employer is unable to meet its contribution or funding requirements, the required contributions for the other participating employers (including us) could increase proportionately.

The DB plan covers our officers and employees who meet certain eligibility requirements, including an employment date prior to February 1, 2010. The DB plan operates on a fiscal year from July 1 through June 30 and files one Form 5500 on behalf of all participating employers. The Employer Identification Number is 13-5645888 and the three digit plan number is 333. There are no collective bargaining agreements in place.

The DB plan's annual valuation process includes calculating its funded status and separately calculating the funded status of each participating employer. The funded status is calculated as the market value of plan assets divided by the funding target (100% of the present value of all benefit liabilities accrued at that date utilizing the discount rate prescribed by statute). The calculation of the funding target as of July 1, 2017, 2016 and 2015 incorporated a higher discount rate in accordance with MAP-21, which resulted in a lower funding target and a higher funded status. Over time, the favorable impact of MAP-21 is expected to decline. As permitted by the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, the DB plan accepts contributions for the prior plan year up to eight and a half months after the asset valuation date. As a result, the market value of plan assets at the valuation date (July 1) will increase by any subsequent contributions designated for the immediately preceding plan year ended June 30.

The most recent Form 5500 available for the DB plan is for the plan year ended June 30, 2016. Our contributions to the DB plan for the fiscal years ended December 31, 2017, 2016 and 2015 were not more than 5% of the total contributions to the DB plan for the plan years ended June 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

The following table presents a summary of net pension costs charged to compensation and benefits expense and the DB plan's funded status.
DB Plan Net Pension Cost and Funded Status
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
Net pension cost charged to compensation and benefits expense for the year ended December 31
 
$
4,450

 
$
5,772

 
$
5,412

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
DB plan funded status as July 1
 
111
%
(a) 
104
%
(b) 
107
%
Our funded status as of July 1
 
117
%
 
113
%
 
118
%

(a) 
The DB plan's funded status as of July 1, 2017 is preliminary and may increase because the participating employers were permitted to make designated contributions for the plan year ended June 30, 2017 through March 15, 2018. Any such contributions will be included in the final valuation as of July 1, 2017. The final funded status as of July 1, 2017 will not be available until the Form 5500 for the plan year ended June 30, 2018 is filed (no later than April 2019).
(b) 
The DB plan's final funded status as of July 1, 2016 will not be available until the Form 5500 for the plan year ended June 30, 2017 is filed (no later than April 2018).

Qualified Defined Contribution Plan. We participate in a tax-qualified, defined contribution plan for financial institutions administered by Pentegra Retirement Services. This DC plan covers our officers and employees who meet certain eligibility requirements. Our contribution is equal to a percentage of voluntary employee contributions, subject to certain limitations. We contributed $1,577, $1,488, and $1,344 in the years ended December 31, 2017, 2016, and 2015, respectively.




Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Nonqualified Supplemental Defined Benefit Retirement Plan. We participate in a single-employer, non-qualified, unfunded supplemental executive retirement plan for financial institutions administered by Pentegra Retirement Services. This SERP restores all of the defined benefits to participating employees who have had their qualified defined benefits limited by Internal Revenue Service regulations. Since the SERP is a non-qualified unfunded plan, no contributions are required to be made. However, we may elect to make contributions to a related grantor trust that was established to indirectly fund the SERP in order to maintain a desired funding level. Payments of benefits may be made from the related grantor trust or from our general assets.

The following table presents the changes in our SERP benefit obligation.
Change in benefit obligation
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
Projected benefit obligation at beginning of year
 
$
20,022

 
$
15,099

 
$
14,074

 Service cost
 
1,035

 
808

 
839

 Interest cost
 
738

 
735

 
665

 Actuarial loss
 
1,712

 
4,055

 
1,485

 Benefits paid
 
(331
)
 
(675
)
 
(1,964
)
Projected benefit obligation at end of year
 
$
23,176

 
$
20,022

 
$
15,099


The measurement date used to determine the benefit obligation was December 31. The following table presents the key assumptions used for the actuarial calculations to determine the benefit obligation.
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Discount rate
 
3.00
%
 
4.00
%
Compensation increases
 
5.50
%
 
5.50
%

The discount rate represents a weighted average that was determined by a discounted cash-flow approach, which incorporates the timing of each expected future benefit payment. We estimate future benefit payments based on the census data of the SERP's participants, benefit formulas and provisions, and valuation assumptions reflecting the probability of decrement and survival. We then determine the present value of the future benefit payments by using duration-based interest-rate yields from the Citi Pension Discount Curve as of the measurement date, and solving for the single discount rate that produces the same present value of the future benefit payments.

The accumulated benefit obligation for the SERP, which excludes projected future salary increases, was $16,704 and $13,744 as of December 31, 2017 and 2016, respectively.

The unfunded benefit obligation is reported in other liabilities. Although there are no plan assets, the assets in the grantor trust, included as a component of other assets, had a total fair value of $20,071 and $17,536 at December 31, 2017 and 2016, respectively.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


The following table presents the components of the net periodic benefit cost and the amounts recognized in OCI for the SERP. 
 
 
Years Ended December 31,
2017
 
2016
 
2015
Net periodic benefit cost:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 Service cost
 
$
1,035

 
$
808

 
$
839

 Interest cost
 
738

 
735

 
665

 Amortization of prior service benefit
 

 

 
(11
)
 Amortization of net actuarial loss
 
1,263

 
1,436

 
1,595

Net periodic benefit cost recognized in compensation and benefits
 
3,036

 
2,979

 
3,088

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Amounts recognized in OCI:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 Actuarial loss
 
1,712

 
4,055

 
1,485

 Amortization of net actuarial loss
 
(1,263
)
 
(1,436
)
 
(1,595
)
 Amortization of prior service benefit
 

 

 
11

Net loss (income) recognized in OCI
 
449

 
2,619

 
(99
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total recognized in compensation and benefits and in OCI
 
$
3,485

 
$
5,598

 
$
2,989


The following table presents the key assumptions used for the actuarial calculations to determine net periodic benefit cost for the SERP.
 
 
Years Ended December 31,
2017
 
2016
 
2015
Discount rate
 
4.00
%
 
4.20
%
 
3.90
%
Compensation increases
 
5.50
%
 
5.50
%
 
5.50
%

The following table presents the components of the pension benefits reported in AOCI related to the SERP. 
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Net actuarial loss
 
$
(10,384
)
 
$
(9,935
)
Net pension benefits reported in AOCI
 
$
(10,384
)
 
$
(9,935
)

The following table presents the amounts that will be amortized from AOCI into net periodic benefit cost during the year ending December 31, 2018.
 
 
Year Ending December 31, 2018
Net actuarial loss
 
$
1,291

Net amount to be amortized
 
$
1,291


The net periodic benefit cost for the SERP, including the net amount to be amortized, for the year ending December 31, 2018 is projected to be approximately $2,904.

The following table presents the estimated future benefit payments reflecting scheduled benefit payments for retired participants and the estimated payments to active participants, weighted based on the probability of the participant retiring, the value of the participant's benefits, and the actual form of payment elected by the participant.
For the Years Ending December 31,
 
 
2018
 
$
2,652

2019
 
4,058

2020
 
2,259

2021
 
1,716

2022
 
7,240

2023 - 2027
 
4,316





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Nonqualified Supplemental Executive Thrift Plan. Effective January 1, 2016, we offer the SETP, a voluntary, non-qualified, unfunded deferred compensation plan that permits certain officers and approved employees of the Bank to elect to defer certain components of their compensation. The SETP is intended to constitute a deferred compensation arrangement that complies with Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code, as amended. The SETP provides that, subject to certain limitations, the Bank will make matching contributions to the participant's deferred contribution account each plan year. For the years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016, we contributed $52 and $47, respectively, to the SETP and our obligation at December 31, 2017 and 2016 was $660 and $248, respectively.

Directors' Deferred Compensation Plan. Effective January 1, 2016, we offer the DDCP, a voluntary, non-qualified, unfunded deferred compensation plan that permits our directors to defer all or a portion of the fees payable to them for a calendar year for their services as directors. The DDCP is intended to constitute a deferred compensation arrangement that complies with Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code, as amended. Any duly elected and serving member of our board may participate in the DDCP. We make no matching contributions under the DDCP. Our obligation under the DDCP at December 31, 2017 and 2016 was $967 and $333, respectively.

The following table presents the compensation earned and deferred by our directors under the DDCP.
 
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
 
2017
 
2016
Compensation earned
 
$
1,768

 
$
1,620

Compensation deferred
 
538

 
319


Note 18 - Segment Information

We report based on two operating segments:

Traditional, which consists of credit products (including advances, letters of credit, and lines of credit), investments (including federal funds sold, securities purchased under agreements to resell, AFS securities and HTM securities), and correspondent services and deposits; and
Mortgage loans, which consists of mortgage loans purchased from our members through our MPP and participating interests purchased in 2012 - 2014 from the FHLBank of Topeka in mortgage loans that were originated by certain of its PFIs under the MPF Program.

These segments reflect our two primary mission asset activities and the manner in which they are managed from the perspective of development, resource allocation, product delivery, pricing, credit risk and operational administration. The segments identify the principal ways we provide services to members.

We measure the performance of each segment based upon the net interest spread of the underlying portfolio(s). Therefore, each segment's performance begins with net interest income.

Traditional net interest income is derived primarily from the difference, or spread, between the interest income earned on advances and investments and the borrowing costs related to those assets, net interest settlements related to interest-rate swaps, and related premium and discount amortization. Traditional also includes the costs related to holding deposits for members and other miscellaneous borrowings as well as all other miscellaneous income and expense not associated with mortgage loans. Mortgage loan net interest income is derived primarily from the difference, or spread, between the interest income earned on mortgage loans, including the premium and discount amortization, and the borrowing costs related to those loans.

Direct other income and expense also affect each segment's results. The traditional segment includes the direct earnings impact of derivatives and hedging activities related to advances and investments as well as all other income and expense not associated with mortgage loans. The mortgage loans segment includes the direct earnings impact of derivatives and hedging activities as well as direct compensation, benefits and other expenses (including an allocation for indirect overhead) associated with operating the MPP and MPF Program and volume-driven costs associated with master servicing and quality control fees.

The assessments related to AHP have been allocated to each segment based upon its proportionate share of income before assessments.




Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


The following table presents our financial performance by operating segment.
Year Ended December 31, 2017
 
Traditional
 
Mortgage Loans
 
Total
Net interest income
 
$
193,278

 
$
69,725

 
$
263,003

Provision for (reversal of) credit losses
 

 
51

 
51

Other income (loss)
 
(5,110
)
 
(886
)
 
(5,996
)
Other expenses
 
69,644

 
12,718

 
82,362

Income before assessments
 
118,524

 
56,070

 
174,594

Affordable Housing Program assessments
 
12,556

 
5,607

 
18,163

Net income
 
$
105,968

 
$
50,463

 
$
156,431

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Year Ended December 31, 2016
 
Traditional
 
Mortgage Loans
 
Total
Net interest income
 
$
144,695

 
$
53,498

 
$
198,193

Provision for (reversal of) credit losses
 

 
(45
)
 
(45
)
Other income (loss)
 
6,674

 
(1,016
)
 
5,658

Other expenses
 
65,746

 
11,853

 
77,599

Income before assessments
 
85,623

 
40,674

 
126,297

Affordable Housing Program assessments
 
9,224

 
4,067

 
13,291

Net income
 
$
76,399

 
$
36,607

 
$
113,006

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Year Ended December 31, 2015
 
Traditional
 
Mortgage Loans
 
Total
Net interest income
 
$
128,175

 
$
67,250

 
$
195,425

Provision for (reversal of) credit losses
 

 
(456
)
 
(456
)
Other income (loss)
 
13,272

 
(2,791
)
 
10,481

Other expenses
 
62,211

 
9,683

 
71,894

Income before assessments
 
79,236

 
55,232

 
134,468

Affordable Housing Program assessments
 
7,976

 
5,523

 
13,499

Net income
 
$
71,260

 
$
49,709

 
$
120,969


We have not symmetrically allocated assets to each segment based upon financial results as it is impracticable to measure the performance of our segments from a total assets perspective. As a result, there is asymmetrical information presented in the tables above including, among other items, the allocation of depreciation without an allocation of the depreciable assets, derivatives and hedging earnings adjustments with no corresponding allocation to derivative assets, if any, and the recording of interest income with no allocation to accrued interest receivable.

The following table presents asset balances by operating segment.
By Date
 
Traditional
 
Mortgage Loans
 
Total
December 31, 2017
 
$
51,992,565

 
$
10,356,341

 
$
62,348,906

December 31, 2016
 
44,406,003

 
9,501,397

 
53,907,400






Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Note 19 - Estimated Fair Values

We estimate fair value amounts by using available market and other pertinent information and the most appropriate valuation methods. Although we use our best judgment in estimating the fair values of financial instruments, there are inherent limitations in any valuation technique. Therefore, these estimated fair values may not be indicative of the amounts that would have been realized in market transactions at the reporting dates.

Certain estimates of the fair value of financial assets and liabilities are highly subjective and require judgments regarding significant factors such as the amount and timing of future cash flows, prepayment speeds, interest-rate volatility, and the discount rates that appropriately reflect market and credit risks. The use of different assumptions could have a material effect on the fair value estimates.

Fair Value HierarchyGAAP establishes a fair value hierarchy and requires us to maximize the use of significant observable inputs and minimize the use of significant unobservable inputs when measuring estimated fair value. The inputs are evaluated, and an overall level for the estimated fair value measurement is determined. This overall level is an indication of the extent of the market observability of the estimated fair value measurement for the asset or liability.

The fair value hierarchy prioritizes the inputs used to measure fair value into three broad levels:

Level 1 Inputs. Quoted prices (unadjusted) for identical assets or liabilities in an active market that we can access on the measurement date.

Level 2 Inputs. Inputs other than quoted prices within level 1 that are observable inputs for the asset or liability, either directly or indirectly. If the asset or liability has a specified or contractual term, a level 2 input must be observable for substantially the full term of the asset or liability. Level 2 inputs include (i) quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities in active markets; (ii) quoted prices for identical or similar assets or liabilities in markets that are not active; (iii) inputs other than quoted prices that are observable for the asset or liability (e.g., interest rates and yield curves that are observable at commonly quoted intervals and implied volatilities); and (iv) inputs that are derived principally from or corroborated by observable market data by correlation or other means.

Level 3 Inputs. Unobservable inputs for the asset or liability.

We review the fair value hierarchy classifications on a quarterly basis. Changes in the observability of the inputs may result in a reclassification of certain assets or liabilities. Such reclassifications are reported as transfers in/out at estimated fair value as of the beginning of the quarter in which the changes occur. There were no such reclassifications during the years ended December 31, 2017, 2016, or 2015.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


The following tables present the carrying value and estimated fair value of our financial instruments. The total of the estimated fair values does not represent an estimate of our overall market value as a going concern, which would take into account, among other considerations, future business opportunities and the net profitability of assets and liabilities.
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
Estimated Fair Value
 
 
Carrying
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Netting
Financial Instruments
 
Value
 
Total
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Adjustment (1)
Assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks
 
$
55,269

 
$
55,269

 
$
55,269

 
$

 
$

 
$

Interest-bearing deposits
 
660,342

 
660,342

 
659,926

 
416

 

 

Securities purchased under agreements to resell
 
2,605,460

 
2,605,461

 

 
2,605,461

 

 

Federal funds sold
 
1,280,000

 
1,280,000

 

 
1,280,000

 

 

AFS securities
 
7,128,758

 
7,128,758

 

 
6,910,224

 
218,534

 

HTM securities
 
5,897,668

 
5,919,299

 

 
5,874,413

 
44,886

 

Advances
 
34,055,064

 
34,001,397

 

 
34,001,397

 

 

Mortgage loans held for portfolio, net
 
10,356,341

 
10,426,213

 

 
10,413,134

 
13,079

 

Accrued interest receivable
 
105,314

 
105,314

 

 
105,314

 

 

Derivative assets, net
 
128,206

 
128,206

 

 
300,014

 

 
(171,808
)
Grantor trust assets (2)
 
21,698

 
21,698

 
21,698

 

 

 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits
 
564,799

 
564,799

 

 
564,799

 

 

Consolidated Obligations:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Discount notes
 
20,358,157

 
20,394,192

 

 
20,394,192

 

 

Bonds
 
37,895,653

 
37,998,928

 

 
37,998,928

 

 

Accrued interest payable
 
135,691

 
135,691

 

 
135,691

 

 

Derivative liabilities, net
 
2,718

 
2,718

 

 
76,988

 

 
(74,270
)
MRCS
 
164,322

 
164,322

 
164,322

 

 

 





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


 
 
December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
Estimated Fair Value
 
 
Carrying
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Netting
Financial Instruments
 
Value
 
Total
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Adjustment (1)
Assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks
 
$
546,612

 
$
546,612

 
$
546,612

 
$

 
$

 
$

Interest-bearing deposits
 
150,225

 
150,225

 
150,072

 
153

 

 

Securities purchased under agreements to resell
 
1,781,309

 
1,781,309

 

 
1,781,309

 

 

Federal funds sold
 
1,650,000

 
1,650,000

 

 
1,650,000

 

 

AFS securities
 
6,059,835

 
6,059,835

 

 
5,790,716

 
269,119

 

HTM securities
 
5,819,573

 
5,848,692

 

 
5,791,111

 
57,581

 

Advances
 
28,095,953

 
28,059,477

 

 
28,059,477

 

 

Mortgage loans held for portfolio, net
 
9,501,397

 
9,587,394

 

 
9,567,140

 
20,254

 

Accrued interest receivable
 
93,716

 
93,716

 

 
93,716

 

 

Derivative assets, net
 
134,848

 
134,848

 

 
233,101

 

 
(98,253
)
Grantor trust assets (2)
 
18,117

 
18,117

 
18,117

 

 

 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits
 
524,073

 
524,073

 

 
524,073

 

 

Consolidated Obligations:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Discount notes
 
16,801,763

 
16,819,659

 

 
16,819,659

 

 

Bonds
 
33,467,279

 
33,614,346

 

 
33,614,346

 

 

Accrued interest payable
 
98,411

 
98,411

 

 
98,411

 

 

Derivative liabilities, net
 
25,225

 
25,225

 

 
103,107

 

 
(77,882
)
MRCS
 
170,043

 
170,043

 
170,043

 

 

 


(1) 
Represents the application of the netting requirements that allow the settlement of (i) positive and negative positions and (ii) cash collateral and related accrued interest held or placed, with the same clearing agent and/or counterparty (includes fair value adjustments on derivatives of $24,954 at December 31, 2017 for which variation margin payments are characterized as daily settled contracts).
(2) 
Included in other assets.

Summary of Valuation Techniques and Significant Inputs.

Cash and Due from Banks. The estimated fair value equals the carrying value.

Interest-Bearing Deposits. The estimated fair value equals the carrying value.

Securities Purchased Under Agreements to Resell. The estimated fair value of overnight securities purchased under agreements to resell approximates the carrying value. The estimated fair value of term securities purchased under agreements to resell is determined by calculating the present value of the future cash flows. The discount rates used in these calculations are the rates for securities with similar terms.

Federal Funds Sold. The estimated fair value of overnight federal funds sold approximates the carrying value. The estimated fair value of term federal funds sold is determined by calculating the present value of the expected future cash flows. The discount rates used in these calculations are the rates for federal funds with similar terms.

AFS and HTM Securities - MBS. The estimated fair value incorporates prices from multiple third-party pricing vendors, when available. These pricing vendors use various proprietary models to price MBS. The inputs to those models are derived from various sources, including, but not limited to, benchmark yields, reported trades, dealer estimates, issuer spreads, benchmark securities, bids, offers, and other market-related data. Because many private-label RMBS do not trade on a daily basis, the pricing vendors use other available information, as applicable, such as benchmark curves, benchmarking of like securities, sector groupings and matrix pricing to determine the prices for individual securities.




Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


We conduct reviews of the pricing vendors' processes, methodologies and control procedures to confirm and further augment our understanding of the vendors' prices for agency and private-label RMBS. Each pricing vendor has an established challenge process in place for all MBS valuations, which facilitates resolution of potentially erroneous prices identified by us.

Our valuation technique for estimating the fair values of MBS initially requires the establishment of a "median" price for each security. All prices that are within a specified tolerance threshold of the median price are then included in the "cluster" of prices that are averaged to compute a "default" price. All prices that are outside the threshold (i.e., outliers) are subject to further analysis (including, but not limited to, comparison to prices provided by an additional third-party valuation service, prices for similar securities, and/or non-binding dealer estimates) to determine if an outlier is a better estimate of fair value. If so, then the outlier (or the other price as appropriate) is used as the final price rather than the default price. In all cases, the final price is used to determine the estimated fair value of the security.

As of December 31, 2017, two or three prices were received for substantially all of our MBS.

Based on the lack of significant market activity and observable inputs for private-label RMBS and home equity loan ABS, the recurring fair value measurements for those securities were classified as level 3 within the fair value hierarchy as of December 31, 2017 and 2016.

AFS and HTM Securities - non-MBS. The estimated fair value is determined using market-observable price quotes from third-party pricing vendors, such as the Composite Bloomberg Bond Trader screen, thus falling under the market approach. 

Advances. We determine the estimated fair value by calculating the present value of expected future cash flows from the advances (excluding the amount of the accrued interest receivable). The discount rates used in these calculations are equivalent to the replacement advance rates for advances with similar terms. In accordance with the Finance Agency's regulations, advances with a maturity or repricing period greater than six months require a prepayment fee sufficient to make us financially indifferent to the borrower's decision to prepay the advances. Therefore, the estimated fair value of advances appropriately excludes prepayment risk.

The inputs used to determine the estimated fair value of advances are as follows:

LIBOR swap curve - we use the LIBOR swap curve, which represents the fixed rates on which fixed-rate payments are swapped in exchange for payments of three-month LIBOR;
Volatility assumption - to estimate the fair value of advances with optionality, we use market-based expectations of future interest-rate volatility implied from current market prices for certain benchmark options;
Spread adjustment to the LIBOR swap curve - the spreads are calculated for various structures of advances using current internal advance pricing indications; or
CO curve - for cost-of-funds floating-rate advances that do not use the inputs above, we use the CO curve, which represents the fixed rates at which the FHLBanks can currently issue debt of various maturities.

Mortgage Loans Held for Portfolio. The estimated fair value of performing mortgage loans is determined based on quoted market prices for similar mortgage loans, if available, or modeled prices. The modeled pricing starts with prices for new MBS issued by GSEs or similar new mortgage loans, adjusted for underlying assumptions or characteristics. Prices are then interpolated for differences in coupon between our mortgage loans and the referenced MBS or mortgage loans. The prices of the referenced MBS and the mortgage loans are highly dependent upon the underlying prepayment and other assumptions. Changes in the prepayment assumptions can have a material effect on the fair value estimates.

The estimated fair value for certain single-family nonperforming loans represents an estimate of the prices we would receive if we were to sell these loans in the nonperforming whole-loan market. These nonperforming loans are 90 days or greater delinquent. We use pricing indications provided by a third-party vendor that transacts whole loan sales within this market segment as an estimate of fair value for these loans. These nonperforming loans are classified as level 3 in the fair value hierarchy.

We record non-recurring fair value adjustments to reflect partial charge-offs on impaired mortgage loans. We estimate the fair value of these assets using a current property value obtained from a third-party.




Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Accrued interest receivable and payable. The estimated fair value equals the carrying value.

Derivative assets/liabilities. We base the estimated fair values of derivatives with similar terms on market prices when available. However, active markets do not exist for many of our derivatives. Consequently, fair values for these instruments are generally estimated using standard valuation techniques such as discounted cash-flow analysis and comparisons to similar instruments. In limited instances, fair value estimates for derivatives are obtained from dealers and are corroborated by using a pricing model and observable market data (e.g., the LIBOR or OIS curves).

A discounted cash flow analysis utilizes market-observable inputs (inputs that are actively quoted and can be validated to external sources). Inputs by class of derivative are as follows:

Interest-rate related:
LIBOR curve to project, but OIS curve to discount, cash flows for collateralized interest-rate swaps; and
Volatility assumption - market-based expectations of future interest-rate volatility implied from current market prices for similar options.

TBAs:
TBA securities prices - market-based prices are determined by coupon, maturity and expected term until settlement.

MDCs:
TBA securities prices - prices are then adjusted for differences in coupon, average loan rate and seasoning.

The estimated fair values of our derivative assets and liabilities include accrued interest receivable/payable and related cash collateral, including initial and variation margin, posted to/received from counterparties. The estimated fair values of the accrued interest receivable/payable and cash collateral equal their carrying values due to their short-term nature.

We adjust the estimated fair values of our derivatives for counterparty nonperformance risk, particularly credit risk, as appropriate. We compute our nonperformance risk adjustment by using observable credit default swap spreads and estimated probability default rates applied to our exposure after considering collateral held or placed.

Grantor Trust Assets. Grantor trust assets, included as a component of other assets, are carried at estimated fair value based on quoted market prices as of the last business day of the reporting period.

Deposits. The estimated fair values are generally equal to their carrying values because the deposits are primarily overnight instruments or due on demand. We determine the estimated fair values of term deposits by calculating the present value of expected future cash flows from the deposits and excluding accrued interest payable. The discount rates used in these calculations are the costs of deposits with similar terms.

Consolidated Obligations. We assume the estimated fair value of discount notes is equal to par value due to their short-term nature.

We determine the estimated fair value of CO bonds by using prices received from up to three designated third-party pricing vendors. These pricing vendors use various proprietary models. The inputs to those models are derived from various sources including, but not limited to, benchmark yields, reported trades, dealer estimates, issuer spreads, benchmark securities, bids, offers, and other market-related data. Since many CO bonds do not trade on a daily basis, the pricing vendors use other available information, as applicable, such as benchmark curves, benchmarking of like securities, sector groupings and matrix pricing to determine the prices for individual CO bonds.

We conduct reviews of the three pricing vendors' processes, methodologies and control procedures to confirm and further augment our understanding of the vendors' prices. Each pricing vendor has an established challenge process in place for all valuations, which facilitates the resolution of potentially erroneous prices identified by us.

As of December 31, 2017, three prices were received for substantially all of our CO bonds, and the final prices for substantially all of those bonds were computed by averaging the three prices.




Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Mandatorily Redeemable Capital Stock. The estimated fair value of capital stock subject to mandatory redemption is equal to its par value and includes, if applicable, an estimated dividend earned at the time of reclassification from capital to liabilities until that amount is paid. In the ordinary course of business, our stock can only be acquired and redeemed at par value. It is not traded, and no market mechanism exists for the exchange of our stock outside the cooperative structure of our Bank.

Estimated Fair Value Measurements. The following tables present, by level within the fair value hierarchy, the estimated fair value of our financial assets and liabilities that are recorded at estimated fair value on a recurring or non-recurring basis on our statement of condition.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Netting
December 31, 2017
 
Total
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Adjustment (1)
AFS securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
GSE and TVA debentures
 
$
4,403,929

 
$

 
$
4,403,929

 
$

 
$

GSE MBS
 
2,506,295

 

 
2,506,295

 

 

Private-label RMBS
 
218,534

 

 

 
218,534

 

Total AFS securities
 
7,128,758

 

 
6,910,224

 
218,534

 

Derivative assets:
 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Interest-rate related
 
128,096

 

 
299,904

 

 
(171,808
)
Interest-rate forwards
 
37

 

 
37

 

 

MDCs
 
73

 

 
73

 

 

Total derivative assets, net
 
128,206

 

 
300,014

 

 
(171,808
)
Grantor trust assets (2)

 
21,698

 
21,698

 

 

 

Total assets at recurring estimated fair value
 
$
7,278,662

 
$
21,698


$
7,210,238

 
$
218,534

 
$
(171,808
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Derivative liabilities:
 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Interest-rate related
 
$
2,669

 
$

 
$
76,939

 
$

 
$
(74,270
)
Interest-rate forwards
 
1

 

 
1

 

 

MDCs
 
48

 

 
48

 

 

Total derivative liabilities, net
 
2,718

 

 
76,988

 

 
(74,270
)
Total liabilities at recurring estimated fair value
 
$
2,718

 
$

 
$
76,988

 
$

 
$
(74,270
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage loans held for portfolio (3)
 
$
2,637

 
$

 
$

 
$
2,637

 
$

Total assets at non-recurring estimated fair value
 
$
2,637

 
$

 
$

 
$
2,637

 
$





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Netting
December 31, 2016
 
Total
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Adjustment (1)
AFS securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
GSE and TVA debentures
 
$
4,714,634

 
$

 
$
4,714,634

 
$

 
$

GSE MBS
 
1,076,082

 

 
1,076,082

 

 

Private-label RMBS
 
269,119

 

 

 
269,119

 

Total AFS securities
 
6,059,835

 

 
5,790,716

 
269,119

 

Derivative assets:
 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Interest-rate related
 
134,206

 

 
232,459

 

 
(98,253
)
Interest-rate forwards
 
339

 

 
339

 

 

MDCs
 
303

 

 
303

 

 

Total derivative assets, net
 
134,848

 

 
233,101

 

 
(98,253
)
Grantor trust assets (2)

 
18,117

 
18,117

 

 

 

Total assets at recurring estimated fair value
 
$
6,212,800

 
$
18,117

 
$
6,023,817

 
$
269,119

 
$
(98,253
)
 
 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Derivative liabilities:
 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Interest-rate related
 
$
24,402

 
$

 
$
102,284

 
$

 
$
(77,882
)
Interest-rate forwards
 
352

 

 
352

 

 

MDCs
 
471

 

 
471

 

 

Total derivative liabilities, net
 
25,225

 

 
103,107

 

 
(77,882
)
Total liabilities at recurring estimated fair value
 
$
25,225

 
$

 
$
103,107

 
$

 
$
(77,882
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage loans held for portfolio (4)
 
$
3,492

 
$

 
$

 
$
3,492

 
$

Total assets at non-recurring estimated fair value
 
$
3,492

 
$

 
$

 
$
3,492

 
$


(1) 
Represents the application of the netting requirements that allow us to settle (i) positive and negative positions and (ii) cash collateral and related accrued interest held or placed, with the same clearing agent and/or counterparty (includes fair value adjustments on derivatives of $24,954 at December 31, 2017 for which variation margin payments are characterized as daily settled contracts).
(2) 
Included in other assets.
(3) 
Amounts are as of the date the fair value adjustment was recorded during the year ended December 31, 2017.
(4) 
Amounts are as of the date the fair value adjustment was recorded during the year ended December 31, 2016.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Level 3 Disclosures for All Assets and Liabilities that are Measured at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis. The table below presents a rollforward of our AFS private-label RMBS measured at estimated fair value on a recurring basis using level 3 significant inputs. The estimated fair values were determined using a pricing source, such as a dealer quote or comparable security price, for which the significant unobservable inputs used to determine the price were not readily available.
Level 3 Rollforward - AFS private-label RMBS
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
Balance, beginning of year
 
$
269,119

 
$
319,186

 
$
401,050

Total realized and unrealized gains (losses):
 
 
 
 
 
 
Accretion of credit losses in interest income
 
6,778

 
9,348

 
8,708

Net losses on changes in fair value in other income (loss)
 
(166
)
 
(197
)
 
(61
)
Net change in fair value not in excess of cumulative non-credit losses in OCI
 
29

 
(156
)
 
(238
)
Unrealized gains (losses) in OCI
 
2,189

 
(3,332
)
 
(7,766
)
Reclassification of non-credit portion in OCI to other income (loss)
 
166

 
197

 
61

Purchases, issuances, sales and settlements:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Settlements
 
(59,581
)
 
(55,927
)
 
(82,568
)
Balance, end of year
 
$
218,534

 
$
269,119

 
$
319,186

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net gains (losses) included in earnings attributable to changes in fair value relating to assets still held at end of year
 
$
6,612

 
$
8,291

 
$
8,647


Note 20 - Commitments and Contingencies

The following table presents our off-balance-sheet commitments at their notional amounts.
 
 
December 31, 2017
Type of Commitment
 
Expire within one year
 
Expire after one year
 
Total
Letters of credit outstanding 
 
$
102,344

 
$
121,381

 
$
223,725

Unused lines of credit (1)
 
1,084,234

 

 
1,084,234

Commitments to fund additional advances (2)
 
4,050

 

 
4,050

Commitments to fund or purchase mortgage loans, net (3)
 
70,831

 

 
70,831

Unsettled CO bonds, at par
 
28,000

 

 
28,000


(1) 
Maximum line of credit amount per member is $50,000.
(2) 
Generally for periods up to six months.
(3) 
Generally for periods up to 91 days.
    
Commitments to Extend Credit. A standby letter of credit is a financing arrangement between us and one of our members for which we charge the member a commitment fee. If we are required to make a payment for a beneficiary's draw, the payment amount is converted into a collateralized advance to the member. Substantially all of these standby letters of credit, including related commitments, range from 3 months to 20 years, although some are renewable at our option. The carrying value of guarantees (commitment fees) related to standby letters of credit is recorded in other liabilities and totaled $2,867 at December 31, 2017.

Lines of credit allow members to fund short-term cash needs (up to one year) without submitting a new application for each request for funds.

We monitor the creditworthiness of our standby letters of credit and lines of credit based on an evaluation of the financial condition of our members. In addition, commitments to extend credit are fully collateralized at the time of issuance. We have established parameters for the measurement, review, classification, and monitoring of credit risk related to these two products. Based on credit analyses performed by us as well as collateral requirements, we have not deemed it necessary to record any additional liability for these commitments. See Note 7 - Advances and Note 9 - Allowance for Credit Losses for more information.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


Commitments to Fund or Purchase Mortgage Loans. Commitments that unconditionally obligate us to fund or purchase mortgage loans are generally for periods not to exceed 91 days. Such commitments are reported as derivative assets or derivative liabilities at their estimated fair value and are reported net of participating interests sold to other FHLBanks.

Pledged Collateral. At December 31, 2017 and 2016, we had pledged cash collateral, at par, of $16,437 and $35,421, respectively, to counterparties and clearing agents. Additionally, at December 31, 2017, variation margin for daily settled contracts totaled $24,954. At December 31, 2017 and 2016, we had not pledged any securities as collateral.

Lease Commitments. Net rental and related costs totaled $287, $212, and $185 for the years ended December 31, 2017, 2016, and 2015, respectively. Total future minimum lease payments were $2,253 at December 31, 2017.

Legal Proceedings. We are subject to legal proceedings arising in the normal course of business. We record an accrual for a loss contingency when it is probable that a loss for which we could be liable has been incurred and the amount can be reasonably estimated. After consultation with legal counsel, management does not anticipate that the ultimate liability, if any, arising out of these proceedings could have a material effect on our financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.

In 2010, we filed a complaint asserting claims against several entities for negligent misrepresentation and violations of state and federal securities law occurring in connection with the sale of private-label RMBS to us. In 2013, 2014 and 2015, we executed confidential settlement agreements with certain defendants in this litigation, pursuant to which we have dismissed pending claims against, and provided legal releases to, certain entities with respect to all applicable securities at issue in the litigation, in consideration of our receipt of cash payments from or on behalf of those defendants. We had previously dismissed the complaint as to the other named defendants. As a result, all proceedings in the RMBS litigation we filed have been concluded. Cash settlement payments, net of legal fees and litigation expenses, totaled $530, $60, and $4,732 for the years ended December 31, 2017, 2016, and 2015, respectively, and were recorded in other income.

Additional discussion of other commitments and contingencies is provided in Note 7 - Advances; Note 8 - Mortgage Loans Held for Portfolio; Note 11 - Derivatives and Hedging Activities; Note 13 - Consolidated Obligations; Note 15 - Capital; and Note 19 - Estimated Fair Values.

Note 21 - Related Party and Other Transactions

Transactions with Related Parties. We are a cooperative whose members and former members (or legal successors) own all of our outstanding capital stock. Former members (including certain non-members) are required to maintain their investment in our capital stock until their outstanding business transactions with us have matured or are paid off and their capital stock is redeemed in accordance with our capital plan and regulatory requirements. See Note 15 - Capital for more information.

Under GAAP, transactions with related parties include transactions with principal owners, i.e, owners of more than 10% of the voting interests of the entity. Due to the statutory limits on members' voting rights and the number of members in our Bank, no shareholder owned more than 10 percent of the total voting interests as of and for the three-year period ended December 31, 2017. Therefore, the Bank had no transactions with principal owners for any of the periods presented.

Under GAAP, transactions with related parties also include transactions with management. Management is defined as persons who are responsible for achieving the objectives of the entity and who have the authority to establish policies and make decisions by which those objectives are to be pursued. For this purpose, management typically includes those who serve on our board of directors. The Bank provides, in the ordinary course of its business, products and services to members whose officers or directors may also serve as directors of the Bank, i.e., directors' financial institutions. However, Finance Agency regulations require that transactions with directors' financial institutions be made on the same terms as those with any other member. Therefore, all of our transactions with directors' financial institutions are subject to the same eligibility and credit criteria, as well as the same conditions, as comparable transactions with all other members.





Notes to Financial Statements, continued
($ amounts in thousands unless otherwise indicated)


The following table presents the aggregate outstanding balances with directors' financial institutions and their balance as a percent of the total balance on our statement of condition.
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Balances with Directors' Financial Institutions
 
Par value
 
% of Total
 
Par value
 
% of Total
Capital stock
 
$
40,564

 
2
%
 
$
50,810

 
3
%
Advances
 
588,108

 
2
%
 
627,105

 
2
%

The par values at December 31, 2017 reflect changes in the composition of directors' financial institutions effective January 1, 2017, due to changes in our board membership resulting from the 2016 director election.

The following table presents transactions with directors' financial institutions, taking into account the beginning and ending dates of the directors' terms, merger activity and other changes in the composition of directors' financial institutions.
 
 
Years Ended December 31,
Transactions with Directors' Financial Institutions
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
Net capital stock issuances (redemptions and repurchases)
 
$
3,912

 
$
1,516

 
$
(12,588
)
Net advances (repayments)
 
79,751

 
11,274

 
112,976

Mortgage loan purchases
 
33,274

 
38,728

 
39,590


Transactions with Members and Former Members. Substantially all advances are made to members, and all whole mortgage loans held for portfolio are purchased from members. We also maintain demand deposit accounts for members, primarily to facilitate settlement activities that are directly related to advances or mortgage loan purchases. Such transactions with members are entered into in the ordinary course of business. In addition, we may purchase investments in federal funds sold, securities purchased under agreements to resell, certificates of deposit, and MBS from members or their affiliates. All purchases are transacted at market prices without preference to the status of the counterparty or the issuer of the security as a member, nonmember, or affiliate thereof.

Under our AHP, we provide subsidies to members, which may be in the form of direct grants or below-market-rate advances. All AHP subsidies are made in the ordinary course of business. Under our Community Investment Program and our Community Investment Cash Advances program, we provide subsidies in the form of below-market-rate advances to members or standby letters of credit to members for community lending and economic development projects. All Community Investment Cash Advances subsidies are made in the ordinary course of business.

Transactions with Other FHLBanks. Occasionally, we loan (or borrow) short-term funds to (from) other FHLBanks. The following table presents the loans to other FHLBanks.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Years Ended December 31,
Loans to other FHLBanks
2017
 
2016
 
2015
Disbursements
 
$
(100,000
)
 
$
(300,000
)
 
$

Principal repayments
 
100,000

 
300,000

 


There were no borrowings from other FHLBanks during the years ended December 31, 2017, 2016, or 2015. There were no loans to or borrowings from other FHLBanks outstanding at December 31, 2017 or 2016.

In December 2016, we agreed to sell a 90% participating interest in a $100 million MCC of certain newly acquired MPP loans to the FHLBank of Atlanta. Principal amounts settled in December 2016 totaled $72 million, and the remaining $18 million settled in January 2017.

Transactions with the Office of Finance. Our proportionate share of the cost of operating the Office of Finance is identified in the Statements of Income.



GLOSSARY OF TERMS

ABS: Asset-Backed Securities
Advance: Secured loan to members, former members or Housing Associates
AFS: Available-for-Sale
AHP: Affordable Housing Program
AMA: Acquired Member Assets
AOCI: Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)
Bank Act: Federal Home Loan Bank Act of 1932, as amended
bps: basis points
CBSA: Core Based Statistical Areas, refer collectively to metropolitan and micropolitan statistical areas as defined by the United States Office of Management and Budget
CDFI: Community Development Financial Institution
CE: Credit Enhancement
CFI: Community Financial Institution, an FDIC-insured depository institution with average total assets below an annually adjusted limit by the Director based on the Consumer Price Index
CFPB: Consumer Financial Protection Bureau
CFTC: United States Commodity Futures Trading Commission
Clearinghouse: A United States Commodity Futures Trading Commission-registered derivatives clearing organization
CME: CME Clearing
CMO: Collateralized Mortgage Obligation
CO bond: Consolidated Obligation bond
DB plan: Pentegra Defined Benefit Pension Plan for Financial Institutions
DC plan: Pentegra Defined Contribution Retirement Savings Plan for Financial Institutions
DDCP: Directors' Deferred Compensation Plan
Director: Director of the Federal Housing Finance Agency
Dodd-Frank Act: Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act, as amended
Exchange Act: Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended
Fannie Mae: Federal National Mortgage Association
FASB: Financial Accounting Standards Board
FDIC: Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation
FHA: Federal Housing Administration
FHLBank: A Federal Home Loan Bank
FHLBanks: The 11 Federal Home Loan Banks or a subset thereof
FHLBank System: The 11 Federal Home Loan Banks and the Office of Finance
FICO®: Fair Isaac Corporation, the creators of the FICO credit score
Final Membership Rule: Final Rule on FHLBank Membership issued by the Federal Housing Finance Agency effective February 19, 2016
Finance Agency: Federal Housing Finance Agency, successor to Finance Board
Finance Board: Federal Housing Finance Board, predecessor to Finance Agency
FLA: First Loss Account
FOMC: Federal Open Market Committee
Form 8-K: Current Report on Form 8-K as filed with the SEC under the Exchange Act
Form 10-K: Annual Report on Form 10-K as filed with the SEC under the Exchange Act
Form 10-Q: Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q as filed with the SEC under the Exchange Act
FRB: Federal Reserve Board
Freddie Mac: Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
GAAP: Generally Accepted Accounting Principles in the United States of America
Ginnie Mae: Government National Mortgage Association
GLB Act: Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act of 1999, as amended
GSE: United States Government-Sponsored Enterprise
HERA: Housing and Economic Recovery Act of 2008, as amended
Housing Associate: Approved lender under Title II of the National Housing Act of 1934 that is either a government agency or is chartered under federal or state law with rights and powers similar to those of a corporation
HTM: Held-to-Maturity
HUD: United States Department of Housing and Urban Development
JCE Agreement: Joint Capital Enhancement Agreement, as amended, among the 11 FHLBanks



LCH: LCH.Clearnet LLC
LIBOR: London Interbank Offered Rate
LRA: Lender Risk Account
LTV: Loan-to-Value
MAP-21: Moving Ahead for Progress in the 21st Century Act, enacted on July 6, 2012
MBS: Mortgage-Backed Securities
MCC: Master Commitment Contract
MDC: Mandatory Delivery Commitment
Moody's: Moody's Investor Services
MPF: Mortgage Partnership Finance®
MPP: Mortgage Purchase Program, including Original and Advantage unless indicated otherwise
MRCS: Mandatorily Redeemable Capital Stock
MVE: Market Value of Equity
NRSRO: Nationally Recognized Statistical Rating Organization
OCC: Office of the Comptroller of the Currency
OCI: Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)
OIS: Overnight-Indexed Swap
ORERC: Other Real Estate-Related Collateral
OTTI: Other-Than-Temporary Impairment or -Temporarily Impaired (as the context indicates)
PFI: Participating Financial Institution
PMI: Primary Mortgage Insurance
REMIC: Real Estate Mortgage Investment Conduit
REO: Real Estate Owned
RMBS: Residential Mortgage-Backed Securities
S&P: Standard & Poor's Rating Service
Safety and Soundness Act: Federal Housing Enterprises Financial Safety and Soundness Act of 1992, as amended
SEC: Securities and Exchange Commission
Securities Act: Securities Act of 1933, as amended
SERP: Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolis 2005 Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan and/or a similar frozen plan
SETP: Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolis 2016 Supplemental Executive Thrift Plan, as amended
SMI: Supplemental Mortgage Insurance
TBA: To Be Announced, which represents a forward contract for the purchase or sale of MBS at a future agreed-upon date for an established price
TDR: Troubled Debt Restructuring
TVA: Tennessee Valley Authority
UPB: Unpaid Principal Balance
VaR: Value at Risk
VIE: Variable Interest Entity
WAIR: Weighted-Average Interest Rate









 



Supplementary Data

Supplementary unaudited financial data for each full quarter within the two years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016 are included in the tables below ($ amounts in millions).
 
 
1st Quarter
 
2nd Quarter
 
3rd Quarter
 
4th Quarter
 
2017
Statement of Income
 
2017
 
2017
 
2017
 
2017
 
Total
Interest income
 
$
210

 
$
243

 
$
274

 
$
289

 
$
1,016

Interest expense
 
151

 
179

 
205

 
219

 
754

Net interest income
 
59

 
64

 
69

 
70

 
262

Provision for (reversal of) credit losses
 

 

 

 

 

Net interest income after provision for credit losses
 
59

 
64

 
69

 
70

 
262

Other income (loss)
 
(3
)
 
(4
)
 
(3
)
 
4

 
(6
)
Other expenses
 
20

 
19

 
20

 
23

 
82

Income before assessments
 
36

 
41

 
46

 
51

 
174

AHP assessments
 
4

 
4

 
5

 
5

 
18

Net income
 
$
32

 
$
37

 
$
41

 
$
46

 
$
156

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1st Quarter
 
2nd Quarter
 
3rd Quarter
 
4th Quarter
 
2016
Statement of Income
 
2016
 
2016
 
2016
 
2016
 
Total
Interest income
 
$
162

 
$
168

 
$
177

 
$
188

 
$
695

Interest expense
 
113

 
122

 
128

 
134

 
497

Net interest income
 
49

 
46

 
49

 
54

 
198

Provision for (reversal of) credit losses
 

 

 

 

 

Net interest income after provision for credit losses
 
49

 
46

 
49

 
54

 
198

Other income (loss)
 
(1
)
 
(2
)
 
(4
)
 
13

 
6

Other expenses
 
19

 
18

 
19

 
22

 
78

Income before assessments
 
29

 
26

 
26

 
45

 
126

AHP assessments
 
3

 
2

 
3

 
5

 
13

Net income
 
$
26

 
$
24

 
$
23

 
$
40

 
$
113


ITEM 9A. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
 
Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures
 
We are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures that are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed by us in our reports filed under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended ("Exchange Act"), is: (a) recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the Securities and Exchange Commission's rules and forms; and (b) accumulated and communicated to our management, including our principal executive officer, principal financial officer, and principal accounting officer, to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosures.

As of December 31, 2017, we conducted an evaluation, under the supervision and with the participation of our management, including our Chief Executive Officer (the principal executive officer), Chief Financial Officer (the principal financial officer) and Chief Accounting Officer (the principal accounting officer), of the effectiveness of the design and operation of our disclosure controls and procedures pursuant to Rule 13a-15 of the Exchange Act. Based on that evaluation, our Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer and Chief Accounting Officer concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures were effective as of December 31, 2017.
 
Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting. There were no changes in our internal control over financial reporting, as defined in Rules 13a-15(f) and 15(d)-15(f) of the Exchange Act, that occurred during our most recently completed fiscal quarter that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.





Limitations on the Effectiveness of Controls. We do not expect that our disclosure controls and procedures and other internal controls will prevent all error and fraud. A control system, no matter how well conceived and operated, can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurance that the objectives of the control system are met. Further, the design of a control system must reflect the fact that there are resource constraints, and the benefits of controls must be considered relative to their costs. Because of the inherent limitations in all control systems, no evaluation of controls can provide absolute assurance that all control issues and instances of fraud, if any, have been detected. These inherent limitations include the realities that judgments in decision making can be faulty and that breakdowns can occur because of simple error or mistake. Additionally, controls can be circumvented by the individual acts of some persons, by collusion of two or more people, or by management override of the controls. The design of any system of controls is also based in part upon certain assumptions about the likelihood of future events, and there can only be reasonable assurance that any design will succeed in achieving its stated goals under all potential future conditions. Additionally, over time, controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate. Because of the inherent limitations in a cost-effective control system, misstatements due to error or fraud may occur and not be detected.

ITEM 10. DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

We use acronyms and terms throughout this Item that are defined herein or in the Glossary of Terms.

Board of Directors

The Bank Act divides the directorships of the FHLBanks into two categories, "member" directorships and "independent" directorships. Both types of directorships are filled by a vote of the members. Elections for member directors are held on a state-by-state basis. Member directors are elected by a plurality vote of the members in their state. Independent directors are elected at-large by all the members in the FHLBank district without regard to the state. No member of management of an FHLBank may serve as a director of an FHLBank.

Under the Bank Act, member directorships must always make up a majority of the board of directors' seats, and the independent directorships must comprise at least 40% of the entire board. A Finance Agency Order issued June 1, 2017 provides that we have 17 seats on our board of directors for 2018, consisting of five Indiana member directors, four Michigan member directors, and eight independent directors. The term of office for directors is four years, unless otherwise adjusted by the Director in order to achieve an appropriate staggering of terms, with approximately one-fourth of the directors' terms expiring each year. Directors may not serve more than three consecutive full terms.

Finance Agency regulations permit, but do not require, the board of directors to conduct an annual assessment of the skills and experience possessed by the board as a whole and to determine whether the capabilities of the board would be enhanced through the addition of individuals with particular skills and experience. We may identify those qualifications and inform the voting members as part of our nomination and balloting process; however, by regulation as described below, we may not exclude a member director nominee from the election ballot on the basis of those qualifications. For the 2017 director elections, our board listed in its request for nominations certain desirable candidate financial and industry experiences, but no particular qualifications beyond the eligibility criteria were required as part of the nomination, balloting and election process.

Nomination of Member Directors. The Bank Act and Finance Agency regulations require that member director nominees meet certain statutory and regulatory criteria in order to be eligible to be elected and serve as directors. To be eligible, an individual must: (i) be an officer or director of a member institution located in the state in which there is an open member director position; (ii) represent a member institution that is in compliance with the minimum capital requirements established by its regulator; and (iii) be a United States citizen. These criteria are the only eligibility criteria that member directors must meet, and we are not permitted to establish additional eligibility or qualifications criteria for member directors or nominees.

Each eligible institution may nominate representatives from member institutions in its respective state to serve as member directors. By statute and regulation, only our shareholders may nominate and elect member directors. Our board of directors is not permitted to nominate or elect member directors, except to fill a vacancy for the remainder of an unexpired term or to fill a vacancy for which no nominations were received. With respect to member directors, under Finance Agency regulations, no director, officer, employee, attorney or agent of our Bank (except in his or her personal capacity) may, directly or indirectly, support the nomination or election of a particular individual for a member directorship. Finance Agency regulations do not require member institutions to communicate to us the reasons for their nominations, and we have no power to require them to do so.





Nomination of Independent Directors. Independent director nominees also must meet certain statutory and regulatory eligibility criteria. Each independent director must be a United States citizen and a bona fide resident of Michigan or Indiana. Before nominating an individual for an independent directorship, other than for a public interest directorship, our board must determine that the nominee's knowledge or experience is commensurate with that needed to oversee a financial institution with a size and complexity that is comparable to that of our Bank. The Bank Act prohibits an independent director from serving as an officer of an FHLBank or as a director, officer, or employee of a member of the applicable FHLBank, or of a recipient of an advance from an FHLBank.

Under the Bank Act, there are two types of independent directors:

Public interest directors - We are required to have at least two public interest directors. Each must have more than four years of experience in representing consumer or community interests in banking services, credit needs, housing, or consumer financial protections.
Other independent directors - Independent directors must have demonstrated knowledge or experience in auditing or accounting, derivatives, financial management, organizational management, project development or risk management practices, or other expertise established by Finance Agency regulations.

Pursuant to the Bank Act and Finance Agency regulations, the board of directors, after consultation with our Affordable Housing Advisory Council, nominates candidates for the independent director positions. Individuals interested in serving as independent directors may submit an application for consideration by the Executive/Governance Committee. The application form is available on our website at www.fhlbi.com, by clicking on "Resources," "Corporate Governance" and "Board of Directors." Our members may also nominate independent director candidates for the Executive/Governance Committee to consider. The conclusion that the independent director nominees may qualify to serve as our directors is based upon the nominees' satisfaction of the regulatorily prescribed eligibility criteria listed above and verified through application and eligibility certification forms prescribed by the Finance Agency. The board of directors then submits the slated independent director candidates to the Finance Agency for its review and comment. Once the Finance Agency has accepted candidates for the independent director positions, we hold a district-wide election for those positions.

Under Finance Agency regulations, if the board of directors nominates only one independent director candidate for each open seat, each candidate must receive at least 20% of the votes that are eligible to be cast in order to be elected. If there is more than one candidate for each open independent director seat, then such requirement does not apply.

Nominating Committee. Our board of directors does not have a nominating committee with respect to member director positions because member directors are nominated by our members. As noted, our board, after review by the Executive/Governance Committee and consultation with our Affordable Housing Advisory Council, nominates candidates for independent director positions.

2017 Member and Independent Director Elections. The Bank Act and Finance Agency regulations set forth the voting rights and processes with respect to the election of member directors and independent directors. For the election of both member directors and independent directors, each eligible institution is entitled to cast one vote for each share of stock that it was required to hold as of the record date (i.e., December 31 of the year prior to the year in which the election is held); however, the number of votes that a member institution may cast for each directorship cannot exceed the average number of shares of stock that were required to be held by all member institutions located in that state on the record date.

The only matter submitted to a vote of our shareholders in 2017 was the fourth quarter election of two independent directors. In addition, because we had only one nominee for two open Indiana member directorships, that nominee, Mr. Myers, was deemed by Finance Agency regulation to be elected without a shareholder vote. In 2017 the nomination of member directors was conducted electronically; for independent directors, the 2017 nomination was conducted both electronically and by mail. Although our procedures permit voting electronically or by paper ballot, the 2017 voting by members was conducted electronically. No meeting of the members was held with regard to the election. The board of directors does not solicit proxies, nor are eligible institutions permitted to solicit or use proxies to cast their votes in an election for directors. The 2017 election was conducted in accordance with the Bank Act and Finance Agency regulations.





Board of Directors Vacancies. Under Finance Agency regulations, if a vacancy occurs on an FHLBank's board of directors, the board, by a majority vote of the remaining directors, shall elect an individual to fill the unexpired term of office of the vacant directorship. Any individual so elected must satisfy all eligibility requirements of the Bank Act and Finance Agency regulations applicable to his or her predecessor. Before an election to fill a vacant directorship occurs, the FHLBank must obtain an executed eligibility certification form from each individual being considered to fill the vacancy, and must verify each individual's eligibility. The FHLBank must also verify the qualifications of any potential independent director. Before electing an independent director, the FHLBank must deliver to the Finance Agency for review a copy of the application form of each individual being considered by the board of directors. Promptly following an election to fill a vacancy on the board, the FHLBank must send a notice to its members and the Finance Agency providing information about the elected director, including his or her name, company affiliation, title, term expiration date and (for member directors) the voting state that the director represents. In November, 2017, in accordance with Finance Agency regulations, our board conducted an election to fill an Indiana member director vacancy (effective January 1, 2018) that remained following the completion of the member director election described in the preceding paragraph.

Our directors are listed in the table below, including those who served in 2017 or serve as of March 9, 2018.
Name
 
Age
 
Director Since
 
Term
Expiration
 
Independent (elected by District) or Member (elected by State)
James D. MacPhee, Chair (1)
 
70
 
1/1/2008
 
12/31/2018
 
Member (MI)
Dan L. Moore, Vice Chair (1)
 
67
 
1/1/2011
 
12/31/2018
 
Member (IN)
Jonathan P. Bradford (2)
 
68
 
4/24/2007
 
12/31/2020
 
Independent
Ronald Brown
 
53
 
1/1/2018
 
12/31/2021
 
Member (IN)
Charlotte C. Decker
 
54
 
1/1/2017
 
12/31/2020
 
Independent
Matthew P. Forrester
 
61
 
1/1/2010
 
12/31/2017
 
Member (IN)
Karen F. Gregerson
 
57
 
1/1/2013
 
12/31/2020
 
Member (IN)
Michael J. Hannigan, Jr.
 
73
 
4/24/2007
 
12/31/2021
 
Independent
Carl E. Liedholm
 
77
 
1/1/2009
 
12/31/2020
 
Independent
James L. Logue, III
 
65
 
4/24/2007
 
12/31/2021
 
Independent
Robert D. Long
 
63
 
4/24/2007
 
12/31/2019
 
Independent
Michael J. Manica
 
69
 
1/1/2016
 
12/31/2019
 
Member (MI)
Larry W. Myers
 
59
 
1/1/2018
 
12/31/2021
 
Member (IN)
Christine Coady Narayanan (3)
 
54
 
1/1/2008
 
12/31/2019
 
Independent
Jeffrey A. Poxon
 
71
 
6/15/2006
 
12/31/2017
 
Member (IN)
John L. Skibski
 
53
 
1/1/2008
 
12/31/2019
 
Member (MI)
Thomas R. Sullivan
 
67
 
1/1/2011
 
12/31/2018
 
Member (MI)
Larry A. Swank
 
75
 
1/1/2009
 
12/31/2018
 
Independent
Ryan M. Warner
 
61
 
1/1/2017
 
12/31/2020
 
Member (IN)

(1) 
Our board of directors, with input from the Executive/Governance Committee, elects a Chair and a Vice Chair to two-year terms. On November 17, 2017, our board elected Mr. MacPhee as Chair and Mr. Moore as Vice Chair.
(2) 
Public Interest Director designation, effective April 24, 2007, throughout current term.
(3) 
Public Interest Director designation, effective May 15, 2014, throughout current term.





Each of our directors serves on one or more committees of our board. The following table presents the committees on which each director serves as of March 9, 2018 as well as whether the director is the chair (C), vice chair (VC), member (x), Ex-Officio member (EO), or alternate (A) of the respective committee.
Name
 
Executive / Governance
 
Finance/Budget
 
Affordable Housing
 
Human Resources
 
Audit
 
Risk Oversight
 
Technology
James D. MacPhee
 
C
 
EO
 
EO
 
EO
 
EO
 
EO
 
EO
Dan L. Moore
 
VC
 
x
 
x
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Jonathan P. Bradford
 
x
 
x
 
x
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
x
Ronald Brown
 
 
 
x
 
x
 
 
 
 
 
x
 
 
Charlotte C. Decker
 
 
 
 
 
x
 
 
 
 
 
x
 
VC
Karen F. Gregerson
 
x
 
 
 
 
 
x
 
 
 
x
 
C
Michael J. Hannigan, Jr.
 
x
 
 
 
x
 
VC
 
 
 
 
 
x
Carl E. Liedholm
 
 
 
C
 
x
 
 
 
 
 
x
 
 
James L. Logue, III
 
 
 
 
 
VC
 
x
 
 
 
 
 
x
Robert D. Long
 
x
 
 
 
 
 
x
 
C
 
 
 
x
Michael J. Manica
 
A
 
VC
 
 
 
 
 
x
 
 
 
 
Larry W. Myers
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
x
 
x
 
x
Christine Coady Narayanan
 
x
 
 
 
 
 
C
 
x
 
 
 
 
John L. Skibski
 
x
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
x
 
C
 
 
Thomas R. Sullivan
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
x
 
 
 
VC
 
 
Larry A. Swank
 
x
 
x
 
C
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Ryan M. Warner
 
 
 
x
 
 
 
x
 
VC
 
x
 
 

The following is a summary of the background and business experience of each of our directors. Except as otherwise indicated, for at least the last five years, each director has been engaged in his or her principal occupation as described below.

James D. MacPhee is the Vice Chair of the board of directors and an Executive Officer of Kalamazoo County State Bank in Schoolcraft, Michigan, after having served as a director and its CEO from 1991 through his retirement in December 2015. Mr. MacPhee also serves as a director of First State Bank in Decatur, Michigan. Mr. MacPhee has worked in the financial services industry since 1968. During his career, Mr. MacPhee has held leadership positions with the Community Bankers of Michigan (formerly the Michigan Association of Community Bankers) and the Independent Community Bankers of America, is a past chair of the latter organization and currently serves on its Federal Delegate Board and its Nominating Committee. He holds an associate's degree in business from Kalamazoo Valley Community College and attended a two-year accelerated executive management program at the University of Michigan (Ross School of Business).

Dan L. Moore is the President and CEO of Home Bank SB in Martinsville, Indiana, and has served in that position since 2006. Prior to that time, Mr. Moore served as that bank's Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer. Mr. Moore has also served as a director of Home Bank SB since 2000. He has been employed by Home Bank SB since 1978. Mr. Moore is a member of the OCC Mutual Savings Association Advisory Committee and a member of the board of Indiana University Health - Morgan Hospital. He holds a bachelor of science degree from Indiana State University and a master of science degree in management from Indiana Wesleyan University.

Jonathan P. Bradford is the owner and President of Development and Construction Resources, LLC in Grand Rapids, Michigan, which provides consulting services for non-profit companies engaged in affordable housing and community development activities. In addition, Mr. Bradford is Vice President of the board of the Michigan Non-Profit Housing Corporation, which owns several multi-family housing developments in Grand Rapids and Detroit, Michigan. Mr. Bradford retired in September 2015 as President and CEO of Inner City Christian Federation, in Grand Rapids, Michigan, a position he had held since 1981. Inner City Christian Federation is involved in the development of affordable housing, as well as housing education and counseling. As President and CEO of Inner City Christian Federation, Mr. Bradford developed the organization's real estate development financing system and guided the development of over 500 housing units and approximately 70,000 square feet of commercial space. Mr. Bradford holds a bachelor of arts degree from Calvin College and a master of social work degree from the University of Michigan with a concentration in housing and community development policy and planning. He is also licensed in the State of Michigan as a residential building contractor.





Ronald Brown is Senior Vice President - General Counsel and a member of the board of directors of United Fidelity Bank, F.S.B., in Evansville, Indiana, and is Senior Vice President - General Counsel of its affiliated thrift holding company, Pedcor Financial, LLC, in Carmel, Indiana. He has held those positions since 2015 and 2005, respectively. He is also a member of the boards of two other affiliated companies, Pedcor Insurance Company and Pedcor Assurance Company. Mr. Brown holds a bachelor of arts degree from the University of Southern California and a juris doctor degree from Indiana University.

Charlotte C. Decker is Chief Information Technology Officer for the UAW Retiree Medical Benefits Trust, in Detroit, Michigan, and has held that position since December 2014. Ms. Decker also served as a Senior Consultant for Data Consulting Group, an information technology consulting services company in Detroit, Michigan, from August 2014 through December 2015. Prior to that, she was Vice President - Chief Technology Officer for Auto Club Group, an insurance and financial services company in Dearborn, Michigan, from September 2008 to June 2014. In addition, she was a Director of Global Computing for General Motors Corporation in Detroit, Michigan, from 2004 to 2007. Ms. Decker holds a bachelor of science degree, a master of science degree, and a master of business administration degree, all from the University of Michigan.

Karen F. Gregerson is the President and CEO of The Farmers Bank in Frankfort, Indiana, and President of The Farmers Bancorp, a bank holding company in Frankfort, Indiana, having been appointed to those positions in April 2016. She is also a director of both entities. Prior to those appointments, Ms. Gregerson was Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of STAR Financial Bank in Fort Wayne, Indiana, a position she had held since 1997. Ms. Gregerson holds a bachelor of science degree from Ball State University and a master of science degree in organizational leadership from the Indiana Institute of Technology.

Michael J. Hannigan, Jr. has been employed in mortgage banking and related businesses for more than 25 years. Currently, he is the President of The Hannigan Company, LLC, a real estate consulting company in Carmel, Indiana, and has held that position since 2007 when he formed the company. From 1986 to 2006, Mr. Hannigan was the Executive Vice President and a director of The Precedent Companies, Inc., a residential real estate company. Mr. Hannigan previously served as a Senior Vice President and director of Union Federal Savings Bank. During his career, Mr. Hannigan has served as a director and founding partner of several companies engaged in residential development, home building, private water utility service, industrial development, and private capital acquisition. Mr. Hannigan is a director and member of the Executive Committee of the Indiana Builders Association, a trade association. He holds a bachelor of business administration degree from the University of Notre Dame. He has previously served as Vice Chair of our board of directors and Vice Chair of the Council of FHLBanks.

Carl E. Liedholm, PhD, is a Professor of Economics at Michigan State University in East Lansing, Michigan, and has held that position since 1965. He has taught graduate and post-graduate courses and presented seminars on international finance, banking and housing matters. Mr. Liedholm has over forty years of experience in generating and analyzing financial and other performance data from enterprises in over two dozen countries. Mr. Liedholm holds a bachelor of arts degree from Pomona College and a doctoral degree from the University of Michigan. He has published numerous books and monographs on economics and related matters.

James L. Logue III is the Senior Vice President and Chief Strategy Officer of Cinnaire Corp., formerly Great Lakes Capital Fund, a housing finance and development company in Lansing, Michigan. He was appointed as Chief Strategy Officer in 2017 after having served as Chief Operating Officer of Cinnaire since 2003. Prior to that, Mr. Logue served as the Executive Director of the Michigan State Housing Development Authority beginning in 1991. Mr. Logue has over 40 years' experience in affordable housing, finance, commercial real estate and economic development matters. He served as Deputy Assistant Secretary for Multifamily Housing Programs at HUD in 1988 - 1989, and has been involved in various capacities with the issuance of housing bonds and the management of multi-billion dollar housing portfolios. Mr. Logue serves as a board member of the National Housing Trust, Washington, D.C. In addition, he serves on the Community Care Board of Sparrow Health System, a locally owned and governed health system in Lansing, Michigan. Mr. Logue holds a bachelor of arts degree from Kean College.





Robert D. Long retired from KPMG LLP on December 31, 2006, where he had been the Office Managing Partner in the Indianapolis, Indiana office since 1999, and had served as an Audit Partner for KPMG since 1988. As an audit partner, Mr. Long served a number of companies with public, private and cooperative ownership structures in a variety of industries, including banking, finance and insurance. Mr. Long maintains his CPA designation. Since December 2014, Mr. Long has been a member of the board, Chair of the Audit Committee and Audit Committee financial expert for Celadon Group, Inc., an NYSE-listed transportation and logistics company. From 2010 to 2015, Mr. Long was a member of the board and Chair of the Audit Committee for Beefeaters Holding Company, Inc., a pet food company. From 2009 to 2014, Mr. Long was a member of the board and Chair of the Audit Committee for Schulman Associates Institutional Review Board, Inc., a company providing independent review services to pharmaceutical and clinical research companies. He holds a bachelor of science degree from Indiana University.

Michael J. Manica is the Executive Vice President and a director of United Community Financial Corporation, a bank holding company, and is President, CEO and director of its banking subsidiary, United Bank of Michigan, in Grand Rapids, Michigan, and has held those positions since March 2014. Before his appointment as President and CEO, Mr. Manica had served as President and Chief Operating Officer and director since 2000. His career with United Bank of Michigan began in 1980. He was previously employed at the FDIC. Mr. Manica serves as Chair of the Michigan Bankers Association. He holds a bachelor of arts degree from the University of Michigan and completed the Graduate School of Banking program at the University of Wisconsin.

Larry W. Myers is the President and CEO of First Savings Financial Group, Inc., a bank holding company, and its banking subsidiary, First Savings Bank in Clarksville, Indiana, and has held those positions since 2009 and 2007, respectively. Previously he served as the Chief Operations Officer of First Savings Bank, and has served as a director of that bank since 2005. Mr. Myers has over 35 years' experience in retail banking, commercial lending and wealth management. Mr. Myers has served as Chair of the Indiana Bankers Association, and currently is a member of its Government Relations Council. He has also served as a director of the Community Bank Council of the American Bankers Association, and currently is a member of its Government Relations Council. Mr. Myers holds a bachelor of science degree and a masters of business administration degree, both from the University of Kentucky.

Christine Coady Narayanan is the President and CEO of Opportunity Resource Fund, with offices in Lansing and Detroit, Michigan, having served in that position since October 2004. Opportunity Resource Fund is a non-profit CDFI engaged in lending for affordable housing and community development purposes. Ms. Narayanan has held various positions with the Opportunity Resource Fund and its predecessor organization since 1989, and served as its Executive Director from 1997 to 2004. She holds an associate degree from Lansing Community College and a bachelor of arts degree from Spring Arbor University.

John L. Skibski is the Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of MBT Financial Corp., a NASDAQ-listed bank holding company located in Monroe, Michigan, and Monroe Bank and Trust, its banking subsidiary. Mr. Skibski has held those positions since 2004, and has been a director of both companies since 2008. Mr. Skibski has over 25 years' experience in banking in various financial controls capacities. He holds a bachelor of business administration degree and a master of business administration degree from the University of Toledo.

Thomas R. Sullivan is a director of Mercantile Bank Corp., a NASDAQ-listed bank holding company, and Mercantile Bank of Michigan, its banking subsidiary, after having served as Chair of the board of directors of Mercantile Bank Corp. from June 2014 until his retirement as Chair in May 2015. From 2000 through June 2014, Mr. Sullivan was President, CEO, and a director of Firstbank Corporation, a NASDAQ-listed multi-bank holding company in Alma, Michigan, and a director of each of its subsidiary banks. Mr. Sullivan was also President and CEO of Firstbank (Mt. Pleasant), a state bank subsidiary of Firstbank Corporation in Mt. Pleasant, Michigan, from 1991 through January 2007. Mr. Sullivan has over forty years of banking experience. He has previously served on the Community Bankers Council of the American Bankers Association, as a director of the Michigan Bankers Association, and as a member of the Regulation Review Committee of the Independent Community Bankers of America. Mr. Sullivan holds a bachelor of science degree from Wayne State University, and has attended several banking schools.

Larry A. Swank is Founder, CEO and Chair of Sterling Group, Inc. and affiliated companies in Mishawaka, Indiana. Mr. Swank has served as Chair and CEO of Sterling Group, Inc. since 1976, and served as its President until July 2012. The principal business of that company and its affiliates involves the acquisition, development, construction and management of multi-family housing and storage units. Mr. Swank's company manages 53 properties in 15 states. Mr. Swank has served as a director of the National Association of Home Builders since 1997 and as a member of its Executive Board from 1997 to 2012. He has served as Chair of that association's Housing Finance Committee on three separate occasions.





Ryan M. Warner is President and a director of Bippus State Bank in Huntington, Indiana. Mr. Warner has held these positions since 1987, and has been employed by Bippus State Bank since 1977. Mr. Warner currently serves as Treasurer of the Huntington County Economic Development board of directors, having previously served as its President. He also serves as Chairman of the board of directors of Parkview Huntington Hospital. Mr. Warner received an associate degree in accounting from International Business College, and completed the Graduate School of Banking program at the University of Wisconsin.

Audit Committee and Audit Committee Financial Expert. Our board of directors has a standing Audit Committee that was comprised of the following directors as of December 31, 2017:

Robert D. Long, Chair, independent director
Matthew P. Forrester, Vice Chair
Karen F. Gregerson
Michael J. Manica
Christine Coady Narayanan, independent director
Ryan M. Warner
James D. MacPhee, Ex-Officio Voting Member
 
Our board of directors has determined that Mr. Long is an Audit Committee Financial Expert under SEC rules, due primarily to his previous experience as an audit partner at a major public accounting firm. Our board has determined that Mr. Long is "independent" under the New York Stock Exchange rules definition, and has further determined that no member director may qualify as "independent" under that definition due to the cooperative ownership structure of our Bank by its member institutions. For further discussion about the board's analysis of director independence, see Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions and Director Independence.

The Bank Act requires the FHLBanks to comply with the substantive audit committee director independence rules applicable to issuers of securities under the rules adopted pursuant to the Exchange Act. Those rules provide that, to be considered an independent member of an audit committee, a director may not be an affiliated person of the registrant. The term "affiliated person" means a person that directly, or indirectly through one or more intermediaries, controls, or is controlled by, or is under common control with, the registrant. The rule provides a "safe harbor," whereby a person will not be deemed an affiliated person if the person is not the beneficial owner, directly or indirectly, of more than 10% of any class of voting securities of the registrant. All of our Audit Committee member directors' institutions presently meet this safe harbor.

Audit Committee Report. Our Audit Committee operates under a written charter adopted by the board of directors that was most recently amended on March 24, 2017. The Audit Committee charter is available on our website by scrolling to the bottom of any web page on www.fhlbi.com and then selecting "Corporate Governance" in the navigation menu. In accordance with its charter, the Audit Committee assists the board in fulfilling its fiduciary responsibilities and overseeing the internal and external audit functions. The Audit Committee is responsible for evaluating the Bank's compliance with laws, regulations, policies and procedures (including the Code of Conduct), and for determining that the Bank has adequate administrative, operating and internal controls. In addition, the Audit Committee is responsible for providing reasonable assurance regarding the integrity of financial and other data used by the board, the Finance Agency, our members and the public. To fulfill these responsibilities, the Audit Committee may, in accordance with its charter, conduct or authorize investigations into any matters within the Committee's scope of responsibilities. The Audit Committee may also retain independent counsel, accountants, or others to assist in any investigation.

The Audit Committee annually reviews its charter and practices and has determined that its charter and practices are consistent with all applicable laws, regulations and policies. During 2017, the Audit Committee met 12 times and, among other matters, also:

reviewed the scope of and overall plans for the external and internal audit programs;
reviewed and recommended board approval of our policy with regard to the hiring of former employees of the independent registered public accounting firm;
reviewed and approved our policy for the pre-approval of audit and permitted non-audit services by the independent registered public accounting firm;
received reports pursuant to our policy for the submission and confidential treatment of communications from employees and others about accounting, internal controls and auditing matters; and
reviewed the adequacy of our internal controls, including for purposes of evaluating the fair presentation of our financial statements in connection with certifications made by our principal executive officer, principal financial officer and principal accounting officer.





The Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 requires that the Audit Committee establish and maintain procedures for the confidential submission of employee concerns regarding questionable accounting, internal controls or auditing matters. The Audit Committee has established procedures for the receipt, retention and treatment, on a confidential basis, of any related concerns we receive, including automated notifications from the EthicsPoint reporting system which was implemented to assist the Audit Committee in administering the anonymous complaint procedures. The Audit Committee ensures that the Bank is in compliance with all applicable rules and regulations with respect to the submission to the Audit Committee of anonymous complaints. The Audit Committee encourages employees and third-party individuals and organizations to report concerns about accounting controls, auditing matters or anything else that appears to involve financial or other wrongdoing pertaining to the Bank.

The Bank is one of 11 regional FHLBanks across the United States, which, along with the Office of Finance, compose the FHLBank System. Each FHLBank operates as a separate entity with its own management, employees, and board of directors, and each is regulated by the Finance Agency. The Office of Finance has responsibility for the issuance of consolidated obligations on behalf of the FHLBanks, and for publishing combined financial reports of the FHLBanks. Accordingly, the FHLBank System has determined that it is optimal to have the same independent audit firm to coordinate and perform the separate audits of the financial statements of each FHLBank and the FHLBanks' combined financial reports. The FHLBanks and the Office of Finance cooperate in selecting and evaluating the performance of the independent auditor, but the responsibility for the appointment of and oversight of the independent auditor remains solely with the audit committees of each FHLBank and the Office of Finance.

PricewaterhouseCoopers ("PwC") has been the independent auditor for the FHLBank System and the Bank since 1990. The Audit Committee engages in thorough evaluations each year when appointing an independent auditor. In connection with the appointment of the Bank's independent auditor, the Audit Committee's evaluation included consultation with the Audit Committees of the other FHLBanks and the Office of Finance. In the course of these evaluations, the Audit Committee considers, among other factors:

an analysis of the risks and benefits of retaining the same firm as independent auditor versus engaging a different firm, including consideration of:
PwC engagement audit partner, engagement quality review partner and audit team rotation;
PwC's tenure as our independent auditor;
benefits associated with engaging a different firm as independent auditor; and
potential disruption and risks associated with changing the Bank's auditor;
PwC's familiarity with our operations and businesses, accounting policies and practices and internal control over financial reporting;
PwC's historical and recent performance of our audit, including the results of an internal survey of PwC's service and quality;
an analysis of PwC's known legal risks and significant proceedings;
both engagement and external data relating to audit quality and performance, including recent Public Company Accounting Oversight Board audit quality inspection reports on PwC and its peer firms;
the appropriateness of PwC's fees, on both an absolute basis and as compared to fees charged to other banks both within and beyond the FHLBank System and trends therein; and
the diversity of PwC's ownership and staff assigned to the engagement.

The Audit Committee reviews and approves the amount of fees paid to PwC for audit, audit-related and other services. Audit fees represent fees for professional services provided in connection with the audit of our annual financial statements and internal control over financial reporting and reviews of our quarterly financial statements, regulatory filings, and other SEC matters. The Audit Committee has determined that PwC did not provide any non-audit services that would impair its independence and there are no other matters which cause the Committee to believe PwC is not independent. Based on its review, the Audit Committee appointed PwC as our independent registered public accounting firm for the year ended December 31, 2017.

In accordance with SEC rules, audit partners are subject to rotation requirements to limit the number of consecutive years an individual partner may provide service to our Bank. For engagement audit and quality review partners, the maximum number of consecutive years of service in that capacity is five years. The process for selection of our lead audit partner pursuant to this rotation policy involves a meeting between the Chair of the Audit Committee and the candidate(s) for the role, as well as discussion by the full Audit Committee and with management.





Management has the primary responsibility for the integrity and reliability of our financial statements, accounting and financial reporting principles, and internal controls and procedures designed to assure compliance with accounting standards and applicable laws and regulations. An independent registered public accounting firm is responsible for performing an independent audit of our financial statements and of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting in accordance with auditing standards promulgated by the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board and standards applicable to financial audits in accordance with Government Auditing Standards, issued by the Comptroller General of the United States. Our internal auditors are responsible for preparing an annual audit plan and conducting internal audits under the direction of our Chief Internal Audit Officer, who reports to the Audit Committee. The Audit Committee's responsibility is to monitor and oversee these processes.

In this context, prior to their issuance, the Audit Committee reviewed and discussed the quarterly and annual earnings releases, financial statements (including the presentation of any non-GAAP financial information) and additional disclosures under "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" with management, our internal auditors and PwC. The Audit Committee also oversaw our internal auditors' review of our policies and practices with respect to financial risk assessment, and our processes and practices with respect to enterprise risk assessment and management (although the board's Risk Oversight Committee has primary responsibility for the review of our risk assessment and risk management matters). The Audit Committee discussed with PwC matters required to be discussed by Auditing Standard No. 1301 Communications with Audit Committee, as amended, and Rule 2-07 (Communication with Audit Committees) of Regulation S-X. The Audit Committee met with PwC and with our internal auditors, in each case with and without other members of management present, to discuss the results of their respective audits; their views regarding the appropriateness of management's estimates, judgments, selection of accounting policies, and systems of internal controls; and the overall quality and integrity of our financial reporting. Management represented to the Audit Committee that our financial statements were prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

Based on its discussions with our management, our internal auditors and PwC, as well as its review of the representations of management and PwC's report, the Audit Committee recommended to the board, and the board has approved, to include the audited financial statements in our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2017, for filing with the SEC.

The 2018 Audit Committee is comprised of the following directors as of March 9, 2018:

Robert D. Long, Chair, independent director
Ryan M. Warner, Vice Chair
Michael J. Manica
Larry W. Myers
Christine Coady Narayanan, independent director
John L. Skibski
James D. MacPhee, Ex-Officio Voting Member





Executive Officers

Our Executive Officers during the last completed fiscal year, as determined under SEC rules, are listed in the table below. Each officer serves a term of office of one calendar year or until the election and qualification of his or her successor, provided, however, that pursuant to the Bank Act, our board of directors may dismiss any officer at any time. Except as indicated, each officer has been employed in the principal occupation listed below for at least five years.
Name
 
Age
 
Position
Cindy L. Konich (1)
 
61
 
President - Chief Executive Officer ("CEO")
William D. Miller (2)
 
60
 
Executive Vice President - Chief Risk Officer ("CRO")
Gregory L. Teare (3)
 
64
 
Executive Vice President - Chief Financial Officer ("CFO")
Chad A. Brandt (4)
 
53
 
Senior Vice President - Treasurer
Jonathan W. Griffin (5)
 
47
 
Senior Vice President - Chief Marketing Officer
Mary M. Kleiman (6)
 
58
 
Senior Vice President - General Counsel and Chief Compliance Officer ("CCO")
Gregory J. McKee (7)
 
44
 
Senior Vice President - Chief Internal Audit Officer
K. Lowell Short, Jr. (8)
 
61
 
Senior Vice President - Chief Accounting Officer ("CAO")
Deron J. Streitenberger (9)
 
50
 
Senior Vice President - Chief Business Operations Officer ("CBOO")

(1)
Ms. Konich was appointed by our board of directors to serve as President - CEO in July 2013. Prior to that appointment, she served as Acting Co-President - CEO for two periods during 2013. Previously, Ms. Konich had been promoted to Executive Vice President - Chief Operating Officer - Chief Financial Officer in July 2010 after having served as Senior Vice President - Chief Financial Officer beginning in September 2007. Ms. Konich holds an MBA and is a CPA.
(2) 
Mr. Miller was promoted to Executive Vice President - CRO effective January 2017, after having been appointed by our board of directors as Senior Vice President - CRO in February 2014. Mr. Miller was named First Vice President - Chief Investment Officer in May 2013. Mr. Miller joined our Bank as First Vice President - Director of Capital Markets in July 2011. Mr. Miller holds an MBA.
(3)
Mr. Teare was promoted to Executive Vice President - CFO effective January 2017, after having been appointed by our board of directors as Senior Vice President - CFO in February 2015. He was previously appointed by our board of directors as Senior Vice President - Chief Banking Officer in September 2008. Mr. Teare holds an MBA.
(4)
Mr. Brandt was appointed by our board of directors as Senior Vice President - Treasurer effective January 4, 2016. Previously, Mr. Brandt was Vice President and Senior Manager - Liquidity and Funding at BMO Harris Bank from July 2015 to December 2015. Prior to that, he was Managing Principal of North Center Management Partners LLC from December 2014 to July 2015. Mr. Brandt also served as Vice President - Finance at Metropolitan Capital Bank & Trust and Metropolitan Capital Investment Banc, Inc. from September 2013 to November 2014, and as a Managing Director of Incapital LLC from October 2011 to June 2013. Mr. Brandt holds an MBA.
(5) 
Mr. Griffin was promoted to Senior Vice President - Chief Marketing Officer effective January 2015, after having been appointed by our board of directors as First Vice President - Chief Credit and Marketing Officer in September 2011. Mr. Griffin holds an MBA and is a CFA.
(6) 
Ms. Kleiman was appointed by our board of directors as Senior Vice President - General Counsel in May 2015. In November 2015, she was appointed by our board of directors to the additional position of CCO. Before joining our Bank, Ms. Kleiman was Associate General Counsel of Anthem, Inc. from 2009 to May 2015. She holds a JD and is licensed to practice law in the State of Indiana. Ms. Kleiman is also a Senior Professional in Human Resources and a Senior Certified Professional with the Society of Human Resources Management.
(7) 
Mr. McKee was promoted to Senior Vice President - Chief Internal Audit Officer effective January 2015, after having been appointed by our board of directors as First Vice President - Director of Internal Audit in January 2006. Mr. McKee holds an MBA and is a CPA.
(8) 
Mr. Short was appointed by our board of directors as Senior Vice President - CAO in August 2009. Mr. Short holds an MBA and is a CPA.
(9) 
Mr. Streitenberger was appointed as Senior Vice President - CBOO in November 2015 after having been appointed as Senior Vice President - Chief Information / MPP Operations Officer, in February 2015. He was previously promoted to Senior Vice President - Chief Information Officer effective January 2015, after having been appointed by our board of directors as First Vice President - Chief Information Officer in June 2013. Before joining our Bank, Mr. Streitenberger served as Vice President - Shared Services at Inmar Corporation from 2012 to 2013. Mr. Streitenberger holds an MBA.





Code of Conduct

We have a Code of Conduct that is applicable to all directors, officers and employees of our Bank, including our principal executive officer, our principal financial officer, our principal accounting officer, and the members of our Affordable Housing Advisory Council. The Code of Conduct is available on our website by scrolling to the bottom of any web page on www.fhlbi.com and then selecting "Corporate Governance" in the navigation menu. Interested persons may also request a copy by contacting us, Attention: Corporate Secretary, FHLBank of Indianapolis, 8250 Woodfield Crossing Boulevard, Indianapolis, IN 46240.

Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance

Not Applicable.

ITEM 11. EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

We use acronyms and terms throughout this Item that are defined herein or in the Glossary of Terms.

Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation

The Human Resources Committee ("HR Committee") is a standing committee that serves as the Compensation Committee of the board of directors and is comprised solely of directors. No officers or employees of our Bank serve on the HR Committee. Further, no director serving on the HR Committee has ever been an officer of our Bank or had any other relationship that would be disclosable under Item 404 of SEC Regulation S-K.

Compensation Committee Report

The HR Committee has reviewed and discussed with Bank management the "Compensation Discussion and Analysis" that follows and, based on such review and discussions, has recommended to our board of directors that the Compensation Discussion and Analysis be included in our Form 10-K for fiscal year 2017.

As of December 31, 2017, the HR Committee was comprised of the following directors:

Christine Coady Narayanan, Chair
Thomas R. Sullivan, Vice Chair
Karen F. Gregerson
James L. Logue III
Robert D. Long
Ryan M. Warner
James D. MacPhee, Ex-Officio Voting Member
 
The HR Committee is comprised of the following directors as of March 9, 2018:

Christine Coady Narayanan, Chair
Michael J. Hannigan, Jr., Vice Chair
Karen F. Gregerson
James L. Logue III
Robert D. Long
Thomas R. Sullivan
Ryan M. Warner
James D. MacPhee, Ex-Officio Voting Member





Compensation Discussion and Analysis

Overview. To provide perspective on our compensation programs and practices for our Named Executive Officers ("NEOs"), we have included certain information in this Compensation Discussion and Analysis relating to Executive Officers and employees other than the NEOs. Our NEOs for the last completed fiscal year consisted of (i) individuals who served as our principal executive officer ("PEO") during such year, (ii) individuals who served as our principal financial officer ("PFO") during such year, (iii) the three most highly compensated officers (other than the officers who served as PEO or PFO) who were serving as Executive Officers (as defined in SEC rules) at the end of the last completed fiscal year; and (iv) up to two additional individuals for whom disclosure would have been required under clause (iii), but for the fact that the individual was not serving as an Executive Officer of our Bank at the end of the last completed fiscal year. The following persons were our NEOs for the period covered by this Compensation Discussion and Analysis (2017).
NEO
 
Title
Cindy L. Konich
 
President - Chief Executive Officer ("CEO") - PEO
Gregory L. Teare
 
Executive Vice President - Chief Financial Officer ("CFO") - PFO
William D. Miller
 
Executive Vice President - Chief Risk Officer ("CRO")
Mary M. Kleiman
 
Senior Vice President - General Counsel ("GC") and Chief Compliance Officer ("CCO")
K. Lowell Short, Jr.
 
Senior Vice President - Chief Accounting Officer ("CAO")

Our executive compensation program is overseen by the Executive/Governance Committee (with respect to the President - CEO's performance and compensation) and the HR Committee (with respect to the other NEOs' compensation), and ultimately by the entire board of directors. The HR Committee meets at scheduled times throughout the year (five times in 2017) and reports its recommendations to the board. The HR Committee has the authority to obtain advice and assistance from outside legal counsel, compensation consultants, and other advisors as the HR Committee deems necessary, with all fees and expenses paid by our Bank. The Executive/Governance Committee assists the board in the governance of our Bank, including nominations of the Chair and Vice Chair of the board and its committee structures and assignments, and in overseeing the affairs of our Bank during intervals between regularly scheduled meetings of the board, as provided in our bylaws. The Executive/Governance Committee meets as needed throughout the year (six times in 2017) and reports its recommendations to the board.

Regulation of Executive Compensation.

Bank Act and Finance Agency Executive Compensation Rule. Because we are a GSE, all aspects of our business and operations, including our executive compensation programs, are subject to regulation by the Finance Agency. The Bank Act and the Finance Agency's rule on executive compensation adopted in 2014 ("Executive Compensation Rule") provide the Director with the authority to prevent the FHLBanks from paying compensation to their executive officers that is not "reasonable and comparable" to compensation for employment paid at institutions of similar size and function for similar duties and responsibilities. While the Safety and Soundness Act and the Executive Compensation Rule prohibit the Director from setting specific levels or ranges of compensation for FHLBank executive officers, the Executive Compensation Rule does authorize the Director to identify relevant factors for determining whether executive compensation is reasonable and comparable. Under the Executive Compensation Rule, such factors include but are not limited to: (i) the duties and responsibilities of the position; (ii) compensation factors that indicate added or diminished risks, constraints, or aids in carrying out the responsibilities of the position; and (iii) performance of the executive officer's institution, the specific executive officer, or one of the institution's significant components with respect to achievement of goals, consistency with supervisory guidance and internal rules of the entity, and compliance with applicable law and regulation.

Pursuant to the Executive Compensation Rule, the Finance Agency requires the FHLBanks to provide information to the Finance Agency for review and non-objection concerning all compensation actions relating to the respective FHLBanks' executive officers. This information, which includes studies of comparable compensation, must be provided to the Finance Agency at least 30 days in advance of any planned FHLBank action with respect to the payment of compensation to executive officers. In addition, the FHLBanks are required to provide at least 60 days' advance notice of any arrangement that provides for incentive awards to executive officers. Under the supervision of our board of directors, we provide this information to the Finance Agency on an ongoing basis as required.





Finance Agency Advisory Bulletin 2009-AB-02. Finance Agency Advisory Bulletin 2009-AB-02, issued in 2009, sets forth certain principles for executive compensation practices to which the FHLBanks and the Office of Finance should adhere in setting executive compensation. These principles consist of the following:

executive compensation must be reasonable and comparable to that offered to executives in similar positions at other comparable financial institutions;
executive incentive compensation should be consistent with sound risk management and preservation of the par value of the FHLBank's capital stock;
a significant percentage of an executive's incentive-based compensation should be tied to longer-term performance and outcome indicators;
a significant percentage of an executive's incentive-based compensation should be deferred and made contingent upon performance over several years; and
the FHLBank's board of directors should promote accountability and transparency in the process of setting compensation.

In evaluating compensation at the FHLBanks, the Director will consider the extent to which an executive's compensation is consistent with these advisory bulletin principles. We have incorporated these principles and the Executive Compensation Rule framework into our development, implementation, and review of compensation policies and practices for executive officers, as described below.

Joint Proposed Rule on Incentive Compensation. Further, in June 2016, six federal financial regulators, including the Finance Agency, published a proposed rule that would prohibit "covered institutions," which include the FHLBanks, from entering into incentive-based compensation arrangements that encourage inappropriate risks or that could lead to a material financial loss. This proposed rule replaces a similar proposed rule published in 2011. As applied to the FHLBanks, covered persons under the 2016 proposed rule include senior management responsible for the oversight of firm-wide activities or material business lines or control functions, as well as non-executive employees: (i) whose annual incentive compensation is at least one-third of their total annual compensation and who are among the top two percent of the highest-compensated persons in the organization; (ii) whose positions give them the authority to commit or expose 0.5 percent or more of the organization's capital; or (iii) who are otherwise identified as "significant risk-takers" by the organization or the applicable regulatory agency. Under the proposed rule, covered financial institutions would be required to comply with three key risk management principles related to the design and governance of incentive-based compensation:

appropriate balance between risk and reward;
effective risk management and controls; and
effective governance.

In addition, the proposed rule would impose requirements with respect to incentive-based compensation arrangements for covered persons related to:

mandatory deferrals of annual and "long-term" incentive-based compensation for senior executive officers and significant risk-takers of 50 percent and 40 percent, respectively, over no less than three years for annual incentive-based compensation and over one additional year for compensation awarded under a long-term incentive plan;
risk of downward adjustment and forfeiture of awards;
clawback of vested compensation; and
limits on the maximum incentive-based compensation opportunity.

The proposed rule would also require boards of directors to obtain: (i) input on the effectiveness of risk measures and adjustments used to balance risk and reward in incentive-based compensation; and (ii) at least annually, from management and from the internal audit or risk management function of the organization, a written assessment of the effectiveness of the organization's incentive-based compensation program and related compliance and control processes in providing risk-taking incentives that are consistent with the organization's risk profile.





Our current compensation policies and practices, among other provisions:

prohibit excessive compensation to covered persons;
prohibit incentive compensation that encourages inappropriate risks, which could lead to material financial loss;
require mandatory deferrals of 50% of incentive compensation over three years for certain executive officers;
require reports to the Finance Agency describing the structure of our incentive-based compensation arrangements for covered persons; and
are designed to help ensure compliance with the requirements and prohibitions of the rules.
 
Finance Agency Rule on Golden Parachute Payments. The Finance Agency's rule on golden parachute payments ("Golden Parachute Rule") sets forth the standards that the Finance Agency will take into consideration when limiting or prohibiting golden parachute payments by an FHLBank, the Office of Finance, Fannie Mae or Freddie Mac. The Golden Parachute Rule generally prohibits golden parachute payments except in limited circumstances with Finance Agency approval. Golden parachute payments may include compensation paid to a director, officer or employee following the termination of such person's employment by a regulated entity that is insolvent, under the appointment of a conservator or receiver or in a troubled condition, or has been assigned a composite examination rating of 4 or 5 by the Finance Agency. Golden parachute payments generally do not include payments made pursuant to a qualified pension or retirement plan, an employee welfare benefit plan, a bona fide deferred compensation plan, a nondiscriminatory severance pay plan, or payments made by reason of the death or disability of the individual.

Compensation Philosophy and Objectives. In 2017, our board of directors adopted a resolution updating our statement of compensation philosophy. Pursuant to the resolution, our compensation philosophy is to provide a market-competitive compensation and benefits package that will enable us to effectively recruit, promote, retain and motivate highly qualified employees, management and leadership talent for the benefit of our Bank, its members, and other stakeholders. We desire to be competitive and forward-thinking while maintaining a prudent risk management culture. Thus, our compensation program encourages responsible growth and prudent risk-taking while delivering a competitive pay package.

Specifically, our compensation program is designed to reward:
 
attainment of performance goals;
implementation of short- and long-term business strategies;
accomplishment of our public policy mission;
effective and appropriate management of financial, operational, reputational, regulatory, and human resources risks;
growth and enhancement of senior management leadership and functional competencies; and
accomplishment of goals to maintain an efficient cooperative system of FHLBanks.

The board of directors regularly reviews these goals and the compensation alternatives available and may make changes in the program from time to time to better achieve these goals or to comply with Finance Agency directives. As a cooperative, we are not able to offer equity-based compensation, and only member institutions (or their legal successors) may own our stock. Without equity incentives to attract, reward and retain NEOs, we provide alternative compensation and benefits such as cash incentive opportunities, pension (with respect to four of the NEOs identified in this Report) and other retirement benefits (as to all NEOs). This approach generally will lead to a mix of compensation for NEOs that emphasizes base salary, provides meaningful incentive opportunities, and creates a competitive total compensation opportunity relative to the market.

Role of the Executive/Governance and HR Committees in Setting Executive Compensation. The Executive/Governance and HR Committees intend that our executive compensation program be aligned with our short-term and long-term business objectives and focus executives' efforts on fulfilling these Bank-wide objectives. The Executive/Governance Committee reviews the President - CEO's performance and researches and recommends the President - CEO's salary to the board of directors. The President - CEO determines the salaries of the other NEOs, generally after consulting with the HR Committee, as discussed below. The HR Committee recommends to the Finance/Budget Committee, for approval by the board, the percentage of salary increases that will apply to merit, promotional and equity increases for each year's budget. The benefit plans that will be offered, and any material changes to those plans from time to time, are approved by the board after review and recommendation by the HR Committee. The HR Committee also recommends the goals, payouts and qualifications for both the annual (short-term) incentive awards and the deferred (long-term) incentive awards for the board's review and approval. Our Executive/Governance and HR Committees operate under written charters adopted by the board of directors and most recently reviewed by the board as of March 24, 2017 and January 19, 2018, respectively. Those charters are available on our website by scrolling to the bottom of any web page on www.fhlbi.com and then selecting "Corporate Governance" in the navigation menu.





Role of Compensation Consultants in Setting Executive Compensation. For each of the last seven years, McLagan, an AON company, was engaged by Bank management to work with the HR Committee to evaluate and update our salary and benefit benchmarks for certain positions, including the NEOs' positions, in our Bank. Many other FHLBanks engage McLagan for the same or similar compensation-related services.

The salary and benefit benchmarks we use to establish reasonable and competitive compensation for our employees are the competitor groups identified by McLagan. The competitor groups are comprised of selected firms that elected to participate in McLagan's Financial Industry Salary Survey. The firms included in the competitor groups can change year-to-year, based on changes in the composition of the McLagan survey participants, changes in financial metrics of firms that elected to participate in the survey for that year, and McLagan's analysis. The primary competitor group is comprised of the other 10 FHLBanks and a number of large regional/commercial banks and other financial companies ("Primary Competitor Group"). The benchmark jobs used from the other FHLBanks are comprised of their comparable position at our Bank (e.g., CEO to CEO). The benchmark jobs used from the other regional/commercial banks include the divisional/functional heads, rather than the overall head of the bank, to account for the difference in scale of activities at a large regional bank compared to an FHLBank (e.g., Head of Corporate Banking used in the benchmark, rather than a large regional bank's CEO, as the appropriate comparison to the FHLBank's CEO). While the benchmark jobs from the regional/commercial banks capture the functional responsibility of FHLBank positions, they do not capture the executive responsibility that exists at the FHLBank.

A number of other publicly-traded regional/commercial banks with assets of $10 billion to $20 billion makes up the secondary competitor group ("Secondary Competitor Group"). The benchmark jobs used from the Secondary Competitor Group include the NEOs reported in their proxy statements, which capture the executive responsibilities encompassed in the positions. The Primary and Secondary Competitor Groups are collectively referred to as "Competitor Groups" and are listed below.

The benchmark jobs selected by McLagan from the Competitor Groups collectively capture the functional and executive responsibilities of our NEO positions, represent comparable market opportunities and represent realistic employment opportunities. We establish threshold, target and maximum base and anticipated incentive pay levels based on this competitor group analysis, while actual pay levels are based on our financial performance, stability, prudent risk-taking and conservative operating philosophies, and our compensation philosophy, as discussed above.




The following institutions are in the Primary Competitor Group, as determined for 2017 compensation decisions.
ABN AMRO
 
Federal Reserve Bank of Cleveland
 
SunTrust Banks
Agricultural Bank Of China
 
Federal Reserve Bank of Kansas City
 
SVB Financial Group
AIB
 
Federal Reserve Bank of Minneapolis
 
Synchrony Financial
Ally Financial Inc.
 
Federal Reserve Bank of New York
 
Synovus
Australia & New Zealand Banking Group
 
Federal Reserve Bank of Richmond
 
TCF National Bank
Banco Bilbao Vizcaya Argentaria
 
Federal Reserve Bank of San Francisco
 
TD Ameritrade
Bank Hapoalim
 
Federal Reserve Bank of St Louis
 
TD Securities
Bank of America Merrill Lynch
 
Fifth Third Bank
 
Texas Capital Bank
Bank of New York Mellon
 
First Citizens Bank
 
The PrivateBank
Bank of Nova Scotia
 
First Republic Bank
 
U.S. Bancorp
Bank of the West
 
FNB Omaha
 
UMB Financial Corporation
Bank of Tokyo - Mitsubishi UFJ
 
Freddie Mac
 
Umpqua Holding Corporation
Bayerische Landesbank
 
GE Capital
 
UniCredit Bank AG
BBVA Compass
 
Hancock Bank
 
Valley National Bank
BMO Financial Group
 
HSBC
 
Webster Bank
BNP Paribas
 
Huntington Bancshares, Inc.
 
 
BOK Financial Corporation
 
Industrial and Commercial Bank of China
 
 
Branch Banking & Trust Co.
 
ING
 
 
Brown Brothers Harriman
 
Intesa Sanpaolo
 
 
Capital One
 
Investors Bancorp, Inc
 
 
Charles Schwab & Co.
 
JP Morgan Chase
 
 
China Construction Bank
 
KBC Bank
 
 
CIBC World Markets
 
KeyCorp
 
 
CIT Group
 
Landesbank Baden-Wuerttemberg
 
 
Citigroup
 
Lloyds Banking Group
 
 
Citizens Financial Group
 
M&T Bank Corporation
 
 
City National Bank
 
Macquarie Bank
 
 
Comerica
 
Mizuho Bank
 
 
Commerzbank
 
Mizuho Capital Markets
 
 
Commonwealth Bank of Australia
 
Mizuho Trust & Banking Co. (USA)
 
 
Crédit Agricole CIB
 
MUFG Securities
 
 
Credit Industriel et Commercial - N.Y.
 
National Australia Bank
 
 
Cullen Frost Bankers, Inc.
 
Natixis
 
 
DBS Bank
 
New York Community Bank
 
 
DnB Bank
 
Nord/LB
 
 
DZ Bank
 
Nordea Bank
 
 
Fannie Mae
 
Norinchukin Bank, New York Branch
 
 
Federal Home Loan Bank of Atlanta
 
Northern Trust Corporation
 
 
Federal Home Loan Bank of Boston
 
People's United Bank, National Assoc
 
 
Federal Home Loan Bank of Chicago
 
PNC Bank
 
 
Federal Home Loan Bank of Cincinnati
 
Rabobank
 
 
Federal Home Loan Bank of Dallas
 
Regions Financial Corporation
 
 
Federal Home Loan Bank of Des Moines
 
Royal Bank of Canada
 
 
Federal Home Loan Bank of New York
 
Royal Bank of Scotland Group
 
 
Federal Home Loan Bank of Pittsburgh
 
Santander Bank, NA
 
 
Federal Home Loan Bank of San Francisco
 
Societe Generale
 
 
Federal Home Loan Bank of Topeka
 
Standard Chartered Bank
 
 
Federal Reserve Bank of Atlanta
 
State Street Corporation
 
 
Federal Reserve Bank of Boston
 
Sumitomo Mitsui Banking Corporation
 
 
Federal Reserve Bank of Chicago
 
Sumitomo Mitsui Trust Bank
 
 




The following institutions are in the Secondary Competitor Group, as determined for 2017 compensation decisions.
MB Financial Inc.
 
Sterling Bancorp
Fulton Financial Corp.
 
Flagstar Bancorp Inc.
Bank of the Ozarks Inc.
 
Trustmark Corp.
Chemical Financial Corp.
 
Hilltop Holdings Inc.
Western Alliance Bancorp
 
International Bancshares Corp.
Bank of Hawaii Corp.
 
Great Western Bancorp
Washington Federal Inc.
 
First Midwest Bancorp Inc.
Old National Bancorp
 
Pinnacle Financial Partners
BancorpSouth Inc.
 
Banc of California Inc.
Cathay General Bancorp
 
United Community Banks Inc.
United Bankshares Inc.
 
 

Additional Services Provided by Compensation Consultant. Apart from its role as a consultant with respect to our executive and director compensation, AON or its affiliates (including McLagan) provided additional services to our Bank during 2017. Those additional services (and the related fees) related to non-recurring projects that involved: an analysis of management committee and governance structure and compliance function ($53,500); marketing business planning ($99,375); an analysis of certain aspects of our Information Technology organizational structure ($80,250); and an analysis of our retirement benefits that cover employees at all levels of the organization ($53,500). Management reported McLagan’s compensation data and recommendations, as well as information concerning the results of these additional engagements, to our board of directors during the course of 2017. The aggregate fees paid to AON or its affiliates during 2017 for recommending the amount or form of executive and director compensation were $36,925. The aggregate fees paid to AON or its affiliates during 2017 for additional services were $286,625. While the HR Committee has concluded that no conflict of interest was created by management's engagement of AON or its affiliates for these additional services, any potential conflicts of interest were mitigated through multiple safeguards and constraints, including: board oversight of the Bank’s management, operations, budget, and compensation arrangements and amounts; comprehensive Finance Agency regulations and monitoring of our compensation, corporate governance, and safety and soundness; and the utilization of McLagan’s compensation expertise throughout much of the FHLBank System.

Role of the Named Executive Officers in the Compensation Process. The NEOs assist the HR Committee and the board of directors by providing data and background information to any compensation consultants engaged by management, the board or the HR Committee. The Human Resources Director assists the HR Committee and compensation consultants by gathering research on the Bank's hiring and turnover statistics, compensation trends, peer groups, cost of living, and other market data requested by the President - CEO, the HR Committee, the Finance/Budget Committee, the Audit Committee, the Executive/Governance Committee, or the board. Further, senior management (including the NEOs) prepares the strategic plan financial forecasts, which are then considered by the Finance/Budget Committee and by the board when establishing the goals and anticipated payout terms for the incentive compensation plans. The CRO oversees the Enterprise Risk Management ("ERM") department's review, from a risk perspective, of the incentive compensation plans' risk-related performance goals and target achievement levels.

Compensation Risk. The HR Committee (as well as the Executive/Governance Committee with respect to the President - CEO's compensation) routinely reviews our policies and practices of compensating our employees, including non-executive officers, and have determined that none of these policies or practices result in any risk that is reasonably likely to have a material adverse effect on our Bank. Further, based on such reviews, the HR Committee and the Executive/Governance Committee believe that our plans and programs contain features that operate to mitigate risk and reduce the likelihood of employees engaging in excessive risk-taking behavior with respect to the compensation-related aspects of their jobs. In addition, the material plans and programs operate within a strong governance, review and regulatory structure that serves and supports risk mitigation.

Elements of Compensation Used to Achieve Compensation Philosophy and Objectives. The total compensation mix for NEOs in 2017 consisted of:

(1)
base salaries;
(2)
annual and deferred incentive opportunities;
(3)
retirement benefits;
(4)
perquisites and other benefits; and
(5)
potential payments upon termination or change in control.





The board of directors has structured the compensation programs to comply with Internal Revenue Code ("IRC") Section 409A. If an executive is entitled to nonqualified deferred compensation benefits that are subject to IRC Section 409A, and such benefits do not comply with IRC Section 409A, then the benefits are taxable in the first year they are not subject to a substantial risk of forfeiture. In such case, the executive is subject to payment of regular federal income tax, interest and an additional federal income tax of 20% of the benefit includable in income. The Key Employee Severance Agreement ("KESA") between our Bank and our President-CEO contains provisions that "gross-up" certain benefits paid thereunder in the event she should become liable for an excise tax on such benefits. Other elements of our NEOs' compensation may be adjusted to reflect the tax effects of such compensation.

Base Salaries. Unless otherwise described, the term "base salary" as used in this Item 11 refers to an individual's annual salary, before considering incentive compensation, deferred compensation, perquisites, taxes, or any other adjustments that may be elected or required. We recruit and desire to retain senior management from national markets. Consequently, cost of living in Indiana is not a direct factor in determining base salary. Merit increases to base salaries are used, in part, to keep our NEO salary levels competitive with the Competitor Groups.

The President - CEO's base salary is established annually by the board of directors after review and recommendation by the Executive/Governance Committee. Our board has concluded that the level of scrutiny to which the base salary determination for the President - CEO is subjected is appropriate in light of the nature of the position and the extent to which the President - CEO is responsible for the overall performance of our Bank. In setting the President - CEO's base salary, the Executive/Governance Committee and the board have discretion to consider a wide range of factors, including the President - CEO's individual performance, the overall performance of our Bank, the President - CEO's tenure, and the amount of the President - CEO's base salary relative to the base salaries of executives in similar positions in companies in our Competitor Groups. Although a policy or a specific formula has not been developed for such purpose, the Executive/Governance Committee and the board also consider the amount and relative percentage of the President - CEO's total compensation that is derived from her base salary. In light of the wide variety of factors that are considered, the Executive/Governance Committee and the board have not attempted to rank or otherwise assign relative weights to the factors they consider. Rather, the Executive/Governance Committee and the board consider all the factors as a whole in determining the President - CEO's base salary, including data and recommendations from McLagan.

After an advisory consultation with the HR Committee, the base salaries for our other NEOs are set or approved annually by the President - CEO, who has discretion to consider a wide range of factors including competitive benchmark data from McLagan, each NEO's qualifications, responsibilities, assessed performance contribution, tenure, position held, amount of base salary relative to similarly-positioned executives in our Competitor Groups and our overall salary budget. Although a policy or a specific formula has not been developed for such purpose, the President - CEO also considers the amounts and relative percentages of total compensation that are derived by the NEOs from their base salaries, including data and recommendations from McLagan.

Based on the foregoing factors, the NEOs' base salaries for 2017 were increased, effective December 26, 2016, as follows.
 NEO
 
Increase % for 2017
 
Base Salary for 2017
Cindy L. Konich
 
7.0%
 
$
829,530

Gregory L. Teare
 
10.0%
 
410,072

William D. Miller
 
7.0%
 
345,176

Mary M. Kleiman
 
5.0%
 
326,222

K. Lowell Short, Jr.
 
3.0%
 
313,014


In October 2016, the HR Committee recommended and the board of directors approved for the 2017 salary budget affecting all employees (i) merit and market-based increases averaging 3.0% of annual base salaries and (ii) promotional and equity adjustments averaging an additional 1.5% of annual base salaries. These approved amounts were used in adjusting base salaries for 2017 and were incorporated into our 2017 operating budget as recommended by our Finance/Budget Committee and approved by our board of directors on November 18, 2016. NEO base salary increases above 3% for 2017 were not taken from the pool of merit and market-based increases approved by the board for 2017.





Annual and Deferred Incentive Opportunities. Generally, as an executive's level of responsibility increases, a greater percentage of total compensation is based on our overall performance. Our incentive plan has a measurement framework that rewards achievement of specific goals consistent with our mission. As discussed below, our incentive plan is performance-based and represents a reasonable risk-return balance for our cooperative members both as users of our products and as shareholders.
 
In 2011, the board of directors adopted an incentive compensation plan effective January 1, 2012 ("Incentive Plan"). The Incentive Plan is a cash-based incentive plan that provides award opportunities based on achievement of performance goals. The purpose of the Incentive Plan is to attract, retain and motivate employees and to focus their efforts on a reasonable level of profitability while maintaining safety and soundness. Employees in the Internal Audit department are excluded from the Incentive Plan but are eligible to participate in a separate incentive compensation plan established by the Audit Committee. With certain exceptions, any employee hired before October 1 of a calendar year becomes a "Participant" in the Incentive Plan for that calendar year. A "Level I Participant" is the Bank's President - CEO, an EVP or a SVP, while a "Level II Participant" is any other participating employee. All NEOs identified as of each December 31 are included among the eligible Level I Participants and must execute an agreement with our Bank containing certain non-solicitation and non-disclosure provisions.

The HR Committee establishes appropriate performance goals and the relative weight to be accorded to each goal under the Incentive Plan, subject to approval by the board of directors. The Incentive Plan effectively combined short-term and long-term incentive plans that were in place for NEOs for 2011 and prior years into one incentive plan for all employees, except for those in Internal Audit. The full migration to the Incentive Plan occurred from 2012 through 2015. The Incentive Plan, as amended, is on file with the SEC. The following sections describe the incentive compensation arrangements for the NEOs under the Incentive Plan.
 
In accordance with Incentive Plan guidelines, performance goals are established for each calendar-year period ("Performance Period") and three-calendar-year period ("Deferral Performance Period"). The board defines the "Threshold," "Target" and "Maximum" achievement levels for each performance goal to determine how much of an award may be earned. The achievement of performance goals determines the value of awards for Level I Participants, which may be Annual Awards and Deferred Awards, and for other Incentive Plan Participants (Annual Awards only). The board may adjust the performance goals to ensure the purposes of the Plan are served, but made no such adjustments during 2015, 2016 or 2017.

Under the Incentive Plan, the board establishes a maximum award for eligible Participants before the beginning of each Performance Period. Each award equals a percentage of the Participant's annual compensation (generally defined as the Participant's annual earned base salary or wages for hours worked).

With respect to Annual Awards and Deferred Awards for the NEOs, the Incentive Plan provides that 50% of an Award to a Level I Participant will become earned and vested on the last day of the Performance Period, subject to the achievement of specified Bank performance goals over such period, the attainment of at least a "Fully Meets Expectations" or "Satisfactory" individual performance rating (or, for 2016 and subsequent years, the numerical equivalent of such rating in our performance measurement structure) over the Performance Period and, subject to certain limited exceptions, active employment on the last day of such period. The remaining 50% of an award to a Level I Participant will become earned and vested on the last day of the Deferral Performance Period, subject to the same conditions for such period, and further subject to the achievement during the Deferral Performance Period of additional performance goals relating to our profitability, retained earnings, prudential management objectives and certain other conditions described below. The level of achievement of those additional goals could cause an increase or decrease to the Deferred Awards.

The table below presents the incentive opportunity percentages of earned base salary for Level I Participants for each of the Performance Periods 2013, 2014, and 2015.
 
 
Total Incentive as % of Compensation
 
50% of Total Incentive Earned and Vested at Year-End
 
50% of Total Incentive Deferred (1) for 3 Years
Position
 
Threshold
 
Target
 
Maximum
 
Threshold
 
Target
 
Maximum
 
Threshold
 
Target
 
Maximum
CEO
 
50.0%
 
75.0%
 
100.0%
 
25.0%
 
37.5%
 
50.0%
 
25.0%
 
37.5%
 
50.0%
EVP/SVP
 
30.0%
 
50.0%
 
70.0%
 
15.0%
 
25.0%
 
35.0%
 
15.0%
 
25.0%
 
35.0%

(1) 
As noted, Deferred Awards are subject to additional performance goals during the Deferral Performance Period. Depending on our performance during the Deferral Performance Period, the Final Award will be worth 75% at Threshold, 100% at Target or 125% at Maximum of the original amount of the Deferred Award.





The table below presents the incentive opportunity percentages of earned base salary for Level I Participants for the 2016 Performance Period.
 
 
Total Incentive as % of Compensation
 
50% of Total Incentive Earned and Vested at Year-End
 
50% of Total Incentive Deferred (1) for 3 Years
Position
 
Threshold
 
Target
 
Maximum
 
Threshold
 
Target
 
Maximum
 
Threshold
 
Target
 
Maximum
CEO
 
50.0%
 
75.0%
 
100.0%
 
25.0%
 
37.5%
 
50.0%
 
25.0%
 
37.5%
 
50.0%
EVP/SVP
 
35.0%
 
52.5%
 
70.0%
 
17.5%
 
26.25%
 
35.0%
 
17.5%
 
26.25%
 
35.0%

(1) 
As noted, Deferred Awards are subject to additional performance goals during the Deferral Performance Period. Depending on our performance during the Deferral Performance Period, the Final Award will be worth 75% at Threshold, 100% at Target or 125% at Maximum of the original amount of the Deferred Award.

The table below presents the incentive opportunity percentages of earned base salary for Level I Participants for the 2017 and 2018 Performance Periods.
 
 
Total Incentive as % of Compensation
 
50% of Total Incentive Earned and Vested at Year-End
 
50% of Total Incentive Deferred (1) for 3 Years
Position
 
Threshold
 
Target
 
Maximum
 
Threshold
 
Target
 
Maximum
 
Threshold
 
Target
 
Maximum
CEO
 
50.0%
 
80.0%
 
100.0%
 
25.0%
 
40.0%
 
50.0%
 
25.0%
 
40.0%
 
50.0%
EVP
 
40.0%
 
60.0%
 
80.0%
 
20.0%
 
30.0%
 
40.0%
 
20.0%
 
30.0%
 
40.0%
SVP
 
35.0%
 
52.5%
 
70.0%
 
17.5%
 
26.25%
 
35.0%
 
17.5%
 
26.25%
 
35.0%

(1) 
As noted, Deferred Awards are subject to additional performance goals during the Deferral Performance Period. Depending on our performance during the Deferral Performance Period, the Final Award will be worth 75% at Threshold, 100% at Target or 125% at Maximum of the original amount of the Deferred Award.

2016 Annual Award (Paid in 2017). Pursuant to the Incentive Plan, the board of directors established the 2016 Annual Award Performance Period Goals, consisting of 4 mission goals, and 10 components within these goals, for all participants, including the NEOs. These goals were tied to profitability, member products, Information Technology performance and risk management performance. Our performance for 2016 resulted in a total weighted average payout of 96%. Although ERM had somewhat different goals for the 2016 Annual Award Performance Period, its 2016 performance also resulted in a total weighted average payout ratio of 96%.

The percent of base salary that an NEO (as a Level I Participant) may have earned for certain achievement levels and the actual percent of base salary payout achieved for 2016 and paid in 2017 (based on the total weighted average achievement) are presented below. As noted, 50% of each NEO's 2016 Award is deferred for a three-year period.

2016 Incentive Plan - Annual Award Performance Period
% of Earned Base Salary By Achievement Level - Paid in 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Actual Payout
NEO
 
Threshold
 
Target
 
Maximum
 
% of Earned Base Salary
 
 Amount (1)
Cindy L. Konich
 
25.0%
 
37.5%
 
50%
 
48%
 
$
373,085

Gregory L. Teare
 
17.5%
 
26.25%
 
35%
 
34%
 
125,583

William D. Miller (2)
 
17.5%
 
26.25%
 
35%
 
34%
 
108,670

Mary M. Kleiman
 
17.5%
 
26.25%
 
35%
 
34%
 
103,729

K. Lowell Short, Jr. (3)
 
17.5%
 
26.25%
 
35%
 
34%
 
102,372

 

(1) 
These amounts were paid on March 3, 2017.
(2) 
Although the weighted values of certain goals were different for Mr. Miller (ERM), his resulting percentage of earned base salary was the same as the other NEOs, excluding Ms. Konich. Mr. Miller elected to defer 10% of this Annual Award in accordance with the terms of the SETP described below.
(3) 
Mr. Short elected to defer 20% of this Annual Award in accordance with the terms of the SETP.





2017 Annual Award (Paid in 2018). In 2016, the board of directors established Annual Award Performance Goals for 2017 for Level I Participants relating to specific mission goals for profitability, member advances growth, MPP performance, Community Investment Program ("CIP") advances originated, achievement of ERM objectives and achievement of Office of Minority and Women Inclusion ("OMWI") objectives. The weights and specific achievement levels for each 2017 mission goal are presented below.
2017 Mission Goals
 
Weighted Value (1)
 
Weighted Value (ERM)
 
 Threshold
 
Target
 
Maximum
 
Actual Result
 
Achievement Percentage (Interpolated)
 
Weighted Average Achievement
 
Weighted Average Achievement (ERM)
Profitability (2)
20%
 
15%
 
290 bps
 
480 bps
 
660 bps
 
maximum
 
100%
 
20%
 
15%
Member Advances
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 

Member Advances Growth (3)
 
15%
 
10%
 
0%
 
1.3%
 
3.5%
 
maximum
 
100%
 
15%
 
10%
Number of Members that Increase Average Daily Advance Balance (4)
 
10%
 
10%
 
115 members
 
120 members
 
140 members
 
maximum
 
100%
 
10%
 
10%
MPP Performance
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 

Mortgage Delinquency Rate (5)
12.5%
 
7.5%
 
0.75%
 
1.00%
 
1.25%
 
maximum
 
100%
 
12.50%
 
7.50%
Member Participation(6)
12.5%
 
7.5%
 
100 members
 
107 members
 
110 members
 
threshold
 
50%
 
6.25%
 
3.75%
CIP Advances Originated (7)
10%
 
10%
 
$50MM
 
$100MM
 
$150MM
 
maximum
 
100%
 
10%
 
10%
ERM
Objectives
(8)
10%
 
30%
 
Achieve One ERM Objective
 
Achieve Two ERM Objectives
 
Achieve Three ERM Objectives
 
maximum
 
100%
 
10%
 
30%
Minority and Women Inclusion (9)
10%
 
10%
 
Achieve One Diversity and Inclusion Objective
 
Achieve Two Diversity and Inclusion Objectives
 
Achieve Three Diversity and Inclusion Objectives
 
maximum
 
100%
 
10%
 
10%
Total
 
100%
 
100%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
93.75%
 
96.25%

(1)  
For all Level I Participants, excluding those in ERM.
(2) 
For purposes of this goal, profitability is defined as the Bank’s profitability rate in excess of the Bank’s cost of funds rate. Profitability is the Bank’s adjusted net income reduced by the portion of net income to be added to restricted retained earnings under the JCE Agreement and increased by the Bank’s accruals for incentive compensation. Adjusted net income represents GAAP Net Income adjusted: (i) for the net impact of certain current and prior period Advance prepayments and debt extinguishments, net of the AHP assessment, (ii) to exclude mark-to-market adjustments on derivatives and certain other effects from derivatives and hedging activities, net of the AHP assessment, and (iii) to exclude the effects from interest expense on MRCS. The Bank’s profitability rate is profitability, as defined above, as a percentage of average total regulatory capital stock (B1 weighted at 100% and B2 weighted at 80% to reflect the relative weights of the Bank’s dividend). Assumes no material change in investment authority under the Finance Agency's regulation, policy, directive, guidance, or law.
(3) 
Member advances growth is calculated as the growth in the average daily balance of advances outstanding to members at par. Average daily balances are used instead of point-in-time balances to eliminate point-in-time activity that may occur and to reward for the benefit of the income earned on advances balances while outstanding. Members that become non-members during 2017 and all captive insurance company members will be excluded from the calculation. Goal assumes no material change in membership eligibility under the Finance Agency's regulation, policy, directive, guidance, or law.




(4) 
Member average daily advance balances are calculated for each member individually. This goal compares: (a) the average daily balance of advances outstanding at par to the member during calendar 2016, to (b) the average daily balance of advances outstanding at par to the same member during calendar 2017. Each member for which (b) is greater than (a) is counted as one member for purposes of this goal. Members that become non-members in 2017 will be excluded from the calculation.
(5) 
Mortgage Delinquency Rate is the difference between (a) the 90 day MBA National Delinquency rate, expressed as a percentage, minus (b) the Bank's MPP conventional mortgage loan portfolio 90 day delinquency rate, expressed as a percentage. The measure is calculated as the simple average of four quarterly calculations.
(6) 
Member participation is calculated by counting each member that delivers a mortgage loan through the Mortgage Purchase Program during 2017.
(7) 
CIP Advances are newly-originated Community Investment Cash Advances, including CIP and other qualifying Advances and CIP qualified letters of credit, provided in support of targeted projects as defined in 12 C.F.R. Part 1291 and the Bank Act.
(8) 
The Board has established three ERM Objectives for 2017. The first ERM Objective, develop Capital Adequacy and Loss Absorption Analysis, requires ERM to develop a process and perform an analysis of the Bank's capital adequacy and loss absorption capacity. The second ERM Objective, enhance ERM Oversight of Bank Information Security, requires ERM to establish and implement processes and procedures to enhance the Bank's ability to identify, measure, monitor, and evaluate information security risk and cybersecurity risk. The third ERM Objective, Acquired Member Asset Risk Analysis, requires ERM to develop and implement an integrated approach to evaluate the Bank's credit and market risk posed by its AMA portfolio. ERM will demonstrate its achievement of each ERM Objective by reporting on them to the Risk Committee and Risk Oversight Committee.
(9)  
The Bank has established three Diversity and Inclusion (D&I) objectives for 2017. The first D&I Objective, Diversity Strategy, requires the Bank to develop a diversity and inclusion strategy for the Bank. The second D&I Objective, Employee Engagement, requires the Bank to host a diversity and inclusion employee engagement event. The third D&I Objective, Training, requires the Bank to hold diversity and inclusion training. Status and reporting on this Goal and its attainment will be provided in writing by the Bank's Minority and Women Inclusion Officer and CFO, and will be confirmed by the President - CEO. If one or more of these designated positions are open at the time any of the foregoing approvals are required, the General Counsel will be substituted.

The percent of base salary that an NEO (as a Level I Participant) may have earned for certain achievement levels and the actual percent of base salary payout achieved for 2017 and paid in 2018 (based on the total weighted average achievement) are presented below. As noted, 50% of each NEO's 2017 Award was deferred for a three-year period.

2017 Incentive Plan - Annual Award Performance Period
% of Earned Base Salary By Achievement Level - Paid in 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Actual Payout
NEO
 
Threshold
 
Target
 
Maximum
 
% of Earned Base Salary
 
 Amount (1)
Cindy L. Konich
 
25.0%
 
40.0%
 
50%
 
47%
 
$
388,842

Gregory L. Teare
 
20.0%
 
30.0%
 
40%
 
38%
 
153,777

William D. Miller (2)
 
20.0%
 
30.0%
 
40%
 
39%
 
132,893

Mary M. Kleiman
 
17.5%
 
26.25%
 
35%
 
33%
 
107,042

K. Lowell Short, Jr. (3)
 
17.5%
 
26.25%
 
35%
 
33%
 
102,708

 

(1) 
These amounts were paid on February 23, 2018.
(2) 
The percent of earned base salary for Mr. Miller is different from the other NEOs because the weighted values of certain goals were different for ERM.
(3) 
Mr. Short elected to defer 100% of this Annual Award in accordance with the terms of the SETP.





2018 Annual Award (Payable in 2019). On January 19, 2018, the board of directors established Annual Award Performance Goals for 2018 for Level I Participants relating to specific mission goals for profitability, member activity, ERM, minority and women inclusion, and operational risk. The weights and specific achievement levels for each 2018 mission goal are presented below.
2018 Mission Goals
 
Weighted Value (1)
 
Weighted Value (ERM)
 
Threshold
 
Target
 
Maximum
Profitability (2)
 
20%
 
15%
 
415 bps
 
571 bps
 
656 bps
Member Activity
 

 

 

 

 

  A. Member Advances Growth (3)
 
20%
 
10%
 
0%
 
1.38%
 
3.15%
  B. Member Education and Outreach (4)
 
15%
 
15%
 
10 events
 
14 events
 
18 events
  C. Increase in MPP Portfolio (5)
 
5%
 
5%
 
Net Growth of $0
 
Net Growth of $635 MM
 
Net Growth of $800 MM
  D. CIP Advances Originated (6)
 
10%
 
5%
 
$50MM
 
$100MM
 
$150MM
ERM Objectives (7)
 
10%
 
30%
 
Achieve One ERM Objective
 
Achieve Two ERM Objectives
 
Achieve Three ERM Objectives
Minority and Women Inclusion - Portion of 2018 Vendor Spend with Qualifying Vendors (8)
 
10%
 
10%
 
12%
 
15%
 
18%
Operational Risk Objective - End-User Computing Inventory System of Record (9)
 
10%
 
10%
 
After the end of the Third Quarter and on or before the end of the Fourth Quarter
 
After the end of the Second Quarter and on or before the end of the Third Quarter
 
On or before the end of the Second Quarter
Total
 
100%
 
100%
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1) 
For all Level I Participants, excluding those in ERM.
(2) 
For purposes of this goal, profitability is defined as the Bank’s profitability rate in excess of the Bank’s cost of funds rate. Profitability is the Bank’s adjusted net income reduced by the portion of net income to be added to restricted retained earnings under the JCE Agreement and increased by the Bank’s accruals for incentive compensation. Adjusted net income represents GAAP Net Income adjusted: (i) for the net impact of certain current and prior period Advance prepayments and debt extinguishments, net of the AHP assessment, (ii) to exclude mark-to-market adjustments on derivatives and certain other effects from derivatives and hedging activities, net of the AHP assessment, and (iii) to exclude the effects from interest expense on MRCS. The Bank’s profitability rate is profitability, as defined above, as a percentage of average total regulatory capital stock (B1 weighted at 100% and B2 weighted at 80% to reflect the relative weights of the Bank’s dividend). Assumes no material change in investment authority under the Finance Agency's regulation, policy, directive, guidance, or law.
(3) 
Member advances growth is calculated as the growth in the average daily balance of advances outstanding to members at par. Average daily balances are used instead of point-in-time balances to eliminate point-in-time activity that may occur and to reward for the benefit of the income earned on advances balances while outstanding. Members that become non-members during 2018 and all captive insurance company members will be excluded from the calculation. Goal assumes no material change in membership eligibility under Finance Agency's regulation, policy, directive, guidance, or law.
(4) 
Member education and outreach events are symposia, conferences, workshops, webinars (with a maximum of four webinars towards achievement of this goal), educational events, presentations at trade conferences, and other events educating Bank members about Advances, MPP, the Bank's community investments products and activities, industry trends, and other products and services. To qualify, events must target more than one member. Status and reporting on this Goal and its attainment will be provided in writing by the officer responsible for the event, and will be confirmed by the CFO or by the CBOO.
(5) 
Net Growth is calculated as the increase in the size of the Bank's MPP portfolio measured as of December 31, 2017, and December 31, 2018. Net Growth is calculated: (a) excluding the effect of any allowances for loan losses on MPP balances; (b) excluding the effect of any AMA obtained from or through other Federal Home Loan Banks; (c) including both FHA and conventional loans; (d) assuming no capital requirement for MPP; and (e) assuming no material change in AMA authority under the Finance Agency's regulation, policy, directive, guidance, or law.
(6) 
CIP Advances are newly-originated Community Investment Cash Advances, including CIP and other qualifying Advances and CIP qualified letters of credit, provided in support of targeted projects as defined in 12 C.F.R. Part 1291 and the Bank Act.




(7) 
The Board has established three ERM Objectives for 2018. The first ERM Objective, Program Maturity Self-Assessment, requires ERM to perform a comprehensive, enterprise-wide self-assessment of the maturity of the Bank’s Enterprise Risk Management Program, and report on the results of the assessment to the Board. The second ERM Objective, Information Technology Assessment, requires ERM to assess the Bank’s information technology program against the Information Technology risk management framework and report on the results of the assessment to the Board. The third ERM Objective, Business Continuity, requires the Bank to operate under its business continuity / disaster recovery plan for a defined period of time, and to return back to normal operations. ERM will demonstrate its achievement of each ERM Objective by reporting on them to the Risk Committee and Risk Oversight Committee.
(8) 
"Qualifying Vendors" are vendors that qualify as minorities, women, individuals with disabilities, and minority-, women-, and disabled-owned businesses.
(9) 
Achievement of this goal requires the Bank to have designated a tool as its system of record for its end-user computing applications inventory, and to have performed an inventory of end-user computing applications using the tool. Satisfaction of this goal will be evidenced in one or more reports to the Bank's Risk Committee.

The weights and specific goals for the 2018 Performance Period differ in some respects from those used for the 2017 Performance Period. The threshold, target and/or maximum performance levels for profitability and advances growth were revised for 2018. The threshold and target performance levels for profitability were increased for 2018 compared to 2017 (to 415 bps from 290 bps, and to 571 bps from 480 bps, respectively), while the maximum performance level for profitability was reduced slightly for 2018 compared to 2017 (to 656 bps from 660 bps) to align those performance levels with our 2018 strategic financial forecast.

With respect to advances, the target mission goal for member advances growth was increased for 2018 compared to 2017 (to 1.38% from 1.3%) while the maximum mission goal for advances growth was reduced for 2018 compared to 2017 (to 3.15% from 3.5%), to align those performance levels with our 2018 strategic financial forecast. For 2018, the board of directors established a new mission goal, with specific minimum, target and maximum achievement levels, relating to the number of member education and outreach events conducted during the year. The combined weighted value of these two mission goals for 2018 (35%) is greater than the combined weighted value of the 2017 advances-related mission goals (25%). The board of directors also eliminated a mission goal used in 2017 relating to the number of members that increase their average daily advances balance. These changes were made to give greater weight to advances-related performance results and to reinforce our marketing plan and efforts relating to advances growth.

The board of directors established a new MPP mission goal for 2018, with specified minimum, target and maximum achievement levels, related to the net growth in the MPP portfolio for 2018. The weighted value of the 2018 MPP mission goal is 15%, while the 2017 MPP goals had a combined weighted value of 25%. The board also eliminated two MPP-related goals used in 2017 involving mortgage delinquency rates and the extent of member participation in MPP. These revisions in MPP-related goals were made to align the performance levels with our 2018 strategic financial forecast and evolving business strategies, with appropriate risk limits reflecting our risk appetite, to allow for improved measurements of growth and performance in the MPP portfolio, and to reflect management's expectations of mortgage market conditions for 2018.

The threshold, target and maximum performance levels for CIP advances originated are unchanged from 2017 to 2018, and the board of directors maintained the weighted value of this mission goal at 10% for 2018. The board also maintained mission goals for 2018 relating to the achievement of up to three specific ERM objectives and maintained the weighted value of this mission goal at 10%.

With respect to OMWI, the board of directors established a new mission goal for 2018 relating to the Bank’s usage of third-party vendors meeting certain criteria, to reflect the importance of this objective to the board and to the Bank as a whole. As a result of regulatory changes, the board also eliminated for 2018 the OMWI-related mission goal used in the 2017 Performance Goals relating to strategy, engagement and training on diversity and inclusion matters. In addition, the board established a new mission goal for 2018, under which the Bank must designate a specific software tool as its system of record for its end-user computing applications and conduct an inventory using the designated tool.

The board of directors established separate weighted values for the 2018 Performance Period goals for ERM, as it did for the 2017 Performance Period.

2013 Deferred Award (Paid in 2017). Under the Incentive Plan, 50% of each Level I Participant's 2013 Award ("2013 Deferred Award") was deferred for a three-year period that ended December 31, 2016 ("2014-2016 Deferral Performance Period"). All conditions for payment of the 2013 Deferred Award were satisfied, including the achievement of specific Bank performance goals relating to our profitability, retained earnings and prudential management standards for the 2014-2016 Deferral Performance Period.




The following table presents the payouts to the NEOs who were Level I Participants when the 2013 Deferred Award was made by applying the actual achievement levels to the performance goals for the 2013 Deferred Award.

2013 Incentive Plan - 2014-2016 Performance Period
% of Original Award - Paid in 2017
NEO (1)
 
Incentive Award for 2013
 
Percentage Deferred
 
Deferred Incentive Award
 
Total Achievement
 
Payout (2)
Cindy L. Konich
 
$
355,202

 
50%
 
$
177,601

 
125%
 
$
222,001

Gregory L. Teare
 
153,480

 
50%
 
76,740

 
125%
 
95,925

K. Lowell Short, Jr.
 
153,868

 
50%
 
76,934

 
125%
 
96,168

(1) 
Mr. Miller and Ms. Kleiman were not Level I participants when the 2013 Deferred Awards were made.
(2) 
These amounts were paid on March 3, 2017.

2014 Deferred Award (Paid in 2018). Under the Incentive Plan, 50% of each Level I Participant's 2014 Award ("2014 Deferred Award") was deferred for a three-year period that ended December 31, 2017 ("2015-2017 Deferral Performance Period"). As noted, the 2014 Deferred Award became earned and vested on that date, subject to the achievement of specific Bank performance goals over the 2015-2017 Deferral Performance Period and certain other conditions. The following table presents the performance goals for the 2014 Deferred Award relating to our profitability, retained earnings and prudential management standards, together with actual results and specific achievement levels for each mission goal.
2015-2017 Mission Goals
 
Weighted Value (1)
 
 Threshold (2)
 
Target (2)
 
Maximum (2)
 
Actual Result
 
Achievement %
 
Weighted Average Achievement
Profitability (3)
 
35%
 
25 bps
 
50 bps
 
150 bps
 
maximum
 
125%
 
44%
Retained Earnings (4)
 
35%
 
3.5%
 
3.9%
 
4.3%
 
maximum
 
125%
 
44%
Prudential
 
30%
 
Achieve 2 Prudential Standards
 
(a)
 
Achieve all 3 Prudential Standards
 
maximum
 
125%
 
37%
Maintain a regulatory capital-to-assets ratio of at least 4.16% as measured on each quarter-end in 2015 through 2017.
 
 
 
 
 
 
Without Board pre-approval, do not purchase more than $2.5 billion of conventional AMA assets per plan year.
 
 
 
 
 
 
Award to FHLBI members the annual AHP funding requirement in each plan year.
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total
 
100%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
125%
(1) 
For Level I Participants.
(2) 
Deferred Awards are subject to additional performance goals for the Deferral Performance Period. Depending on our performance during the Deferral Performance Period, the Final Award will be worth 75% at Threshold, 100% at Target or 125% at Maximum of the original amount.
(3) 
For purposes of this goal, profitability is defined as the Bank's profitability rate in excess of the Bank's cost of funds rate. Profitability is the Bank's adjusted net income reduced by the portion of net income to be added to restricted retained earnings under the JCE Agreement and increased by the Bank's accruals for incentive compensation. Adjusted net income represents GAAP net income adjusted: (i) for the net impact of certain current and prior period advance prepayments and debt extinguishments, net of the AHP assessment, (ii) to exclude mark-to-market adjustments and certain other effects from derivatives and hedging activities, net of the AHP assessment, and (iii) to exclude the effects from interest expense on MRCS. The Bank's profitability rate, as defined above, as a percentage of average total regulatory capital stock (B1weighted at 100% and B2 weighted at 80% to reflect the relative weights of the Bank's divide). Assumes no material change in investment authority under the Finance Agency's regulation, policy, directive, guidance, or law.
(4) 
Total retained earnings divided by mortgage assets, measured at the end of each month. Calculated each month as total retained earnings divided by the sum of the carrying value of the MBS and AMA assets portfolios. The calculation will be the simple average of 36 month-end calculations.
(a)
There is no target level for this goal.





Each of the Level I Participants listed below received an average performance rating for the 2015-2017 Deferral Performance Period of at least "Fully Meets Expectations" or "Satisfactory" (or, for 2016 and subsequent years, the numerical equivalent of such rating in our performance measurement structure), and each was employed by the Bank on the last day of the 2015-2017 Deferral Performance Period, thereby satisfying the two remaining conditions for payment of the 2014 Deferred Award.

The following table presents the payouts to the NEOs who were Level I Participants when the 2014 Deferred Award was made by applying the achievement levels described above to the performance goals for the 2014 Deferred Award.

2014 Incentive Plan - 2015-2017 Performance Period
% of Original Award - Paid in 2018
NEO (1)
 
Incentive Award for 2014
 
Percentage Deferred
 
Deferred Incentive Award
 
Total Achievement
 
Payout (2)
Cindy L. Konich
 
$
602,568

 
50%
 
$
301,284

 
125%
 
$
376,605

Gregory L. Teare
 
180,802

 
50%
 
90,401

 
125%
 
113,001

William D. Miller
 
195,906

 
50%
 
97,953

 
125%
 
122,441

K. Lowell Short, Jr.
 
181,192

 
50%
 
90,596

 
125%
 
113,245

(1) 
Ms. Kleiman was not a Level I participant when the 2014 Deferred Awards were made.
(2) 
These amounts were paid on February 23, 2018, except Mr. Short elected to defer 100% of his 2014 Deferred Award in accordance with the terms of the SETP. The amount deferred was not paid on the date indicated.

2018 Deferred Award (Payable in 2022). The board of directors established Deferred Award Performance Goals for Level I Participants (which include all of our NEOs) for the three-year period ending December 31, 2021 ("2019-2021 Deferral Performance Period"), relating to our profitability, retained earnings and prudential management standards. The mission goals, weighted values and performance levels for the 2019-2021 Deferral Performance Period are the same as those previously established by the board for the 2018-2020 Deferral Performance Period and are substantially similar to those previously established by the board for each of the three-year Deferral Performance Periods covering 2015 through 2019.

The table below presents the mission goals, weighted values and performance levels for the 2019-2021 Deferral Performance Period.
2019 - 2021 Mission Goals
 
 
Threshold (2)
 
Target (2)
 
Maximum (2)
 
Weighted Value (1)
 
Profitability (3)
 
35%
 
25 bps
 
50 bps
 
150 bps
Retained Earnings (4)
 
35%
 
3.5%
 
3.9%
 
4.3%
Prudential Standards: (5)
 
30%
 
Achieve 1 Prudential
Standard
 
(a)
 
Achieve 2 Prudential Standards
Maintain a regulatory capital-to-assets ratio of at least 4.16% as measured on each quarter-end in 2019 through 2021.

Award to FHLBI members the annual AHP Competitive funding requirement in each plan year.
(1) 
For Level I Participants.
(2) 
Deferred Awards are subject to additional Performance Goals for the Deferral Performance Period. Depending on the Bank's performance during the Deferral Performance Period, the Final Award will be worth 75% at Threshold, 100% at Target or 125% at Maximum of the original amount.
(3) 
For purposes of this goal, profitability has the same definition as for the 2015-2017 mission goals (set forth above). This rate assumes no material change in investment authority under Finance Agency regulation, policy, directive, guidance, or law. Attainment of this goal will be computed using the simple average of annual profitability measures over the three-year period.
(4) 
Total retained earnings divided by the sum of the carrying value of the MBS and AMA assets portfolios, measured at the end of each month. The calculation will be the simple average of 36 month-end calculations.
(5) 
For each of the three-year Deferral Performance Periods ending December 31, 2017, 2018 and 2019, the Threshold and Maximum performance levels for the Prudential Standards goal were 2 and 3, respectively.
(a) 
There is no target level for this goal.





Other Incentive Plan Provisions. The Incentive Plan provides that a termination of service of a Level I Participant during a Performance Period may result in the forfeiture of the Participant's award. The Incentive Plan recognizes certain exceptions to this general rule if the termination of service is (i) due to the Level I Participant's death, "Disability," or "Retirement"; (ii) for "Good Reason"; or (iii) without "Cause" due to a "Reduction in Force" (in each case as defined in the Incentive Plan). If one of these exceptions applies, a Level I Participant's Annual Award or Deferred Awards generally will be treated as earned and vested, and will be calculated using certain assumptions with respect to our achievement of applicable performance goals for the applicable Performance Period. Payment may be accelerated if the Participant dies or becomes "Disabled" while an employee of the Bank, or if the termination is without "Cause" due to a "Reduction in Force".

The Incentive Plan provides that awards may be reduced or forfeited in certain circumstances. If, during a Deferral Performance Period, we realize actual losses or other measures or aspects of performance related to the Performance Period or Deferral Performance Period that would have caused a reduction in the final award for the Performance Period or Deferral Performance Period, the remaining amount of the final award to be paid at the end of the Deferral Performance Period will be reduced to reflect this additional information. In addition, all or a portion of an award may be forfeited at the direction of the board of directors if we have failed to remediate to the satisfaction of the board an unsafe or unsound practice or condition (as identified by the Finance Agency) that is material to our financial operation and within the Level I Participant's area(s) of responsibility. Under such circumstances, the board may also direct the cessation of payments for a vested award. Further, the board may reduce or eliminate an award that is otherwise earned but not yet paid if the board finds that a serious, material safety-soundness problem or a serious, material risk management deficiency exists at our Bank, or in certain other circumstances.

Retirement Benefits. We have established and maintain a comprehensive retirement program for our NEOs. During 2017, we provided qualified and non-qualified defined benefit plans and qualified and non-qualified defined contribution plans to certain of our NEOs. The benefits provided by these plans are components of the total compensation opportunity for NEOs. The board of directors believes that these plans serve as valuable retention tools and provide significant tax deferral opportunities and resources for the participants' long-range financial planning. These plans are discussed below.

Pension and Thrift Plans - In General. Our retirement program is comprised of two qualified retirement plans: the DB Plan (for eligible employees hired before February 1, 2010) and the DC Plan (for all eligible employees).

Our board of directors established a SERP in 1993 in response to federal legislation that imposes restrictions on the retirement benefits otherwise earned by executives. The SERP was frozen, effective December 31, 2004, and is now referred to as the "Frozen SERP." A separate SERP ("2005 SERP") was established effective January 1, 2005 to conform to the IRC Section 409A regulations. As described below, the SERP restores retirement benefits of NEO participants and certain other employees under the DB Plan that would otherwise be limited by Internal Revenue Service ("IRS") regulations. The DB Plan and SERP provide benefits based on a combination of a participant's length of service, age and annual compensation.

In November 2015, we established the SETP, effective January 1, 2016. As described below, the purpose of the SETP is to permit the NEOs and certain other employees to elect to defer compensation in addition to their DC Plan deferrals. The DC Plan and SETP provide benefits based upon amounts deferred by the participant and employer matching contributions based upon the amount of the participant's deferral and compensation. In addition, as described below, the DC Plan and SETP provide enhanced benefits for qualified employees who do not participate in the DB Plan. The DB Plan, the SERP, the DC Plan and the SETP have all been amended and restated from time to time to comply with changes in laws and regulations of the IRS and to modify certain benefit features.    
    
DB Plan and SERP. All employees who met the eligibility requirements and were hired before February 1, 2010, participate in the DB Plan, a tax-qualified, multiple employer defined benefit pension plan. The plan neither requires nor permits employee contributions. Participants' pension benefits vest upon completion of five years of service. Benefits under the DB Plan are based upon compensation up to the annual compensation limit established by the IRS, which was $270,000 in 2017. In addition, benefits payable to participants in the DB Plan may not exceed a maximum benefit limit established by the IRS, which in 2017 was $215,000, payable as a single life annuity at normal retirement age.

The SERP, as a non-qualified retirement plan, preserves and restores the full pension benefits that are not payable from the DB Plan, due to IRS limitations regarding compensation, years of service or benefits payable. In determining whether a participant is entitled to a restoration of retirement benefits, the SERP utilizes the identical benefit formula applicable to the DB Plan. In the event that the benefit payable from the DB Plan has been reduced or otherwise limited due to IRS limitations, the participant's lost benefits are payable under the terms of the SERP. In this respect, the SERP is an extension of our retirement commitment to the NEO participants and certain other employees as highly-compensated employees.





Our board of directors amended the DB Plan, effective for all employees hired on or after July 1, 2008, to provide a reduced benefit. All eligible employees hired on or before June 30, 2008 (including two NEOs) were grandfathered under the benefit formula and the terms of the DB Plan in effect as of June 30, 2008 ("Grandfathered DB Plan") and are eligible to continue under the Grandfathered DB Plan (except as described below in footnote 4 to the Pension Benefits Table), subject to future plan amendments made by the board of directors. All eligible employees hired on or after July 1, 2008 but before February 1, 2010 (including two NEOs) are enrolled in the amended DB Plan ("Amended DB Plan"). Thus, as shown below in the Pension Benefits Table, as of December 31, 2017, four NEOs participate (or have previously accumulated benefits) in either the Grandfathered DB Plan or the Amended DB Plan and three of those four are eligible to participate in the SERP.

During 2010 our board of directors discontinued eligibility in the Amended DB Plan for new employees. As a result, no employee hired on or after February 1, 2010 is enrolled in that plan, while participants in the Grandfathered DB Plan or Amended DB Plan as of January 31, 2010 continue to be eligible for the Grandfathered DB Plan or Amended DB Plan (and, as applicable, the SERP) and accrue benefits thereunder until termination of employment.

The following sections describe the differences in the benefits provided under these plans.

Grandfathered DB Plan. The following table shows estimated annual benefits payable upon retirement at age 65 by combining the Grandfathered DB Plan and the SERP. The estimated annual benefits are calculated in accordance with the formula currently in effect for specified years of service and compensation for individuals participating in both plans, and hired prior to July 1, 2008.
 Sample High 3-Year Average Compensation
 
Annual Benefits Payable at age 65 Based on Years of Benefit Service
30
 
35
$1,000,000
 
$
750,000

 
$
875,000

1,100,000
 
825,000

 
962,500

1,200,000
 
900,000

 
1,050,000

 
Formula: The combined Grandfathered DB Plan and SERP benefit equals 2.5% times years of benefit service times the high three-year average compensation. Benefit service begins one year after employment, and benefits are vested after five years. Benefit payments commencing before age 65 are reduced by applying an early retirement factor based on the participant's age when payments begin. The allowance payable at age 65 would be reduced by 3.0% for each year the employee is under age 65. However, if the sum of age and years of vesting service at termination of employment is at least 70 ("Rule of 70"), the retirement allowance would be reduced by 1.5% for each year the employee is under age 65. Beginning at age 66, retirees are also provided an annual retiree cost of living adjustment of 3.0% per year, which is not reflected in the table.
    




Amended DB Plan. The following table shows estimated annual benefits payable upon retirement at age 65 by combining the Amended DB Plan and the 2005 SERP. The estimated annual benefits are calculated in accordance with the formula currently in effect for specified years of service and compensation for individuals participating in both plans, hired on or after July 1, 2008 but before February 1, 2010. 
 Sample High 5-Year Average Compensation
 
Annual Benefits Payable at age 65 Based on Years of Benefit Service
15
 
20
$300,000
 
$
67,500

 
$
90,000

400,000
 
90,000

 
120,000

500,000
 
112,500

 
150,000

600,000
 
135,000

 
180,000

700,000
 
157,500

 
210,000


Formula: The combined Amended DB Plan and 2005 SERP benefit equals 1.5% times years of benefit service times the high five-year average compensation. The benefit is not payable under the Frozen SERP because no participant in the Amended DB Plan is an eligible participant in the Frozen SERP. Benefit service begins 1 year after employment, and benefits are vested after five years. The allowance payable at age 65 would be reduced according to the actuarial equivalent based on actual age when early retirement commences. Benefit payments commencing before age 65 are reduced by applying an early retirement factor based on the participant's age when payments begin. If a participant satisfied the Rule of 70 at termination of employment, the retirement allowance would be reduced by 3.0% for each year the participant is under age 65.
 
The following table sets forth a comparison of the Grandfathered DB Plan and the Amended DB Plan. 
 DB Plan Provisions
 
 Grandfathered DB Plan
(All Employees Hired on or before June 30, 2008)
 
 Amended DB Plan
(All Employees Hired between July 1, 2008 and January 31, 2010)
Benefit Increment
 
2.5%
 
1.5%
Cost of Living Adjustment
 
3.0% Per Year Cumulative, Commencing at Age 66
 
None
Normal Form of Payment
 
Guaranteed 12 Year Payout
 
Life Annuity
Early Retirement Reduction for less than Age 65:
 
 
 
 
 i) Rule of 70
 
1.5% Per Year
 
3.0% Per Year
ii) Rule of 70 Not Met
 
3.0% Per Year
 
Actuarial Equivalent

With respect to all employees hired before February 1, 2010:
 
Eligible compensation includes salary (before any employee contributions to tax qualified plans), short-term incentive, bonus (including Annual Awards under the Incentive Plan), and any other compensation that is reflected on the IRS Form W-2 (but not including long-term incentive payments, such as Deferred Awards under the Incentive Plan).
Retirement benefits from the DB Plan are paid in the form of a lump sum, annuity, or a combination of the two, at the election of the retiree at the time of retirement. Any payments involving a lump sum are subject to spousal consent.
Retirement benefits from the SERP may be paid in the form of a lump sum payment, or annual installments up to 20 years, or a combination of lump sum and annual payments. The benefits due from the SERP are paid out of a grantor trust that we have established or out of our general assets. The assets of the grantor trust are subject to the claims of our general creditors.
    
    




DC Plan and SETP. All employees, including the NEOs, who have met the eligibility requirements may participate in the DC Plan, a retirement savings plan qualified under IRC Section 401(k). The DC Plan generally provides for an immediate (after the first month of hire) fully vested employer match of 100% on the first 6% of base pay that the participant contributes. In November 2017, the board of directors approved an amendment to the DC Plan, effective January 1, 2018, to establish an employer-funded non-elective contribution ("NEC") program. This plan amendment ("NEC Amendment") provides an additional employer-funded benefit for certain DC Plan participants, including two of our NEOs, who were hired (or re-hired) on or after February 1, 2010 and therefore do not participate (or do not currently accumulate benefits) in the Grandfathered DB Plan or the Amended DB Plan. Under the NEC Amendment, the Bank will make an additional NEC of 4% of base pay per year to the DC Plan account of each employee who is eligible to participate in the DC Plan and does not participate in the DB Plan. The NEC Amendment further provides for a vesting schedule for NECs based on an employee's years of service at the Bank. Partial vesting begins when an eligible employee has attained at least two years of service. Eligible employees become fully vested in their NECs when they have attained five years of service.

Eligible compensation in the DC Plan is defined as base salary. A participant in the DC Plan may elect to contribute up to 50% of eligible compensation, subject to the following limits. Under IRS regulations, in 2017 an employee could contribute up to $18,000 of eligible compensation on a pre-tax basis, and an employee age 50 or over could contribute up to an additional $6,000 on a pre-tax basis. Participant contributions over that amount may be made on an after-tax basis. A total of $54,000 per year ($60,000 per year including catch-up contributions for employees age 50 or over) could have been contributed to a participant's account in 2017, including our matching contribution and the participant's pre-tax and after-tax contributions. In addition, no more than $270,000 of annual compensation could have been taken into account in computing eligible compensation in 2017. The amount deferred on a pre-tax basis will be taxed to the participant as ordinary income when distributed from the DC Plan. The plan permits participants to self-direct the investment of their DC Plan accounts into one or more investment funds. All returns are at the market rate of the respective fund(s) selected by the participant.

The DC Plan also permits a participant (in addition to making pre-tax elective deferrals) to fund a separate "Roth Elective Deferral Account" (also known as a "Roth 401(k)") with after-tax contributions. A participant may make both pre-tax and Roth 401(k) contributions, subject to the limitations described in the previous paragraph. All Bank contributions will be allocated to the participant's safe-harbor account, subject to the maximum match amount described above. Under current IRS rules, withdrawals from a Roth 401(k) account (including investment gains) are tax-free after the participant reaches age 59 1/2 and if the withdrawal occurs at least five years after January 1 of the first year in which a contribution to the Roth 401(k) account occurs. In addition, the DC Plan permits in-plan Roth conversions, which allow participants to convert certain vested contributions into Roth contributions similar to a Roth Individual Retirement Account conversion.

Any Bank employee who is a participant in the DC Plan is, upon approval by the board of directors, eligible to become a participant in the SETP. Each DC Plan participant who is an officer with a title of First Vice President or a higher officer level (which includes all NEOs) is automatically eligible to become a SETP participant. We intend that the SETP constitute a deferred compensation arrangement that complies with IRC Section 409A regulations. The SETP permits a participant to elect to have all or a portion of his or her base salary and/or annual incentive plan payment withheld and credited to the participant's deferral contribution account. The SETP provides that, subject to certain limitations, the Bank will contribute to the participant's account each plan year, up to the contribution that would have been made for the benefit of the participant under the DC Plan, including, if applicable, the NECs described above, as if the participant did not participate in the SETP and without regard to benefit or compensation limits imposed by the IRC. The plan permits participants to self-direct the investment of their deferred contribution account into one or more investment funds. All returns are at the market rate of the respective fund(s) selected by the participant. The benefits are paid out of an investment account established for each participant under a grantor trust that we have established out of our general assets.  The assets of the grantor trust are subject to the claims of our general creditors.  The trust will be maintained such that the SETP is at all times considered unfunded and constitutes a mere promise by the Bank to make SETP benefit payments in the future. Any rights created under the SETP are unsecured contractual rights against the Bank.





Perquisites and Other Benefits. We offer the following additional perquisites and other benefits to all employees, including the NEOs, under the same general terms and conditions:
 
medical, dental, and vision insurance (subject to employee expense sharing);
vacation leave, which increases based upon officer title and years of service;
life and long-term disability insurance (the PEO and the PFO are eligible for enhanced monthly benefits under our disability insurance program);
travel and accident insurance, as well as kidnapping coverage, which include life insurance benefits;
educational assistance;
employee relocation assistance, where appropriate, for new hires; and
student loan repayment assistance.

In addition, we provide as a taxable benefit to the NEOs and certain other officers spouse/guest travel to board of directors meetings and preapproved industry activities (limited to two events per year unless otherwise approved by the President - CEO, or by the Chief Internal Audit Officer in the case of the President - CEO).
 
Potential Payments Upon Termination or Change in Control.

Severance Pay Plan. The board of directors has adopted a Severance Pay Plan that pays each NEO, upon a qualifying termination as described below (or in the Bank's discretion on a case-by-case basis), up to a maximum 52 weeks of base pay computed at the rate of 4 weeks of severance pay for each year of service with a minimum of 8 weeks of base pay to be paid. In addition, the plan pays a lump sum amount equal to the NEO's cost to maintain health insurance coverage under the Consolidated Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act ("COBRA") for the time period applicable under the severance pay schedule. The Severance Pay Plan may be amended or eliminated by the board at any time.

The Severance Pay Plan does not apply to NEOs who have entered into a KESA with the Bank or who are participants under the Bank's Key Employee Severance Policy ("KESP") if a qualifying event has triggered payment under the terms of the KESA or the KESP. As of the date of this Report, Ms. Konich is the only NEO with whom we have a KESA; all other NEOs are participants under the KESP. If any NEO's employment is terminated but a qualifying event under the KESA or the KESP, as applicable, has not occurred, the provisions of the Severance Pay Plan apply.

The following qualifying events will trigger an NEO's right to severance benefits under the Severance Pay Plan:
 
the elimination of a job or position;
a reduction in force;
a substantial job modification, to the extent the incumbent NEO is no longer qualified for, or is unable to perform, the restructured job; or
the reassignment of staff requiring the relocation by more than 75 miles of the NEO's primary residence.

In addition, the Bank has discretion under the Severance Pay Plan to provide additional pay or outplacement services to amicably resolve employment separations involving our NEOs and other employees.

The following table lists the amounts that would have been payable to the NEOs under the Severance Pay Plan if triggered as of December 31, 2017, absent a qualifying event that would result in payments under Ms. Konich's KESA or the KESP.  
 
 
Months of
 
Cost of
 
Weeks of
 
Cost of
 
Total
NEO
 
COBRA
 
COBRA
 
Salary
 
Salary
 
Severance
Cindy L. Konich
 
12
 
$
21,444

 
52
 
$
887,614

 
$
909,058

Gregory L. Teare
 
10
 
12,526

 
40
 
331,220

 
343,746

William D. Miller
 
7
 
4,013

 
28
 
197,022

 
201,035

Mary M. Kleiman
 
3
 
3,758

 
12
 
78,294

 
82,052

K. Lowell Short, Jr.
 
9
 
11,273

 
36
 
225,378

 
236,651


The amounts listed above do not include payments and benefits to the extent that they are provided on a nondiscriminatory basis to NEOs generally upon termination of employment. These payments and benefits include:
 
accrued salary and vacation pay;
distribution of benefits under the DB Plan; and
distribution of plan balances under the DC Plan.





The amounts listed above also do not include payments from the SERP or the SETP. Amounts payable from the SERP may be found in the Pension Benefits Table. Account balances for the SETP may be found in the Non-Qualified Deferred Compensation Table.

Key Employee Severance Agreement and Key Employee Severance Policy. In general, key employee severance arrangements in the form of agreements or a board-approved policy are intended to promote retention of certain officers in the event of discussions concerning a possible reorganization or change in control of the Bank, to ensure that merger or reorganization opportunities are evaluated objectively, and to provide compensation and other benefits to covered employees under certain circumstances in the event of a consolidation, change in control or reorganization of the Bank. As described in the following paragraphs, these arrangements provide for payment and, in some cases, continued and/or increased benefits if the officer's employment terminates under certain circumstances in connection with a reorganization, merger or other change in control of the Bank. If we were not in compliance with all applicable regulatory capital or regulatory leverage requirements at the time payment under the KESA or KESP becomes due, or if the payment would cause our Bank to fall below applicable regulatory requirements, the payment would be deferred until such time as we achieve compliance with such requirements. Moreover, if we were insolvent, have had a receiver or conservator appointed, or were in "troubled condition" at the time payment under an arrangement becomes due, the Finance Agency could deem such a payment to be subject to its rules limiting golden parachute payments.

Key Employee Severance Agreement. Ms. Konich's KESA was entered into during 2007. Under the terms of her agreement, Ms. Konich is entitled to a lump sum payment equal to a multiplier of her three preceding calendar years':

base salary (less salary deferrals), bonus, and other cash compensation;
salary deferrals and employer matching contributions under the DC Plan and SETP; and
taxable portion of automobile allowance, if any.

Ms. Konich is entitled to a multiplier of 2.99, if she terminates for "good reason" or is terminated "without cause" during a period beginning 12 months before and ending 24 months after a reorganization. This agreement also provides that benefits payable to Ms. Konich pursuant to the SERP would be calculated as if she were three years older and had three more years of benefit service. The agreement with Ms. Konich also provides her with coverage for 36 months under our medical and dental insurance plans in effect at the time of termination (subject to her payment of the employee portion of the cost of such coverage).

We do not believe payments to Ms. Konich under the KESA would be subject to the restriction on change-in-control payments under IRC Section 280G or the excise tax applicable to excess change-in-control payments, because we are exempt from these requirements as a tax-exempt instrumentality of the United States government. If it were determined, however, that Ms. Konich is liable for such excise tax payment, the agreement provides for a "gross-up" of the benefits to cover such excise tax payment. This gross-up of approximately $2.8 million is not shown as a component of the value of the KESA in the table below.

Further, the agreement with Ms. Konich provides that she will be reimbursed for all reasonable accounting, legal, financial advisory and actuarial fees and expenses she incurs with respect to execution of the agreement or at the time of payment under the agreement. The agreement also provides that Ms. Konich will be reimbursed for all reasonable legal fees and expenses she incurs if we contest the enforceability of the KESA or the calculation of the amounts payable under the agreement, so long as she is wholly or partially successful on the merits or the parties agree to a settlement of the dispute.





If a reorganization of our Bank had triggered payments under Ms. Konich's KESA on December 31, 2017, the value of the payments for her would have been approximately as follows in the table below.
Benefit
 
Value
2.99 times average of the 3 prior calendar years base salary, bonuses and other cash compensation paid to the executive except for salary deferrals which are included below
 
$
3,549,447

2.99 times average of the executive's salary deferrals and employer matching contributions under the DC Plan and SETP for the 3 prior calendar years
 
275,615

Additional amount under the SERP equal to the additional benefit calculated as if the executive were 3 years older and had 3 more years of credited service
 
2,236,689

Medical and dental insurance coverage for 36 months
 
43,920

Reimbursement of reasonable accounting, legal, financial advisory, and actuarial services (1)
 
15,000

Total value of KESA
 
$
6,120,671


(1) 
The amount of $15,000 for reimbursement of reasonable accounting, legal, financial advisory, and actuarial services is an estimate and does not represent a minimum or maximum amount that could be paid.

Key Employee Severance Policy. On March 9, 2017, the board of directors adopted the KESP, effective as of that date, which establishes three participation levels for covered employees: (i) Level 1 Participants, which include any Executive Vice President, (ii) Level 2 Participants, which include any Senior Vice President, and (iii) Level 3 Participants, which include any other officer designated by the HR Committee to be a Level 3 Participant from time to time. Thus, covered executives under the KESP include all NEOs other than Ms. Konich. Mr. Teare and Mr. Miller are Level 1 Participants, and Mr. Short and Ms. Kleiman are Level 2 Participants.

Under the KESP, if the covered employee terminates for "good reason" or is terminated without "cause," in either case within six months before or 24 months after a reorganization, the covered employee is entitled to a lump-sum payment equal to a multiple (2.0 for Level 1 Participants, 1.5 for Level 2 Participants and 1.0 for Level 3 Participants) of the average of his or her three preceding calendar years' base salary (inclusive of amounts deferred under a qualified or nonqualified plan) and gross bonus (inclusive of amounts deferred under a qualified or nonqualified plan); provided that, for any calendar year in which the covered employee received base salary for less than the entire year, the gross amount shall be annualized as if such amount had been payable for the entire calendar year. All amounts payable under the KESP are capped at an amount equal to one dollar ($1) less than the aggregate amount which would otherwise cause any such payments to be considered a “parachute payment” within the meaning of Section 280G of the IRC.

In addition, to the extent the covered employee is eligible, he or she will continue after a compensated termination to be covered by the Bank’s medical and dental insurance plans in effect immediately prior to the compensated termination, subject to the covered employee’s payment of the employee’s portion of the cost of such coverage. The coverage will continue for Level 1, Level 2 and Level 3 Participants for 24 months, 18 months and 12 months, respectively. In the event the covered employee is ineligible under the terms of such plans for continuing coverage or such plans shall have been modified, the Bank will provide through other sources coverage which is substantially equivalent to the coverage provided immediately prior to the compensated termination, subject to the covered employee’s payment of a comparable portion of the cost of such coverage as under the Bank’s medical and dental insurance plans. The KESP also provides for outplacement services for all covered employees.





Summary Compensation Table for 2017
Name and Principal Position
 
Year
 
Salary 
 
Bonus 
 
Non-Equity Incentive Plan Compensation (1)
 
Change in Pension
Value and
Nonqualified
Deferred
Compensation
Earnings (2)
 
All Other Compensation (3)
 
Total
(a)
 
(b)
 
(c)
 
(d)
 
(g)
 
(h)
 
(i)
 
(j)
Cindy L. Konich
President - CEO (PEO)
 
2017
 
$
829,530

 
$

 
$
765,447

 
$
3,980,000

 
$
49,772

 
$
5,624,749

 
2016
 
775,242

 

 
595,086

 
2,996,000

 
46,515

 
4,412,843

 
2015
 
680,030

 

 
430,624

 
1,943,000

 
15,900

 
3,069,554

Gregory L. Teare
EVP - CFO
(PFO)
 
2017
 
410,072

 

 
266,778

 
234,000

 
24,604

 
935,454

 
2016
 
372,788

 

 
221,508

 
153,000

 
22,367

 
769,663

 
2015
 
342,491

 

 
196,657

 
97,000

 
15,900

 
652,048

William D. Miller
EVP - CRO 
 
2017
 
345,176

 

 
255,334

 

 

 
600,510

 
2016
 
322,582

 

 
108,670

 

 
19,355

 
450,607

 
2015
 
313,170

 

 
87,630

 

 
15,900

 
416,700

Mary M. Kleiman SVP - GC & CCO (4)
 
2017
 
326,222

 

 
107,042

 
70,000

 
19,573

 
522,837

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
K. Lowell Short, Jr.
SVP - CAO
 
2017
 
313,014

 

 
215,953

 
137,000

 
18,781

 
684,748

 
2016
 
303,888

 

 
198,540

 
93,000

 
18,233

 
613,661

 
2015
 
294,557

 

 
184,184

 
62,000

 
15,900

 
556,641


(1) 
The Non-Equity Incentive Plan Compensation table below shows the components of the "Non-Equity Incentive Plan Compensation" column and the dates that these amounts were paid.
(2) 
These amounts represent a change in pension value under the Grandfathered DB Plan, Amended DB Plan and the SERP, as applicable. The change in pension values are determined by calculating the present values of pension benefits accrued through the beginning and ending plan valuation dates. The calculations incorporate various assumptions and changes in compensation, age and service, and utilize discount interest rates based on market interest rates. Therefore, changes in market interest rates can have a significant impact on the change in pension value. The discount rates used as of December 31, 2017 were significantly lower than the discount rates used as of December 31, 2016, which caused a significant increase in the change in pension values for 2017. No NEO received preferential or above-market earnings on deferred compensation.
(3) 
The All Other Compensation table below shows the components of the "All Other Compensation" column.
(4) 
Ms. Kleiman was not an NEO in 2016 or 2015.





Non-Equity Incentive Plan Compensation - 2017
 
 
 
 
Annual Incentive 
 
Deferred Incentive 
 
Total Non-Equity
Name
 
Year
 
Amounts Earned 
 
Date Paid
 
Amounts Earned
 
Date Paid
 
Incentive Plan
Compensation
Cindy L. Konich
 
2017
 
$
388,842


2/23/2018

$
376,605


2/23/2018
 
$
765,447

 
 
2016
 
373,085

 
3/3/2017
 
222,001

 
3/3/2017
 
595,086

 
 
2015
 
280,355

 
3/4/2016
 
150,269

 
3/4/2016
 
430,624

Gregory L. Teare
 
2017
 
153,777

 
2/23/2018
 
113,001

 
2/23/2018
 
266,778

 
 
2016
 
125,583

 
3/3/2017
 
95,925

 
3/3/2017
 
221,508

 
 
2015
 
97,547

 
3/4/2016
 
99,110

 
3/4/2016
 
196,657

William D. Miller (1)
 
2017
 
132,893

 
2/23/2018
 
122,441

 
2/23/2018
 
255,334

 
 
2016
 
108,670

 
3/3/2017
 
(a)

 
(a)
 
108,670

 
 
2015
 
87,630

 
3/4/2016
 
(b)

 
(b)
 
87,630

Mary M. Kleiman (2) 
 
2017
 
107,042

 
2/23/2018
 
(c)

 
(c)
 
107,042

K. Lowell Short, Jr. (3)
 
2017
 
102,708

 
N/A
 
113,245

 
N/A
 
215,953

 
 
2016
 
102,372

 
3/3/2017
 
96,168

 
3/3/2017
 
198,540

 
 
2015
 
83,894

 
3/4/2016
 
100,290

 
3/4/2016
 
184,184


(1) 
Mr. Miller elected to defer 10% of his 2016 Annual Incentive pursuant to the SETP. The amount deferred was not paid on the date indicated.
(2)
Ms. Kleiman was not an NEO during 2016 or 2015.
(3)
Mr. Short elected to defer 100% and 20% of his 2017 and 2016 Annual Incentive, respectively, and 100% of his 2014 Deferred Award pursuant to the terms of the SETP. The amount deferred for 2016 was not paid on the date indicated.
(a) 
Mr. Miller was not a Level I participant in the Incentive Plan when the 2013 Deferred Awards were made.
(b) 
Mr. Miller was not a Level I participant in the Incentive Plan when the 2012 Deferred Awards were made.
(c) 
Ms. Kleiman was not a Level I participant in the Incentive Plan when the 2014 Deferred Awards were made.

All Other Compensation - 2017
Name
 
Year
 
 Bank Contribution
to DC Plan (1)
 
Total All Other
Compensation
Cindy L. Konich
 
2017
 
$
49,772


$
49,772

 
 
2016
 
46,515

 
46,515

 
 
2015
 
15,900

 
15,900

Gregory L. Teare
 
2017
 
24,604

 
24,604

 
 
2016
 
22,367

 
22,367

 
 
2015
 
15,900

 
15,900

William D. Miller
 
2017
 

 

 
 
2016
 
19,355

 
19,355

 
 
2015
 
15,900

 
15,900

Mary M. Kleiman (2)
 
2017
 
19,573

 
19,573

K. Lowell Short, Jr.
 
2017
 
18,781

 
18,781

 
 
2016
 
18,233

 
18,233

 
 
2015
 
15,900

 
15,900


(1) 
Includes Bank contributions to the SETP, as appropriate.
(2) 
Ms. Kleiman was not an NEO during 2016 or 2015.

There were no other perquisites or benefits that are available to the NEOs that are not available to all other employees and that are valued at greater than $10,000, either individually or in the aggregate.





Grants of Plan-Based Awards Table for 2017
 
 
Estimated Future Payouts Under Non-Equity Incentive Plans
Name
 
Plan Name
 
Grant Date (1)
 
Threshold (2) (3)
 
Target
 
Maximum
(a)
 
 
 
(b)
 
(c)
 
(d)
 
(e)
Cindy L. Konich
 
Incentive Plan - Annual
 
12/1/2011
 
$
20,738

 
$
331,812

 
$
414,765

 
 
Incentive Plan - Deferred
 
12/1/2011
 
291,632

 
388,842

 
486,053

Gregory L. Teare
 
Incentive Plan - Annual
 
12/1/2011
 
8,201

 
123,022

 
164,029

 
 
Incentive Plan - Deferred
 
12/1/2011
 
115,333

 
153,777

 
192,221

William D. Miller
 
Incentive Plan - Annual
 
12/1/2011
 
5,178

 
103,553

 
138,070

 
 
Incentive Plan - Deferred
 
12/1/2011
 
99,670

 
132,893

 
166,116

Mary M. Kleiman
 
Incentive Plan - Annual
 
12/1/2011
 
5,709

 
85,633

 
114,178

 
 
Incentive Plan - Deferred
 
12/1/2011
 
80,281

 
107,042

 
133,802

K. Lowell Short, Jr.
 
Incentive Plan - Annual
 
12/1/2011
 
5,478

 
82,166

 
109,555

 
 
Incentive Plan - Deferred
 
12/1/2011
 
77,031

 
102,708

 
128,385


(1) 
The Grant Date shown is the original adoption date of the Incentive Plan. The 2017 Awards were granted in November 2016, effective January 1, 2017.
(2) 
The Incentive Plan - Annual threshold payout is the amount expected to be paid when meeting the threshold for the smallest weighted of the eight components of the 2017 Annual Award Performance Period Goals. If the threshold for the smallest weighted of the eight components was achieved, but the threshold for all of the other components was not reached, the payout would be 5.00% of the maximum Annual Award for Ms. Konich, 3.75% for Mr. Miller, and 5.00% for Mr. Teare, Ms. Kleiman, and Mr. Short (2.50% x earned base salary for Ms. Konich, 1.50% x earned base salary for Miller, 2.00% x earned base salary for Mr. Teare, and 1.75% x earned base salary for Ms. Kleiman and Mr. Short). There was no guaranteed payout under the 2017 Annual Award provisions of the Incentive Plan. Therefore, the minimum that could be paid out under this plan is $0 for each NEO. The Non-Equity Incentive Plan Compensation - 2017 table previously presented shows the amounts actually earned and paid under the 2017 Annual Award provisions of the Incentive Plan.
(3) 
The Incentive Plan - Deferred threshold payout is based upon the amount earned under the Incentive Plan - Annual and is further dependent on attaining the threshold over the three-year deferral period (2018-2020). The threshold is the amount expected to be paid when meeting the threshold for achievement under the Deferred Award provisions of the Incentive Plan over the three-year period. Depending on our performance during the Deferral Performance Period, the Final Award will be worth 75% at Threshold, 100% at Target or 125% at Maximum of the original amount of the Deferred Award (from the 2017 Incentive Plan - Annual Award Performance Period table previously presented). There is no guaranteed payout under the Deferred Award provisions of the Incentive Plan. Therefore, the minimum that could be paid out to an NEO under this plan is $0.





Pension Benefits Table for 2017
Name (1)
 
Plan Name
 
Number of Years of Credited Service (2)
 
Present Value of Accumulated Benefits
 
Payments During Last Fiscal Year
(a)
 
(b)
 
(c)
 
(d)
 
(e)
Cindy L. Konich
 
DB Plan
 
33
 
$
2,527,000

 
$

 
 
SERP
 
33
 
14,259,000

 

Gregory L. Teare (3)
 
DB Plan
 
15
 
622,000

 

 
 
SERP
 
9
 
332,000

 

Mary M. Kleiman (4)
 
DB Plan
 
7
 
572,000

 

K. Lowell Short, Jr.
 
DB Plan
 
7
 
363,000

 

 
 
SERP
 
7
 
169,000

 


(1) 
Mr. Miller is not a participant in the DB Plan or the SERP.
(2) 
For each of the NEOs, the years of credited service have been rounded to the nearest whole year.
(3)
Mr. Teare earned six years of credited service in the DB Plan as an employee of the Federal Home Loan Bank of Seattle.
(4) 
Ms. Kleiman earned seven years of credited service in the DB Plan during her previous employment by the Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolis. When Ms. Kleiman left the Bank in 2008, her participation and accumulated benefits were frozen and her benefits under the SERP were paid. As she can no longer accumulate benefits under the DB Plan, she is eligible for the NEC under the DC Plan.

Pension values are determined by calculating the present values of pension benefits accrued through the plan valuation dates. The calculations incorporate various assumptions and changes in compensation, age and service, and utilize discount interest rates based on market interest rates. The present value of the accumulated benefits is based upon a retirement age of 65, using the RP-2014 white collar worker annuitant tables (with Scale MP-2017), a discount rate of 3.60% for the DB Plan, and a discount rate of 3.00% for the SERP for 2017, compared to 4.14% and 4.00%, respectively, for 2016. The discount rates for the DB Plan and the SERP are based on the Citi Pension Liability Index and the Citi Pension Discount Curve, respectively, both of which are determined by yields on high-quality corporate bonds at the valuation dates.

Non-Qualified Deferred Compensation
Name
 
Executive Contributions in Last FY (2017)
$
 
Bank Contributions in Last FY (2017)
$
 
Aggregate Earnings in Last FY (2017)
$
 
Aggregate Withdrawals / Distributions
$
 
Aggregate Balance at Last FYE (12/31/2017)
$
(a)
 
(b)(1)
 
(c)(2)
 
(d)
 
(e)
 
(f)(3)
Cindy L. Konich
 
$
49,772

 
$
33,577

 
$
24,770

 
$

 
$
185,541

Gregory L. Teare
 
24,604

 
8,404

 
3,251

 

 
63,055

William D. Miller
 
10,867

 

 
8,918

 

 
54,315

Mary M. Kleiman
 
19,573

 
3,373

 
1,545

 

 
24,492

K. Lowell Short, Jr.
 
58,036

 
2,581

 
12,796

 

 
110,957


(1) 
The amounts in this column do not reflect amounts an NEO may have elected to defer related to the 2017 Annual Award paid on February 23, 2018.
(2)
The amounts in this column are also disclosed as a component of "All Other Compensation" in the Summary Compensation Table.
(3)
No amount reported in this column has been reported in the Summary Compensation Table for prior years.

The SETP is described in more detail above in "Retirement Benefits - DC Plan and SETP." Participants in the SETP elect the timing of distribution of their benefits provided, however, that they are permitted to withdraw all or a portion of the amount in their account, in a single lump sum, if the participant has experienced an unforeseeable emergency (as defined by the SETP and determined by an administrative committee appointed by our board) or in certain other, limited circumstances. None of the NEOs made a withdrawal or received a distribution from the SETP during 2017.





Principal Executive Officer Pay Ratio Disclosure

Our President - CEO is our PEO. As described below, for the year ended December 31, 2017, we determined the ratio of the total compensation, as determined in the Summary Compensation Table ("Total Compensation"), of our PEO to the Total Compensation of the Bank's median employee.

Total Compensation includes, among other components, amounts attributable to changes in pension value under the Bank's Grandfathered DB Plan, Amended DB Plan and the SERP, as applicable. Such change in pension value represents the difference between the present value of pension benefits accrued through the beginning valuation date and the present value of pension benefits accrued through the ending valuation date. The present value calculations incorporate many assumptions and utilize discount rates based on market interest rates. The discount rates used as of December 31, 2017 were significantly lower than the discount rates used as of December 31, 2016, which caused a significant increase in the change in pension values for 2017. Conversely, an increase in discount rates, all else being equal, would have caused a decrease in the pension value. Additionally, the change in pension value varies considerably among employees based upon their tenure at the Bank, their annual compensation and several other factors. Finally, no portion of this change in pension value has been paid or made available to the PEO or median employee; in fact, no portion is realizable until a qualifying event occurs, such as retirement.

For 2017, the Total Compensation of the PEO was $5,624,749. As of December 31, 2017, our PEO had 33 years of credited service under the Grandfathered DB Plan and SERP. Her Total Compensation therefore includes the change in the present value of her pension benefits, which amounted to $3,980,000, and constituted 71% of her reported 2017 Total Compensation. Excluding the 2017 change in pension value, the PEO’s Total Compensation was $1,644,749.

We identified the median employee by first determining the total of salary, wages, bonuses (if any) and incentive awards (collectively, "cash compensation") for each of the full-time and part-time employees of our Bank on the last pay date of 2017 and annualizing the cash compensation of those who were not employed by the Bank for all of 2017. We then ranked the 2017 annual cash compensation for all such employees from lowest to highest, excluding the PEO.

There were two employees at the median based on cash compensation, but neither participates in a pension plan. We therefore selected as the median employee the individual who participates in the same plan as our PEO (the Grandfathered DB Plan), and whose 2017 annual cash compensation was closest to that of the actual median employees. We made no other material assumptions or adjustments in identifying the median employee. This approach ensures that the median employee's Total Compensation, like the PEO's Total Compensation, includes a change in pension value and thereby provides an appropriate comparison. We then calculated the median employee's Total Compensation in the same manner that we calculated Total Compensation for the PEO.

The median employee’s Total Compensation consisted of cash compensation of $120,670 and change in pension value, based on nine years of credited service, of $65,000, for a total of $185,670. As a result, the ratio of the PEO’s Total Compensation to that of the median employee was 30:1. Excluding the 2017 changes in pension value from both the PEO's and the median employee's Total Compensation, the ratio was 14:1.





Director Compensation

Finance Agency regulations provide that each FHLBank may pay its directors reasonable compensation for the time required of them and their necessary expenses in the performance of their duties, as determined by a compensation policy to be adopted annually by the FHLBank's board of directors. The Director annually reviews the compensation and expenses of FHLBank directors and has the authority to determine that the compensation and/or expenses paid to directors are not reasonable. In such case, the Director could order the FHLBank to refrain from making any further payments; however, such an order would only be applied prospectively and would not affect any compensation earned but unpaid or expenses incurred but not yet reimbursed.

2017 Compensation. In October 2016, after consideration of McLagan's market research data, a director fee comparison among the FHLBanks and our ability to recruit and retain highly-qualified directors, our board adopted a director compensation and travel expense policy for 2017 ("2017 Policy"). Under the 2017 Policy, compensation was comprised of per-day attendance fees for mandatory in-person events, per-call fees for participating in conference calls and quarterly retainer fees, subject to the combined fee cap shown below. The fees were intended to compensate directors for:

time spent reviewing materials sent to them on a periodic basis;
preparing for meetings and teleconference calls;
actual time spent attending meetings and participating in conference calls of our board of directors or its committees; and
participating in any other activities, such as attending new director orientations and director meetings called by the Finance Agency or the Council of FHLBanks.

Member marketing meetings and customer appreciation events were not counted in calculating the in-person meeting fees. Additional compensation was paid for serving as chair or vice chair of the board or as chair of a board committee. Director per-day and per-call fees were subject to forfeiture and penalties in certain circumstances for excessive absences. In addition, the 2017 Policy authorized a reduction of a director's quarterly retainer fee if a majority of disinterested directors determined that such director's performance, ethical conduct or attendance was significantly deficient. Because we are a cooperative and only member institutions can own our stock, no director may receive equity-based compensation. Director fees were paid at the end of each quarter.

The following table summarizes the payment terms of the 2017 Policy as approved by the board of directors.
Position
 
Per-call Fee
 
Per-day 
In-Person Fee
 
Quarterly
Retainer Fee
 
Additional
Committee Chair Fee (1)
 
Combined Annual
Fee Cap
 
Chair
 
$
300

 
$
5,273

 
$
14,875

 
$
10,000

 
$
129,000

(a)
Vice Chair
 
300

 
4,818

 
13,625

 

 
109,000

 
Audit Committee Chair
 
300

 
4,318

 
12,250

 
10,000

 
108,000

 
Finance Committee Chair
 
300

 
4,318

 
12,250

 
10,000

 
108,000

 
HR Committee Chair
 
300

 
4,318

 
12,250

 
10,000

 
108,000

 
Budget/Information Technology Committee Chair
 
300

 
4,318

 
12,250

 
10,000

 
108,000

 
Affordable Housing Committee Chair
 
300

 
4,318

 
12,250

 
10,000

 
108,000

 
Risk Oversight Committee Chair
 
300

 
4,318

 
12,250

 
10,000

 
108,000

 
All other directors
 
300

 
4,318

 
12,250

 

 
98,000

 

(1) 
It has been the board of directors' practice not to appoint any director as more than one Committee Chair.
(a) 
For 2017, the Chair of our board of directors also served as Chair of the Executive/Governance Committee and, like the other Committee Chairs, was eligible to receive $10,000 for serving as a Committee Chair. This amount is included in the Combined Annual Fee Cap.





Director Compensation Table for 2017
Name
 
Fees Earned or
Paid-in Cash
 
Total
(a)
 
(b)
 
(h) (1)
Jonathan P. Bradford
 
$
108,000

 
$
108,000

Charlotte C. Decker
 
98,000

 
98,000

Matthew P. Forrester
 
98,000

 
98,000

Karen F. Gregerson
 
108,000

 
108,000

Michael J. Hannigan, Jr.
 
98,000

 
98,000

Carl E. Liedholm
 
108,000

 
108,000

James L. Logue, III
 
98,000

 
98,000

Robert D. Long
 
108,000

 
108,000

James D. MacPhee
 
129,000

 
129,000

Michael J. Manica
 
98,000

 
98,000

Dan L. Moore
 
109,000

 
109,000

Christine Coady Narayanan
 
108,000

 
108,000

Jeffrey A. Poxon
 
98,000

 
98,000

John L. Skibski
 
108,000

 
108,000

Thomas R. Sullivan
 
98,000

 
98,000

Larry A. Swank
 
98,000

 
98,000

Ryan M. Warner
 
98,000

 
98,000

Total
 
$
1,768,000

 
$
1,768,000


(1)
The amounts listed in this table do not reflect any reduction for 2017 compensation deferred by a director under the DDCP described below, or earnings on such deferred compensation. Eight directors elected to defer all or a portion of their 2017 compensation pursuant to the DDCP.

We provide various travel, accident, and kidnapping insurance coverages for all of our directors, officers and employees. These policies provide a life insurance benefit in the event of death within the scope of the policy. Our total annual premium for these coverages for all directors, officers and employees was $8,118 for 2017.

We also reimburse directors or directly pay for reasonable travel and related expenses in accordance with the director compensation and travel reimbursement policy. Total travel and related meeting expenses reimbursed to or paid for directors, together with other meeting expenses, totaled $252,252 for the year ended December 31, 2017.

2018 Compensation. In September 2017, after considering McLagan market data research and a director fee comparison among the FHLBanks, the board of directors adopted a director compensation and expense reimbursement policy for 2018 ("2018 Policy"). Under the 2018 Policy, each director has an opportunity to earn an annual fee (divided into quarterly payments), subject to the combined fee limit shown below. The fees are intended to reflect the time required of directors in the performance of official Bank and board business, measured principally by meeting attendance thresholds and participation at board and committee meetings and secondarily by performance of other duties, which include:

preparing for board and committee meetings;
chairing meetings as appropriate;
reviewing materials sent to directors on a periodic basis;
attending other related events such as management conferences, FHLBank System meetings, director training and new director orientation; and
fulfilling the responsibilities of directors.

Additional compensation is paid for serving as chair or vice chair of the board of directors or as chair of a board committee. The 2018 Policy authorizes a reduction of a director’s fourth quarterly payment if a majority of disinterested directors determines that such director’s performance, ethical conduct or attendance is significantly deficient. Because we are a cooperative and only member institutions may own our stock, no director may receive equity-based compensation. The 2018 Policy provides that director fees are to be paid at the end of each quarter.





The following table summarizes the payment terms of the 2018 Policy as approved by the board of directors.
Position
 
Annual
Fee Limit (1)
 
Chair
 
$
135,000

(a)
Vice Chair
 
115,000

 
Audit Committee Chair
 
115,000

 
Finance/Budget Committee Chair
 
110,000

 
Human Resources Committee Chair
 
110,000

 
Technology Committee Chair
 
110,000

 
Affordable Housing Committee Chair
 
110,000

 
Risk Oversight Committee Chair
 
110,000

 
All other directors
 
100,000

 

(1) 
It has been the board of directors' practice not to appoint any director as more than one Committee Chair.
(a) 
For 2018, the Chair of our board of directors also serves as Chair of the Executive/Governance Committee and, like the other Committee Chairs, is eligible to receive $10,000 for serving as a Committee Chair. This amount is included in the Combined Annual Fee Limit.

Directors' Deferred Compensation Plan. In November 2015, we established the DDCP, effective January 1, 2016. The DDCP permits members of our board of directors to elect to defer all or a portion of the fees payable to them for a calendar year for their services as directors. We intend that the DDCP constitute a deferred compensation arrangement that complies with Section 409A of the IRC, as amended. Any duly elected and serving member of our board may become a participant in the DDCP. We make no matching contributions under the DDCP.

All contributions credited to a participant’s account will be invested in an irrevocable grantor trust ("Trust") established to provide for the Plan’s benefits. The DDCP is administered by an administrative committee appointed by our board, currently the HR Committee. The Trust will be maintained such that the DDCP at all times for purposes of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 will be unfunded and constitutes a mere promise by the Bank to make DDCP benefit payments in the future. Any rights created under the DDCP are unsecured contractual rights against the Bank. The Bank establishes an investment account for each participant under the Trust, which at all times remains an asset of the Bank, subject to claims of the Bank’s general creditors. The DDCP permits participants to allocate their investment account among investment options established by the HR Committee or the board. No above-market or preferential earnings are paid on any earnings under the DDCP. In general, a participant may elect to have his or her deferred compensation paid in a single lump sum payment, in annual installment payments over a period of two to five years, or in a combination of both such methods.





ITEM 12. SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS

The following table sets forth the beneficial ownership of our Class B common stock as of February 28, 2018, by each shareholder that beneficially owned more than 5% of the outstanding shares. Each shareholder named (with its parent holding company) has sole voting and investment power over the shares beneficially owned.
Name and Address of Shareholder
 
Number of Shares Owned
 
% Outstanding Shares
Flagstar Bank, FSB - 5151 Corporate Drive, Troy, MI
 
3,025,028

 
14.8
%
Lincoln National Life Insurance Company - 1300 S Clinton Street, Fort Wayne, IN
 
1,360,000

 
6.7
%
Jackson National Life Insurance Company - 1 Corporate Way, Lansing, MI
 
1,253,921

 
6.1
%
Chemical Bank - 333 E. Main Street, Midland, MI
 
1,101,720

 
5.4
%
Total
 
6,740,669

 
33.0
%

The majority of our directors are officers and/or directors of our financial institution members. The following table sets forth the financial institution members that have one of its officers and/or directors serving on our board of directors as of February 28, 2018.
Name of Member
 
Director Name
 
Number of Shares Owned by Member
 
% of Outstanding Shares
United Fidelity Bank, FSB
 
Ronald Brown
 
48,961

 
0.24
%
The Farmers Bank
 
Karen F. Gregerson
 
17,325

 
0.08
%
First State Bank
 
James D. MacPhee
 
2,346

 
0.01
%
Kalamazoo County State Bank
 
James D. MacPhee
 
3,090

 
0.02
%
United Bank of Michigan
 
Michael J. Manica
 
39,600

 
0.19
%
Home Bank SB
 
Dan L. Moore
 
20,526

 
0.10
%
First Savings Bank
 
Larry W. Myers
 
86,764

 
0.43
%
Monroe Bank & Trust
 
John L. Skibski
 
41,482

 
0.20
%
Mercantile Bank of Michigan
 
Thomas R. Sullivan
 
110,355

 
0.54
%
Bippus State Bank
 
Ryan M. Warner
 
7,875

 
0.04
%
Total
 
 
 
378,324

 
1.85
%

ITEM 13. CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE

We use acronyms and terms throughout this Item that are defined herein or in the Glossary of Terms.

Related Parties

We are a cooperative institution and owning shares of our Class B stock is generally a prerequisite to transacting business with us. As such, we are wholly-owned by financial institutions that are also our customers (with the exception of shares held by former members, or their legal successors, in the process of redemption). In addition, our directors may serve as officers and/or directors of our members, and we conduct our advances and AMA business almost exclusively with our members. Therefore, in the normal course of business, we extend credit to and purchase mortgage loans from members with officers or directors who may serve as our directors. However, such transactions are on substantially the same terms, including interest rates and collateral, as those prevailing at the time for comparable transactions with persons not related to our Bank (i.e., other members), and that do not involve more than the normal risk of collectability or present other unfavorable terms.

Also, in the normal course of business, some of our member directors and independent directors are officers of entities that may directly or indirectly participate in our AHP. All AHP transactions, however, including those involving (i) a member (or its affiliate) that owns more than 5% of the Bank's capital stock, (ii) a member with an officer or director who is a director of our Bank, or (iii) an entity with an officer, director or general partner who serves as a director of our Bank (and that has a direct or indirect interest in the AHP transaction), are subject to the same eligibility and other program criteria and requirements and the same Finance Agency regulations governing AHP operations.





We do not extend credit to or conduct other business transactions with our directors, executive officers or any of our other officers or employees. Executive officers may obtain loans under certain employee benefit plans but only on the same terms and conditions as are applicable to all employees who participate in such plans.

Related Transactions

We have a Code of Conduct that requires all directors, officers and employees to disclose any related party interests through ownership or family relationship. These disclosures are reviewed by our ethics officers and, where appropriate, our board of directors to determine the potential for a conflict of interest. In the event of a conflict, appropriate action is taken, which may include: recusal of a director from the discussion and vote on a transaction in which the director has a related interest; removal of an employee from a project with a related party vendor; disqualification of related vendors from transacting business with us; or requiring directors, officers or employees to divest their ownership interest in a related party. The Corporate Secretary and ethics officers maintain records of all related party disclosures, and there have been no transactions involving our directors, officers or employees that would be required to be disclosed herein.

Director Independence

General. As of the date of this Form 10-K, we have 17 directors: pursuant to the Bank Act, nine were elected or re-elected as member directors by our member institutions and eight were elected or re-elected as "independent directors" by our member institutions. None of our directors are "inside" directors, that is, none of our directors are employees or officers of our Bank. Further, our directors are prohibited from personally owning stock in our Bank. Each of the nine member directors, however, is a senior officer or director of an institution that is our member and is encouraged to engage in transactions with us on a regular basis.

Our board of directors is required to evaluate and report on the independence of our directors under two distinct director independence standards. First, Finance Agency regulations establish independence criteria for directors who serve as members of our Audit Committee. Second, SEC rules require that our board of directors applies the independence criteria of a national securities exchange or automated quotation system in assessing the independence of our directors.

Finance Agency Regulations Regarding Independence. The Finance Agency director independence standards prohibit an individual from serving as a member of our Audit Committee if he or she has one or more disqualifying relationships with our Bank or our management that would interfere with the exercise of his or her independent judgment. Relationships considered to be disqualifying by our board of directors are: employment with us at any time during the last five years; acceptance of compensation from us other than for service as a director; serving as a consultant, advisor, promoter, underwriter or legal counsel for our Bank at any time within the last five years; and being an immediate family member of an individual who is or who has been an Executive Officer within the past five years. Our board of directors assesses the independence of each director under the Finance Agency's independence standards, regardless of whether he or she serves on the Audit Committee. As of the date of this Form 10-K, each of our directors is "independent" under these criteria relating to disqualifying relationships.

SEC Rules Regarding Independence. SEC rules require our board of directors to adopt a standard of independence with which to evaluate our directors. Pursuant thereto, our board adopted the independence standards of the New York Stock Exchange ("NYSE") to determine which of our directors are "independent," which members of our Audit Committee are not "independent," and whether our Audit Committee's financial expert is "independent."

As noted above, some of our directors who are "independent" (as defined in and for purposes of the Bank Act) are employed by companies that may from time to time have (or seek to have) limited business relationships with our Bank due to those companies' participation in projects funded in part through our AHP. None of those companies, however, has, or within the past three most recently completed fiscal years had a relationship with us that resulted in payments to, or receipts from, the Bank in excess of the limits set forth in the NYSE independence standards. Moreover, any business relationship between those directors' respective companies and the Bank is established and conducted on the same terms and conditions provided to similarly-situated third parties. After applying the NYSE independence standards, our board determined that, as of the date of this Form 10-K, our eight directors (Mses. Decker and Narayanan and Messrs. Bradford, Hannigan, Liedholm, Logue, Long and Swank) who are "independent" directors, as defined in and for purposes of the Bank Act, are also independent under the NYSE standards.





Based upon the fact that each member director is a senior officer or director of an institution that is a member of our Bank (and thus the member is an equity holder in our Bank), that each such institution routinely engages in transactions with us (which may include advances, MPP and AHP transactions), and that such transactions occur frequently and are encouraged in the ordinary course of our business and our member institutions' respective businesses, our board of directors concluded for the present time that none of the member directors meet the independence criteria under the NYSE independence standards. It is possible that, under a strict reading of the NYSE objective criteria for independence (particularly the criterion regarding the amount of business conducted with our Bank by the director's institution), a member director could meet the independence standard on a particular day. However, because the amount of business conducted by a member director's institution may change frequently, and because we generally desire to increase the amount of business we conduct with each member institution, we believe it is inappropriate to draw distinctions among the member directors based upon the amount of business conducted with our Bank by any director's institution at a specific time.

Our board of directors has a standing Audit Committee comprised of seven directors (including the ex-officio member), five of whom are member directors and two of whom are "independent" directors (according to Bank Act director classifications established by HERA). For the reasons noted above, our board of directors determined that none of the current member directors on our Audit Committee are "independent" under the NYSE standards for audit committee members. However, our board of directors determined that the independent director who serves as Chair of the Audit Committee and is the Audit Committee Financial Expert under SEC rules, due primarily to his previous experience as an audit partner at a major public accounting firm, is "independent" under the NYSE independence standards for Audit Committee members.

SEC Rule Regarding Audit Committee Independence. The Exchange Act, as amended by HERA, requires the FHLBanks to comply with the substantive Audit Committee director independence rules applicable to issuers of securities pursuant to the rules of the Exchange Act. Those rules provide that, to be considered an independent member of an Audit Committee, the director may not be an affiliated person of the Exchange Act registrant. The term "affiliated person" means a person that directly, or indirectly through one or more intermediaries, controls, or is controlled by, or is under common control with, the registrant. The rule provides a "safe harbor," whereby a person will not be deemed an affiliated person if the person is not the beneficial owner, directly or indirectly, of more than 10% of any class of voting securities of the registrant. All of our Audit Committee member directors' institutions presently meet this safe harbor.

ITEM 14. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING FEES AND SERVICES

The following table sets forth the aggregate fees billed for the years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016 by our independent registered public accounting firm, PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP ($ amounts in thousands).
 
 
2017
 
2016
Audit fees
 
$
753

 
$
676

Audit-related fees
 
41

 
150

Tax fees
 

 

All other fees
 
1

 
6

Total fees
 
$
795

 
$
832


Audit fees were incurred for professional services rendered for the audits of our financial statements. Audit-related fees were incurred for certain FHLBank System assurance and related services, as well as fees related to PwC's participation at FHLBank conferences. All other fees were incurred for non-audit services for an annual license for PwC's disclosure software and other advisory services rendered.

We are exempt from all federal, state, and local taxation, except employment and real estate taxes. Therefore, no fees were paid for tax services during the years presented.

Our Audit Committee has adopted Independent Accountant Pre-approval Policies and Procedures ("Pre-approval Policy"). In accordance with the Pre-approval Policy and applicable law, on an annual basis, the Audit Committee reviews the list of specific services and projected fees for services to be provided for the next 12 months by our independent registered public accounting firm and pre-approves audit services, audit-related services, tax services and non-audit services, as applicable. Pre-approvals are valid until the end of the next calendar year, unless the Audit Committee specifically provides otherwise.





Under the Pre-approval Policy, the Audit Committee may delegate pre-approval authority to one or more of its members subject to a pre-approval fee limit. The Audit Committee has designated the Committee Chair as the member to whom such authority is delegated. Pre-approved actions by the Committee Chair as designee are reported to the Audit Committee at its next scheduled meeting. New services that have not been pre-approved by the Audit Committee that are in excess of the pre-approval fee level established by the Audit Committee must be presented to the entire Audit Committee for pre-approval.

ITEM 15. EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES

The exhibits to this Annual Report on Form 10-K are listed below.

EXHIBIT INDEX
Exhibit Number
 
Description
 
 
 
3.1*
 
 
 
 
3.2*
 
 
 
 
4*
 
 
 
 
10.1*+
 
 
 
 
10.2*+
 

 
 
 
10.3*
 
 
 
 
10.4*
 
 
 
 
10.5*+
 
 
 
 
10.6*+
 
 
 
 
10.7+
 
 
 
 
10.8*+
 

 
 
 
10.09*+
 

 
 
 
10.10+
 



Exhibit Number
 
Description
 
 
 
 
 
 
10.11*+
 

 
 
 
12
 
 
 
 
24
 
 
 
 
31.1
 
 
 
 
31.2
 
 
 
 
31.3
 
 
 
 
32
 
 
 
 
101.INS
 
XBRL Instance Document
 
 
 
101.SCH
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document
 
 
 
101.CAL
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document
 
 
 
101.LAB
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document
 
 
 
101.PRE
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document
 
 
 
101.DEF
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase Document

* These documents are incorporated by reference.

+ Management contract or compensatory plan or arrangement.





SIGNATURES
 
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

FEDERAL HOME LOAN BANK OF INDIANAPOLIS
 
 
/s/ CINDY L. KONICH
 
 
Cindy L. Konich
 
 
President - Chief Executive Officer
 
 
(Principal Executive Officer)
 
 
Date: March 9, 2018
 

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated below:
Signature
 
Title
 
Date
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ CINDY L. KONICH
 
President - Chief Executive Officer
 
March 9, 2018
Cindy L. Konich
 
 
 
 
(Principal Executive Officer)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ GREGORY L. TEARE
 
Executive Vice President - Chief Financial Officer
 
March 9, 2018
Gregory L. Teare
 
 
 
 
(Principal Financial Officer)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ K. LOWELL SHORT, JR.
 
Senior Vice President - Chief Accounting Officer
 
March 9, 2018
K. Lowell Short, Jr.
 
 
 
 
(Principal Accounting Officer)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ JAMES D. MACPHEE*
 
Chair of the board of directors
 
March 9, 2018
James D. MacPhee
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ DAN L. MOORE*
 
Vice Chair of the board of directors
 
March 9, 2018
Dan L. Moore
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ JONATHAN P. BRADFORD*
 
Director
 
March 9, 2018
Jonathan P. Bradford
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ RONALD BROWN*
 
Director
 
March 9, 2018
Ronald Brown
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ CHARLOTTE C. DECKER*
 
Director
 
March 9, 2018
Charlotte C. Decker
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ KAREN F. GREGERSON*
 
Director
 
March 9, 2018
Karen F. Gregerson
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ MICHAEL J. HANNIGAN, JR.*
 
Director
 
March 9, 2018
Michael J. Hannigan, Jr.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 



Signature
 
Title
 
Date
 
 
 
/s/ CARL E. LIEDHOLM*
 
Director
 
March 9, 2018
Carl E. Liedholm
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ JAMES L. LOGUE III*
 
Director
 
March 9, 2018
James L. Logue III
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ ROBERT D. LONG*
 
Director
 
March 9, 2018
Robert D. Long
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ MICHAEL J. MANICA*
 
Director
 
March 9, 2018
Michael J. Manica
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ LARRY W. MYERS*
 
Director
 
March 9, 2018
Larry W. Myers
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ CHRISTINE COADY NARAYANAN*
 
Director
 
March 9, 2018
Christine Coady Narayanan
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ JOHN L. SKIBSKI*
 
Director
 
March 9, 2018
John L. Skibski
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ THOMAS R. SULLIVAN*
 
Director
 
March 9, 2018
Thomas R. Sullivan
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ LARRY A. SWANK*
 
Director
 
March 9, 2018
Larry A. Swank
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ RYAN M. WARNER*
 
Director
 
March 9, 2018
Ryan M. Warner
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


* By:
/s/ K. LOWELL SHORT, JR.
 
 
K. Lowell Short, Jr., Attorney-In-Fact